United States      Office of Air Quality      EPA-450 3-80 007a
Environmental Protection  Planning and Standards     September 1980
Agency        Research Triangle Park NC 27711     „ ~
Air
Surface Coating of       Draft
Metal Furniture -         EIS
Background Information
for Proposed Standards

-------
                                    EPA-450/3-80-007a
Surface  Coating of Metal Furniture
      Background Information  for
            Proposed Standards
             Emission Standards and Engineering Division
            U S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
               Office of Air, Noise, and Radiation
             Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards
            Research Triangle Park, North Carolina 27711
                U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
                Region 5, Library (PL-12J)
                77 West Jackson Boulevard, 12th Floor
                Chicago, II 60604-3590

-------
This report has been reviewed by the Emission Standards and Engineering Division
of the Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards, EPA,  and approved for publication
Mention of trade names or commercial products is not intended to constitute endorsement
or recommendation for use.  Copies of this report are available through the Library
Services Office (MD-35), U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Research Triangle
Park, N.C. 27711, or from National Technical Information Services, 5285 Port Roval
Road, Springfield, Virginia 22161.
                       Publication No. EPA-450/3-80-007a
                    U.S. Environmental Protection Agency

-------
                    ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY

                        Background Information
                               and Draft
                    Environmental Impact Statement
                for Surface Coating of Metal Furniture

                             Prepared by:
Don R.  Goodwin                                                 (Date)
Director, Emission Standards and Engineering Division
U.  S.  Environmental Protection Agency
Research Triangle Park, NC  27711

1.    The proposed standards of performance would limit emissions of
     volatile organic compounds from new, modified, and reconstructed
     facilities for surface coating of metal furniture.  Section 111
     of the Clean Air Act (42 U.S.C. 7411), as amended, directs the
     Administrator to establish standards of performance for any
     category of new stationary source of air pollution which ". .  .
     causes or contributes significantly to air pollution which may
     reasonably be anticipated to endanger public health or welfare."
     The proposed standards of performance are expected to affect all
     regions of the nation.

2.    Copies of this document have been sent to the following Federal
     Departments:  Labor; Health and Human Services; Defense;
     Transportation; Agriculture; Commerce; Interior; and Energy; the
     National Science Foundation; and Council on Environmental Quality;
     to members of the State and Territorial Air Pollution Program
     Administrators (STAPPA) and the Association of Local Air Pollution
     Control Officials (ALAPCO); to EPA Regional Administrators; and to
     other interested parties.

3.    The comment period for review of this document is 60 days and is
     expected to begin on or about September 22, 1980.

4.    For additional information contact:

     Gene W. Smith
     Standards Development Branch (MD-13)
     U. S. Environmental Protection Agency
     Research Triangle Park, NC  27711
     telephone:  (919) 541-5421.

5.    Copies of this document may be obtained from:

     U. S. EPA Library (MD-35)
     Research Triangle Park, NC  27711

     National Technical Information Service
     5285 Port Royal Road
     Springfield, VA  22161
                                m

-------
                            TABLE OF CONTENTS

Section                                                             Page
1.0  Introduction	1-1
     1.1  Background and Authority for Standards	1-1
     1.2  Selection of Categories of Stationary Sources 	 1-4
     1.3  Procedure for Development of Standards of Performance .   . 1-6
     1.4  Consideration of Costs	1-8
     1.5  Consideration of Environmental Impacts	1-9
     1.6  Impact on Existing Sources	1-10
     1.7  Revision of Standards of Performance	1-11
     1.8  Executive Summary of Regulatory Alternative Impacts . .   .1-11
     1.9  Environmental Impact	1-12
     1.10 Economic Impact	1-12
2.0  The Metal Furniture Industry 	 2-1
     2.1  General Description 	 2-1
     2.2  Processes or Facilities and Their Emissions 	 2-2
          2.2.1  The Basic Process	2-2
     2.3  Baseline Emissions	2-11
          References for Chapter 2	2-13
3.0  Emission Control  Techniques	3-1
     3.1  Emission Control  Through Coating Formulation Changes. .   . 3-2
                                    IV

-------
Section                                                            ^S6-
          3.1.1  Powder Coatings	3-2
          3.1.2  High Solids Coatings	3-23
          3.1.3  Waterborne Coatings	3-35
     3.2  Emissions Control with Add-on Control  Equipment 	 3-44
          3.2.1  Carbon Adsorption	3-44
          3.2.2  Incineration	3-51
          3.2.3  Condensation	3-68
          3.2.4  Other Add-on Control Equipment and Process
                 Modification 	 3-74
     3.3  Control Efficiencies for Coating Formulation Changes. .  . 3-74
          3.3.1  Powder Coatings	3-77
          3.3.2  High Solids Coatings	3-77
          3.3.3  Waterborne Coatings	3-80
     3.4  Control Efficiencies for Add-on Control Equipment ....  3-82
          3.4.1  Carbon Adsorption	3-82
          3.4.2  Incineration	3-82
          3.4.3  Condensers	3-86
          References for Chapter 3	3-87
4.0  Modification and Reconstruction	4-1
     4.1  40 CFR 60 Provisions for Modification and Reconstruction.  4-1
          4.1.1  Definition of Modification 	  4-1
          4.1.2  Definition of Reconstruction 	4-2
     4.2  Applicability to Surface Coating of Metal Furniture  . .  .  4-2
          4.2.1  Modification Examples	4-3
          4.2.2  Examples  of Reconstruction 	  4-6

-------
Section                                                             Pa9e
5.0  Model Plants and Regulatory Alternatives  	  5-1
     5.1  Model Plants	5-1
          5.1.1  Spray Coating	5-1
          5.1.2  Dip Coating	5-2
          5.1.3  Flow Coating	5-14
     5.2  Regulatory Alternatives 	  5-14
          5.2.1  Add-on Control Equipment 	  5-21
          5.2.2  Coating Formulation Change 	  5-33
          References for Chapter 5	5-41
6.0  Environmental Impact 	  6-1
     6.1  Air  Pollution Impact	•	6-1
     6.2  Water Pollution Impact	6-7
     6.3  Solid Waste Impact	6-12
     6.4  Energy Impact-	6-15
     6.5  Other Environmental  Impacts  	  6-19
     6.6  Other Environmental  Concerns	6-19
          6.6.1  Irreversible  and Irretrievable Commitment of
                 Resources	6-19
          6.6.2  Environmental  Impact  of Delayed Standards	6-20
          References for Chapter 6	6-21
 7.0  Economic  Impact	7-1
     7.1  Industry Profile	7-1
          7.1.1   Industry Structure  	 7-1
          7.1.2   Trends in  Industry	7-8
          7.1.3   Industry Operating  Statistics	7-28
                                     VI

-------
Section
          7.1.4  Imports and Exports	7-31
          7.1.5  Projections of Affected Facilities 	  7-31
     7.2  Metal Furniture Analysis	7-35
          7.2.1  New Facilities	7-35
          7.2.2  Modified or Reconstructed Facilities 	  7-53
     7.3  Other Cost Considerations	7-74
          7.3.1  Water Treatment	7-74
          7.3.2  Solid Waste Disposal  	  7-74
          7.3.3  OSHA Requirements	7-75
          7.3.4  Regulatory Agency Manpower Requirements. .  .  .  7-75
     7.4  Economic Impact Assessment	7-75
          7.4.1  Introduction and Summary	7-75
          7.4.2  Industry Expansion 	  7-84
          7.4.3  Methodology	7-89
          7.4.4  Plant-Level Impact Analysis	7-91
          7.4.5  Industry Compliance Costs	7-130
     7.5  Aggregate Economic Impact Assessment	7-138
          7.5.1  Industry Structure and Concentration Effects .  7-139
          7.5.2  Employment Effects	7-139
          7.5.3  Balance of Trade Effects 	  7-140
          7.5.4  Inflationary Impact	7-140
          7.5.5  Energy  Impact	7-140
          7.5.6  Industry-wide Compliance Costs  	  7-141
          References for Chapter  7	7-149
                                     Vll

-------
Appendix A	'	   A-l
Appendix B	   B~l
Appendix C	   C-1
Appendix D	   D-!
Appendix E	   E-l
                                    vm

-------
                                 LIST OF FIGURES

Figure                                                               f^S6-
  2-1     Flow diagram - electrostatic spray coating  operation ...  2-7
  2-2     Flow diagram - dip coating operations	2-9
  2-3     Flow diagram - flow coating operations	2-10
  3-1     Electrostatic gun	3-12
  3-2     Powder spray booth equipped with powder recovery system.  .  3-14
  3-3     Flow diagram for a powder coating line	3-18
  3-4     Part coating in a fluidized bed of powder	3-20
  3-5     Schematic of high solids coating spray  equipment 	  3-29
  3-6     Static mixers	3-31
  3-7     Typical EDP coating system 	  3-42
  3-8     Carbon adsorption process	3-47
  3-9     Incinerator with a distributed burner	3-54
  3-10    Incinerator employing mixing plates	3-55
  3-11    Incinerator using a discrete burner	3-56
  3-12    Bake oven equipped with incinerator and heat recovery. .  .  3-59
  3-13    Inert gas drying system	3-61
  3-14    Schematic of a catalytic afterburner system	3-65
  3-15    Bake oven equipped with N2 condenser	3-71
  3-16    Effects of  temperature  and time	3-84
  3-17    Typical temperature - performance curve for various
          molecular species being oxidized over Pt/A!2Q3 catalyst. .  3-85

-------
Figure
—	                                                                Page

  5-1     Example automated spray coating lines with manual
          touch-up for flat metal furniture surfaces (Models
          A and C)	                                   .- _
                                     	b-3

  5-2     Example automated spray coating lines with manual
          touch-up for complex metal  furniture surfaces
          (Models B and D)	           5_4

  5-3     Example small  metal  furniture manual  spray coatinq
          nnes (Models E and  F)	     5-5

  5-4     Example metal  furniture dip coating  lines  for medium
          and  large plants  (Models G and H)	    .  .  .  .   5_12

  5-5     Example small  metal  furniture dip coating  line  (Model  I)  .   5-13

  5-6     Example metal  furniture flow  coating  line  (Model J)          5-13

  5-7      VOC control by incineration	5_34


  7-1     Irfn?Sr-1n numbers of establishments and employees in the
         Metal Furniture Household Furniture Industry  (SIC 2514)   .  7-18

  7"2     MT?SniJ-nUmrers of establishments and employees in the
         Metal Office Furniture  Industry (SIC 2522)  	  7_i8

 7-3     Trends  in numbers  of establishments and employees in the
         Public Building and Related  Furniture Industry (SIC 2531).  7-19

 7-4     Trends in numbers  of establishments and employees in the
         Metal Partitions  and Fixtures  Industry (SIC 2542)  ....  7-19

 7-5     Trends in the value of shipments for the Metal Household
         Furniture Industry (SIC 2514)  in current and constant
         dollars	       7-22

 7-6     Trends in the value of shipments for the Metal Office
         Furniture Industry (SIC 2522)  in current and constant
         dollars	     7-22

 7-7     Trends in the value of shipments for  the Public  Building
         and Related  Furniture Industry (SIC  2531) in  current and
         constant dollars	7_23

 7-8     Trends in the  value of shipments for  the Metal Partitions
         and Fixtures  Industry (SIC 2542) in current and  constant
         dollars	     7-23

 7-9     Percent  changes from  previous  year in  real  gross  national
         product  and constant  Metal Household Furniture Industry
         shipments  (SIC  2514)	.     7_26

-------
Figure                                                            Pa9e

  7-10     Percent changes from previous year in real gross
           national product and constant Metal Office Furniture
           Industry shipments (SIC 2522) 	 7-26

  7-11     Percent changes from previous year in real gross
           national product and constant Public Building and
           Related Furniture Industry shipments	7-27

  7-12     Percent changes from previous year in real gross
           national product and constant Metal Partitions
           and Fixtures Industry shipments (SIC 2542)	7-27

  7-13     Spray coating cost effectiveness	7-51

  7-14     Dip and flow coating cost effectiveness	7-52

-------
                          LIST OF TABLES
Table                                                               Page
 1-1     Matrix of Environmental  and Economic Impacts of the
         Proposed Surface Coating of Metal  Furniture Emission
         Limits	1-13
 2-1     Distribution of Establishments by  Employment Size	2-3
 2-2     Distribution of Establishments by  Paint Consumption. .  .  .  2-4
 3-1     Metal  Furniture Products Being Powder Coated 	  3-3
 3-2     Other Metal  Products Being Powder  Coated 	  3-5
 3-3     Powder Coating Resin Groups	3-7
 3-4     Advantages of Powder Coating When  Compared  to Organic
         Solvent-Based Coatings 	  3-8
 3-5     Disadvantages of Powder  Coatings When Compared to
         Organic Solvent-Based Coatings 	  3-9
 3-6     Overall Weight Percent of Powder Utilized	3-16
 3-7     Process Operating Parameters for Powder Coating Lines
         Using Electrostatic Spray	3-16
 3-8     Process Operating Parameters for Powder Coating Lines
         Using Fluidized Bed	3-22
 3-9     Metal  Furniture Products Being Coated With  High Solids  .  .  3-24
 3-10    Advantages for High Solids Coatings  When Compared to
         Organic Solvent-Based Coatings 	  3-26
 3-11    Disadvantages for High Solids Coatings When Compared
         to Organic Solvent-Based Coatings	3-27
 3-12    Process Operating Parameters for High Solids Coating
         Lines	3-33
                                 xn

-------
                                                                    Page
Table                                                               — *-
  3-13    Properties of Waterborne Coatings ............ 3~36

  3-14    Solids and Solvent Content of Waterborne Paints ..... 3-37

  3-15    Advantages of Waterborne Coating ............. 3-39

  3-16    Disadvantages of Waterborne Coating ........... 3-39

  3-17    Advantages of Employing Carbon Adsorbers ......... 3-49

  3-18    Disadvantages of Employing Carbon Adsorbers  ....... 3-49

  3-19    Percent of Total VOC Emissions from Various  Coating
          Steps  .......................... 3-50

  3-20    Problem Solvents for Carbon Adsorption .......... 3-50

  3-21    Process Operating  Parameters for Carbon Adsorbers
          Employed  to  Control VOC Emissions  ............ 3~b^
   3-22     Heat  Recovery  Equipment  and  Thermal  Energy  Recovery  .  .  .  3-58

   3-23     Advantages  of  Employing  Thermal  Incineration  as  a
           Control  Technique  ....................  3~b^
   3-24    Disadvantages  of Employing Thermal  Incineration as  a
           Control  Technique
   3-25    Process .Operating Parameters for a Thermal  Incinerator.  .  3-64

   3-26    Advantages of Employing Catalytic Incineration as a
           Control Technique ....................  3~67

   3-27    Disadvantages of Employing Catalytic Incineration as
           a Control Technique ...................  3~°'
   3-28    Process Operating Parameters for a Catalytic Incinerator. 3-69

   3-29    Advantage of Employing Condensation as a Control
           Technique ........................ 3~72

   3-30    Disadvantages of Employing Condensation as a Control
           Technique ........................ 3~72

   3-31    Process Operating Parameters for a Shell Tube Condenser  . 3-73

   3-32    Emission Reduction Via Powder Coatings .......... 3-78

   3-33    Control Efficiencies for High Solids Coatings ...... 3-79
                                      xm

-------
Tab1e                                                               Page
  3-34    Control Efficiencies for Water-Based Coatings 	  3-81
  3-35    Control Efficiencies for Add-On Air Pollution
          Control Equipment 	  ....  3-83
  4-1     Potential  Modification Examples 	  4-4
  5-1     Model  Plant A	5-6
  5-2     Model  Plant B	5-7
  5-3     Model  Plant C	5-8
  5-4     Model  Plant D	5-9
  5-5     Model  Plant E	5-10
  5-6     Model  Plant F	5-11
  5-7     Model  Plant G	5-15
  5-8     Model  Plant H	5-16
  5-9     Model  Plant I	5-17
  5-10    Model  Plant J	5-19
  5-11    Regulatory Alternative Summary for Each Model Plant .  .  .  5-22
  5-12    Emission Reduction for Model Plant A - Large Spray
          Coating Facility for Flat Metal Furniture Surfaces. .  .  .  5-23
  5-13    Emission Reduction for Model Plant B - Large Spray
          Coating Facility for Complex Metal Furniture Surfaces  .  .  5-24
  5-14    Emission Reduction for Model Plant C - Medium Size
          Spray Coating Facility for Flat Metal Furniture
          Surfaces	5-25
  5-15    Emissions  Reduction for Model Plant D - Medium Size
          Spray Coating Facility for Complex Metal Furniture
          Surfaces	5-26
  5-16    Emission Reduction for Model Plant E - Small Spray
          Coating Facility for Flat Metal Furniture Surfaces. .  .  .  5-27
  5-17    Emission Reduction for Model Plant F - Small Spray
          Coating Facility for Complex Metal Furniture Surfaces  .  .  5-28
  5-18    Emission Reduction for Model Plant G - Large Dip
          Coating Facility for Metal Furniture	5-29
                                     xiv

-------
Table
 5-19     Emission Reduction for Model Plant H - Medium Size
          Dip Coating Facility for Metal Furniture
 5-20     Emission Reduction for Model Plant I - Small Dip
          Coating Facility for Metal Furniture
 5-21     Emission Reduction for Model Plant J - Small Flow
          Coating Facility for Metal Furniture
 5-22     Process Parameters for Model Plants Applying
          Powder Coatings ......................
 5-23     Process Parameters for Model Plants Applying
          High Solids Coatings  ...................
 5-24     Process Parameters for Model Plants Applying
          Waterborne Coatings ....................
 6-1      Emission  Estimates for Spray Coating  Employing
          Regulatory Alternatives ..................  b"^
 6-2      Emission  Estimates for Dip  Coating  Employing
          Regulatory Alternatives ..................  b~J
 6-3      Emission  Estimates  for  Flow Coating Employing
          Regulatory Alternatives ..................  b'4
 6-4      Quality of Water Discharge  ................  6"8
  6-5      Qualitative  Analysis for Water Usage at Model Plant A. .  .  6-10
  6-6       Qualitative  Analysis for Pollutant Discharge Rates in
           Water Effluents Versus  Coating Formulation Changes ....  6-11
  6-7      Solid Waste  Estimates for Model Plants ..........  6-13
  6-8      Energy Consumption Estimates for Model Plants .......  6-16
  6-9      Qualitative Analysis of Energy Consumption on a Coating
           Line ...........................  6~17
  6-10     Projections of Energy Consumption for Each Regulatory
           Alternative ........................  6"18
  7-1      Metal Furniture Manufacturing  Industry, 1976-1977 .....  7-2
  7-2      Concentration  Ratios in Metal  Furniture Manufacturing. . .  7-4
  7-3      Percent  of Value of  Industry  Shipment  in Metal  Furniture
           Manufacturing  Made by Multi-Unit and Single-Unit
           Companies, 1972 ...................... 7~5
                                    xv

-------
Table                          •                                     Page
 7-4      Distribution of Establishments in the Metal  Furniture
          Manufacturing Industry  by Firm Size, 1972	7-6
 7-5      Legal Form of Organization for Metal Furniture
          Manufacturers, 1972	7-7
 7-6      Geographic Distribution of Metal Furniture
          Establishments, 1976	7-9
 7-7      Metal Furniture Product Mix, 1963-1967	7-11
 7-8      1977 Product Breakdown  for Metal Household
          Furniture (SIC 2514)	7-12
 7-9      1977 Product Breakdown  for Metal Office Furniture
          (SIC 2522)	7-14
 7-10     1977 Product Breakdown  for Public Building and
          Related Furniture (SIC  2531)	7-16
 7-11     Capacity Utilization Rates - Fourth Quarters, 1977
          and 1976	7-17
 7-12     Number of Establishments and Employees in Metal
          Furniture Manufacturing Industry, 1958-1977  	  7-20
 7-13     Industry Shipments for Metal Furniture Manufacturing
          in Current and Constant Dollars, 1967-1977	7-24
 7-14     Percent Changes from Previous Year  in Real Gross National
          Product and Constant Metal Furniture Manufacturing
          Industry Shipments	7-25
 7-15     Labor and Materials Costs in Metal  Furniture Manfacturing
          Relative to Value of Industry Shipments  	  7-29
 7-16     Metal Furniture Coating Materials Costs Versus Total
          Materials Costs and Value of Shipments, 1972 and 1967  . .  7-30
 7-17     Profit Before Taxes for Total Assets for Household
          Furniture Manufacturers  	  7-32
 7-18     Profit Before Taxes over Total  Assets for Metal Office
          Furniture Manufacturers and Business and Institutional
          Furniture Manufacturers  	 7-33
 7-19     Calculation of Total Affected Facilities, 1980-1985  .  . .  7-36
 7-20     Control Costs Parameters	  7-39
                                   xvn

-------
Table

 7-21     Basis for Control Costs	7-40

 7-22     Control Costs for Model Plant A - Large Spray Coating
          Facility for Flat Metal Furniture Surfaces	7-41

 7-23     Control Costs for Model Plant B - Large Spray Coating
          Facility for Complex Metal Furniture Surfaces 	 7-42

 7-24     Control Costs for Model Plant C - Medium Size Spray
          Coating Facility for Flat Metal Furniture Surfaces.  .  . 7-43

 7-25     Control Costs for Model Plant D - Medium Size Spray
          Coating Facility for Complex Metal Furniture Surfaces  . 7-44

 7-26     Control Costs for Model Plant E - Small Spray Coating
          Facility for Flat Metal Furniture Surfaces	7-45

 7-27     Control Costs for Model Plant F - Small Spray Coating
          Facility for Complex Metal Furniture Surfaces 	 7-46

 7-28     Control Costs for Model Plant G - Large Dip Coating
          Facility for Metal Furniture	7-47

 7-29     Control Costs for Model Plant H - Medium Dip Coating
          Facility for Metal Furniture	7-48

 7-30     Control Costs for Model Plant I - Small Dip Coating
          Facility for Metal Furniture	7-49

 7-31     Control Costs for Model Plant J - Small Flow Coating
          Facility for Metal Furniture	7-50

 7-32     Plant  A -  Incremental  Control Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level Facilities 	 7-54

 7-33     Plant  B -  Incremental  Control Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level Facilities 	 7-55

 7-34     Plant  C -  Incremental  Control Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level Facilities	7-56

 7-35     Plant  D -  Incremental  Control Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level Facilities	7-57

 7-36     Plant  E -  Incremental  Control Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level Facilities	7-58

 7-37     Plant  F -  Incremental  Control Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level Facilities 	 7-59
                                   xvn

-------
Table                          •                                     Page

 7-38     Plant G - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level  Facilities	7-60

 7-39     Plant H - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP level  Facilities	7-61

 7-40     Plant I - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level  Facilities	7-62

 7-41     Plant J - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of SIP Level  Facilities	7-63

 7-42     Plant A - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-64

 7-43     Plant B - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-65

 7-44     Plant C - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-66

 7-45     Plant D - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-67

 7-46     Plant E - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-68

 7-47     Plant F - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-69

 7-48     Plant G - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-70

 7-49     Plant H - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-71

 7-50     Plant I - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-72

 7-51     Plant J - Incremental  Control  Costs for Reconstruction
          of Uncontrolled Facilities	7-73

 7-52     Model Shelving Plants  	 7-77

 7-53     Model Chair Plants	7-77

 7-54     Summary of Major Impacts Shelving Plants	7-79

 7-55     Summary of Major Impacts Chair Plants	 7-80

 7-56     Model Shelving and Chair Plants 	 7-90

                                    xviii

-------
Table

 7-57     Profit Impact Shelving Plants - New Facilities
          SIP Baseline
                                                                     7'93
 7-58     Profit Impact Shelving Plants - New Facilities
          Uncontrolled Baseline ...................  7-94

 7-59     Profit Impact Shelving Plants Modified/Reconstructed
          Facilities SIP Baseline ..................  7-95

 7-60     Profit Impact Shelving Plants Modified/Reconstructed
          Facilities Uncontrolled Baseline .............  7-96

 7-61     Profit Impact Chair Plants - New Facilities
          SIP Baseline .......................  7-97

 7-62     Profit Impact Chair Plants - New Facilities
          Uncontrolled Baseline ...................  7-99

 7-63     Profit Impact Chair Plants - Modified/Reconstructed-
          Facilities SIP Baseline ..................  7-101

 7-64     Profit Impact Chair Plants - Modified/Reconstructed
          Facilities Uncontrolled Baseline .............  7-103

 7-65     Profit Impairment Shelving Plants - New Facilities
          SIP and Uncontrolled Baseline ...............  7-108

 7-66     Profit Impairment Shelving Plants - Modified/Recon-
          structed Facilities SIP and Uncontrolled Baselines ....  7-109

 7-67     Profit Impairment Chair Plants - New Facilities
          SIP and Uncontrolled Baselines ..............  7-110

 7-68     Profit Impairment Chair Plants - Modified/Recon-
          structed Facilities SIP and Uncontrolled Baselines ....  7-112

 7-69     DCF Analysis for Determining General Criteria for
          Major Profit Impairment ..................  7-115

 7-70     Estimated Assets for Model Plants .............  7-119

 7-71     Incremental Capital Costs for New Facilities  .......  7-120

 7-72     Incremental Capital Costs for Modified/Reconstructed
          Facilities  ........................  7-122

 7-73     Capital Availability Impact for New Facilities  ......  7-124

 7-74     Capital Availability Impact for Modified/Reconstructed
          Facilities  ........................  7-126
                                     xix

-------
Table                                                                Page

 7-75     Cash Flow to Current Maturities of Long-Term Debt
          Analysis	7-128

 7-76     Representative Combinations of Regulatory Alternatives
          Covering the Ten Types of Model Plants 	  7-132

 7-77     Distribution of Lines in Coating Method Categories
          by Size of Plant Involved	7-133

 7-78     Surface Area Coated per Year by Projected New and
          Replacement Lines	7-135

 7-79     Incremental Annualized Control Cost per Thousand
          Square Meters Coated New Facilities - SIP Baseline ....  7-136

 7-80     Incremental Annualized Control Cost.per Thousand
          Square Meters Coated Modified/Reconstructed
          Facilities - SIP Baseline	7-137

 7-81     Inflation Impact Shelving Plants 	  7-142

 7-82     Inflation Impact Chair Plants	7-143

 7-83     Incremental Energy Use per Line per Day-SIP Baseline . .  .  7-145

 7-84     Incremental Energy Use per Line per Day-Uncontrolled
          Baseline	7-146
                                   xx

-------
                             1.   INTRODUCTION

1.1   BACKGROUND AND AUTHORITY FOR STANDARDS
     Before standards of performance are proposed as a Federal  regulation,
air pollution control methods available to the affected industry and the
associated costs of installing and maintaining the control  equipment are
examined in detail.  Various levels of control based on different technolo-
gies and degrees of efficiency are expressed as regulatory alternatives.
Each of these alternatives is studied by EPA as a prospective basis for a
standard.   The alternatives are investigated in terms of their impacts on
the economics and well-being of the industry, the impacts on the national
economy, and the impacts on the environment.  This document summarizes the
information obtained through these studies so that interested persons will
be privy to the information considered by EPA in the development of the
proposed standard.
     Standards of performance for new stationary sources are established
under Section 111 of the Clean Air Act (42 U.S.C. 7411) as amended, herein-
after referred to as the Act.  Section 111 directs the Administrator to
establish standards of performance for any category of new stationary
source of air pollution which "... causes, or contributes significantly
to air pollution which may reasonably be anticipated to endanger public
health or welfare."
     The Act requires that standards of performance for stationary sources
reflect, "... the degree of emission reduction achievable which (taking
into consideration the cost of achieving such emission reduction, and any
nonair quality health and environmental impact and energy requirements) the
Administrator determines has been adequately demonstrated for that category
of sources."  The  standards apply only to stationary sources, the construc-
tion or modification of which commences after regulations are proposed by
publication in the Federal Register.

-------
     The 1977 amendments to the Act altered or added numerous provisions
that apply to the process of establishing standards of performance.
     1.   EPA is required to list the categories of major stationary sources
that have not already been listed and regulated under standards of perfor-
mance.   Regulations must be promulgated for these new categories on the
following schedule:
     a.    25 percent of the listed categories by August 7, 1980.
     b.    75 percent of the listed categories by August 7, 1981.
     c.    100 percent of the listed categories by August 7, 1982.
A governor of a State may apply to the Administrator to add a category not
on the list or may apply to the Administrator to have a standard of perfor-
mance revised.
     2.   EPA is required to review the standards of performance every
4 years and, if appropriate, revise them.
     3.   EPA is authorized to promulgate a standard based on design, equip-
ment, work practice, or operational procedures when a standard based on
emission levels is not feasible.
     4.   The term  "standards of performance" is redefined, and a new term
"technological system of continuous emission reduction" is defined.  The new
definitions clarify that the control system must be continuous and may
include a low- or  non-polluting process or operation.
     5.   The time  between the proposal and promulgation of a standard under
section 111 of the Act may be extended to 6 months.
     Standards of  performance, by themselves, do not guarantee protection
of health or welfare because they are not designed to achieve any specific
air quality levels.  Rather, they are designed to reflect the degree of
emission limitation achievable through application of the best adequately
demonstrated technological system of continuous emission reduction, taking
into consideration the cost of achieving such emission reduction, any
nonair-quality health and environmental impacts, and energy requirements.
     Congress had  several reasons for including these requirements. First,
standards with a degree of uniformity are needed to avoid situations where
some States may attract industries by relaxing standards relative to other
States.  Second, stringent standards enhance the potential for  long-term
                                  1-2

-------
growth.   Third,  stringent standards may help achieve long-term cost savings
by avoiding the  need for more expensive retrofitting when pollution ceilings
may be reduced in the future. Fourth,  certain types of standards for coal-
burning sources  can adversely affect the coal market by driving up the
price of low-sulfur coal or effectively excluding certain coals from the
reserve base because their untreated pollution potentials are high.  Con-
gress does not intend that new source performance standards contribute to
these problems.   Fifth, the standard-setting process should create incen-
tives for improved technology.
     Promulgation of standards of performance does not prevent State or
local agencies from adopting more stringent emission limitations for the
same sources.  States are free under Section 116 of the Act to establish
even more stringent emission limits than those established under Section 111
or those necessary to attain or maintain the National Ambient Air Quality
Standards (NAAQS) under Section 110.  Thus, new sources may in some cases
be subject to limitations more stringent than standards of performance
under Section 111, and prospective owners and operators of new sources
should be aware of this possibility in planning for such facilities.
     A similar situation may arise when a major emitting facility  is to be
constructed  in a geographic area that falls under the prevention of signi-
ficant deterioration of air quality provisions of Part C of the Act.  These
provisions require, among other things, that major emitting facilities to
be constructed in such areas are to be subject to best available control
technology.  The term Best Available Control Technology (BACT), as defined
in the Act,  means
          ...  an emission  limitation based on the maximum degree of
          reduction of each pollutant subject to regulation under
          this Act emitted from, or which results from, any major
          emitting facility, which the permitting authority, on a
          case-by-case basis, taking into account energy, environ-
          mental, and economic impacts and other costs, determines is
          achievable for such facility through application of produc-
          tion processes and available methods, systems, and techniques,
          including fuel cleaning or treatment or innovative fuel
          combustion techniques for control of each such pollutant.
          In no event shall  application of  'best available control
          technology' result in emissions of any pollutants which
          will exceed the emissions allowed by any applicable standard
          established pursuant to Sections  111 or 112 of this Act.
          (Section 169(3))
                                  1-3

-------
     Although standards of performance are normally structured in terms of
numerical  emission limits where feasible,  alternative approaches are some-
times necessary.   In some cases physical  measurement of emissions from a
new source may be impractical  or exorbitantly expensive.   Section lll(h)
provides that ^ >e Administrator may promulgate a design or equipment stan-
dard in those cases where it is not feasible to prescribe or enforce a
standard of performance.   For example, emissions of hydrocarbons from
storage vessels for petroleum liquids are greatest during tank filling.
The nature of the emissions, high concentrations for short periods during
filling and low concentrations for longer periods during storage, and the
configuration of storage tanks make direct emission measurement impractical.
Therefore, a more practical approach to standards of performance for storage
vessels has been equipment specification.
     In addition, Section Hl(j) authorizes the Administrator to grant
waivers of compliance to permit a source to use innovative continuous
emission control  technology.  In order to grant the waiver, the Admini-
strator must find:  (1) a substantial likelihood that the technology will
produce greater emission reductions than the standards require or an equi-
valent reduction at lower economic energy or environmental cost; (2) the
proposed system has not been adequately demonstrated; (3) the technology
will not cause or contribute to an unreasonable risk to the public health,
welfare, or safety; (4) the governor of the State where the source is
located consents; and  (5) the waiver will not prevent the attainment or
maintenance of any ambient  standard.  A waiver may have conditions attached
to assure the source will not prevent attainment of any NAAQS.  Any such
condition will have the force of a performance standard.  Finally, waivers
have definite end dates and may be terminated earlier if the conditions are
not met or if the system fails to perform as expected.  In such a case, the
source may be given up to 3 years to meet the standards with a mandatory
progress  schedule.
1.2  SELECTION OF CATEGORIES OF STATIONARY SOURCES
     Section  111  of the Act directs the Adminstrator to list categories of
stationary sources.  The Administrator "... shall  include a category
                                  1-4

-------
of sources in such list if in his judgement it causes,  or contributes
significantly to, air pollution which may reasonably be anticipated to
endanger public health or welfare."  Proposal  and promulgation of standards
of performance are to follow.
     Since passage of the Clean Air Amendments of 1970, considerable
attention has been given to the development of a system for assigning
priorities to various source categories.   The  approach  specifies areas of
interest by considering the broad strategy of  the Agency for implementing
the Clean Air Act.  Often, these "areas"  are actually pollutants emitted by
stationary sources.   Source categories that emit these  pollutants are
evaluated and ranked by a process involving such factors as:   (1) the level
of emission control  (if any) already required  by State  regulations, (2) esti-
mated levels of control that might be required from standards of performance
for the source category, (3) projections  of growth and  replacement of
existing facilities for the source category, and (4) the estimated incremental
amount of air pollution that could be prevented in a preselected future
year by standards of performance for the  source category.  Sources for
which new source performance standards were promulgated or under development
during 1977, or earlier, were selected on these criteria.
     The Act amendments of August 1977 establish specific criteria to be
used in determining priorities for all major source categories not yet
listed by EPA.  These are:  (1) the quantity of air pollutant emissions
that each such category will emit, or will be  designed  to emit; (2) the
extent to which each such pollutant may reasonably be anticipated to endan-
ger public health or welfare; and (3) the mobility and  competitive nature
of each such category of sources and the  consequent need for nationally
applicable new source standards of performance.
     The Administrator is to promulgate standards for these categories
according to the schedule referred to earlier.
     In some cases it may not be feasible immediately to develop a standard
for a source category with a high priority.  This might happen when a
program of research is needed to develop  control techniques or because
techniques for sampling and measuring emissions may require refinement.  In
the developing of standards, differences  in the time required to complete
                                  1-5

-------
the necessary investigation for different source categories must also be
considered.  For example, substantially more time may be necessary if
numerous pollutants must be investigated from a single source category.
Further, even late in the development process the schedule for completion
of a standard may change.  For example, inablility to obtain emission data
from well-controlled sources in time to pursue the development process in a
systematic fashion may force a change in scheduling.   Nevertheless, priority
ranking is, and will continue to be, used to establish the order in which
projects are initiated and resources assigned.
     After the source category has been chosen, the types of facilities
within the source category to which the standard will apply must be deter-
mined.  A source category may have several facilities that cause air pollu-
tion, and emissions from some of these facilities may vary from insignificant
to very expensive to control.  Economic studies of the source category and
of applicable control technology may show that air pollution control is
better served by applying standards to the more severe pollution sources.
For this reason, and because there is no adequately demonstrated system for
controlling emissions from certain facilities, standards often do not apply
to all facilities at a source.  For the same reasons,  the standards may not
apply to all air pollutants emitted.  Thus, although a source category may
be selected to be covered by a standard of performance, not all pollutants
or facilities within that source category may be covered by the standards.
1.3  PROCEDURE FOR DEVELOPMENT OF STANDARDS OF PERFORMANCE
     Standards of performance must (1) realistically reflect best demon-
strated control practice; (2) adequately consider the cost, the nonair-
quality health and environmental impacts, and the energy requirements of
such control; (3) be applicable to existing sources that are modified or
reconstructed as well as new installations; and (4) meet these conditions
for all variations of operating conditions being considered anywhere in the
country.
     The objective of a program for developing standards is to identify the
best technological system of continuous emission reduction that has been
adequately demonstrated.  The standard-setting process involves three
principal phases of activity:  (1) information gathering, (2) analysis of
the information, and (3) development of the standard of performance.

                                  1-6

-------
     During the information-gathering phase, industries are queried through
a telephone survey, letters of inquiry,  and plant visits by EPA representa-
tives.   Information is also gathered from many other sources to provide
reliable data that characterize the pollutant emissions from well-controlled
existing facilities.
     In the second phase of a project, the information about the industry
and the pollutants emitted is used in analytical studies.   Hypothetical
"model  plants" are defined to provide a common basis for analysis.   The
model plant definitions, national pollutant emission data, and existing
State regulations governing emissions from the source category are then
used in establishing "regulatory alternatives."  These regulatory alterna-
tives are essentially different levels of emission control.
     EPA conducts studies to determine the impact of each regulatory alterna-
tive on the economics of the industry and on the national  economy, on the
environment, and on energy consumption.   From several possibly applicable
alternatives, EPA selects the single most plausible regulatory alternative
as the basis for a standard of performance for the source category under
study.
     In the third phase of a project, the selected regulatory alternative
is translated into a standard of performance, which, in turn, is written in
the form of a Federal regulation.  The Federal regulation, when applied to
newly constructed plants, will limit emissions to the levels indicated in
the selected regulatory alternative.
     As early as is practical in each standard-setting project, EPA represen-
tatives discuss the possibilities of a standard and the form it might take
with members of the National Air Pollution Control Techniques Advisory
Committee.  Industry representatives and other interested parties also
participate in these meetings.
     The information acquired in the project is summarized in the Background
Information Document (BID).  The BID, the standard, and a preamble explaining
the standard are widely circulated to the industry being considered for
control, environmental groups, other government agencies, and offices
within EPA.  Through this extensive review process, the points of view of
expert reviewers are taken into consideration as changes are made to the
documentation.
                                  1-7

-------
     A "proposal package" is a-ssembled and sent through the offices of EPA
Assistant Administrators for concurrence before the proposed standard is
officially endorsed by the EPA Administrator.   After being approved by the
EPA Administrator, the preamble and the proposed regulation are published
in the Federal Register.
     As a part of the Federal Register announcement of the proposed regula-
tion, the public is invited to participate in the standard-setting process.
EPA invites written comments on the proposal  and also holds a public hearing
to discuss the proposed standard with interested parties.  All public comments
are summarized and incorporated into a second volume of the BID.   All
information reviewed and generated in studies in support of the standard of
performance is available to the public in a "docket" on file in Washington,
D. C.
     Comments from the public are evaluated,  and the standard of performance
may be altered in response to the comments.
     The significant comments and EPA's position on the issues raised are
included in the "preamble" of a "promulgation package," which also contains
the draft of the final regulation.   The regulation is then subjected to
another round of review and refinement until  it is approved by the EPA
Administrator.  After the Administrator signs the regulation, it is published
as a "final rule" in the Federal Register.
1.4  CONSIDERATION OF COSTS
     Section 317 of the Act requires an economic impact assessment with
respect to any standard of performance established under Section 111 of the
Act.   The assessment is required to contain an analysis of:  (1) the costs
of compliance with the regulation,  including the extent to which the cost
of compliance varies depending on the effective date of the regulation and
the development of less expensive or more efficient methods of compliance;
(2) the potential inflationary or recessionary effects of the regulation;
(3) the effects the regulation might have on small business with respect to
competition; (4) the effects of the regulation on consumer costs; and (5)
the effects of the regulation on energy use.  Section 317 also requires that
the economic impact assessment be as extensive as practicable.
                                  1-8

-------
     The economic impact of a proposed standard upon an industry is usually
addressed both in absolute terms and in terms of the control  costs that
would be incurred as a result of compliance with typical,  existing State
control regulations.  An incremental approach is necessary because both new
and existing plants would be required to comply with State regulations in
the absence of a Federal standard of performance.   This approach requires a
detailed analysis of the economic impact from the cost differential that
would exist between a proposed standard of performance and the typical
State standard.
     Air pollutant emissions may cause water pollution problems, and cap-
tured potential  air pollutants may pose a solid waste disposal problem. The
total environmental impact of an emission source must, therefore, be ana-
lyzed and the costs determined whenever possible.
     A thorough study of the profitability and price-setting mechanisms of
the industry is essential to the analysis so that an accurate estimate of
potential adverse economic impacts can be made for proposed standards.  It
is also essential to know the capital requirements for pollution control
systems already placed on plants so that the additional capital requirements
necessitated by these Federal standards can be placed in proper perspective.
Finally, it is necessary to assess the availability of capital to provide
the additional control equipment needed to meet the standards of performance.
1.5  CONSIDERATION OF ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS
     Section 102(2)(C) of the National Environmental Policy Act (NEPA) of
1969 requires Federal agencies to prepare detailed environmental impact
statements on proposals for legislation and other major Federal actions
significantly affecting the quality of the human environment.  The objective
of NEPA is to build into the decisionmaking process of Federal agencies a
careful consideration of all environmental aspects of proposed actions.
     In a number of legal challenges to standards of performance for various
industries, the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia
Circuit has held that environmental impact statements need not be prepared
by the Agency for proposed actions under Section 111 of the Clean Air Act.
Essentially, the Court of Appeals has determined that the best system of
emission reduction requires the Administrator to take into account counter-
                                  1-9

-------
productive environmental effects of a proposed standard, as well as economic
costs to the industry.  On this basis, therefore, the Court established a
narrow exemption from NEPA for EPA determination under Section 111.
     In addition to these judicial determinations, the Energy Supply and
Environmental Coordination Act (ESECA) of 1974 (PL-93-319) specifically
exempted proposed actions under the Clean Air Act from NEPA requirements.
According to Section 7(c)(l), "No action taken under the Clean Air Act
shall be deemed a major Federal action significantly affecting the quality
of the human environment within the meaning of the National Environmental
Policy Act of 1969" (15 U.S.C. 793(c)(l)).
     Nevertheless, the Agency has concluded that the preparation of environ-
mental impact statements could have beneficial effects on certain regulatory
actions.   Consequently, although not legally required to do so by
Section 102(2)(C) of NEPA, EPA has adopted a policy requiring that environ-
mental impact statements be prepared for various regulatory actions, including
standards of performance developed under Section 111 of the Act.   This
voluntary preparation of environmental impact statements, however, in no
way legally subjects the Agency to NEPA requirements.
     To implement this policy, a separate section in this document is
devoted solely to an analysis of the potential environmental  impacts asso-
ciated with the proposed standards.   Both adverse and beneficial  impacts in
such areas as air and water pollution, increased solid waste  disposal, and
increased energy consumption are discussed.
1.6  IMPACT ON EXISTING SOURCES
     Section 111 of the Act defines a new source as ".  .  .  any stationary
source, the construction or modification of which is commenced ..." after
the proposed standards are published.   An existing source is  redefined as  a
new source if "modified" or "reconstructed"  as defined in amendments to the
general provisions of Subpart A of 40 CFR Part 60, which were promulgated
in the Federal  Register on December 16, 1975 (40 FR 58416).
     Promulgation of a standard of performance requires States to establish
standards of performance for existing sources in the same industry under
Section 111 (d) of the Act if the standard for new sources limits emissions
of a designated pollutant (i.e.,  a pollutant for which air quality criteria
                                  1-10

-------
have not been issued under Section 108 or which has not been listed as a
hazardous pollutant under Section 112).  If a State does not act, EPA must
establish such standards.  General provisions outlining procedures for
control of existing sources under Section lll(d) were promulgated on
November 17, 1975, as Subpart B of 40 CFR Part 60 (40 FR 53340).
1.7  REVISION OF STANDARDS OF PERFORMANCE
     Congress was aware that the level of air pollution control achievable
by any industry may improve with technological advances.  Accordingly,
Section 111 of the Act provides that the Administrator "... shall, at
least every 4 years, review and, if appropriate, revise ..." the standards.
Revisions are made to assure that the standards continue to reflect the
best systems that become available in the future.   Such revisions will not
be retroactive, but will apply to stationary sources constructed or modified
after the proposal of the revised standards.
1.8  EXECUTIVE SUMMARY OF REGULATORY ALTERNATIVE IMPACTS
     Chapter 5 of this BID describes the selected regulatory alternatives.
The bases of selection of these regulatory alternatives are presented in
Chapters 2 through 4 of this document.  Chapters 5,  6, and 7 contain infor-
mation pertaining to the environmental and economic impacts for each of the
regulatory alternatives, respectively.  The regulatory alternatives selected
for controlling volatile organic compounds (VOCs) from surface coating of
metal furniture are:
 Regulatory
alternatives
     I
    II
   III
    IV
Typical control option
(a) SIP - 60 percent
  solids coating
(b) 60 to 70 percent
  solids coating
(c) SIPs and Inciner-
  ation
(d) Waterborne coatings
(e) Waterborne (electro-
  deposition)
(f) Powder
Additional emission
  reduction from
  SIPs (percent)
    Baseline 0
        30
     30 to 50

        50

        85
      slOO
Control options
    to meet
  regulatory
  alternative
(a) through (f)

(a) through (f)
(c),  (d),  (e),
  and (f)
(e) and (f)
                                  1-11

-------
     The environmental  and economic impacts of each regulatory alternative
are summarized in the next two sections.
1.9  ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT
                                                   V
     A summary of the environmental impacts for each regulatory alternative
is contained in Table 1-1.   These impacts are detailed in Chapter 6 of this
BID.   The most oeneficial regulatory alternative from an environmental
impact standpoint is Number IV.
1.10  ECONOMIC IMPACT
     None of the regulatory alternatives  cause an irreversible economic
impact upon the metal furniture industry.   However, the higher the emission
reduction requirements  (Regulatory Alternative III and IV), the more costly
it becomes for the industry to comply.
                                  1-12

-------
Table  1-1.   MATRIX OF ENVIRONMENTAL AND ECONOMIC  IMPACTS OF THE
  PROPOSED SURFACE COATING  OF METAL FURNITURE EMISSION LIMITS
\Impact
Control \
option (regu- \
latory alter- \ Water Solid
native) \ Air pollution waste Energy Noise
Powder,
electrostatic +4** +3** +2* +3** n
spray (Regulatory
Alternative IV)
Infla-
Economic tionary
+1** to +1** to
-2** -2**
Powder,
fluidized bed „„ y* _„»» „„ „, ^
(Regulatory +4+3^+2 032
Alternative IV)
Waterborne,
Electrostatic Spray -*» ,* ,« -»* Q „** *
(Regulatory Alter- J ^ l * u £ 1
native III)
Waterborne, Dip,
and Flow (Regula- ,** ,* 0 ?Jt» .
tory Alternative III) * u
Waterborne,
Electrodeposition .».„ ,„ 3>t* „,
(Regulatory Alter- * l +J +l u
native IV)
High Solids
(Regulatory Alter- +3** -1* -1* +2** 0
natives I or II)
Incinerator plus
High Solids or
Waterborne (Regula- +3** -1* -1* +1* 0
tory Alternatives I,
II, or III)
-1* -1*
-3* -1**
+1* 0
-1* 0
Key.:
+ Beneficial 0 No Impact * Short-term Impact
- Adverse Impact 1 Negligible Impact ** Long-term Impact
                 2 Small Impact
                 3 Moderate Impact
                 4 Large Impact
*** Irreversible Impact
                                   1-13

-------
                     2.   THE METAL FURNITURE  INDUSTRY

2.1  GENERAL DESCRIPTION
     The metal  furniture industry consists of the following industry
groups and subgroups:

     Metal household furniture (SIC 2514)
     Dining and breakfast furniture
     Kitchen furniture
     Porch, lawn, and outdoor furniture
     Other metal household furniture
     Metal household furniture, nsk (not specified by kind)

     Metal office furniture (SIC 2522)
     Metal office seating
     Desks
     Cabinets and cases
     Other metal office furniture including tables, standard, etc.
     Metal office furniture, nsk (not specified by kind)

     Public building and related furniture (SIC 2531)
     School furniture, except stone and concrete
     Public building and related furniture, except school furniture
     Public school  furniture, nsk

     Metal partitions and fixtures (SIC 2542)
     Metal partitions
     Metal shelving and lockers
     Metal storage  racks and accessories

-------
     Metal  partitions and fixtures (SIC 2542) (continued)
     Metal  fixtures for stores,  banks,  offices and miscellaneous
          fixtures
     Metal  partitions, shelving, lockers, fixtures, nsk

The industry includes approximately 1400 establishments employing
approximately 100,000 people.   The term "establishment" means a plant,
rather than a company; i.e., a company can consist of more than one
establishment.   In this industry, however, few companies actually have
more than one establishment.  In 1972,  the average number of establishments
per company in SICs 2522, 2531,  and 2542 were 1.16, 1.04, and 1.05,
respectively.   (No similar data for SIC 2514 are available).
     Table 2-1  shows a distribution of establishments according to
employment size classes.  The four distributions are remarkably consistent
with each other:  all four show definite biases toward small plants.
Fifty percent of the establishments in the metal furniture industry,
viewed as a whole, have less than twenty employees, and eighty percent
have less than 100 employees.
     The industry size diversity  is also demonstrated by a study of the
                                                          p_-l /-
annual paint consumption rates  of the plants  in existence.      This
breakdown is shown in Table 2-2.  These  data were  used to determine size
categories for the model plants presented in  Chapter 5 of this document.
2.2  PROCESSES OR FACILITIES AND  THEIR EMISSIONS
2.2.1  The Basic Process
     The metal furniture coating  industry utilizes primarily solvent-
borne coatings being  applied by spray, dip,  and flow coating processes.
                                                         y_ -| c
Dry  coating  thickness  is generally  in  the area of  1 mil.       Coatings
for  metal furniture  must be resistant  to abrasion  and  maintain  a good
appearance.  In addition, metal  furniture must often be  able to withstand
regular  cleaning with  harsh detergents.
     The coatings  used  in the industry consist primarily of  solvent-
borne resins.  Other coatings include  acrylics, amines,  vinyls,  and
cellulosics.   Some metallic coatings are also used on  office furniture.
The  solvents used  are mixtures  of aliphatics,  xylene,  toluene,  and other
aromatics.
                                   2-2

-------
                            Table 2-1.   DISTRIBUTION OF ESTABLISHMENTS BY EMPLOYMENT SIZE
no
oo

SIC
code
2514


2522


2531



2542








Industry
group
Metal household furniture
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Metal office furniture
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Public building and
related furniture
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Metal partitions and fixtures
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Totals for four industry
groups
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Cumulative percent of
establishments
Employment size class
Total

391
100

177
100


377
100

449
100


1394
100

100
1-9

128
33

42
24


133
35

167
33


470
34

49
10-19

69
18

25
14


52
14

71
16


218
16

49
20-49

64
16

23
13


92
24

102
23


281
20

69
50-99

42
11

25
14


44
12

49
11


160
11

80
100-249

47
12

38
21


43
11

45
10


173
12

92
250-499

35
9

12
7


12
3

11
2


70
5

Approx.
> 500

6
2

9
5


1
<1

4
1


20
2

100
       Source:   U.  S.  Department of Commerce,  Bureau  of the Census,  County Business Patterns 1976, CBP-76-1.

-------
                           Table  2-2.   DISTRIBUTION OF  ESTABLISHMENTS  BY  PAINT  CONSUMPTION
ro
SIC
code
2514


2522


2531


2542








Industry
group
Metal Household Furniture
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Metal Office Furniture
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Metal Office Furniture
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Metal Partitions and Fixtures
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Totals for Four Industry
Groups
Number of establishments
Percent of establishments
Cumulative percent of
establishments
Annual paint
Total

391
100

177
100

377
100

449
100


1395
100

100
0-
2000

39
10

9
5

30
8

67
15


145
10

10
2001-
7500

90
23

35
20

31
8

45
10


201
14

24
7501-
40000

133
34

53
30

158
42

135
30


479
35

59
consumption (liters)
40001-
115000

51
13

9
5

98
26

67
15


225
16

75
115000-
190000

27
7

44
25

30
8

45
10


146
11

86
>1 90001

51
13

27
15

30
8

90
20


198
14

100

-------
     The metal furniture coating industry solvent emissions are directly
related to the types of coating materials used and the technique with
which they are applied.  Typical coatings presently used contain 65
volume percent solvent and 35 percent solids.      Other types of
coatings such as waterborne, high solids and powder are beginning to
appear in the industry.  These will be further discussed in Chapter 3.
     Application, or transfer, efficiencies  range from 30 to 95 percent
depending upon the application technique and the configuration of the
item being coated.17'18  Application efficiency does not affect emis-
sions from the curing  oven; however, it  is a major factor in emissions
from the coating application step.  It is important, therefore, to
achieve the  highest application efficiency possible.  Application
efficiency may be calculated by the following equation:
                            c _  (AKTKIOOO)  T (S/100)
                            E             -


where,  E = Application efficiency
        A = Area  coated (square  meters)
        T = Dry coating thickness  (meters)
        S = Solids content  of  paint (volume  percent)
        Q = Quantity of paint  applied  (liters)

      2.2.1.1  Spray Coating.   Spray coating is  the  most common application
 technique  used.   Spray coating lines  generally  consist of six major
 steps.   These may vary, however,  from plant to  plant.   These steps are
 listed below:
      1.   Three-  or  five-stage washer
      2.   Oven
      3.   Manual  touch-up spray
      4.   Electrostatic spray
      5.   Manual  touch-up spray
      6.   Oven
 Furniture pieces are  loaded onto an overhead conveyor moving at speeds
 ranging from 2.5 to 7 meters per minute.  This conveyor carries the
                                   2-5

-------
 pieces through all  steps of the coating process.   Figure 2-1  provides a
 block diagram of the steps  involved in the process.
      A five-stage cleaning  process  contains the following steps:
      1.   Alkaline cleaner wash
      2.   Iron phosphate
      3.   Hot water  rinse
      4.   Chromic wash
      5.   Cold water rinse
      The  alkaline cleaning  removes  oil  and grease  and  the phosphate
 treatment improves  the  adhesion characteristics of the surface.   Most
 metal  furniture coating operations  use  only three  stages eliminating  the
 chromic wash and cold water rinse.
      After washing,  the parts  pass  through a dry-off oven and  then into
 a  touchup booth where manual spray  guns  apply a reinforcement  coating to
 the  parts prior to  topcoat  application.  This step is  generally eliminated
 in metal  furniture  coating  operations and  a one coat process is used.
      The  topcoat operation  is,  naturally,  the most important step in  the
 finishing process.   The paint  is applied by manual  or  automatic electro-
 static spraying.  Application  efficiency for electrostatic spraying
 varies from  60  to 95  percent depending upon the type of  application
 equipment and the configuration of  the item being  painted.18   Applica-
 tion  efficiency for  flat  surfaces is generally  85  percent and  for
 complex shaped  objects  it is 65 percent.   Because  of the  length of time
 that  the  item is  in  the spray  booth and  flash-off  area,  approximately 70
 percent of the  solvent  evaporates prior  to  the  curing  step.19
     Color changes present  no  great problem  for electrostatic  spraying.
 In manual  operations, the operator purges the line with  solvent, wipes
 the gun,  and connects the line to the new color coating  supply.  In some
 larger operations different spray guns may be used, each attached to a
 different feed  line.  Automated systems may  have several guns which are
programmed for color sequence or there may be a single gun and line
purging may be required as with the manual  operation.   Some larger
operations perform color mixing compounding with computer programming.
The color  ingredients are selected in accordance with programs designed
to meet customer requirements.
                                  2-6

-------
                      Load
3-stage
washer
Dry off
oven
ro
        Unload


Curing
oven


Flash-off
area


Electrostatic
spray booth


                           Figure 2-1.   Flow diagram -  electrostatic spray coating operation.

-------
      2-2-l-2  Dip Coating.   Dip coating is the second most commonly used
 method of paint application.   With this method,  the wash stage is
 similar to that of spray coating.
      Dip coating may be done  manually or automatically.   Items to be
 coated are loaded on an overhead conveyor which  lowers them into the
 paint tank.   They are then  raised from the tank  and suspended  in a
 flash-off area over a drainboard.   The items  are then passed into the
 oven.   Figure 2-2 shows the steps involved in the dip coating  process.
      Approximately 40 percent of the  solvent  emissions which occur
 during dip coating are released during application and flash-off.19
 Application efficiency is approximately 90 percent for dip coating and
 there is no appreciable difference resulting  from differing object
 configurations.     Typical  dry coating thickness is 2.54 x 10-3  cm (1
 mil)  and the paint is usually a solvent-based alkyd with 35 volume
 percent solids.
      Color changes  are not  easily accomplished with dip  coating.   If an
 operation  requires  multiple colors, it will generally require  several
 tanks,  each  filled  with a different color  paint.
      2.2.1.3   Flow  Coating.    Flow  coating  is  a method used  to  a  much
 lesser  extent  in  the  metal  furniture  coating  industry.   The  wash  stage
 is the  same  as with  spray and  dip  coating.
      For topcoat  application,  furniture  items are  carried by an  overhead
 conveyor into  a flow  coating  chamber.    In  the chamber, paint is  directed
 at the  object  from  many  angles  through  as  many as  100  nozzles.    These
 nozzles effectively  form a  curtain of  paint through which the  furniture
 items must pass.  After  application,  the coated  objects  are  held  over a
 drain board  in a  flash-off  area.  They then pass  into  the curing  oven.
 Figure  2-3 shows  the  steps  involved in the flow  coating  process.20
 Approximately 80 percent of all solvent emissions are  released in the
 application and flash-off areas.    Application  efficiency is estimated
 at 90 percent for flow coating and there is no significant difference
                            18
with varying object shapes.     Typical dry coating thickness is 2.54 x
 10-3 cm (1 mil) and the paint is usually a solvent based alkyd with 35
 volume percent solids.
     Color changes are not easily accomplished with flow coating.  If
multiple colors are needed,  several coating chambers are usually needed.
                                  2-8

-------
                      Load
                              3-stage
                              washer
Dry off
oven
ro
Unload
                                                                                              v


Curing
oven
>»
"s
Flash-off
area
**
*•
Dip
tank
€ 	
^»
                                   Figure  2-2.   Flow diagram - dip coating operations.

-------
                      Load
             3-stage
             washer
           Dry off
           oven
INi
       Unload <-
Curing
oven
Flash-off
area
 Flow
Chamber
                                Figure 2-3.  Flow diagram - flow coating  operations.

-------
2.3  BASELINE EMISSIONS
     For the purpose of this study, the term "baseline emissions" refers
to the level of emission control required of the metal furniture surface
coating industry in the absence of a New Source Performance Standard
(NSPS).
     The metal furniture industry is located almost entirely in urban
areas which are nonattainment areas for photochemical oxidants.  State
Implementation Plans (SIPs) have been developed to control volatile
organic compound (VOC) emissions from various sources including the
metal furniture industry within these areas.  In addition to some
existing facilities, all new, modified and reconstructed metal furniture
coating facilities will be required to comply with these SIP regulations.
     The method for control of VOC emissions by the SIPs is based on the
Control Techniques Guideline (CTG) document published by the U. S.
                                                 21
Environmental Protection Agency in December 1977.    This document
presents an emission limit of 0.35 kg VOC per liter of coating applied
(3.0  Ib/gallon).  This  level is, therefore, considered to be the  base-
line  emission rate and  is used  as  the basis for comparison of  regulatory
alternatives  in Chapter 5.
                                   2-11

-------
                      REFERENCES  FOR  CHAPTER  2
1.    U.  S.  Department of Commerce, 1972 Census of Manufacturers, Industry
     Series, MC72(2)-25B, January 1975.

2.    Oge, M. T.   Trip Report.   Bunting Company.  Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.
     Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report 86.
     March 8, 1976.

3.    Oge, M. T.   Trip Report.   Goodman Brothers Manufacturing Company.
     Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield,
     Connecticut.   Trip Report 85.  March 8, 1976.

4.    Oge, M. T.   Trip Report.   Steelcase Company.  Grand Rapids, Michigan.
     Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report 72.
     February 24,  1976.

5.    Fisher, J.  R.  Trip Report.   Virco Manufacturing Corporation.  Gardena,
     California.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut.  Trip
     Report 57.   February 11,  1976.

6.    Oge, M. T.   Trip Report.   Herman Miller Incorporated.  Zeeland,
     Michigan.  Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip
     Report 100.   April 2, 1976.

7.    Thompson, M.  S.  Trip Report.  U. S. Furniture Industries.  Blacksmith
     Shop Division.   Highpoint, North Carolina.  Springborn Laboratories,
     Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip  Report 108.  April  6, 1976.

8.    Oge, M. T.   Trip Report.   Angel Steel Company.   Plainwell, Michigan.
     Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report 103,
     April 5, 1976.

9.    Industrial Surface Coating Questionnaire.  OMB No. 158-S75014.
     Simmons Company.  Atlanta, Georgia.  December 4, 1975.

10.  Industrial Surface Coating Questionnaire.  OMB No. 158-S75014.
     Lyon Metal Products, Inc.  Aurora, Illinois.  February 12, 1976.

11.  Industrial Surface Coating Questionnaire.  OMB No. 158-S75014.
     Shelby Williams Industrial,  Inc.  Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.
     February 26,  1976.
                                  2-13

-------
12.   Telecon Survey.   TRW,  Inc. ,  Environmental  Engineering Division.
     Telecon survey of metal  furniture coating  plants regarding annual
     paint consumption.   January-February 1979.

13.   California Air Resources Board Survey of Metal  Furniture Coating
     Plans.   1978.

14.   Economic Information Systems.   Listing of  metal furniture coating
     establishments.

15.   Nunn, A.  B.  and D.  L.  Anderson.   Trip Report.   Steelcase, Inc.
     Grand Rapids,  Michigan.   TRW,  Inc. ,  Durham, North Carolina.
     March 27-28, 1979.

16.   Nunn, A.  B.  and D.  L.  Anderson.   Trip Report.   Delwood Furniture
     Co.   Irondale, Alabama.   TRW,  Inc.,  Durham, North Carolina.
     April 18, 1979.

17.   Danielson, John A., Editor.   Air Pollution Engineering Manual,
     AP-40, 2nd Edition.  Air Pollution Control District County of
     Los  Angeles, EPA, Office of Air and Water  Programs, Office of
     Air  Quality Planning and Standards,  Research Triangle Park,
     North Carolina.   May 1973.

18.   Brewer, G. E.  F., "Painting Waste Loads Associated with Metal
     Finishing", Journal of Coatings Technology, Vol. 49, No. 625,
     February 1977.

19.   Suther, Burton J. , (Foster D.  Snell) and Uday Potasku (JACA
     Corporation).   Controlling Pollution from the Manufacturing and
     Coating of Metal Products—Metal Coating Air Pollution Control,
     Volume 1, EPA-625/3-77-009.   May 1977.

20.   Flow Coating Process of Paint Application.  Data Sheet F-24,
     George Koch Sons, Inc., Evansville, Indiana.

21.   Gallagher, V.  N., and J. Pratapas.  Control of Volatile Organic
     Emissions from Existing Stationary Sources, Volume III:  Surface
     Coating of Metal Furniture.   EPA-450/2-77-032.   U. S. Environmental
     Protection Agency, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina.
     December 1977.
                                  2-14

-------
                       3.   EMISSION CONTROL TECHNIQUES

     This chapter establishes control  techniques that are available to the
metal furniture industry to control volatile organic compound (VOC) emis-
sions.   In addition, it develops control  efficiencies for each control
technique.  Control techniques which are  evaluated include coating formula-
tion changes, "add-on" air pollution control equipment, and process modifi-
cations.  Coating formulation changes include powder, high solids, and
waterborne coatings instead of conventional solvent-based coatings. The
basic aim behind coating formulation changes is to reduce or eliminate the
organic solvent concentrations present and to increase the solids content
or the water content of the coating.  These changes should in turn reduce
VOC emissions to the atmosphere.
     Add-on air pollution control  equipment which is considered includes
incinerators, process boilers, carbon adsorbers, condensers and absorbers.
Both types of incinerators are evaluated:  thermal and catalytic.  Discus-
sions relating to add-on control techniques are only applicable to paint
lines that continue to use conventional organic solvent-based coatings.
     Finally, emission reduction performance associated with process
modification is discussed.  Improving transfer  efficiencies in applying
solvent-borne coatings is emphasized for this control  technique.
     Each control technique is also evaluated to determine impact  upon
reducing  or eliminating "fugitive"  emissions of VOC.   Without this
evaluation, the exact control efficiency of a control  technique cannot be
determined.
     Control techniques and their  associated control  efficiencies  are
applied in Chapter  5  to the model  plants to establish  regulatory  alterna-
tives.   From the  regulatory alternatives,  the control  techniques  which will
be  recommended  for  economic analysis in  Chapter 7 will be  determined.

-------
3.1  EMISSION CONTROL THROUGH COATING FORMULATION CHANGES
     Topics regarding formulation changes which are discussed in the
following sections are:
     1.    Discussion of which surface coating industries (metal furniture
          and other related) employ coating formulation changes as an air
          pollution control technique.
     2.    Chemical compositions.
     3.    Advantages and disadvantages of coating formulations.
     4.    Coating application techniques.
     5.    Process descriptions.
     6.    Process VOC emissions.
     7.    Operating parameters  for new metal furniture  lines.
3.1.1  Powder Coatings
     A control technique often  employed  in the metal furniture  industry  is
powder coating.   Powder is  applied to outdoor furniture as well as  indoor
products  such as  shelves,  beds,  and  chair frames.  Table 3-1 shows  the type
of metal  furniture products  being powder coated, the powder  resin type,  the
application  process, and the coating thickness.
     In addition  to the metal  furniture  industry,  several other surface
coating industries apply powder coatings to  metal  substrates.   Table  3-2
lists some of these.  The  process  steps  for  powder coating of  metal pro-
ducts shown  in Table 3-2 are the same or similar to process  steps in  the
metal furniture  industry.   Since the application of powder coatings to
metal substrates  is  a physical  process,  most comparisons between  surface
coating of metal  furniture and surface  coating  of  other metal  products are
applicable.   Before  powder can be applied  as a  coating, part size,  part
mass, part shape, paint thickness,  color changing  and  matching, and
 "Faraday  Effect"  are the most  important evaluations  to be made.
      Chemical  compositions of  powder coatings  used in  surface  coating
 industries consist of  synthetic resins, pigments,  solid additives,  and from
 0 to 10 percent entrapped  volatiles.  The film formers are  the synthetic
 resins  (alkyd,  vinyl,  acrylic, epoxy, urethane, etc.).  The  surface
 coating industry classifies surface coatings by the resin  type (e.g., alkyd
 paint,  vinyl paint, etc.).  Pigments consist of both inorganic and organic
                                   3-2

-------
                           Table 3-1.  METAL FURNITURE PRODUCTS BEING POWDER COATED
CO
CO
Product
Indoor metal furniture
Outdoor metal furniture
Outdoor metal furniture
Lawn and patio furniture
(17 and 22 guage mild steel)
Patio and casual furniture
Steel file cabinets and desks
Metal furniture
Metal chairs
Lawn furniture
Hospital bed frames and parts
Chair bases, frames, and
other parts
Application
process9
ES-automatic
ES-automatic
FB
ES
ES
ES.ED
ES-automatic
FB
ES
ES-automatic
ES-automatic
Powder Coating _3
resin type thickness (10 cm)
Epoxy resin
Cellulose
acetate
butyrate (CAB)
CAB
—
Polyester
—
PVC
polyester
(thermoset)
Vinyl and
polyester
Polyester
Epoxy
Epoxy
3.81 - 12.7
17.8 - 20.8
17.8 - 20.3
—
—
—
6.35
2.54
38.1 - 40.6
3.81
6.10
6.10
Reference
1
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9-11
                                                   (continued)

-------
                                             Table 3-1.  (Concluded)
CO
Product
Chair bases and arms
Shop furniture
Tubular metal furniture


Stadium seating
Hospital beds
Indoor and outdoor furniture

Library shelves
Dinette tables
Metal finishing parts
Office furniture
Hospital furnishing parts
Application
process3
FB
ES
ES-manual


ES-manual
ES
ES-automatic

ES-automatic
ES
ES-manual
ES-automatic
FB and ES
Powder Coating3
resin type thickness (10 cm)
Nylon 11
CAB
Epoxy and
thermoplastic
polyester
Polyester
(thermoplastic)
Nylon II
Epoxy and
polyester
Epoxy
Epoxy
Epoxy
Epoxy
Nylon
25.5 - 50.8
8.89 - 10.2
3.81


7.62
—
2.54 - 7.62

5.59
—
6.35 - 10.2
7.62 - 20.3
— — —
Reference
10,11
12
13


14
15
16,17

18
16
19
20
19
        ES  refers  to electrostatic application  of  powder.
        FB  refers  to fluidized bed application  of  powder.
        ED  refers  to electrostatic disk  application of powder.

-------
                                Table 3^2.   OTHER METAL PRODUCTS BEING POWDER COATED
co
i
01
Metal
product
Bicycle parts
Metal tubing
Trailer hitches
Lawn and garden
equipment
Metal part for
electrical equipment
Metal parts for fan
coils and ice makers
Lawn and garden
tractors
Automobiles
Oil filters
Outside and floor panels
of automobiles
Refrigerator liners,
shelving and kick plates
Components for electrical
equipment
Application
process3
ES-automatic
ES-automatic
ES-automatic
ES-automatic
and manual
—

ES

ES-automatic

ES-automatic
ES-automatic

ES-automatic

ES-automatic
and manual
Powder
type
CAB
Vinyl
Epoxy
Acrylic

Epoxy

Epoxy

Acrylic


Epoxy

Epoxy
Epoxy
Epoxy
Coating o
thickness (10 cm) Reference
7.62 21
5
22
23

16, 24

6.10 - 10.2 25

26

27
2.54 - 5.08 28
on
	 t.y
30
2.29 31
       aES  refers  to electrostatic application  of powder.

-------
compounds which are used for color and opacity.   Additives are used to aid
in production and improve application and performance properties of the
            32
film former.
     There are two general synthetic resin types of powder coatings:
thermoset and thermoplastic types.  Thermosetting powders harden during
heating inside a bake oven as a result of cross-linking or polymerizing of
the resin.  Thermoplastic powders soften with the application of heat and
resolidify during cooling.    Table 3-3 lists the powder coatings grouped
                    I c OQ
by synthetic resins.  '     Thermosetting and thermoplastic coatings are
usually applied by electrostatic spray and fluidized bed, respectively.
Most thermoplastic coatings require a solvent or powder primer before the
coating can be applied.    '    The most widely applied thermosets in the
metal furniture industry are epoxies and polyesters.  '    These materials
provide a tough, chemical and abrasive resistant coating which achieves
excellent adhesion to almost any metallic substrate.  Several of the thermo-
plastics  listed in Table 3-3 are being applied successfully to metal furni-
ture products.  Most of the thermoplastics are applied in thick films for
wear resistance in areas such as chair legs, bases and arms.
     Both powder coating types offer several advantages and disadvantages
(Tables 3-4 and 3-5).  when compared to solvent-based coatings.  The majority
of advantages apply to outdoor type products where color matching is not as
important.  Some of the disadvantages mentioned in Table 3-5 are so critical
that powder coating certain parts may not be possible, e.g., color matching
and Faraday Effect.  Color matching presents problems for facilities that
coat parts with different paint types (metal!ics) and then assemble the
                              34 35
parts into a finished product.   '    Lack of proper color match can result
in a large number of rejected parts.  The second disadvantage, Faraday
Effect, applies to all types of coatings applied electrostatically.  This
phenomenon occurs for parts with recesses which are surrounded by metal.
The electrostatically charged particles travel to the closest ground and as
a result  the recesses on  the part are not coated.  The Faraday Effect
becomes a significant problem if the parts require a reinforcement spray
or a touch-up spraying.    This effect can sometimes be overcome by preheating
the part, coating at a reduced voltage, or focusing the spray directly at
                         •3  I n ic  oc
the problem recess area.  '   '   '
                                  3-6

-------
              Table 3-3.  POWDER COATING RESIN GROUPS
Thermosetting
Thermoplastics
Epoxy
Polyester
Acrylic
Polyvinyl chloride or "vinyl"
Polyethylene
Cellulose acetate butyrate (CAB)
Nylon
Polyester
Acrylic
Cellulose acetate propionate (CAP)
Fluoroplastics
                                    3-7

-------
      Table 3-4.  ADVANTAGES OF POWDER COATINGS WHEN COMPARED TO
                  ORGANIC SOLVENT-BASED COATINGS
                 Advantages                           Reference

 1.  Provides •• tougher more abrasive resistant
     finish.                                      3, 5, 18,  24, 28, 36, 37
 2.  Fewer rejects and sags.                      5, 14,  26, 28, 38, 39

 3.  Lower energy consumption.                     2, 25,  28, 38, 40-42
 4.  Production rates can sometimes be
     increased.                                   26, 28, 38, 40
 5.  Less metal products are damaged during
     packing and shipping because coating is
     more abrasive resistant.                     38, 40
 6.  Eliminates OSHA requirements for
     solvents.                                    24, 43
 7.  Usually no final refinishing required.       43
 8.  Less metallic preparation  for parts
     to be coated.                                10, 14, 18, 36, 40
 9.  Preferred for wire-type parts.               14, 36, 39
10.  Superior for tubular parts.                   36

11.  No additional solvents for controlling
     viscosity or cleaning equipment required
     to be purchased or stored  at facility.       24, 38
12.  Less powder required to cover same
     surface area at same coating thickness.      24, 38, 42
13.  Good coatings for electrical insulation
     and ambient temperature variations.          16
14.  Significant reduction of VOC emissions.      44
15.  No primer required for thermosets and
     some thermoplastics.                         14
16.  Problems associated with water usage are
     reduced or eliminated.                       —

17.  In many applications powder  can be reclaimed
     and reused, providing a higher powder utili-
     zation efficiency than transfer efficiencies
     achieved with conventional  solvent-based
     coatings.                                    38
                               3-8

-------
      Table 3-5.  DISADVANTAGES OF POWDER COATINGS WHEN COMPARED TO
                        ORGANIC SOLVENT-BASED COATINGS
               Disadvantages                       Reference
 1.  Color changes require that appli-
     cation area and powder recovery
     system be thoroughly cleaned.      1, 2, 10, 26, 28, 33, 36, 40, 44

 2.  Tapped holes in parts require
     masking.                            26, 36, 45

 3.  Almost all thermoplastics
     presently require a organic
     or powder primer.                  10, 16

 4.  Certain shapes cannot be electro-
     statically coated because of the
     "Faraday Effect."                  10, 13, 28, 33, 40, 43, 44

 5.  Difficult to coat small  numbers
     of parts.                          11, 36

 6.  Powders are explosive, but minimum
     ignition temperature of powders
     is higher than for organic
     solvents.                          10, 36

 7.  High capital costs for manufac-
     turing and application equipment
     for powder coatings.               26, 33

 8.  Electrostatic gun hoses  may plug
     frequently.                        25

 9.  Difficult to touch-up complex
     surfaces.                          3, 13, 38

10.  Metallic and some other types of
     finishes  available from  organic
     solvent-based coatings have not
     been duplicated commercially in
     available powder coatings.         34, 35
                               3-9

-------
     The application of powder coatings to metal  parts eliminates VOC
emissions in the coating storage, application and flash-off areas.   Also,
VOC emissions from the bake oven are reduced significantly when compared to
other coatings.   The only exceptions are thermoplastic powders which
require that the part be coated with an organic solvent-based primer.  For
this type of operation, VOC emissions can result from the primer application
area and preheat oven.  Control efficiencies developed for powder coatings
are discussed in Section 3.3.1 of this chapter.  The remainder of the
discussion in this section concentrates on powder application techniques.
     Powder coatings can be applied to metal parts by one of several
coating techniques which include:   (a) spray,  (b) fluidized bed, and
(c) electrofluidized bed.11'36'44   Application techniques most common to
the metal furniture industry  are electrostatic spray  and  fluidized  bed
coating.  Sections  3.1.1.1 and  3.1.1.2 discuss these  two  coating techniques
in detail.
     3.1.1.1  Electrostatic Spraying  of  Powder Coatings.   Electrostatic
spraying  of  powder  is  the  most  widely used application  technique for powder
coatings  in  the metal  furniture industry.   The basic  principal  of  electro-
static spray is that  opposite charges attract  and  like  charges  repel.
Therefore,  the  metal  part  to  be coated is grounded  or given a positive
charge, whereas the atomized  powder particles  (20  to  80 pm) receive a
 negative charge at the discharge point of a spraying  gun.   The electrical
potential that  results between the particles and the  part causes the par-
 ticle  to be physically attracted to the part.   As  a result, the particles
 adhere uniformly to the surface of the metal part.   As the powder film
 forms, the part becomes insulated and the powder charge is dispelled
 through the grounded part.  A uniform film which is free of voids, is the
 final  result.37'44'46'47  Thermosets are the preferred powder for electro-
 static application because not all of the thermoplastics can be ground to
 the required spraying particle size  range.
       If the powder is a thermoset, the film coating on the part is cured  by
 baking in an oven at  an elevated temperature.  However, for thermoplastic
 powders, the part must be preheated  before  the powder  is applied electrosta-
 tically.  Post heating may be  necessary  even  for the thermoplastic  powders.
                                    3-10

-------
Usually,  finished film thicknesses for electrostatically applied powder
coatings  vary from about 0.025 to 0.170 mm  (1.0 to 8.0 mils), depending
upon part temperature, powder particle size, electrical potential difference
between part and particles, and spraying duration.  It is much more common,
however,  to find film coating thicknesses of 0.025 to 0.106 mm (1.0 to 5.0
mils).36'48'49
     The most common electrostatic spraying device used in the metal
furniture industry is the manual electrostatic gun.  Figure 3-1 shows
schematically an electrostatic gun spraying a grounded part.  The basic
components of an electrostatic gun include a basic console, powder spray
gun, spray booth, and powder recovery and recycling system.  Each component
is discussed below in detail.7'12'16'25'50"53
     •    Basic Console
     The basic console or cabinet contains the powder supply for the gun
and converts line current to high-voltage direct current.   The unit contains
the air supply which is used to atomize the powder particles.   Moisture
from the air supply is removed by a drier.  The unit is usually equipped
with a reservoir, vibrator, air fluidizer and hose.  The control  regulates
air volume and pressure, voltage, amperage, vibrator frequency and powder
flow rate.11'37'50'51'53
     •    Powder Spray Gun
     The spray is activated by manually depressing a trigger switch which
initiates powder flow and transfer of voltage.   The pattern flow is deter-
mined by a deflector located inside the gun.  The electrode on some guns is
cleaned by an airstream.   '    This ensures that the gun provides a constant
electrical discharge to the powder particles.   Also a powder hose and a
high-voltage cable are connected to the gun.
     Automated electrostatic guns are mounted on vertical  or horizontal
reciprocators,  and operation is controlled by a master switch  on  the control
panel.   The number of guns  in an automatic system usually varies  from 1 to
12 and is dependent upon part size and complexity, the extent  and rate of
travel  of the reciprocating guns,  and the  conveyor speed.   Most automated
application lines require that more than  one gun be employed because the
operation of several  guns at a moderate output  rate provides a higher
transfer efficiency than one gun operating at a high output rate.2'35'38'50'52
                                  3-11

-------
                      Rosin  Picks  Up  Charge  Here
GO
I
ro
                                                                                                      High Voltage
                                            Semi-Conducting  Paint
                                  High-Voltage Lead
   \
Resin and Air
                                           Figure 3-1.  Electrostatic gun.

-------
     •    Spray Booth
     Powder spray booths are much simpler in design than spray booths
                                    oo
employed for solvent-based coatings.     The floors are sloped downward to
improve powder overspray collection and to allow for easier cleanout of the
spray booths.   The guns are mounted in the side of the walls of the booth,
but sizes of openings are kept to a minimum to prevent powder loss.   Guns
can also be mounted on both sides of a booth to allow both surfaces of a
part to be coated at one time.  The interior walls are vertical and free of
any type of projections to minimize hang-up of powder.
     The dimensions of the booth are governed by part size, conveyor size,
                                      38
conveyor speed and the number of guns.
     •    Recovery and Recycle System
     Figure 3-2 shows a spray booth with a powder recovery system.   Recovery
and recycling of overspray powder is of economic significance when considering
powder coating.   Most recovery systems collect powder particles by filtration
systems which are usually preceeded by cyclones.  If cyclones are employed,
the largest particles are removed from the spray booth exhaust air as a
result of centrifugal action and collected in a hopper below the cyclone. '
The smaller particles are removed from the exhaust air by filtration.
Collection systems also include bag filters, tube filters, or a continuous
                             37
moving belt of fabric filter.    The application of the belt filtration
system reduces some of the problems associated with color changes because
powder is removed after the belt leaves the spray booths.    Cyclones
recover about 75 to 95 weight percent of the powder but the collection
efficiency depends upon the powder particle size.
     After the airstream leaves the cyclone, particles of less than 2 urn in
size remain in the airstream.  The filtration system removes about 99
weight percent of these particles, whereas, if an "absolute" filter is
employed, a total of 99.97 percent of the powder can be removed from the
airstream.  After the airstream has been adequately filtered, it can be
exhausted back into the building.
     For coating operations in which only one color is being used, powder
particles recovered from the cyclone and filtration system can be recycled
and about 98 percent of the overspray powder can be utilized.    However,
                                  3-13

-------
           a.    Reservoir and controls
           b.    Elevator-mounted industrial  spray gun
           c.    High-voltage electrode and deflector plate
           d.    Part being coated
           e.    Grounded conveyor
           f.    Powder tube and high-voltage cable
           g.    Spray booth
           h.    Powder recovery unit
           i.    Exhaust fan
           j.    Exhaust line for powder recovery
           k.    Clean air returned to booth
           1.    Clean air exhausted to atmosphere

Figure 3-2.  Powder spray booth equipped with powder recovery system.
                                   3-14

-------
if more than one color is required, only the powder collected by the cyclone
can be reused because powder recycled from the filtration system can cause
color contamination, a problem which can be overcome if a separate filtra-
tion system is employed for each color.     For operations in which color
changes are required, powder utilization depends upon a combination of the
efficiency of the powder recovery unit and the initial transfer efficiency
in the spraying booth.  The effect of these two variables is shown in Table
3-6.
     Powder to be recycled is pneumatically or manually transported to the
powder reservoir.  This material is screened to remove oversized particles
that will not carry a charge and is mixed with virgin powder in the
          1 _ O ~j "1C -3-1 OQ CT
reservoir.   ' »1D»0/»°°»3-L  jne voltage for most electrostatic guns can be
varied to 90 KV which provides a method of controlling powder film thickness.
The polarity of the charging electrode in the guns can be varied but most
powder particles are sprayed with a negative charge.
     Transfer efficiency for electrostatic spraying of powders varies
depending upon part shape and size.  The transfer efficiencies for certain
shapes and sizes are shown below.  '  '     However, powder utilization
efficiency is much higher (90 percent or greater) than the transfer
efficiencies shown since oversprayed powder is recycled.

       Shape                    Size        Transfer efficiency (percent)
Flat surface                    Large                   65-85
Wire racks and baskets          Variable                50-80

     Table 3-7 lists the operating parameters of powder coating lines
presently in use.  This information may be representative of new coating
lines that would fall under New Source Performance Standard (NSPS) regula-
tions.   These coating lines are considered to be both manually or automati-
cally operated and apply only to the spraying of thermoset powders.   The
same coating lines may be employed for thermoplastics but either additional
equipment for a primer or preheating of parts might be required.   In some
cases,  both might be required.   The coating line for powder thermosets does
not require spray primer and flash-off areas as are needed for solvent-based
                                  3-15

-------
       Table 3-6.  OVERALL WEIGHT PERCENT OF POWDER UTILIZED'
 Weight  fraction
 Powder  recovery
       80
       85
       90
       Weight fraction transfer
       50         65         80
       82.5       90.1       95.2
       85.7       91.8       96.4
       89.2       94.6       97.5
 'Assuming color changes, with powder in bag filters discarded,
 bWeight fraction deposited on the part to be painted.

             Table  3-7.  PROCESS  OPERATING  PARAMETERS  FOR
            POWDER COATING LINES  USING ELECTROSTATIC SPRAY
       Parameter

Conveyor speed
Spacing between furniture parts
Number of cleaning stages for
  parts
Dry-off oven
Application area
  Electrical output of guns
  Number of guns
  Touch-up guns
  Polarity of  charged particles
  Compressed air  output

  Powder output
  Powder overspray reuse
 Flash-off

 Powder baking
Operating range
—___—————
1.5-14 m/min  (5-45  ft/mln)1-4'7'13'15'40
0.31-0.61 m (1-2  ft)3
 31, 3, 5,7,16
 370-530  K (200-500°F)  for 5-15 min
1,4,11
 35-100 KV DC''*'
 1 121-3,7,11,16,26,35

 °-21'26
 Positive or negative
 1420-7080 m3/sec at 146-488 kg/m
   (30-100 psig)35*48'49
 0-36  kg  (0-80 IbJ/hr/gun1 >35
 97 percent
 Not required for all  thermosets and
   some thermoplastics.
 436-505  K (325-450°F) for 4-30
   ^1,2,4,5,7,11-13
  ^Usually negative.
                                       3-16

-------
coatings (Figure 2-1).  The spray booths are also not equipped with water
curtains.  A powder recovery system on the spray booth is the only additional
equipment required.
     The remainder of this section details process descriptions of a coating
line employing electrostatic spraying of powder and evaluates the process
parameters shown in Table 3-7.   The process involves five steps which
include loading of parts on a conveyor, cleaning of parts, drying of parts,
spraying of parts, and curing of the powder coatings on the parts
(Figure 3-3).     Each is discussed in detail below.
     •    Conveyor
     All of the coating facilities studied that employ electrostatic spraying
of powder use a conveyor system (mainly overhead) which transports the
parts through a cleaning rinse, dry-off oven, spray booth, bake oven, and
unloading area.  Parts are hung on hooks at specified intervals governed by
part size.  Conveyors are normally loaded and unloaded by hand, but automatic
systems are available.1-4'7-12'15'17'19'28
     0    Cleaning
     Usually,  the metal parts are cleaned in a 3-stage iron phosphate
rinse.   From 1 to 3 stages of the cleaning system may consist of an iron
phosphate rinse.   The purpose of this rinse is to remove oil and dirt on
the parts.  This phosphatizing of the metal parts is followed by a water
rinse stage.   The last stage involves spray coating the parts with a chromic
acid rinse.1-4'16'26
     •    "Dry-Off" Oven
     The wet parts next travel  through the "dry-off" oven to vaporize the
liquid on the parts.   Before the parts are sprayed with powder, they are
cooled by traveling along on the conveyor in the open plant for 5 to 15
minutes.1"4'7"12
     •    Powder Spraying
     Powder spraying of the parts can begin after parts have cooled, but
this is not a requirement for thermoplastic powders.  In some automated
systems, the parts are indexed by an "electric eye"  located at the entrance
of the spray booth.  The electric eye is part of the automatic control that
starts and stops the powder flow to the electrostatic gun.  The remainder
                                                            i_4 7-1? 90
of the spraying booth was discussed earlier in this section.   '  «-,<-u
                                  3-17

-------
   Parts
                           Stages of cleaning
                                                 Dry-Off
                                                  Oven
co

CO
Powder Spray
    Booth
                                           No Flash-Off Area
                                                                          Oven
To Assembly
of Parts
                                 Figure 3-3.  Flow diagram for a powder coating line.

-------
     Some coating lines are equipped with manual spraying in a smaller
touch-up booth.
     •    Baking
     After the parts have been coated,  the coating is cured in a bake oven.
The oven itself is usually gas- or oil-fired and consists of more than one
zone.   One or more of the zones are used to bring the part to a specified
temperature while the remainder of the  zones maintains the part temperature.
Curing time depends upon the mass of these parts, the type of powder, and
the coating thickness.   This process on the coating line is the only source
                                                                 1-3 n 44 4ft 57
of VOCs on a powder coating line employing thermosetting powders.    '  '   '   '
     The flow diagram in Figure 3-3 shows the equipment that would be
needed for powders that require parts to be prime coated first.  Emissions
of VOCs would also result from the primer application, the preheat oven,
and the post heat oven (if required).
     In the area of new developments in application techniques, a high
                                                                           A
speed rotating disk has been used to powder coat office cabinets and desks.
The disk is a spraying device that could replace the electrostatic gun on a
powder coating line.   Powder particles  are discharged from the disk which
rotates at high centrifugal speeds (30,000 rpm), and the particles are
atomized by a combination of centrifugal and electrostatic forces.  The
disk offers higher transfer efficiencies and is considered to be an
improvement over the electrostatic gun.  '  '
     Section 3.1.1.2 discusses the second application technique (fluidized
bed) employed in the metal furniture industry.   This application technique
is used when an extra thick coating is  desired.
     3.1.1.2  Fluidized Bed Application of Powder Coatings.   Figure 3-4 is
a schematic of a metal  part to be powder coated in a fluidized bed. The
metal  part is cleaned by the same iron  phosphate system discussed in
Section 3.1.1.1.   For parts to be coated with a thermoplastic powder, an
organic primer (or sometimes a powder)  is added to the surface of the part.
Next,  the part is preheated above the fusion point of the resin particles
and is dipped manually or automatically into the fluidized bed where the
particles melt onto the part.   Loose powder is  blown or shaken from the
formed film.   For thermoplastics, the coating solidifies as the part cools
                                  3-19

-------
      PREHEATED
      PART TO BE_
      COATED
POROUS
PLATE
                                      t1

mr\ v,
,
•iir»'iui_r\

                                       T
                                LOW PRESSURE AIR
              Figure 3-4.  Part coating in  a  fluidized bed of powder.
                                       3-20

-------
on the conveyor line.   However,  for some thermoplastics and all  thermosets,
post heating is required.   The post heating of some thermoplastics is
employed to provide a more uniform film.   After the coating has  cured and
the part is sufficiently cool, each part is removed manually from the
              1,10,14,28,33,36,38,39
conveyor line.  '   '  '   '
     A particle recovery system much like those employed for electrostatic
spraying systems can also be used to collect resin particles from the top
of the fluidized bed.  Resin particles, because of the decreasing particle
size, are elutriated from the fluidized bed.  A slightly negative pressure
is maintained across the top of the fluidized bed of resin particles to
collect this elutriated material.  The resin particles are collected by
either a cyclone and filtration system, or both.  '
     The fluidized bed application technique is preferred  in the metal
furniture industry for thermoplastics coating operations.  Thicker protec-
tive films  can result from this application technique.  Coating thicknesses
can  range from 0.15 to 1.5 mm (6  to 60 mils); they depend  upon mass  and
temperature of the part and part  residence  time within the fluidized bed  of
resin particles.10'28'36'58   In  fact, two  different coatings (vinyl  and
polyester)  have  been applied with this  application technique to the  same
chair parts.
      Emissions of  VOCs can result from  the  following processes when
                                              10 29
applying either  a  thermoset or  thermoplastic:   '
Coating                                  Process source of VOC emissions
Thermoset                                Bake  oven
Thermoplastic  (no  primer)3               Bake  oven
Thermoplastic  (organic  primer)3         Primer application area,  preheat
                                         oven,  and bake oven
  Emissions  of  VOCs from the  bake oven only result if  post heating is
 3required.
      Table 3-8 contains process operating parameters  for fluidized bed
 coating lines  presently operating in the metal furniture industry.   These
 data are representative of the new coating lines  that would fall  under NSPS
 regulations.
                                   3-21

-------
      Table 3-8.  PROCESS OPERATING PARAMETERS FOR POWDER COATING
                            LINES USING FLUIDIZED BED
Parameter
           Operating range
Conveyor speed
Spacing between furniture parts
Number of cleaning stages
  for parts
Dry-off oven
Primer applicationa
Flash-off3
Preheat oven

Particle resin size
Air flow through fluidized
bed
Bake ovenc
Cool down time
2.4-4.9 m/min (8-16 ft/min)11'59
0.31-0.61 m (1-2 ft)3

3-611
370-530 K (290°F-500°F) for 5-15 min.
One coat11
8 min.11
400-615 K f275°F-650°F) for 4-6
min.ll'39*59
200 y and above.60
15:61 m3/hr per m2 of plate (50-200
ftYhr per ft* of plate)"30
440-500 K (340°F-450°F) for 4-30
rnin.11*58
                                     11
5-15 min.
         10
 Only required for certain thermoplastic powders.
temperature will vary depending upon resin type.
••
"Bake oven required for all thermosets and some thermoplastics where
 film uniformity is a problem.
 Applies only to thermoplastics that cure as a result of cooling.
                                 3-22

-------
3.1.2  High Solids Coatings
     A second coating formulation change currently employed in the metal
furniture industry to reduce VOC emissions is high solids coatings.  This
group of coatings is oligomeric and includes such general categories as
radiation curable systems, "high solids coatings" (anything greater than
50 percent by volume solids is being considered) and the already discussed
powder coatings (see Section 3.1.1).  The radiation curable systems are not
discussed.  These types of coatings are not being used in the metal furniture
industry since there is a potential health hazard associated with the
isocyanate emissions from these coatings, and the difficulties involved
                         61 62
in curing these coatings.   '
     Table 3-9 shows the types of metal furniture products being coated
with higher solids coatings.  All coatings are being applied by electro-
static guns unless specified otherwise in the table.   Other industries
which require surface coating and which are investigating and using high
                                                                   C O_ "7 C
solids include the automotive, can, coil, and appliance industries.
Surface coating of appliance parts with high solids has been very success-
ful.  The metal furniture industry is studying everything from 50 to 100
percent by volume solids.
     The chemical composition of high solids coatings consists of
modifications of their solvent-based counterparts.  High solids coatings
are categorized into two general groups:   two-component/ambient curing and
single-component/heat-converted materials.  The general chemical composi-
tion of both groups includes synthetic resins, pigments, additives, and
solvents at a reduced concentration (when compared to solvent-based coatings).
The general properties of pigments and additives have been mentioned in
Section 3.1.1.   The synthetic resin types that have been developed for
single-component/heat-converted materials include epoxy, acrylic, polyester
and alkyd.  The two-component systems include acrylics, polyesters, epoxys,
                      en -jr\ -}•} 77—QC
urethanes, and others.   '   '  '       The single- and two-component coatings
offer several advantages and disadvantages which are presented in Table
3-10 and 3-11,  respectively.
     Three spraying techniques can be employed to apply single- and
two-component high solids coatings:  (1)  air atomization, (2) airless
atomization, and (3) electrostatic methods.44'81'97'101'102
                                  3-23

-------
Table 3-9.  METAL FURNITURE PRODUCTS BEING COATED WITH HIGH SOLIDS
Product
Panel and desk
parts
Metal drawers
Metal furniture
parts
Shop furniture
and shelving
Office
furniture
Metal furniture
parts
Metal furniture
parts
Lighting fix-
tures, shelving,
and office
furniture3
Metal furniture
shelving.and
fixtures0
Resin Solids content
type by volume (%)
Acrylic/
polyester 54
Alkyd
Alkyd 55
Alkyd
Acrylic/
polyester
—
56
Alkyd
enamel 66-80
Alkyd-
ami ne 62
Coating
thickness (10~3 cm) Reference
3.05 10
2.54-3.81 63
64
65
65
66
67
68
68
                             (continued)

-------
                                       Table  3-9.   Concluded

Product
Steel office
furniture
Steel .
shelving
Steel .
shelving
Resin
type
Polyester
Alkyd
Polyester
Solids content Coating.,
by volume (%) thickness (10" cm)
60
67
65
Reference
68
68
68
aThe low range of solids coating applied by disc and the high range of solids coating applied by
 high speed disc.

 Coating applied by disk.

cCoating applied by high speed bell  or disk.

 Coating applied by high speed disk.

-------
          Table 3-10.   ADVANTAGES FOR HIGH SOLIDS  COATINGS  WHEN
          COMPARED TO  CONVENTIONAL ORGANIC SOLVENT-BASED  COATINGS
      Advantage                                            Reference


1.   Reduction of VOC emissions.                    44,  86-109

2.   Reduced shipping costs, inventory,
    and handling of drums containing
    the coatings.                                 44,  87,  88,  94,  95

3.   Potential for reduction of energy             44,  69,  79,  81,  87-92,
    usage to cure coatings.                       94,  100

4.   Reduced air flow rates through
    spray booths and bake ovens.                  81,  89,  105

5.   Less coating is applied to obtain
    same dry film thickness.                      67,  70,  80,  87,  90, 104

6.   Two-component systems can cure
    under ambient conditions.                     77

7.   Higher production rates can be
    achieved.                                     69

8.   Color matching comparable to
    solvent-based paints.                         69

9.   Utilization of paint heaters, high
    speed disks and bells can result  in
    the application of coatings that
    contain more solids.                          93-97, 101-103,  110
                                   3-26

-------
            Table 3-11.  DISADVANTAGES FOR HIGH SOLIDS COATINGS WHEN
                   COMPARED TO ORGANIC SOLVENT-BASED COATINGS
                Disadvantage                            Reference


 1.  Higher viscosity in application area.            44, 88, 97

 2.  Reduced shelf-life for two-component            ..
     coating.

 3.  Less latitude with in-plant formula             ..
     modifications.

 4.  Short pot lives for some two-component          ft,
     coating systems.

 5.  Elaborate feeding equipment required
     for two-component coating systems.               81

 6.  Premature loss of solvent caused by
     preheating.                                      97

 7.  Possible  requirement of careful
     metal preparation.                               10, 67, 69,  90
 8.  Decrease  in  quality of mechanical
     properties of a coating as the
     molecular weight of the resin
     decreases.                                      93

 9.  More difficult spray booth cleaning
     due to tackiness of some high solids
     coatings.                                       10, 67, 80

10.  "Faraday  effect" is a problem for
     certain shapes.                                 33, 34

11.  Metallic  finishes from organic solvent-
     based coatings have not been matched with
     other high solids coatings.
                                    3-27

-------
     Air atomization uses its own air supply which may be heated, filtered,
humidified, or a combination thereof.  Airless atomization is accomplished
by forcing the coating through spray nozzles under a pressure of 6.9 to
13.8 MPa (1,000 to 2,000 psig).   Both the air and airless spraying techniques
exhibit poor transfer efficiencies.  '      As a result, these spraying
techniques are not common for applying high solids coatings in the metal
furniture industry.  These two spraying techniques are mainly employed for
touch-up work for parts that exhibit the Faraday Effect.   Therefore, the
spraying technique this section concentrates on is spraying by electrostatic
methods.
     The three basic types of electrostatic spraying techniques that have
been successful in applying high solids coatings at acceptable transfer
efficiencies (greater than 50 percent)  are listed below and shown
schematically in Figure 3-5:81»93,94,101,102
Type of Spray Equipment                 Mechanical Energy for Atomization
Air atomization - electrostatic guns    Compressed air
Airless or hydraulic atomization -
   electrostatic guns                   Hydraulic
Electrostatic atomizing -
   electrostatic disks and bells        Centrifugal and electrostatic

For electrostatic guns using air and airless atomization, the coating is
atomized by compressed air or mechanical forces and charged electrostatically.
In the disk or bell systems, a combination of mechanical  force (centrifugal)
and electrostatic means are used to atomize, charge, and deposit the coating.
Transfer efficiencies achieved by applying high solids (60 to 70 percent by
volume solids) with the disks and bells range from 80 to 90 percent regardless
of part shape.   These systems are schematically shown in Figure 3-5.  '
     Each electrostatic system is equipped with coating handling equipment.
The air and airless electrostatic guns  are supplied from a pressure fed
device with a fluid regulator or metering valve, and an air driven piston
pump with a fluid regulator, respectively.   Two-component coating systems
present additional  equipment problems associated with the varying pot lives
of the coatings.   The pot lives  of certain two-component coatings and mixing
requirements of equipment located before the electrostatic spraying device
                 01
are listed below:
                                  3-28

-------
                                                                Coating
Coating
(a) Electrostatic  Gun
                                    Paint
                                    Spraying
                                    Direction
Rotating Disk
(b) High Speed Disk
                                                                                            Paint
                                                                                     	^- Spraying
                                                                                            Direction
                                   High
                                Voltage
                                            Drain
                                         (c)  Mini-Bel
              Figure 3-5.   Schematic of  high  solids coatings spraying equipment,

-------
Pot Life
One to five minutes

Five minutes to eight hours
spray device
Eight hours
supply tanks
Mixing Equipment
External mix at the site of
atomization
Static mixers located close to the

Static mixers or premixers in fluid
Figure 3-6 shows how electrostatic equipment is fed with static mixers
depending upon pot lives that are associated with two-component coatings.
All of the feeding systems in Figure 3-6 are automatically controlled to
maintain a close relationship (± 5 percent) between the coating and the
catalyst.  This is done to avoid the coatings' curing in the spraying
device, or at some other earlier stage of processing before the baking
ovens.  Paint heaters constitute additional equipment which may be neces-
sary  for electrostatic guns.  Some single- and two-component coatings
must  be heated to a flowable viscosity.  Paint heaters, however, are not
always necessary for disk or bell systems.  These systems seem to be parti-
cularly well suited to the application of high solids coatings.  '   '
      The remainder of this section discusses the process description of a
representative high solids coating line, and describes the various sources
(including fugitive) of VOC emissions.  The process description of a coating
line  is very similar to that of an organic solvent-based coating line.  The
line  consists of a conveyor and cleaning, dry-off, application, flash-off,
and baking areas.  The conveyor, cleaning, and dry-off areas are basically
the same as the powder coating lines and are  not discussed in this section.
The application, flash-off, and baking areas  are discussed below:
      t   Application Area
      This area  includes the spray booth, electrostatic spraying device,
possibly a paint heater, and paint mixing equipment.  Of these, only the
spray booth has not previously been  discussed.
      Spray booths  on high  solids coating  lines are downdraft or sidedraft
design and can  be  smaller  in size when compared to conventional solvent-
based spray booths because less makeup air  is required to  handle VOC
                                   3-30

-------
  Ratio pump or
other feed source
                          Short Pot Life Systems
                                               Rotating head
                                            dual-disk atomizer
                               External
                               mix manual
                               spray gun
  Ratio pump or
other feed source
                                                            External mix
Electrostatic
airspray gun
with static
mi xer
                      Medium or Long Pot Life Systems
                                             Rotating  head
                                             disk atomizer
    Ratio  ump or
  other feed source
                                        Ratio pump or
                                      other feed source
                        Figure 3-6.   Static mixers.
                                     3-31

-------
emissions.   ''     Most spray booth dimensions are based on the largest
part to be coated.
     For electrostatic systems, the spray booth is equipped with hand held
and automatically operated guns, disks or bells.  The number of electrostatic
guns reported to be in use (mounted on vertical or horizontal reciprocators)
range from one to twelve.  For spray booths using a disk, the booths are
designed in a circular shape.  Also, coating lines equipped with disks or
bells usually require two of each of these atomizing devices.
     Due to the difficulty of controlling film thickness with high solids
paints, automatic electrostatic spraying systems are usually employed;
                                           69 94 112
manual equipment is used for touch-up only.  '  '
     •   Flash-Off Area
     A flash-off area is required to allow a prescribed amount of solvent to
evaporate before the coated part enters the bake oven.  This prevents bubbling,
                              44
uneven coating thickness, etc.
     Enclosed flash-off areas used with high solids coatings, when compared
to conventional solvent based coatings, require less residence time for the
                                        89
coated part and allow reduced air flows.    However, most flash-off areas
in the metal furniture industry are not enclosed.
     •   Baking Oven
     Two-component systems require little or no baking to cure the resins.
However, single-component coatings require baking at 425 to  450  K (300° to
350°F) which aids in the crosslinking of reactive groups, like hydroxyls or
carboxyls, with ami no compounds.
     The process operating parameters are  summarized  in Table 3-12.   This
information is  considered to  be representative  of a new coating  line  using
high solids coatings.
     Emissions  of VOCs from  high solids coating lines result from the
application, flash-off and baking  oven.  For plants in which the flash-off
area  is not enclosed, VOC emissions  that result from  this area are con-
sidered to be fugitive.  The  other part of the  plant  that might  be a  source
of  fugitive VOCs is  the  coatings storage area.   Section  3.3.2 discusses
control efficiencies  of  high  solids  coating  systems compared to  conventional
organic solvent-based coatings.
                                  3-32

-------
                Table 3-12.   PROCESS OPERATING PARAMETERS FOR
                         HIGH SOLIDS COATING LINES
Parameter
          Operating range
Conveyor speed
Parts spacing
Number of cleaning stages for
  parts
Dry-off oven
Application area
  Electrostatic gun systems
     Number of guns
     Touch-up guns
     High solids output
     Compressed air


  Electrostatic disk systems
     Number of disks
     Rotation speed
     High solids output
     Disk diameters
     Air requirements

  Electrostatic bell systems
     Number  of bells
     Rotation speed
     High solids  output
     Air requirements

 Coating thickness
 Electrical  output
                                                                1-4 10
                                                                1 H'1U
1.5-14 m/min (5-45 ft/min).
0.31-0.61 m (1-2 ft)3
3_510,64,67,69
370-530 K (200-500°F) for 5-15 min.
1_1264'67
0_264,67
200-1500 1/min (0.05-0.4 gal/min)113'114
1420-7080 m3/sec at 150-490 kg/m3
(30-100 psig)37'50'51
 ,108
               .70
1800-20,000 RPM'
0-1000 1/min (0-0.3 gal/min)115'116
200-500 mm (8-20 inches)115'116
0.009 m3/sec (18 CFM) at 190 kg/m3
(40 pslg)115'116
2-694
900-30,000 RPM70'94'117
0-400 1/min  (0-0.1 gal/min)117
0.005 m3/sec  (10  CFM)  at  290  kg/m3
(60 psig)117
(0.5-2.0 mil)70'112
0-140 KV118
                                  (Continued)
                                    3-33

-------
                        Table 3-12.  Concluded.
Parameter                                       Operating range

Bake oven

  High solids baking

    Single-component                    410-470 K C275-4000F>63'64'7Q'81
                                        97,102
    Two-component                       340-360 K (150-180°F) for 10 nrin.19
                                    3-34

-------
3.1.3  Waterborne Coatings
     One of the control techniques presently employed in the metal furniture
industry is the use of waterborne coatings.   These coatings can be applied
by conventional or electrostatic spray, conventional or electrophoretic
dip, or flow coating lines to a wide variety of parts.   Waterborne coatings
are being successfully applied in the automobile, coil, appliance, metal
can, and electronics industries as well as in the metal furniture
         11Q-104
industry.liy '^
     The term waterborne refers to any coating which uses water as the
primary carrier combined with organic solvent and is differentiated from
pure organic solvent-borne paints.  There are basically three types of
waterborne coatings:  latex or emulsion paints, partially solubilized
                                        125
dispersions, and water-soluble coatings.      Table 3-13 lists the proper-
ties of these three types of paints.  Most current interest is centered
around the partially solubilized dispersions and emulsions.  Emulsions are
of particular interest because they can build relatively thick films without
                                                          1 ?fi 1?7
blistering and they contain no noxious amine solubilizers.    '
     Most of the solubilized waterborne paints are based on alkyd or polyester
resins.  Table 3-14 shows the solids and water content of several types of
waterborne paints.
     A common method of solubilizing is to incorporate carboxyl-containing
materials such as maleic anhydride and acrylic acid into the polymer.  The
acids are then "solubilized" with low molecular weight amines such as
triethylamine.   After application, the coatings are baked and the water,
                                                                  128
solvent, and amine evaporate leaving a pigment film on the object.
     The use of waterborne coatings can reduce the explosion problem
associated with organic solvent-based paints.  Some organic solvents are
used, but the amount used is greatly reduced.  Waterborne coatings have the
additional value of reducing the amount of air flow needed from the
application areas and curing ovens and can reduce energy consumption.
     In organic solvent-based paints, relatively few monomers can be used
because of solubility and viscosity.  Molecular weights are especially
restricted.  In waterborne coatings, the selection of useable monomers is
much wider.  In addition, waterborne paints can contain a higher solids
                                  3-35

-------
                 Table 3-13.   PROPERTIES OF WATERBORNE  COATINGS
Properties
Latex or
emulsion
paints
Partially
sol utilized
dispersions
Water-soluble
coatings
Molecular weight

Viscosity
Viscosity
  control
Solids content

Gloss

Chemi cal
  resistance

Exterior
  durability

Impact
  resistance

Stain
  resistance

Color reten-
tion on oven
bake

Reducer


Wash-up
Up to 1 million   50,000 to 200,000   20,000 to 50,000
Low - not de-
pendent on mole-
cular weight

Require thick-
ness
High

Low

Excellent


Excellent


Excellent


Excellent


Excellent



Water


 Difficult
Somewhat depen-
dent on molecu-
lar weight

Thickened by
addition of
co-solvent

Medium

Medium

Good to
excellent

Excellent
Excellent


Good
 Good to
 excellent
 Water
 Moderately
 difficult
Very dependent on
molecular weight
Governed by mole-
cular weight and
solvent control

Low

High

Fair to good


Very good


Good to excellent


 Fair to good


 Fair  to good
 Water or solvent/
 water mix

 Easy
                                    3-36

-------
                     Table  3-14.   SOLIDS  AND SOLVENT
                      CONTENT  OF  WATERBORNE  PAINTS
Waterborne
paint system
High solids polyester
Coil -coating polyester
High solids alkyd
Short oil alkyd
Water reducible polyester
Water reducible alkyd
High solids water reducible
Solids content
volume percent
80
51
80
34
48
29
80
Water to
solvent ratio
80/20
51/49
80/20
34/66
82/18
67/33
90/10
conversion varnish
                                 3-37

-------
content than organic solvent-based coatings without an increase in
          42
viscosity.
     An additional advantage of waterborne systems is ease of cleanup.
Waterborne paint systems can usually be cleaned with water whereas organic
solvent-based systems require solvents for cleaning.  Organic solvent may
be needed for cleanup of waterborne systems if the paint has dried.
     A problem associated with waterborne systems is the propensity to rust
and corrode.  Coating lines, including ovens, must therefore be protected
by the use of stainless steel or some other appropriate material.
     Another disadvantage is the requirement for more pretreatment.  Most
organic solvent-based systems can tolerate small amounts of grease or oil
on the surface to be coated because they  have the ability to "self clean"
the part.  This  is  not true for most waterborne systems in that  the surface
                                                               129
must be totally  oil  free or the paint will not adhere properly.     This
can increase pretreatment costs.  On the  other hand, drying is not always
needed prior to  coating; therefore this step may be  eliminated and
pretreatment costs  decreased.
     Ambient humidity levels can  cause problems for  waterborne systems.  On
days of high humidity the drying  process  may be slowed, requiring proper
air conditioning to overcome the  problem.   In  addition, a  longer flash-off
time  is usually  needed  for  waterborne  systems  thereby  increasing space
requirements.
      Color availability  has been  suggested as  a problem with waterborne
coatings.  One  furniture manufacturer  reports,  however, that any color can
be obtained and that the quality  of  the  finish is  as good  or better  than
                                       122
 that  of organic solvent-based  systems.
      Summaries  of the advantages  and disadvantages of waterborne paints  are
 presented in Table 3-15 and 3-16.   The use of  these coatings  in  the  metal
 furniture industry is limited  at  present; however, it is  expected to
          130
 increase.
      3.1.3.1  Waterborne Spray.   Spraying of waterborne paints has been
 used little in the past although  it is a growing technology.   At present,
 waterborne paints are being applied electrostatically on commercial  equip-
 ment,131"133 farm machinery,134'135 automobiles,136 fabricated metal
                                  3-38

-------
            Table 3-15.   ADVANTAGES OF WATERBORNE COATINGS
1.   Reduction of fire or explosion potential  and toxicity in
    both the storage and application areas.
2.   Greater variety of available monomers.
3.   Higher solids content possible at same viscosity.
4.   Lower raw material cost (e.g., water vs.  solvent).
5.   Ease of clean-up.
6.   Good selection of colors.
7.   Good quality finish.
8.   Can be formulated for metal!ics.
9.   Rapid color changes possible.
         Table 3-16.  DISADVANTAGES OF WATERBORNE COATINGS
1.  Protection of equipment against rust needed.
2.  More pretreatment may be required than for organic
    solvent-based paint.
3.  Longer flash-off may be required.
4.  Humidity control equipment may be necessary.
5.  Possible emission of amines to the atmosphere.
6.  "Faraday effect" is a problem for certain shapes.
7.  Metallic finishes from organic solvent-based coatings have
    not been matched with other waterborne coatings.
                              3-39

-------
products,137"139 and appliances',140 as well as on metal furniture.122'141'142
     Since waterborne paints are readily atomized, they can be applied by
                                                                    140 143
air, airless, or by electrostatic spray using guns, disks, or bells.   '
These can be operated manually or automatically.  Waterborne and organic
solvent-borne pai.its are generally of similar viscosity; therefore, there
are few if any differences between spray systems for the two coating types.
Waterborne paints are more corrosive however, and require the use of
stainless steel or plastic pipes and pumps, and stainless steel or aluminum
spray nozzles.
     The only significant problem associated with electrostatic spraying of
waterborne paints is a safety hazard resulting  from the high conductivity
of  the paint itself.  As the paint is charged at the gun, the charge travels
back through the supply line to the paint  reservoir.   The system, therefore,
must be insulated or isolated.  This presents no problem for small  operations;
however, for large facilities using separate paint supply rooms,  it presents
a  significant problem.  There is a possible method for overcoming this
disadvantage.   It involves  the  use of a  small paint reservoir at  the  spray
booth which, through the  use of a  level  sensor, is automatically  filled  as
needed  from  the main paint  supply  line.  The  supply line  is equipped  with  a
spray nozzle similar to that of a  garden hose and the  line  is grounded.
The small  paint reservoir is charged  to  approximately  90  kV and is  isolated.
As the  supply  line  fills  the  reservoir,  the  electrostatic charge  atomizes
the paint,  thus producing an  air gap  between the reservoir  and  the nozzle.
This gap  isolates  the  supply  line  and paint  supply room from  the  electro-
 static  charge  at the booth.   Color changes with this  type of  system can be
 accomplished through the  use  of multiple reservoirs  at the spray booth.
These buckets  are small  and could  be  changed within  a matter of seconds.
      The system appears  to  be technically feasible although it has not been
 applied to an actual coating line.   The technology was developed by the
 Applied Technology Division of TRW,  Inc.,  while designing a charged droplet
 scrubber.   The system has been successfully tested for that operation.
      The basic spray painting process using waterborne paint differs very
 little from a process using organic solvent-borne coating.      Emissions
 come from the spray booth,  flash-off area, and curing oven.  The magnitude
                                   3-40

-------
of the emissions is dependent upon the organic solvent content of the paint
and the efficiency with which it is applied.   Transfer efficiency for
conventional spraying ranges from 30 to 60 percent depending upon a number
of variables including part complexity.    Electrostatic spraying by guns,
disks, and bells can increase to levels ranging from 60 to 95 percent.   '
     3.1.3.2  Waterborne Dip Coating.   Dip coating is one of the most
              	                                145
common techniques for the application of waterborne paints.      This method
is presently being used in the automobile and bicycle industries as well as
in the metal furniture industry.          The dip coating process is
essentially the same for waterborne as with organic solvent-borne coatings.
The dip tank must be constructed of stainless steel or some other corrosion
resistant material and the flash-off period may have to be longer for the
reasons previously explained.  These are the only significant differences
between the two systems.
     The factors affecting emissions from a dip coating line are the same
as for spray coating.  The transfer efficiency for dip coating of waterborne
paint is estimated at 90 percent which is the same as for organic
solvent-borne paint.
     3,1.3.3  Electrodeposition of Waterbornes.  Electrodeposition  (EDP)  of
waterborne paint is one of the most promising emission control techniques
available.  It  has proved successful when applied to automobiles, lawnmowers,
metal furniture, and miscellaneous other metal parts and products.
Electrodeposition  is capable of applying a 0.25 urn (1 mil) coating  in a
single application which makes  it very attractive to the metal furniture
industry.  Autophoretic coating which  is similar to  EDP is not used in the
metal furniture industry because this  technique is presently  limited to
                 150
black paint only.
      Electrodeposition  involves lowering parts to be coated  into a  tank of
low solids waterborne coating solution.  The  tank or the periphery  of the
tank  are  negatively charged while the  parts are grounded.  The negatively
charged polymer is  attracted to the metal surface and  is deposited  uniformly.
                                               152
Systems of  opposite polarity can also  be used.    Figure 3-7  represents a
typical EDP line using  ultrafiltration.
                                     3-41

-------
CO
I

-P*

ro
                                                           Deionized Water
                                    S     IS     —
                  v^Conveyor  ^x"      >^gJ^.-j
              Electrodeposition

                  Dip Tank



                 Paint Supply
                                            Rinse Tank #2       Rinse Tank #3
                                  Paint Return
                  Ultrafiltration
Ultrafiltrate
                                                      Holding Tank
                                                         Drain
                                     Figure 3-7.  Typical EDP coating system.

-------
     Electrodeposition lines require a deionized water rinse stage at the
end of the pretreatment cycle which is not found in other systems; however,
a dry-off oven, though often used, is not required.  The rinsed parts are
lowered into the EDP tank containing waterborne paint consisting of a 7 to
                                             1 ^"3
10 percent dispersion of a colloidal polymer.      To avoid striping, the DC
current is not applied until the parts are totally submerged.   Dwell time
in the tank is typically 1.5 to 2 minutes.153'154  The thickness of the
coating can be controlled by selecting the appropriate dwell time and
electrical potential. The voltage ranges from 50 to 400 volts and the
amperaqe ranges from 50 to 4,000 amps.  Average conditions involve a voltage
                                                       125 152
of 200 to 250 volts and an amperage of 300 to 450 amps.
     After the current is turned off, the parts are lifted from the bath,
drained, rinsed in deionized water to remove "dragout," and then baked.
Solids from the dragout are carried by the rinse water and collected by
ultrafiltration.  The rinse water is passed through an ultrafilter which
allows no particles  larger than 200 angstroms to pass.  Only water, some
electrolyte, and organic solvent permeate the filter and are reused in the
                                                                          41
rinse.  Resin  and pigment materials are returned directly to the  EDP tank.
This process is reported to reduce paint consumption by up to 30 percent.    '
     The quality of  the finish  is affected by voltage, amperage,  tempera-
                                                119
ture,  dwell time, pH, and paint solids content.     Excessively high voltage
causes holes in the  coating due to gassing.  Too high  a temperature  is
detrimental due to possible paint flocculation  at  temperatures approaching
305  K  (90°F).  At high pH levels, there  is a reduction in deposition;  if
the  pH drops below the isoelectric point, the entire  tank of paint  can
coagulate.
     As the paint solids are  attracted to the grounded metal part,  they
tend to "wring" the  water out of  the  coating leaving  the coating  which  is
approximately  90 percent solids with  the  remaining 10  percent consisting
primarily  of water.   Approximately  2.5 percent  of  the  coating on  the sub-
                                    -i pc
 strate is  volatile  organic  solvent.      If the  solids  content  in  the EDP
 tank is too  high, the voltage cannot  "wring" the moisture from the  deposited
 film;  if  the paint  is too  low in  solids,  the film  can  be too thin.
                                  3-43

-------
     Furniture parts painted With EDP are normally baked for 15 to 30
minutes at 410 to 480 K (275° to 400°F).
     The EDP process has three potential  sources of VOC emissions:  solvent
evaporation during curing, evaporation from the surface of the EDP tanks,
and evaporation from the cascading rinse  water.  Emissions from the tank
surface and the rinse water are very minor.   This is due to a large extent
to the ultrafiltration process. Emissions from the curing oven are low due
to the small quantity of solvent on the wet substrate.
     3.1.3.4  Waterborne Flow Coating.  Waterborne flow coating is
essentially no different from flow coating with organic solvent-based
paint.  This process has seen use in several industries including those
producing major appliances, trailers, and metal furniture.158'159  As with
other types of waterborne applications, certain precautions have to be
taken to prevent rusting of the flow coating chamber and nozzles.
     Sources of emissions from this system are the flow coating chamber,
flash-off area, and curing oven.  Emissions from the flash-off and curing
steps are similar to other waterborne processes.  Emissions from the flow
coating chamber are dependent upon the transfer efficiency which is achieved.
This is estimated to be approximately 90 percent.
3.2  EMISSIONS CONTROL WITH ADD-ON CONTROL EQUIPMENT
     Each of the following sections describes add-on air pollution control
equipment for VOC emissions as follows:
     •    Processes which employ add-on control equipment in the metal
          furniture industry
     •    Principle behind add-on control devices
     •    Variables of performance
     •    Process descriptions
     t    Advantages and disadvantages
     •    Process VOC controls
     •    Operating parameters for new add-on control devices.
3.2.1  Carbon Adsorption
     Carbon adsorption as a control technique has been commercially used
for several years.  Although carbon adsorbers are not being employed in the
metal furniture industry, nor any other metal coating industry to date,
                                  3-44

-------
several other facilities within the surface coating industry have used
carbon adsorption to control VOC emissions.  These industries include those
which surface coat paper, and rubber products.I60~163  it is felt that
carbon adsorbers have the potential to be incorporated in the metal
furniture industry.
     In general terms, the principle behind adsorption as it applies to the
metal furniture industry includes the following.  The "activated" carbon
constitutes the adsorbent, and the organic solvent that is removed from an
airstream is referred to as the adsorbate.  For the metal furniture industry,
there is a mixture of organic solvents or adsorbates.   These include a
complex combination of aliphatics, aromatics, esters,  ketones, alcohols,
etc.  '   '     Adsorption of the adsorbates occurs at the surface of the
adsorbent.   The effectiveness of the adsorbent depends on its surface area,
porosity and existence of capillaries.  In the metal furniture industry,
for each adsorbate removed, the type of adsorption is  "physical."  Physical
adsorption means that the adsorbates are collected by and removed from the
adsorbent without a chemical change.   All adsorption processes are exother-
mic, and for surface coating operations, the temperature change in a carbon
bed would be about 10 K.34'164'165
     There are several variables which affect the performance of carbon
adsorbers and most are related mathematically to the adsorptive capacity of
the carbon.   This term, adsorptive capacity, defines the weights of adsor-
bates that can be retained on a given weight of carbon and is expressed
below:166

                    Adsorptive Capacity = T 1ogV(Co/Ci)
where,  adsorptive capacity = 9 of adsorbate
            v       ^    J   g of adsorbent
     Vm = liquid molar volume of adsorbate at normal boiling point
      T = absolute temperature
     Co = concentration of adsorbate at saturation
     Ci  = initial  adsorbate concentration into adsorber
The liquid molar volume of an individual adsorbate is  related to the
individual  molecular weight and density of the solvent at its boiling
                                 3-45

-------
point.   The greater the Vm of the adsorbates, the higher the molecular
weights and boiling points.   In other words, carbon generally has a greater
adsorptive capacity for higher boiling solvents.   The removal of solvents
by physical adsorption is practical for adsorbates with molecular weights
        32
over 45.    The actual quantity of adsorbates removed increases as their
concentration increases and the adsorbent temperature decreases.
     Generally, physical adsorption of a group of adsorbates in the metal
furniture industry results in both low and high boilers at first being
adsorbed across the bed uniformly.  However, as more high boilers increase
on the adsorbent, the more volatile portion of the adsorbates are vaporized.
At this point, the bed has reached the breakthrough point.  This process
continues until the exit airstream contains the highest boiling component
which means the adsorbent is saturated.  In practice, it  is best to operate
the carbon bed until the breakthrough point has been reached and then the
                   32
bed is regenerated.
     Figure 3-8 shows a typical carbon adsorption process and is repre-
sentative of a unit that could be  installed at a metal furniture facility.
Usually, the equipment consists of a filter and cooler, blower, two carbon
beds, condenser, and decanter.  The blower maintains a constant flow of
organic vapor-laden air to the unit.  As the airstream travels through the
carbon adsorber, it is first filtered to remove particulate matter and
cooled to no greater than 311 K (100°F).  The adsorbates  in the airstream
are adsorbed onto the activated carbon in one of the two  carbon beds.
Usually, two carbon beds are adequate for continuous operation; one unit
adsorbs gaseous organics, while the other is desorbed with steam or hot
air.  However, three or more carbon beds may handle more  effectively the
heterogeneous mixture of adsorbates resulting from the surface  coating of
metal furniture.   For the three bed case, two beds in series operate while
the third  is regenerated.  This permits the  activated carbon bed to remain
in service after breakthrough since the second bed in series removes the
low boiling solvents emitted from the first  bed.  When the first bed becomes
saturated, it  is removed from service and regenerated.  The  second bed then
becomes the first  bed and the newly regenerated bed  is the new  second bed
in series.34'164'166'167
                                      3-46

-------
                                                                                           Stripped
                                                                                             Air
Vapor-
laden
Air-
stream.
CO
I
  I
Filter
                          Cooler     Blower
                                                     Adsorber No. 1
                                                                 y
                                                     Adsorber No. 2
                                            Low-pressure
                                                Steam
                                                                             •>
                                                                                Condenser
                                                                                                  Jte covered
                                                                                                  "Solvent
                                                                                                    Water
                                                                                          Decanter
                                       Figure 3-8.  Carbon adsorption process.

-------
     During the desorption process,  organics  are removed from the carbon
bed by blowing steam,  hot air or inert gas across the bed.   The removed
organic vapors and steam (the preferred carrier gas)  are liquified from the
airstream in a condenser.   The collected solvents and water are then
separated in a decanter.   To separate the recovered mixture into reusable
solvents would require fractional distillation.    '     An alternative to
this approach is to incinerate the organics in order to recover heat to
produce steam for other processes at the plant.   '   '
     Tables 3-17 and 3-18 list advantages and disadvantages for employing
carbon adsorbers on coating lines in the metal furniture industry.  The
advantages and disadvantages discussed relate only to carbon adsorbers that
have the potential to be employed on coating lines that apply conventional
solvent-based paints to metal parts.  The remainder of this section concen-
trates upon the emissions from a coating line and determines what processes
on the coating line can be controlled by carbon adsorbers.
     Theoretically, carbon adsorbers could be employed to control VOC from
the application, flash-off and bake oven areas.  The applicability of doing
this is discussed in detail for each process area that emits VOCs.
     Carbon adsorbers could be used to control VOCs from all of the
different types of application techniques (including touch-up) such as
spray, flow, dip, and roller coating.  The percent of VOC emitted from the
                                         44
application areas is shown in Table 3-19.    The table indicates that
carbon adsorbers are best employed for coating methods using spray and
flow.  All of the coating methods could feasibly be controlled by this
method if the flash-off area were enclosed and flash-off air were vented
along with the air from the application area to  the carbon adsorber.
Generally, most of the emitted solvents from the application and  flash-off
areas used in the metal furniture industry fall  into a molar volume range
(80 to 190 cmVmole) that is generally acceptable  for adsorption.  Table
3-20 lists some of the solvents  that present problems for carbon  adsorbers.
Of the solvents listed, nonane (a component of most grades of mineral
spirits)  is commonly used in the metal furniture  industry.  Mineral spirits
are used  in substantial proportions  in many alkyd  and acrylic  enamels  but
might not be  effectively  desorbed with either  super heated steam  or hot
                                  3-48

-------
        Table 3-17.  ADVANTAGES FOR EMPLOYING CARBON ADSORBERS
 Advantage                                              Reference


 1.   Proven technology for controlling
     solvent emissions in other non-related
     industries.                                      Ill, 168, 169

 2.   If treating a homogeneous phase, reduced
     costs because of solvent recovered.              Ill, 168
     Table 3-18.   DISADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING CARBON ADSORBERS
 Disadvantage                                           Reference


 1.  Carbon beds that treat exhaust concentrations
     of 100-200 ppm of solvent require large
     amounts of steam during regeneration (30 kg/
     kg of solvent).                                  44, 164, 168

 2.  Materials of construction must be
     corrosive resistant.                             44, 164, 168

 3.  The Mass Transfer Zone (MTZ) will increase
     as air velocities increase.                      44, 164

 4.  Increased non-production related operating
     costs of a facility.                             168

 5.  Adsorbers have to handle a mixture of
     solvents.                                       44
 6.  Effluents from bake ovens must be cooled
     to less than 310 K (lOQOF).                      44

 7.  Water vapor (spray booths) from the
     application area would compete for
     adsorptive sites.                               44
 8.  High boiler solvents  emitted from the bake
     oven would be difficult to desorb.              Ill,  170

 9.  Polymerized products  and plasticizers from
     the bake oven could foul  a carbon bed.           44

10.  Carbon bed fires can  occur.                      Ill

11.  Any particulate  can coat a carbon bed and
     render it ineffective.                          44
                               3-49

-------
               Table  3-19.  PERCENT  OF TOTAL VOC  EMISSIONS
                                                 42
                       FROM VARIOUS COATING STEPS
Coating Method3
Spray Coat
Flow Coat
Dip Coat
Roller Coat
Coating Step
Application Flash-Off
30-50
30-50
5-10
0- 5
10-30
20-40
10-30
10-20
Bake Oven
20-40
10-30
50-70
60-80
aCoating only with organic solvent-based coatings.



           Table 3-20. PROBLEM SOLVENTS  FOR  CARBON ADSORPTION169
Sol vent
Dodecane
Undecane
2-ethylhexyl acetate
Decane
Butyl carbitol
Nonane
2,6-dimethyl 4-heptanone
Di ethyl cyclohexane
Butyl cyclohexane
1 -methyl pentyl acetate
Di ethyl cyclopentane
Nitroethane
Propanone
Dichloromethane
Ethanol
Nitromethane
Methanol
Boiling
Vmcm3/mol
274
251
238
229
213
207
207
207
207
194
192
75
74
65
61
53
42
Point
K
489
468
472
447
504
423
446
—
447
—
425
389
329
313
351
374
339
(°F)
(421)
(383)
(390)
(345)
(448)
(302)
(345)
—
(345)
—
(307)
(239)
(133)
(104)
(173)
(214)
(149)
                                    3-50

-------
    129
air.      The major disadvantages that might prevent this control technique
from being employed on this part of the coating line are 1, 3, 5, and 7
(Table 3-18).
     Controlling VOCs from the flash-off area offers three alternatives all
of which require enclosing the flash-off area:   (a) control combined air
flow from the flash-off and application areas (already discussed); (b)
control individual air flow from flash-off; and (c) control combined air
flow from the flash-off and baking oven areas.   A fourth alternative,
representative of the industry, is to allow this area to remain as a fugi-
tive source of VOCs.     For carbon adsorbers, the handling of emissions
from the flash-off area depends in part on a detailed analysis of Table
3-19.
     The last area emitting VOCs that could be controlled by a carbon
adsorber is the baking oven.   However, Disadvantages 2, 5, 6, 8, and 9
shown in Table 3-18 may prevent utilization of this control technique for
most metal furniture bake oven VOC emissions.  Section 3.4.1 discusses the
control efficiencies of using carbon adsorbers when employed to control VOC
emissions from the various process areas.   Table 3-21 contains information
considered to be representative for new metal furniture coating lines
employing carbon adsorbers.
3.2.2  Incineration
     Incineration of gaseous  organics has been widely used in several
industrial surface coating industries including the metal furniture
         124
industry.     Other industries which have successfully employed incinera-
tion as a control technique for VOC emissions include automobile, paper,
                                        Ifi3 17?~-lftfi
can fabric, and coil  coating  industries.    '         Data from these indus-
tries indicate that incineration could also be considered a possible control
technique for the metal furniture industry.
     There are two different  types of incineration processes:  thermal or
direct flame,  and catalytic.   Before these two incineration methods are
described, a brief explanation of the principle of this control technique
for VOCs is provided here as  it relates to the metal furniture industry.
     In general terms, the gaseous solvents emitted from a coating line are
combustible materials which can under proper conditions be converted to
                                 3-51

-------
                 Table  3-21.   PROCESS OPERATING PARAMETERS FOR
              CARBON ADSORBERS EMPLOYED TO  CONTROL VOC EMISSIONS
     Parameter
               Operating range
Application area
     Air flow through adsorber
     Carbon in bed
     Blower
     Number of carbon beds
     Saturation point
     Percent by volume of
     solvent in coating
     Steam usage
     Carbon bed replacement
4.7-21 SCMS (10,000-45,000 SCFM)159'160'161
5,000-12,000 kg (11,000-27,000 lb)159'160'162
2_3159,161
60-90 min.
161
50_78159,160,161
30 kg/kg of solvent (30 Ib/lb of solvent)163
0.5-2 yr.Ul.162.163
                                    3-52

-------
carbon dioxide and water vapor.   However,  no combustion process is TOO
percent efficient and some carbon monoxide is formed.   During the incinera-
tion of these materials, proper control  of time, temperature, and turbu-
lence determines how efficient the incinerator is in controlling VOC emis-
sions.  The remainder of this section concentrates on the two types of
incineration.
     3.2.2.1  Thermal or Direct Flame Incinerator.  A thermal incinerator
consists essentially of a fuel feed system and burners, a combustion zone,
and a means of exhausting the products of combustion.   The auxiliary fuel
is usually natural gas, although propane and butane and some fuel oils are
employed.  The purpose of the burners is to combust the auxiliary fuel so
that the temperature inside the combustion chamber is high enough to ensure
incineration of the gaseous vapors emitted from the coating  line.  This
zone of the thermal incinerator must also provide good mixing.  There are
four types of gas burners which are used to burn the auxiliary fuel; nozzle-
mixing, premixing, multiport, and mixing plates.  The gas burners are
arranged either in distributive or discrete patterns.  Nozzle-mixing and
premixing burners are arranged in distributive patterns for  which firing  is
done  tangentially (Figure 3-9).  Air for combustion of the gaseous fuel  is
taken from the waste stream or outside air.  The  contaminated air stream  is
                                                                   32 44
introduced tangentially or along the major axis of the incinerator.   '
     Multiport burners  are installed across a section of the incinerator
and use only the air from the waste stream for  combustion.   This  type of
incineration cannot  handle all of the VOC contaminated airstream.  Thus  the
portion of the waste stream that is bypassed mixes with the  burner flames
                                 32 44
in a  restricted and  baffled area.   '
      Mixing  plate burners (discrete pattern) are  placed across the inlet  of
the incinerator and  the flames are mixed directly with the VOC contaminated
exhaust  stream.  This mixing  provides high velocities which  improves  turbu-
lence of the waste stream.  Figure 3-10 shows an  example of  a burner  employing
mixing plates.32'44  Figure 3-11 shows a burner that employs fuel  oil as
the auxiliary  fuel.  This type of  incinerator uses  a discrete pattern.
      To  increase  mixing in all of  the above  mentioned  burning techniques,
baffles  or  turning vanes  are  placed  in front of the  air  inlet zone.   Also,
                                  3-53

-------
                                                                 Exhaust


                                                                    A
Vapor-Laden
Airstream
   Natural  Gas
                Figure  3-9.   Incinerator with a distributed burner
                                    3-54

-------
co
en
cn
                  Natural Gas
D        Adjustable-1
           Gap
D
D
D
D
                                     \
                                 Vapor-Laden
                                 Airstream
                                                        Baffles
                                                                                         M

                                                                                       Exhaust
           ^•"T-VT" /   /   /////////
                                              Figure  3-10.   Incinerator employing mixing  plates

-------
co
                        Vapor-Laden
                         Airstream
             Fuel
                                                                                         Exhaust
                  Combustion
                      Air
                                 Figure 3-11.  Incinerator  using  a  discrete  burner.

-------
tangential air inlet is part of the design of the burner.   The mixing in
this part of the incinerator is very critical to efficient burning of the
                44
gaseous solvent.
     The next part of the incinerator is the combustion zone.   After the
temperature of the vapor-laden airstream is raised, the combustion zone
must maintain this temperature and provide the required residence time for
the organic solvents to be converted to carbon dioxide and water vapor.   A
range of 922 to 1,089 K (1,200° to 1,500°F) for 0.3 to 0.5 seconds is quite
efficient in converting most gaseous solvents to carbon dioxide and water
vapor.   Insufficient combustion chamber volume has been the most significant
design flaw in the failure of some incinerators.   The size of the combus-
tion chamber is determined by the volumetric flow rate of the vapor-laden
gas stream, and combustion products at the design temperature and retention
     44
time.
     Additional equipment that can be installed along with thermal
incinerators consists of heat recovery equipment.  This equipment has been
employed only with incinerators that control VOC emissions from bake oven
areas.   Heat recovery equipment reduces the amount of fuels required by the
incinerator and,  in some cases, by the bake ovens.  The type of heat recovery
equipment varies depending on the desired amount of fuel savings.  The
various heat recovery equipment and approximate thermal energy that can be
recovered are shown in Table 3-22.
     Figure 3-12 shows an incinerator equipped with a single pass fume
preheater.  Required equipment includes a preheat recuperator, piping, and
a pump for the working fluid.   Heat recovered by-this system can be used in
the metal dry-off ovens and makeup air for the oven.   '   '
     A second heat recovery system which is more efficient than the single
pass is a multiple chamber preheat and recovery system.  This type of heat
recovery system has been installed on a coil coating line.   The equipment
includes an incinerator equipped with an odd number of preheat and recovery
chambers which contain stoneware material.   In operation,  the bake oven
exhaust is preheated in one chamber before passing through the incinerator,
and heat is recovered from the incinerator exhaust stream.   Each chamber
can serve to preheat or recover heat in this system.   All  of the recovered
                                 3-57

-------
       Table 3-22.  HEAT RECOVERY EQUIPMENT AND THERMAL ENERGY RECOVERY

Heat recovery               Percent of thermal energy
equipment                   recovered from incinerator       Reference

Single-pass fume preheater            40-69             44, 177,  189, 194
Multi-pass preheat and recovery       70-90             44, 177
Regenerative heat exchanger           75-90             44
Inert Gas drying system                 90              191
                                    3-58

-------
CO
I
en
             Di lution Air —£*


                 Work In	>
                                              Fuel
Bake Oven
                                                                             To  Exhaust
                                                          ->-Work Out
                            Figure  3-12.  Bake oven equipped with  incinerator and heat  recovery.

-------
energy is maintained with the process.   Another example (regenerative heat
exchange) of this type of heat recovery equipment uses both refractory and.
                                   44 177
rotary plates instead of stoneware.   '
     A proposed inert gas drying system would reduce fuel  consumption in
the incinerator and bake oven.   In this system, the incinerator handles
only an inert gas with solvent vapors exhausted from a bake oven.   The
incinerator only required auxiliary fuel for a pilot burner and just enough
combustion air (stoichiometrically balanced ) to burn the solvents in the
inert gas stream.  This produces an exhaust gas from the incinerator which
contains very little oxygen.   Heat from the incinerator exhaust gas is
recovered and heat demand in the bake oven is satisfied by recycling the
cooled incinerator exhaust stream through the bake oven.  Heat captured in
the heat recovery system can be used in the metal preparation area.  The
inert gas drying system can reduce the size of the bake oven (reduced lower
explosive limit [LEL] concerns) and the incinerator.  The proposed system
                                         191
and incinerator are shown in Figure 3-13.
     Tables 3-23 and 3-24 provide advantages and disadvantages of employing
incineration as a control technique for processes on a metal furniture
coating line.
     Thermal incinerators could be employed on all three process areas that
emit VOCs on a coating line.   However, as mentioned in Table 3-24,
Disadvantage 3 would be a significant problem for controlling VOCs from a
spray booth because of air flow requirements based on the threshold limit
value (TLV) which by definition demands more air than lower explosive limit
values used by ovens.  For TLVs, about 60 times more air is necessary above
the amount that  is required for evaporation.  Thus, it  is not practical to
recommend thermal incinerators for the spray booth or an enclosed  flash-off
area (which would require TLV design basis).   '
     Thermal incinerators have only been employed successfully on  bake
ovens.  With heat recovery equipment to  reduce fuel consumption, thermal
incinerators have proven to be an acceptable control technique for this
process area.  Also, from Table 3-19,  it appears for the dip and roller
application methods that the majority  of VOCs would be  controlled  by this
method.  Finally, if the flash-off area was enclosed and designed  to
                                  3-60

-------
GO

cr>
Dilution

 Work In
                                               Pilot
                                               Burner
                                                LT
                                      Incinerator
                              Bake Oven
                                                n.
                                               Pilot
                                               Burner
                                                                       •>-To Vent
                                                          Heat
                                                         Recovery
                                                         System
                                                         • Air
                                                          a MI
xer
                                                                                               Work Out
                                            Figure  3-13.  Inert  gas  drying system.

-------
Table 3-23.  ADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING THERMAL INCINERATION AS A
                         CONTROL TECHNIQUE
Advantage                                          Reference


1.  Has small space requirement, low-maintenance   167
    operation.

2.  Can provide waste boiler heat for other plant  167
    operations.

3.  With heat recovery equipment, can provide
    energy to other process areas.                 44, 177, 189-194
Table 3-24.  DISADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING THERMAL INCINERATION AS A
                         CONTROL TECHNIQUE
Disadvantage                                       Reference
1.  High operating costs in areas of large air
    requirements with low VOC concentrations
    (0.1 to 10 percent LEL).                       167

2.  Cannot be used on some types of halogenated
    solvents because of toxic combustible
    products.                                      167

3.  Large air flows (e.g., from spray booth)
    reduce the efficiency of an incinerator.       44, 162

4.  Problem of auto-ignition for single-pass
    heat recovery systems, because of
    condensation.                                  177

5.  Warping of materials of construction for
    some incinerators.                             174, 181
                                  3-62

-------
 handle  air  flows  in  the  25  percent  LEL  range,  it  might  be  practical  to
 combine this  flow with bake oven  exhaust  to  further  reduce VOC  emissions
 from  the coating  line.
      Table  3-25 contains  the process  operating parameters  for thermal
 incinerators  that have been employed  on surface coating lines other  than
 the metal furniture  industry.   This information is considered to  be
 representative of a  metal furniture bake  oven employing thermal incinera-
 tion  to control VOC  emissions.
      3.2.2.2  Catalytic  Incineration.  The catalytic  incinerator  differs
 from  the direct-fired unit  in that the catalyst enables combustion of the
 solvent at  a  lower temperature.   The  catalyst promotes  combustion by
 increasing  the rate  of oxidation  reactions without itself  changing chemi-
 cally.   Oxidation of the  solvents occurs  at  the surface of the  catalyst
 (Figure 3-14).34,44,168
      A  catalytic  incinerator contains a preheat section, a chamber which
 contains  the  catalyst, temperature indicator and  controllers, safety equip-
 ment  and optional heat recovery equipment.   The preheat section is used to
 raise the temperature of  the incoming gas stream  to 590  to  750  K  (600° to
 900°F).   The  preheat section is basically a  discrete burner followed by a
 mixing  zone.  The increase  of gas temperature obtained  in  the preheat
 section  is  sufficient for the solvent vapors to be catalytically burned as
 the gas  stream leaves the incinerator at an  elevated temperature of 700 to
 860 K (800° to 1,100°F).   Heat recovery equipment at the exit of a catalytic
 incinerator is optional.   This type of equipment  has already been discussed
 in Section 3.2.2.1.
     The catalyst itself  is usually of the platinum family of metals supported
 on metal or matrix elements made of ceramic honeycombs or  rods,  or aluminum
 pellets.  Criteria for catalyst supports are (a)  high geometric surface
 area,  (b) low pressure drop, (c) uniform gas flow across the surface of the
 catalyst, and (d) structural integrity and durability.  The performance of
 the catalyst  is dependent upon the temperature of the incoming gas and
 residence time between the solvent vapors  and catalyst.   In addition, the
efficiency of the catalyst is also a function of  organic compositions and
concentration being  oxidized.  ''
                                 3-63

-------
               Table 3-25.  PROCESS OPERATING PARAMETERS

                       FOR A THERMAL  INCINERATOR
Parameter
                 Range
Volumetric Flow Rate
Oven Exhaust Temperature
Oven Exhaust Residence Time
  Inside Incinerator

Incinerator Operating
  Temperature

Normal Operating Temperature

Single Pass Fume Preheater
  Exhaust
2.4 to 24 SCMS (5000 to 50 000 SCFM)172'
  176, 180, 187, 190


330 to 420 K (140»to 300°F)185' 187' 190'
  191
0.3 to 0.5 sec.
                                                 42
920 to 1250 K (1200°to 1800°F)162' 17°5
  172-175, 181, 187, 189, 190


1030 K(1400°F)

620 to 730 K  (650° to 850°F) 187' 19°
                                  3-64

-------
                PREHEAT
                BURNER
                                                   CATALYST
                                                   ELEMENT
cn
   FUEL
 STREAM —
 300-480 K
(70-400 F)
                                      590-750 K
                                     (600-900 F)
 700-860 K
(800-1100 F)
 CLEAN GAS
•TO STACK
                         COMBUSTION/MIXING
                              CHAMBER
                                                                                OPTIONAL HEAT RECOVERY
                                                                                  (REGENERATIVE OR
                                                                                   RECYCLE SYSTEM)
                                Figure  3-14.  Schematic of catalytic afterburner system.

-------
     Tables 3-26 and 3-27 list advantages and disadvantages of employing
catalytic incinerators on coating lines for the metal furniture industry.
This information relates to coating lines that employ solvent based coatings
(e.g., the model plants) in the application area.
     Disadvantages 2 and 4 shown in Table 3-27 would present a problem for
a catalytic incinerator employed in the application area of a coating line.
Application areas (e.g., spray booths) would probably have to be equipped
with water curtains and maybe even filtration pads to collect particulates
emitted from applying the coating.  The particulate contains pigments and
additives.  Inorganic pigments contain heavy metals that can poison the
catalyst. The known heavy metal poisons contained in inorganic pigments are
zinc, lead, arsenic, bismuth, tin, and cadmium.  Organic pigments, addi-
tives (e.g., plasticizers, paint driers, etc.) and other metallic oxides
coat and deactivate (disadvantage 3) certain catalyst sites.  The catalyst
poisoning and deactivating coupled with high air flow requirements and low
vapor concentrations in the application oven exhaust reduces the effective-
ness of this control technique.  Therefore, catalytic incineration is not
recommended to control VOC emissions from the application area, or combined
                                32 44
application and flash-off areas.  '
     Catalytic incinerators could probably operate more effectively in
controlling VOC emissions from the bake oven.  This  is the process in which
the catalytic units have been employed to control VOCs in other surface
                  104.-107
coating industries         mainly due to the fact that the incinerator can
handle lower air flows and, in turn, higher solvent  vapor concentrations.
Catalyst coating still might occur for certain solvent based coatings
because of additives and plastic  resins.  Therefore, some gas conditioning
may be required for bake oven gaseous exhaust.
      It might also be applicable  to combine the flash-off area exhaust air
with  the bake oven exhaust.  This would require enclosing the flash-off
area with design flow rates of 25 percent LEL or less.  The disadvantages
of such a recommendation are:
      •    The exhaust air from the flash-off area would lower the temperature
          of bake oven  gaseous exhaust which,  in turn, increases the  fuel
          usage in the  preheat section of the catalytic unit.
                                  3-66

-------
            Table 3-26.  ADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING CATALYTIC

                  INCINERATION AS A CONTROL TECHNIQUE
     Advantage                                              Reference
1.

2.
Requires less auxiliary fuel to operate than
a thermal incinerator.
Smaller combustion chambers are employed
42

42
     than with a thermal  incinerator.
           Table  3-27.  DISADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING CATALYTIC

                  INCINERATION AS A CONTROL TECHNIQUE



     Disadvantage                                           Reference


1.   Platinum family metals are very expensive.              32

2.   Catalysts can be poisoned by heavy metals              32, 42, 193
     present in the off-gas stream.

3.   Deactivation of the catalyst can result from           32, 42,
     coating of catalyst sites and excessive use            166, 193
     at temperatures above 863 K (1100°F).

4.   Gas conditioning,  filtration of inlet  gas              42
     stream to incinerator, might  be necessary.
                                  3-67

-------
     •    Access to the flash-off area by plant personnel  would require
          that protective respiratory devices be worn.
     Table 3-28 contains process operating parameters for  a catalytic
incinerator employed to control  VOCs from bake ovens.   This information is
based on data collected for catalytic units installed on bake ovens in
other surface coating industries.  However, these parameters are considered
representative for the metal furniture industry.
3.2.3  Condensation
     Vapor condensers have been employed principally in the refinery and
petrochemical, and the chemical  industries.  They have found use in
controlling odors from certain other industries (e.g., rendering cookers,
coal-tar-dipping, etc.).  Condensers have also been used as an integral
part of other air pollution control systems (e.g., carbon adsorbers).   '
Condensers have not been used in the metal furniture nor any other surface
coating industry to control VOC emissions.  However, since the exhaust from
metal furniture coating lines contains VOCs, this control  technique may be
employed under proper process conditions, alone or in conjunction with
another control technique.
     The principle behind condensation of vapors is operation of the condenser
at an increased pressure or to extract heat from the vapor-laden exhaust
stream.  In practice, air pollution control condensers operate through
removal of heat from the exhaust stream.  With this type of unit, condensa-
tion occurs through two distinct physical mechanisms:  (a) dropwise mechanism,
and (b) filmwise mechanism.  Only steam condenses in a truly dropwise
manner.  Dropwise condensation yields higher heat transfer coefficients
than film condensation.  Chemical promoters can be added to the condensing
surface of certain metals to prevent the condensate from forming a film.
It would be difficult to predict the physical mechanisms by which condensates
would form from exhaust streams  associated with the metal furniture or any
other surface coating industry.
     Two types of condensers that can be employed are contact and surface
condensers.  Contact condensers  require that the coolant physically mix
with the vapor-laden gas stream.  For the most part, only surface con-
densers are recommended for this control technique.
                                  3-68

-------
               Table 3-28.  PROCESS OPERATING PARAMETERS
                      FOR A CATALYTIC INCINERATOR
     Parameter             "                         Range


Volumetric Flow Rate               1.9 to 17 SCMS (4000 to
                                        36 000 SCFM)182' 184'  185
Oven Exhaust Temperature           370 to 420 K (200° to 300°F)184'  185
                                                            d?
Preheated Temperature              590 to 750 K  (600-900°F)^
Operating Temperature of           700 to 860 K  (8000-1100°F)42'  183'  185
  Catalyst
Catalyst Replacement               0.2-3 years 182' 183
                                  3-69

-------
     Most surface condensers are the tube and shell  type.   Water or air
flows inside the tubes and vapors condense on the shell  side.   Usually, if
water is used as a coolant, chilling is required.  Surface condensers
recover 10 to 20 times less condensate than contact condensers.   Other
equipment that might be necessary is subcooling associated devices which
prevent the condensate from vaporizing after it has been discharged from
the condenser.  This depends upon whether the surface contactor is a
horizontal or vertical condenser.
     Figure 3-15 depicts a tube and shell system which uses an  inert or air
gas stream and a precooler to lower the bake oven exhaust gas temperature.
The inert or  air stream contains the vaporized solvent from the bake oven
which is removed in a two-stage condenser.  After the inert or  airstream
leaves  the second  condenser, it is preheated by  energy recovered  by  the
precooler to  satisfy the  heating requirements of the bake oven.   The  inert
gas  stream can  be  liquid  nitrogen or any  inert gas  at ambient temperature.
An  inert gas  system would reduce the size of the bake oven and  associated
fuel  requirements.  If  liquid nitrogen is used,  it  aids  in removing  the
qaseous solvent by condensation.  This type of system, therefore, would  be
                                          -I QC I Q~7
a combined  surface and  contact  condenser.    '
      Tables  3-29 and  3-30 contain advantages and disadvantages  for employing
condensation as a control  technique.   Because of the  disadvantages 1  through
 3 shown in  Table 3-30,  employing condensation to control  VOC  emissions from
 the application area  is not recommended.
      This control  technique can only be considered for  the flash-off or
 bake oven areas or both.   Combining the flash-off  exhaust with the bake
 oven exhaust stream would be beneficial since  the  oven's exhaust tempera-
 ture would be lowered.   This would reduce some of  the cooling requirements
 of the condenser.   However, this might require that the flash-off area be
 designed at flow rates of 25 percent  LEL.
      Table 3-31 contains process operating parameters for a condenser
 employed to control VOCs from the flash-off and bake oven areas.  Very
  little actual data are available for  controlling VOCs with the control
 technique for surface coating processes.   Even  though it is a proven  tech-
  nology, it has  not been demonstrated  successfully  on any surface coating
  line in the  metal furniture industry.
                                   3-70

-------
co
Recycled N_	^-
   Work  In
                                      H,,0  Condenser
                            Bleed-Off
                            Stream
                            -K
                               Heater
                     Bake  Oven
                                                                   Recovered
                                                                   Solvent
                                                               Recycled
                                                               N0 Stream
                                                              /  c.
                                                                                   c
                                                                                       Recovered
                                                                                       Solvent
                                                                                       Storage
Work Out
                               Figure  3-15.  Bake oven equipped with N9 condenser.

-------
                Table  3-29. ADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING

                CONDENSATION AS A CONTROL TECHNIQUE
Advantage                             	Reference

1.    Proven  technology  in other nonrelated industries.  109,166

2.    Recovered  heterogeneous mixtures of organic       42
      solvents could  be  burned  in a process boiler.

3.    Heat  exchangers and low temperature cooling        194
      coils can  reduce cooling  requirements (some-
      times up to  75%).

4.    May perform  best as an  integral  part of  other      109
      air pollution control equipment.
                Table  3-30.   DISADVANTAGES OF EMPLOYING

                  CONDENSATION AS A CONTROL TECHNIQUE



Disadvantage                       	Reference


1.   At a solvent concentration in the 100 to               32
     200 ppm range, refrigeration costs would
     be very expensive.

2.   Since most application areas for conventional          166
     solvent based paints are equipped with water
     curtains, the condensation of water and
     solvent would occur.  A decanter would be
     required to separate the collected water
     and solvents.

3.   Large air volumes or particulate matter can            109
     reduce condensation efficiencies by as much
     as 50%.

4.   Cooling  requirements are  more  demanding                 194, 195
     for bake  oven  exhaust  streams.
                                  3-72

-------
Table 3-31.  PROCESS OPERATING PARAMETERS FOR A SHELL TUBE CONDENSER
   Parameters                             Range


Volumetric flow rate             0.14 to 4.7 SCMS (300 to 10,000 SCFM)196

Oven exhaust temperature         3?° to 420 K (200° to 300°F) 186>187

Preheated temperatures of air    370 K (200°F)196'197
or inert gas to bake oven

Solvent concentration            1500 ppma

Pressure                         1.0 (105)Pa (1 atm)196


aModel plant concentration.
                                  3-73

-------
3.2.4  Other Add-on Control  Equipment and Process Modification
     This section discusses  other add-on equipment for controlling VOC
emissions, and process modification of existing conventional  solvent based
coatings to reduce VOC emissions.  Other add-on control devices evaluated
were process boilers, and absorption systems.   Both of these add-on control
devices were rejected because of technical problems associated with each
control system.  Therefore,  these control techniques will not be considered
in Chapter 5 (Model Plants and Regulatory Alternatives).
     Process modification, which would improve coating transfer efficien-
cies of existing lines applying conventional solvent based coatings, was
also rejected as a control technique.  It was rejected because there are no
possible process modifications which would reduce emissions below the level
                                                           103
specified by the existing State  Implementation Plans (SIP).
3.3  CONTROL EFFICIENCIES FOR COATING FORMULATION CHANGES
     This section establishes control efficiencies of  coating  formulation
changes such as powder,  high solids, and waterborne formulations.   The
bases  and assumptions for the control efficiencies are established  in the
following discussions.   The control  efficiencies presented in  this  section
are  utilized in Chapter  5 to determine  emission  reduction for  the model
plants in selecting  regulatory alternatives.
     It  is  assumed that  all of the  organic  solvent in  any paint  is  emitted
and  is proportional  to a ratio of percent solvent per  unit of  dry solids
applied.  This  is  not a  linear function  but instead an exponential
relationship.   As  solids content decreases  in  the coating, the organic
solvent  content increases exponentially.  This  ratio  can be  expressed
mathematically as  shown  below:

                      Relative Solvent  Emissions  =  RSE

                            Percent  Solvent
                      RSE =
                            Percent Solids
                     where percent solvent = 100 -  percent solids

                     DCC _ 100 - Percent Solids
                     Kbt     Percent Solids(3-2)
                                  3^74

-------
Equation 3-2 can also be employed to determine RSE values for waterborne by
adjusting the equation for the amount of solvent presented in the volatile
portion of the coating:
                     0<;r _ 100 ~ Percent Solids Pu
                     K5t ~   Percent Solids     *"v                    (3-3)
                     where FV = organic fraction of the volatile.

     Finally, the calculated RSE for different coating formulations can be
adjusted for different transfer efficiencies (TE) that result from applica-
tion techniques and coating types.
                         _ 100 - Percent Solids   FV
                            Percent Solids      x TE                  (3-4)

Equation 3-4 was employed to calculated RSE values for all coating
                                         44 77 ft? ftfi 9^
formulations on a volume or weight basis.   '  '  '  '
     To obtain emission reduction by volume or weight  basis when comparing
two different coatings,  the following example can be employed:

Example Calculation
     Determine the emission reduction (volume and weight basis) when
switching from a 35 percent by volume solids coating to a 70 percent by
volume solids coating.  Transfer efficiencies are 85 and 80 percent,
respectively.  Solvent density for both paints is 0.88 kg/liter.
     (a)  Using Equation 3-4 to determine emission reduction by volume.

               (RSE)35 =    ^5~ 0785" = 2'18
          .'., Emission reduction by volume is
                                       (RSE),, - (RSE)7n
          Percent Emission Reduction = - ?^cc\ - ~ (100)        (3-5)
                                     = 75 percent
                                  3-75

-------
     (b)  Determine emission reduction by weight:
          Equation 3-4 can be rewritten to consider percent solvent as
          shown below:

                        R<-r _   Percent Solvent     FV
                          *   1  - Percent Solvent x TE

     By multiplying both sides of the above equation by a solvent density
(ps), emission reduction by weight for two coatings can be obtained.   The
solvent density of 0.88 kg/liter is based on reference 106.
         o  (RSE)   =   Percent Solvent   x £V        0.65      	1_ n ftft
         ps ^KbtJ65   1 - Percent Solvent x TE ps ~ 1 - 0.65  *  0.85  °'88

         Ps (RSE)65 =1.92 kg/liter

        (ps RSE)3Q = ^ -1- 0.88 = 0.47 kg/liter

       .'., Emission reduction by weight is:

                                     1 92 - 0 47
        Percent Emission Reduction =     , 9?    = 76 percent

     The above calculations were verified by employing a material balance
on each model.  The material balance calculation presented below was used
to verify Equation 3-4 calculations.

Example Calculation (Model Plant A, Chapter 5)

     Total solids on coated parts = 101,600 liters
(35% by volume solids coating; 85% transfer efficiency; 0.88 solvent density)
          Total solids applied  =  10Q'|i|0  =  119,500 liters

     Total coating applied  =  119>500   =  119>500  =  341,000 liters
                               % solids      0.35
       Total emitted solvent = (341,000)(0.65)(0.88) = 195,000 kg
                                   3-76

-------
(70% by volume solids coating; 80% transfer efficiency; 0.88 solvent density)
           Total solids applied  =  "^o'sQ0  =  127,000 liters

           Total coating applied  =  1Q7^00  =  181,400 liters

        Total emitted solvent = (181,400)(0. 30)(0.88) = 48,000 kg

.'., Percent emission reduction by weight  =  -—/-iQ5Vin3>)    = ^ Percer|t

3.3.1  Powder Coatings
     After using Equations 3-4 and 3-5 for 100 percent solids coatings, the
control efficiencies are 100 percent.   This emission reduction can only be
employed for the application and flash-off areas of a coating line, and for
the spraying of thermoset powders.   Therefore, transfer efficiencies for
this type of coating were not considered because overspray in the metal
furniture industry is not emitted through a bake oven.  Other control
efficiencies shown apply to thermoplastic powder not requiring a primer.
The values are applicable when the thermoplastic is sprayed or applied via
a fluidized bed.  Control efficiency values shown in Table 3-32 are based
upon percent by weight change in the applied solids coating.   This change
is a result of VOC emissions mainly from thermoset coatings.   The VOC
                                               44 57
emissions are due to polymerization byproducts.  '
     Emission reduction from coating lines employing a thermoplastic that
required a low solids primer will not be provided.  This is because emis-
sions from this type of coating would be comparable to model  plants applying
35 percent by volume solids coating by the dip methods.  Therefore, control
efficiencies for these lines would be above the level established by the
State Implementation Plans (SIPs).10
3.3.2  High Solids Coatings
     The control efficiencies (by volume and weight) shown in Table 3-33
are based on the approach shown in the example calculation provided in
Section 3.3.   The emission reductions represent a comparison with the 35
percent by volume solids coating associated with the model plants presented
in Chapter 5.  All three electrostatic spraying techniques were evaluated:
gun, disk, and bell.   '    The following assumptions were employed in
determining the control efficiencies:
                                  3-77

-------
        Table  3-32.   EMISSION  REDUCTION  VIA POWDER COATINGS
     Coating                      Emission              References
                                reduction  (%)
Thermosetting powders3
Epoxy
Acrylics
Polyester (urethane)
Thermoplastic powders
Polyester (others)
Acrylics
PVC and cellulose acetate
Butyrate

97-99
99
96-98
99
99
90-95


48,
48,
48,
48,
48,
48,


57
57
57
57
57
57

aVOC emissions from bake oven only.

bVOC emissions from application and cool down areas.
                                  3-78

-------
  Table 3-33.  CONTROL EFFICIENCIES FOR HIGH SOLIDS COATINGS

High solids coatings                       Emission reduction  '
                                        by weight or volume (%)
60% by Volume solids
  Flat surface                                    62
  Complex surface                                 61
65% by Volume coatings
  Flat surface                                    69
  Complex surface                                 69
70% by Volume coatings
  Flat surface                                    75
  Complex surface                                 75
80% by Volume coatings
  Flat surface                                    85
  Complex surface                                 85
aApproach the same as reported in References 44, 85, 86 and 90.
 Some round-off error (approximately 2 percent)  may exist for
 the calculations (e.g., 60% solids).
                                3-79

-------
     A.   In converting from a volume to weight basis,  the solvent density
employed was 0.88 kg per liter (7.3 Ib per gal).   This value is consistent
with the density employed in reference 106 which is the basis for the 0.36
kg of VOC per liter of coating (minus water) limitation that has been
adopted by most states in their State Implementation Plans.   The emission
limitation of 0.36 kg of VOC per liter of coating (minus water) is the
regulation being employed for new coating lines in the absence of a New
Source Performance Standard.
     B.   The transfer efficiencies employed in the calculations for flat
and complex surfaces are 80 and 60 percent, respectively.  These values are
considered to be conservative, but data presented in references 89 and 106
are inconsistent.  The transfer efficiencies employed, however, are con-
sidered to be representative at high solids (greater than 60 percent by
volume) coatings because mechanical energies associated in applying the
coatings are higher.
     C.   The control efficiencies presented in Table 3-33 are considered to
be applicable for both single and dual component high solids coatings.
     D.   Only electrostatic spraying techniques are considered to be
applicable.
3.3.3  Waterborne Coatings
     Control efficiencies (by volume and weight) shown in Table 3-34 for
the spray, dip,  flow, and electrodeposition coating of waterborne paints
are also based  on the example calculations shown in Section  3.3. These
control efficiencies are also based on a comparison with solvent emissions
from systems applying solvent based paint  containing 35 percent by volume
solids.  The water-to-solvent ratio of the volatile portion  of the paint
considered  ranged from 67/33 to 82/18.^   Assumptions employed  in determining
the control efficiencies are presented below:
     (a)  All waterborne spraying was assumed  to be accomplished by
          electrostatic techniques.
     (b)  Transfer  efficiencies for electrostatic  spraying  used  in the
          calculations are  based on data  reported  in  reference  106.
     (c)  Transfer  efficiency used  for dip and flow coating is  90
          percent.
                                  3-80

-------
        Table 3-34.  CONTROL EFFICIENCIES FOR WATER-BASED COATINGS

Application                             Control efficiency
technique                              % by weight or volume     Ref.
82/18  Waterborne - Electrostatic
  spraying3»b
     Flat surface                              80-82     42, 54, 118
     Complex surface                           80-82     123, 143
67/33  Waterborne - Electrostatic
  sprayingb.c
     Flat surface                               67       42, 54, 123, 143
     Complex surface                            67
82/18  Waterborne - Dip and flow coating9       82       42, 118, 123, 143
67/33  Waterborne - Dip and flow coating0       67       42, 118, 123, 143
82/18  Waterborne - Electrodeposition           95       123, 152,  154,  155

 For a 35 percent by volume solids with 82 to 18 hLO solvent ratio.
 Control  efficiencies for any electrostatic  spraying technique.
c
 For a 35 percent by volume solids with 67 to 33 H20 to solvent ratio.
 Regardless of chemical  composition of coating - 20 percent solids.
                                   3-81

-------
3.4  CONTROL EFFICIENCIES FOR ADD-ON CONTROL EQUIPMENT
     Control efficiencies of VOCs for add-on air pollution control
equipment are presented in Table 3-35, and these data will be used in
Chapter 5 to select regulatory alternatives.  Add-on control  equipment
evaluated for emission reduction were carbon adsorbers, thermal  and cata-
lytic incinerators, and condensers.   The bases and assumptions for the
control efficiencies are presented in the following sections.
3.4.1  Carbon Adsorption
     The control efficiencies (weight basis) presented in Table 3-35 are
based on data collected by Springborn Laboratories.  This information
includes control efficiencies received from plant trips.       '     None
of the control efficiency data for VOCs are for coating lines in the metal
furniture industry.  The control efficiencies are for  spray  booths equipped
with carbon adsorbers in such industries as surface coating  of paper and
asbestos fibers.  The only source test data were for a can coating line
equipped with a carbon adsorber.      All process emissions of VOCs on the
coating line were vented to  this ,control device.  The  following assumptions
were employed in utilizing the above  data:
     A.  The control efficiencies reported  in Table 3-35  were considered to
be representative of metal furniture  coating  lines  since  surface coating
lines  in other  industries are comparable or exactly the same.
     B.  Control efficiencies would  only be applicable for coating lines
spraying conventional solvent based  coatings.
3.4.2   Incinerators
     The control efficiencies for incinerators  are  based  on  stack  test  data
reported in references 42,  185  and  196,  and data  obtained during plant
trips  taken by  Springborn  Laboratories.13'171"175'181'182'184'185  Only one
plant  trip, taken  by  Springborn  Laboratories  was  to a  metal  furniture
facility using  an  incinerator.    Also,  control  efficiency data are  only
applicable  for  incinerators  controlling  VOC emissions  from bake ovens.
Figures 3-16 and 3-17 show effects  of temperature on  percent VOC  destruc-
tion for a  thermal  and  catalytic incinerator, respectively.   Assumptions
employed in selecting control efficiencies  for incineration  are presented
below:
                                  3-82

-------
            Table 3-35.  CONTROL EFFICIENCIES FOR ADD-ON
                   AIR POLLUTION CONTROL EQUIPMENT
Add-on control
device
Process being
controlled
Control efficiency
for control  device
    (% by wt)
Ref.
Carbon adsorber
Carbon adsorber
Thermal incinerator
Spray booth
Entire coating line
Bake oven
90
80
96
111,160,163
162
44,183,187
198
  Catalytic incinerator  Bake oven

  Shell-tube condenser   Bake oven and flash-off
                             90
                  44,183,187
  JSee Section 3.4.3 for explanation of control efficiency.
                                   3-83

-------
  TOO
   80
c
O)

ID  60
Q.
O
3
S-
•4->
en
Ol
Q

O
O
   40
   20
    0   BUD
                                 1UUU   	TTDtT

                            Increasing Temperature.  K
                 Figure  3-16.  Effects of temperature  and  time.
                          (Redrawn from Reference 42)
                                     3-84

-------
  100
   so
c
QJ
O

0>
Q.
to
s_
C
o
   40
    20
                   200
400         600         800
     Temperature, K
                                                                   1000
             Figure 3-17.   Typical temperature - performance curve for
               various molecular species being oxidized over Pt/Al203
                       catalyst.  (Redrawn from Reference 42).

                                        3-35

-------
     A.   The control  efficiencies for both the thermal  and catalytic
incinerator are mainly based on operating temperatures  of 1,033 K (1,400°F)
and 703 K (800°F), respectively.   These operating temperatures are consis-
tent with temperature data presented in trip reports written by Springborn
Laboratories and information obtained from a literature
     .  13,44,171-175,181-189
search.  '
     B.  Reported control efficiencies and operating temperatures reported
for incinerators being employed on bake ovens in other surface coating
industries are considered to be applicable.
3.4.3  Condensers
     No  control efficiency  for condensers  is  shown  in Table 3-35  because  no
stack  test  data are  available  for this control  technique.  Vendor and
literature  information  indicate  the  control efficiencies range from about
90 to  95 percent  by  weight.167'195'196   A more  conservative 90 percent by
weight control  efficiency is  used to control  VOC emissions from flash-off
areas  or bake oven areas or both.
                                   3-86

-------
                        REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER 3


1.  Bardin, P. C.,  Field  Editor,   High-Production  EPS  System  at Bunting.
    Industrial Finishing.  48  (3).   March  1972.

2.  Hood, Jack.   Powder Application  at  Flanders  Industries,  Inc.   The
    Association  for Finishing  Processes  of SME,  Dearborn,  Michigan.
    FC  76-434, 1976.

3.  Burnham,  Lowell.   Power  Application  to Complex Shapes  and Masses at
    Homecrest.   The Association  for  Finishing Processes of SME, Dearborn,
    Michigan.  FC 76-436,  1976.

4.  Schrantz,  Joe,  Executive Editor.  How  Oxford Pendaflex Gets that
    Quality Finish.   Industrial  Finishing.   52 (7):  18-22.   July 1976.

5.  Schrantz,  Joe,  Executive Editor.  High-Production  System Powder
    Coats  Structural  Steel Tubing.   Industrial Finishing.   5_2 (4): 52-60.
    April  1977.

6.  Poll,  Gerald H.,  Editor.  Super-Durable Exterior Powder Coatings.
    Products  Finishing.   39: 62-67.   March 1975.

7.  Schrantz,  Joe,  Editor.   Automatic Powder Systems Coat Lawn Furniture.
    Industrial Finishing.  51 (4):  32-38.   April 1975.

8.  Oge,  M. T.  Trip Report  - Goodman Brothers Manufacturing Co.,
    Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield,
    Connecticut.  Trip Report 85.   March 8, 1976.

9.  Oge,  M. T.  Trip Report  - Steelcase Co., Grand Rapids, Michigan.
    Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report 72.
     February  24, 1976.

10.   Nunn,  A.  B.  and D. L. Anderson.   Trip Report - Steelcase,  Inc.,
    Grand Rapids, Michigan.   TRW,  Inc., Durham, North Carolina.
    March 27-28, 1979.

11.   Besselsen, John.  Painting with Powder.  The Association for  Finishing
     Processes of SME, Dearborn,  Michigan, FC 76-431,  1976.

12.   Thompson, M. S.  Trip Report - U. S. Furniture Industries, Highpoint,
     North Carolina.  Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.
     Trip Report No. 108.   April  6, 1976.

13.   Fisher,  J.  R.  Trip Report - Visco Manufacturing  Corp., Gardena,
     California.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut, Trip
     Report No.  57.  February 11, 1976.
                                 3-87

-------
14   Powder Coating Seating Scores at Iowa State's New Stadium.  Powder
     Finishing World.   2 (3):  50-52.   Third Quarter 1975.

15.   Hospital Bed Protected by Nylon 11 Powder Coating.  Powder Finishing
     World.  2 (2): 78.  Second Quarter 1975.

16.   Obrzut, J. J.  Powder Coating:  A Finisher's Finish.  Iron Age.
     November 16, 1972.

17.   Oge, M. T.  Trip Report - Bunting Co.,  Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.
     Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No. 86.
     March 8, 1976.

18.   Poll, Gerald  H., Jr.  Powder  Coating Over One Million Square  Feet
     Per Month.   Products  Finishing.  38: 58-65.  December 1975.

19   Oge   M  T    Trip  Report - Herman Miller,  Inc.,  Zelland,  Michigan.
     Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip  Report  No.  100.
     April 2,  1976.

20   Powder  Systems Cuts  Finishing Costs  at Westinghouse.   Powder
     Finishing World.   2  (3): 20-21.  Third Quarter  1975.

21   Inversion Powder  Coatings Bicycles  in  20 Colors.   Industrial
     Finishing.   50  (9):  58-63.   September  1974.

22   Robinson, Thomas, G., Associate Editor.  Powder Coating Trailer
     Hitches.   Products Finishing.  38:  76-81.   June 1974.

 23    Stacy,  B. J. and Akin R.  H.   Powder Coatings at Gravely.  Presented
      at the Association of Finishing Processes of SME, Dearborn,  Michigan.
      FC 76-450, 1976.

 24   Mazin, J.  Technical Developments in 1976.   Metal  Finishing.
      75 (2): 74-75.   February 1977.

 25   Meyer  C. H.  Epoxy Powder Coating at  McQuay-Perfec, Inc.  The
      Association  for Finishing Processes of SME, Dearborn, Michigan.
      FC 76-441, 1976.

 26.  Poll, Gerald, H., Jr., Editor.  High-Production  Acrylic Powder
      Coating.  Production Finishing.  38 (12): 46-52.   September  1974.

 27.  Cole,  Edward N.   Coatings and  Automobile Industries Have Common
      Interest.   American  Paint and  Coatings Journal.   58  (51): 58-63.
      June 3,  1974.

 28   Schrantz, Joe, Editor.  Automatic  Powder Systems Coat  Lawn  Furniture.
      Industrial  Finishing.  51 (4):  32-38.   April 1975.

 29.  Automotive  Powder:   Under the  Hood.   Products  Finishing.  40: 56-57.
      November 1976.
                                  3-88

-------
30.   Cole, Gordon E.,  Jr.   Outlook for Powder in '76:  Up 20 Percent.
     Powder Finishing World.  2 (4):6.  Fourth Quarter 1975.

31.   St.  John, W.  Allis-Chalmer's Thin-Film Powder Coating.  Products
     Finishing.   38:3-8.   March 1973.

32.   Hughes, T.  W.,  .  A.  Horn, C.  W.  Sandy, and R.  W. Serth.  Source
     Assessment:   Prioritization of Air Pollution from Industrial Surface
     Coating Operations.   Monsanto Research Corporation, Dayton, Ohio.
     Office of Research and Development, U. S. EPA, Washington, D.C.
     EPA-650/2-75-019a.  February 1975.

33.   Cole, G.  E.   The Powder Coatings Market.  GCA Chemical Corporation.
     (Presented at NPCA Chemical Coatings Conference, Powder Coatings
     Session.   Cincinnati, Ohio.  April 22, 1976).

34.   Ramig, Alexander, Dr. of Glidden Coatings and Resins Division.
     Rebuttal  Presentation before NAPCTAC concerning Industrial Surface
     Coating of Metal  Furniture.  February 27, 1980.

35.   Lissy, Gus of Nordson Company.  Rebuttal Presentation  before NAPCTAC
     concerning Industrial Surface Coating of Metal  Furniture.
     February 27, 1980.

36.   Cehanowicz, L., Editor.  The Switch On for Powder Coating.  Plastics
     Engineering.  31 (9): 28-30.   September 1975.

37.   Gabris, Tibor.   Trip Report - Interrad Corporation, Stanford,
     Connecticut.  Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.
     August 27, 1975.

38.   Levinson,.S. B.   Powder Coating.  Journal of Paint Technology.
     44 (570): 38-52.   July 1972.

39.   Pegg, F.  E.   Applying Plastic Coatings with the Fluidized  Bed  Process:
     Part 1 - Coating Materials.  Plastic Design and Processing.
     10 (9): 38-41.   1970.

40.   Halappen, H. S.  and G. H.  Poll.  Powder Coating '76:   State of the
     Art.   The Association for  Finishing Processes of SME,  Dearborn,
     Michigan.  FC 76-430.  1976.

41.   Garrder, D.  S.   Energy Consumption of Six Different Coatings.
     Products Finishing.   40:46-49.  March 1976.

42.   Goodell, P.  H.   Economic Justification of Powder Coating.  The
     Association for Finishing  Process of SME, Dearborn, Michigan.
     FC 76-459.  1976.

43.   Feith, D.  When To Powder?  When To Paint?  The Association for
     Finishing Process of SME,  Dearborn, Michigan.   FC 76-457.  1976.
                                 3-89

-------
44.   Suther, B.  J.,  (Foster D.  Snell) and Uday Potasku (JACA Corporation)
     Controlling Pollution from the Manufacturing and Coating of Metal
     Products—Metal Coating Air Pollution Control, Volume 1.
     EPA-625/3-77-009.   May 1977.

45.   Axtell, D.   Automated Powder Coating System Problems, Solutions,
     Assets.  The Association for Finishing Process of SME, Dearborn,
     Michigan.  FC 76-435.  1976.

46.   The Ransburg Automatic Process - The Worlds Standard for Electrostatic
     Printing Efficiency.  Ransburg Electrostatic Equipment, Indianapolis,
     Indiana.  Equipment Bulletin.

47.   Ransburg Manual Electrostatic Equipment.  Ransburg  Electrostatic
     Equipment, Indianapolis, Indiana.   Equipment Bulletin HG-76-10M.

48.   Cole,  G. E., Jr.   (GCA Chemical  Corporation) and D.  Scarborough.
     Volatile Organic and  Safety Considerations  for Automotive  Powder
     Finishes.  SAE, Dearborn, Michigan.

49.  Letter and attachments from Farrell,  R.  F., Glidden Powder Coatings,
     to Cole, G. C., GCA  Associates.  April  3, 1978.  Response  to  initial
     draft  of Surface Coating of Metal  Furniture prepared by Springborn
     Laboratories.

50.  Gabris,  Tibor.  Trip Report - Interred  Corporation, Stanford,
     Connecticut.   Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.
     August 27, 1975.

51.  Ransburg Electrostatic Powder Coating.   Ransburg Electrostatic
     Equipment,  Indianapolis,  Indiana.   Bulletin Number P-101.

52.  Melchore,  J.   Trip Poport  - Nordson Corporate'"0   Amherst,  Ohio.
     Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip Report No.  88.
     March  11,  1976.

53.  Gabris, Tibor.   Trip Report - W. R. Grace & Co., Lexington,
     Massachusetts.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut.
      September  18,  1975.

 54.   Ransburg Electrostatic Swirl-Air.   Ransburg Electrostatic Equipment,
      Indianapolis,  Indiana.   Equipment Bulletin.

 55.   Memo from Holley,  W. H.,  Springborn Laboratories,   Inc., Enfield,
      Connecticut, to Robert Diehl, Springborn Laboratories.   November 1, 1977.
      Covering the problem of powder  fines.

 56   Brewer, George E.  F.  Painting  Waste Loads Associated with Metal
      Finishing.  Journal  of Coating  Technology: 48-51.   February 1977.
                                  3-90

-------
57   Telecon.   Holley, William H.,  Springborn Laboratories, Inc., Enfield,
     Connecticut, with Jim Pfeifer, Pratt and Lambert, Buffalo, New York
     and Tim Birdsall, Warren, Indiana.  October 18, 1977.  Emissions of
     volatile organics from cured powder coatings.

58.  How Nylon Powder Coatings Help.  Products Finsihing.  38: 80-81.
     April 1974.

59.  Besselsen, J.  Paint Finishing 1977.  The Association for Finishing
     Processes of SME, Dearborn, Michigan.  FC 77-692.   1977.

60.  Hall, A.  Maybe  It's Not Goodbye Paint, But  It's Certainly Hello
     Powder Coating.  Modern Plastics.  49 (5): 48-51.   May 1972.

61.  Curtis, L. G.  Higher Solids Coatings for Metals and Plastics.  High
     Solids Coatings.  2 (4): 4-10.  October 1977.

62.  Nickerson,  R.  S.  The State-of-the-Art in UV  Coating Technology.
     Industrial  Finishing.  50  (2): 10-13.  February  1974.

63.  Oge, M. T.  Trip Report -  Simmons  Co., Munster,  Indiana.  Springborn
     Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No.  41.
     January 28, 1976.

64.  Oge, M. T.  Trip Report -  Lyon Metals Products,  Inc., Aurora,  Illinois.
     Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip Report  No.  91.
     March  12, 1976.

65.  Telecon.  Holley, W.  H., Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut,
     with L. LeBras,  PPG,  Pittsburgh,  Pennsylvania.   August  24,  1977.
     Use  of high solids  paints  in  the  metal  furniture industry.

66.  Letter from Scharfenberger, J.,  Ransburg  Electrostatic  Equipment,
     Indianapolis,  Indiana,  to  W.  Holley,  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,
     Connecticut.   September 16, 1977.   Covering high solids coating
     uses.

67.  Sremba, J.   The Real  World of High Solids.   High Solids Coatings.
     3 (3):  17-20.

68.  Fugita,  E.  M.  and  L.  G.  Shepard.   Consideration of Model Rule for
     the  Control of Volatile Organic  Compound Emissions from Metal  Furniture
     and  Fixture Coating Operations.   State  of California Air Resources
     Board.   September  27,  1978.

 69.  Jeff,  W.   High Solids Coatings for General  Industrial.   High Solids
      Coatings.   3 (2):  17-20.   June 1978.

 70.  Murphy, E.  M.   High Solids Coatings - Experience.   High Solids
      Coatings.   3 (4):  5-11.   December 1978.
                                  3-91

-------
71.   More Solids, Less Solvent.   Products Finishing.  42: 46-48.
     July 1978.

72.   Consdorf, A. P., Editor.  Which Way Will You Go On Finishing?
     Appliance Manufacturer.  April 1977.  pg. 43-49.

73.   Price, M. B.  High Solids Coatings Where Can They Be Used?  Reliance
     Universal, Anc.  (Preprint, NPCA Chemicals Coatings Conference,
     Cincinnati, Ohio.  April 22, 1976).

74.   Telecon.  Holley W. H., Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut
     with R. Craig, Rohn and Haas, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.   Status  of
     high solids acrylic coatings and waterborne coatings.

75.   Telecon.  Holley, W. H., Springborn Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut
     with G. Wilhelm, Ashland Chemical,  Columbus, Ohio.  August 24,  1977.
     Status of high solids  coatings, particularly alkyds for  metal  furniture.

76.   Tweet, D.  High Solids  Coatings Market Trends  for 1977.   High  Solids.
     1: 12.  October 1976.

77.   Lovald, R. A. and D. D. Taft.  High Solids Epoxy Coatings.  High
     Solids Coatings.  1: 3:10.  October 1976.

78.   Young, R. G. and W. R.  Howe11, Jr.  Epoxies Offer Fulfillment  of
     High Performance Needs.  Modern Paint and Coatings.  52  (3): 43-47.
     March  1975.

79.   Lunde, D.   Acrylic  Oligomers:  One  Approach to High  Solids.  High
     Solids Coatings.  1 (3): 5-9.  July 1976.

80.   Question Corner.  High Solids Coatings.  2  (3): 4.   July 1977.

81.  DeVittorio, J.  M.   Application Equipment for High Solids and  Plural
     Component Coatings.   High  Solids  Coatings.  1  (2):  7-12.  April 1976.

82.  Lunde,  D.  I.  Acrylic  Resins  Defy Conventional Relationships  in New
     Technology  Coatings.   Modern  Paint and  Coatings.  53 (3): 51-53.
     March  1976.

83.  Baker,  R.  D.  and J.  J.  Bracco.  Two-Component  Urethanes:  Higher
     Solids Systems  at  Lower Cure  Temperature.   Modern  Paint and Coatings.
     53  (3):  43-47.   March 1976.

84.  Telecon.   Holley,  W.  H.,  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut
     with  J.  J.  Bracco,  Mobay,  Pittsburgh,  Pennsylvania.   August 23, 1977.
     Status of  high  solids coatings  in the  metal  furniture  industry.

85.  Telecon.   Holley,  W.  H.,  Springborn Laboratories,  Inc.  Enfield,
     Connecticut,  with  J.  A. Scharfenberger,  Ransbury Corporation,
      Indianapolis,  Indiana.  August 29, 1977.  High solids  application
     equipment.
                                 3-92

-------
  86.  Mercuno,  A., and S.  N.  Lewis.   High Solids Coatings for Low Emission
      Industrial Finishing.   Journal  of Paint Technology.  47 (607)- 37-44
      August 1975.                                          —

  87.  Letter from LeBras,  L.  R.,  PPG  Industries, Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania,
      to W.  H.  Holley,  Jr.,  Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.
      September  16, 1977.   High  solids industrial coatings.

  88.  Lunde,  D.  I.   Aqueous  and  High  Solids Acrylic Industrial Coatings.
      High Solids Coatings.   1 (2):  13-15.   April 1976.

  89.  Wilhelm, G.  H.   Conservation Through High Solids Coating Systems
      High Solids Coatings.   2 (4): 11-14.   October 1977.

  90.  Question Corner.   High  Solids Coatings.   1 (1):  3-4.   January 1976.

  91.  High Solids Paint:  A  Cost  Comparison.   High Solids Coatinq
      1  (1):  4-5.   January 1976.

  92.  Garrder, D.  S.   Energy  Consumption  of Six Different Coatings.
      Products Finishing.  40: 46-49.   March 1976.

  93.  Golownia,  R.  F.   High Solids Coatings for Applicances.   High Solids
      Coatings.   3  (2):  2-14.  June 1978.

  94.  Nunn, A. B.  and D. L. Anderson.   Trip Report - Ransburg Electrostatic
      Equipment,  Indianapolis, Indiana.   TRW,  Inc.,  Durham, North Carolina
      April 24-25,  1979.

  95.  Pontius, J. D.  High Solids  Are  Here  Today.   High  Solids  Coatings
      3  (3):  13-16.  September 1978.

  96.  Bernard, D. A.  Will High Solids  Work?   High  Solids Coatinqs
      3  (4):  12-15.  December 1978.

  97.  Scharfenberger, J. A.   New High  Solids Coating Equipment  Offers
      Energy/Ecology Advantages.    Modern  Plastics.   53 (2):  52-53.
      February 1976.

  98.  LeBras, L.  R.  Prospects for Low  Emissions  Liquid  Industrial Coatings  -
     High Solids.  PPG Industries, Pittsburgh,  Pennsylvania,   (presented
     at Fourth Water-Borne and Higher  Solids  Coatings Symposium,  New Orleans
     Louisiana,  February 14, 1977).                                           '

 99. High Solids Coatings Based on Acrylates.   High Solids Coatinqs
     2 (4): 15-16.  October 1977.

100. Powers,  H.  R.   Economic and Energy Savings Through  Coatings.  The
     Association for Finishing Process of SME,  Dearborn, Michigan
     FC 76-217.   1976.
                                 3-93

-------
101.  Scharfenberger, J.  A.   Application Equipment for High Solids Coatings.
     Ransburg Corporation,  Indianapolis, Indiana.  October 15, 1975.

102.  DeVittorio, J.  M.   Application Equipment for High Solids and Plural
     Component Coatings.  Ransburg Corporation, Indianapolis, Indiana.
     November 7, 1975.

103.  Caffee, D. F.   Electrostatic Spraying from Its Origin to Today.
     Ransburg Electrostatic Equipment.  September 5, 1978.

104.  Brenner, D. L.  and J.  D. Pontius.  High Solids Coatings Are Ready.
     Management.  January 1978.

105.  High Solids, A Rosy Outlook.  Industrial Finishing.  54 (7).
     July 1978.

106.  Walberg, A. C.   Electrostatic Application of High Solids Coatings.
     High Solids Coatings.   3: 5-14.  March 1978.

107.  Ellis, William H., Z.  Saary, and D. G. Lesnini.  Insulation of
     Exempt Replacements for Aromatic Solvents.  Journal  of Paint
     Technology.  41 (531): 249-258.  April 1969.

108.  Gallagher, V.  N., and J. Pratapas.  Control of Volatile Organic
     Emissions from Existing Stationary Sources Volume III:  Surface
     Coating of Metal Furniture.  EPA-450/2-77-032.  U. S. Environmental
     Protection Agency, Research Triangle  Park, North Carolina.
     December 1977.

109.  Larson, E. C., and H.  E. Sipple.  Los Angeles Rule 66 and Exempt
     Solvents.  Journal of Paint Technology.  39 (508): 258-264.  May 1967.

110.  The Ransburg Automatic Process.  Technical Bulletin.

111.  Danielson, J.  A.,  Editor.  Air Pollution Engineering Manual.   AP-40,
     Second Edition, Air Pollution Control District of Los Angeles, EPA,
     Office of Air and Water Programs Office of Air Quality Planning  and
     Standards, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina.   May 1973.

112.  Telcon.  Holley, W. H., Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut
     with L. LeBras, PPG,  Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania.  August 25,  1977.
     Questions on high  solids finishings.

113.  Unpublished data.  Received from E. W. Pete Drum, Ransburg
     Electrostatic Equipment, Indianapolis, Indiana.

114.  Product Profile R-F-H Hand Gun.  Ransburg Electrostatic  Equipment,
     Indianapolis, Indiana.  Technical Bulletin.

115.  Product Profile Ransburg Turbodisk.   Ransburg  Electrostatic Equipment,
     Indianapolis, Indiana.  Technical Bulletin.
                                 3-94

-------
 116.  Product Profile 17384 Tilted Disk Rotator.   Ransburg Electrostatic
      Equipment,  Indianapolis,  Indiana.   Technical  Bulletin.

 117.  Product Profile Turbobell.   Ransburg Electrostatic Equipment,
      Indianapolis,  Indiana.   Technical  Bulletin.

 118.  Product Profile 18100,  17264 Power Supply System.   Ransburg
      Electrostatic  Equipment,  Indianapolis,  Indiana.   Technical  Bulletin.

 119.  Loop,  F.  M.  Automotive Electrocoat.   PPG Industries,  Inc.
      (Presented  at  NPCA,  Chemical  Coatings  Conference.   Cincinnati,  Ohio.
      April  22, 1976).

 120.  Coutts,  G.  Our Experience  with  Water-Reducible  Paint.   The Association
      for  Finishing  Process of  SME,  Dearborn,  Michigan.   FC  74-647.   1974.

 121.  LeBras,  L.  R.   Prospects  for Low Emission Liquid Industrial Coatings  -
      Water-Borne.   PPG  Industries,  Inc.,  Pittsburgh,  Pennsylvania.
      (Presented  at  Fourth  Water-Borne and Higher Solids Coatings Symposium,
      New  Orleans, Louisiana.   February  14,  1977).

 122.  Nunn,  A.  B. and D. L. Anderson.  Trip  Report  - Delwood  Furniture
      Co., Irondale,  Alabama.   TRW,  Durham,  North Carolina.   April  18,  1979.

 123.  Vierling, E. J.  Conversion  to Water-Reducible Paint.   Control  Data
      Corporation.   (Presented  at  NPCA,  Chemical Coatings  Conference.
      Cincinnati, Ohio.  April  23,  1976).

 124.  Strand,  R.  L.   Water-Borne Coatings  in Metal  Packaging.   American
      Can  Company.   (Presented  at  NPCA,  Chemical Coatings  Conference.
      Cincinnati, Ohio.  April  23,  1976).

 125.  Fugita,  E.  M.  and  L.   G. Shepard.   Consideration  of Model  Rule for
      the  Control of  Volatile Organic  Compound  Emissions from Metal
      Furniture and  Fixture Coating  Operations.  State of  California  Air
      Resources Board.  June 29, 1978.

 126.  Telecon.  Holley, W.   H.,  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut
     with Kurnik, Walt, Ashland Chemical.  August  24, 1977.   Status  of
     waterborne coatings,  particularly  alkyds, in  the metal  furniture
      industry.

127. Telecon.  Holley, W.  H.,  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut
     with Dunham, John, Hanna  Chemical  Coatings, Columbus, Ohio.
     August 25, 1977.  Status  of waterborne and high solids  coatings  in
     the metal furniture industry.

128. Rifi, M. R.   The Use  of Neutralizing Agents and Cosolvents  in
     Water-Borne Coatings.   Union Carbide Corporation.  (Presented at
     NPCA, Chemical  Coatings Conference.  Cincinnati,  Ohio   April 23,  1976).
                                 3-95

-------
129.  Kuehner, N.  A.   Pretreatment for Water-Borne Coatings.  Metal Finishing.
     75 (4):  33-36.   April 1977.

130.  Prane, J.  W.  Water-Borne Coating Usage -- Current and Future.
     (Presented at NPCA, Chemical Coatings Conference, Cincinnati, Ohio.
     April 23,  1976).

131.  Heffron, W.  H.   Conversion to Water-Borne Coatings at Pitney  Bowes.
     Pitney Bowes.  (Presented at NPCA, Chemical Coatings Conference.
     Cincinnati, Ohio.  April 23, 1976).

132.  Kloppenburg, W. B.  Trip Report — ESF (Electro Coating Finishers),
     Arden Hills, Minnesota.  Springborn Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut.
     Trip Report No. 135.

133.  Kloppenburg, W. B.  Trip Report — Singer Co., Auburn, New  York.
     Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip  Report No.  144.
     July 21, 1976.

134.  Thompson, M. S.  Trip Report - Allis Chalmers Corp.,  LaPorte, Indiana.
     Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip  Report No.  18.
     January 8,  1976.

135.  Thompson, M. S.  Trip Report - J.  I. Case Division of Tenneco,
     Racine, Wisconsin.   Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.
     Trip  Report No.  98.  April 2, 1976.

136. Gabris, T.   Trip  Report -  Ford Motor Co., Canada.  Springborn
     Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.  Trip Report  No.  56.
     February 10, 1976.

137. Water-Borne Coating Applied by Automatic, Electrostatic,  Heated,
     Airless Spray  System.   Industrial  Finishing.   53  (8): 22-26.
     August  1977.

138. Electric Wheel  Converts to Water-Borne Alkyd Enamel.   Industrial
     Finishing.   52 (12):  50-52.   December  1976.

139. Kloppenburg, W.  B.   Trip Report  -  Peachtree Door, St. Josephs,
     Missouri.   Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip
     Report  No.  87.   March 11,  1976.

140. Heuertz, M., Editor.   Electrostatic  Disks Apply Water-Borne Acrylic
     Coating.   Industrial Finishing.   52  (4):  22-26.   April  1976.

141. Schrantz,  J.,  Editor.   Water-Borne Coating Applied Electrostatically.
      Industrial  Fnishing.   52 (8):  24-28.   August 1978.

142.  Robison, G. T., Associate Editor.   Water-Borne Coatings Decorate
      Lee/Rowan  Products.  Products Finishing.   42: 72-76.   October 1978.
                                  3-96

-------
 143. The Latest In Water-Borne Coatings Technology.  Industrial Finishing
      51 (9): 48-53.  September 1975.

 144. TRW CDS Corrosion Studies by CDS Product Operations.  U.S. Environmental
      Protection Agency.  Industrial Environmental Research Laboratory,
      Office of Research and Development, Research Triangle Park
      North Carolina.   Publication No.  EPA-600/7-79-017.  January 1979.

 145. Telecon.   Hoi ley, W.  H.,  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut
      with Kirkpatrick, Bob, Lilly Industrial Coatings,  Indianapolis
      Indiana.   August 26,  1977.   Use of waterborne and high solids coatings
      in the metal  furniture industry.

 146. Gabris, T.   Trip Report - Chrysler Corporation, Detroit, Michigan
      Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip Report No  8
      December 30,  1975.                                             '   '

 147. Gabris, T.   Trip Report - Chrysler Corporation, Belvidere, Illinois
      Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip Report No  14
      January 5,  1976.

 148. Gabris, T.   Trip Report  - General  Motor Corporation, South Gate
      California.   Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip
      Report No.  102.   April  5, 1976.

 149.  Oge,  M. T.  Trip Report - Schwinn  Bicycle  Co.,  Chicago,  Illinois
      Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip Report No  97
      April  2,  1976.                                                 '

 150.  Telecon.  Gabris, T.,  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut
      with Henning,  Fred, Amcherm  Products.   November 15,  1977.   Waterborne
      coatings  usage.

 151.  Gabris, T.  Trip  Report - General Motors Corporation,  Detroit,
      Michigan.  Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield,  Connecticut    Trip
      Report  No. 9.  December 30,  1975.

 152.  Levinson, S. D.  Electrocoat, Powder Coat, and  Radiate - Which and
     Why?  Journal of Paint Technology.   44  (569): 41-49.   June  1972.

 153. One-Coat Finish for Supermarket Shelving by Electrocoat.   Product
     Bulletin F-46.  George Koch  Sons, Inc.   Evansville,  Indiana.

 154. Electrocoating Twins Offer Two Colors.   Product Bulletin F-38
     George Koch Sons, Inc.   Evansville, Indiana.

155. Oge, M. T.  Trip Report - Angel Steel  Co., Plainwell, Michigan
     Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No  103
     April 5, 1976.                                                '

156. Schrantz,  J. ,  Associate Editor.   How Ultra-Filtration Benefits
     Equipto.  Industrial  Finishing.   48 (9): 28-32.   September 1972.
                                3-97

-------
157. Schrantz, J., Associated Editor.  UF Benefits Conveyorized, Batch-Type
     EDP Systems.  Industrial Finishing.  48 (11): 26-29.  November 1972.

158. Switching to a Water-Borne Flow Coat System.  Finishing Highlights.
     p.  16-19.  March/April 1976.

159. Flow Coating Water Base Paint.  Data Sheet  F-52.  George Koch Sons,
     Inc.   Evansville, Indiana.

160. Oge,  M.  T.  Trip Report - Fasson Co., Painesville, Ohio.  Springborn
     Laboratories, Enfield Connecticut.  Trip Report No. 141.  July 14,  1976.

161. Oge,  M.  T.  Trip Report - Scott Graphics, South Hadley, Massachusetts.
     Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No.  139.
     July 19, 1976.

162. Gabris,  T.  Trip Report - American Can Co.,  Lemonyne, Pennsylvania.
     Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No.  89.
     March 11, 1976.

163. McCarthy, R. A.   Trip Report - Raybestos-Manhattan, Inc., Mannheim,
     Pennsylvania.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip
     Report No. 77.  February 27, 1976.

164. Mattai,  M. M.   Process for Solvent Pollution Control.  Chemical
     Engineering Process.  66 (12): 74-79.  December 1970.

165. Control  of Gaseous Emissions.  Training Course 415.  Office of Air
     and Waste Management Air Pollution Training  Institute.  Research
     Triangle Park, North Carolina.  May 1975.

166. Grant, R. M., M. Manes, and S. B. Smith.  Adsorption of Normal
     Paraffins and Sulfur Compounds on Actuated Carbon.  AIChE Journal.
     8 (3): 403.  1962.

167. Oge,  M.  T.  Trip Report - Brown-Bridge Mills, Troy, Ohio.  Springborn
     Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No. 140.
     July 20, 1976.

168. Lund, H. F., Editor.  Industrial Pollution  Control Handbook.
     New York.  McGrawHill.  1971.

169. Perry, J. H., Editor.  Chemical Engineer's  Handbook.  Fourth Edition,
     New York.  McGrawHill.  1963.

170. Cavanaugh, E.  C., G. M. Clancy, and R. G. Wetherold.  Evaluation of
     a Carbon Adsorption/Incineration Control System for Auto Assembly
     Plants.   Radian Corporation, Austin, Texas.  EPA Contract No.
     68-02-1319, Task 46.  May 1978.

171. Stern, A. C.  Air Pollution.   Academic Press, New York.  Vol. II,
     Second Edition.   Chapter 16.   1968.
                                 3-98

-------
 172.  Gabns, T.   Trip Report - Litho-Strip Co., South Kilburn,  Illinois.
      Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No  35
      January 22, 1976.

 173.  Gabris, T.   Trip Report - Ford Motor Co., Milpitas, California.
      Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No  120
      April 8, 1976.

 174.  Gabris, T.   Trip Report - Roll Coater, Inc., Kingsbury, Indiana.
      Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No  76
      February 26,  1976.

 175.  Gabris, T.   Trip Report - National  Gas Corporation Danbury, Connecticut.
      Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No  128
      April 27,  1976.

 176.  Gabris, T.   Trip Report - American  Can Co.,  Plant No.  025, Erickson
      New Jersey.   Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip
      Report No.  6.   December 29,  1975.

 177.  Mueller, J.  H.   Coil  Coating Fume Control  with a Feedback Energy
      Recovery System.   (Reprint of a paper  presented at 1977 Annual
      Meeting of  the  National  Coil  Coaters Association.   May  9,  1977).

 178.  Oge,  M.  T.  Trip Report -  Hazen Paper  Company,  Holyoke, Massachusetts
      Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report No   134
      May 19,  1976.

 179.  Fisher,  R.  J.  Trip Report -  California  Finished Metals,  Inc.
      Cucamonga,  California.   Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut
      Trip  Report No.  27.   January  14,  1976.

 180.  Gabris, T.  Trip  Report  - American  Can Co.,  Hillside, New  Jersey
      Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report No   5
      December 19, 1975.                                             '   '

 181.  Gabris, T.   Trip  Report  - Armco Steel Corp., Middletown, Ohio
      Springborn  Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report No   16
      January 5, 1976.                                              "

 182. Gabris, T.   Trip  Report - Ford Motor Co., Milpitas,  California.
     Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No   112
     April 7, 1976.                                                 "

183. Fisher, J.  R.   Trip Report - Supracote Svc., Cueamonga, California
     Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No   31
     January 16,  1976.                                             "

184. Kloppenburg, W.  B. and W. R.  Diehl.   Trip Report - General  Electric
     Co., Schenectady, New York.   Springborn Laboratories  Enfield
     Connecticut.  Trip Report No.  106.  April 6,  1976.
                                3-99

-------
185.  Gabris, T.   Trip Report - Continental Can Co., Inc., Portage, Indiana.
     Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No.  80.
     March 3, 1976.

186.  McCarthy, R.  A.   Trip Report - DuPont Corporation, Fairfield,
     Connecticut.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip
     Report No.  130.   April 30, 1976.

187.  Godonski, G.  Raymond, Anthony, V. Gimbrone, William J. Green
     (Graphics Arts Technical Foundation), Robert J. Reita, Paul R. Eisanan
     (Carnegie-Mellon University), and John T. Dale (EPA).  An Evaluation
     of Emissions and Control Technologies for the Metal Decorating
     Process.  J.  of APCA. 24 (6): 579-585.  June 1974.

188.  Kloppenburg, W.  B.   Trip Report - Chicago Magnet Wire, Elks Grove,
     Illinois.  Springborn Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip
     Report No.  124.   April 9, 1976.

189.  Heat Recovery Combined with Oven Exhaust Incineration.   Industrial
     Finishing.   52 (6): 26-27.  June 1976.

190.  Benfarado,  D. M.  Air Pollution Control by Direct Flame  Incineration
     in the Paint Industry.  Journal of Paint Technology.  39 (508): 265.
     May 1967.

191.  Hemsath, K. H., A.  C. Thekdi, and F. J. Vereecke.  Pollution  Control
     with Energy Recovery in Coating Industry.  (Presented at 67th Annual
     Meeting of the Air Pollution Control Association, Denver, Colorado.
     June 9-13, 1974).

192.  Digiacomo, J. D. and H. T. Lindland.  An Economical Design for a
     Solvent Fume Incinerator.  (Presented at 67th Annual Meeting  of the
     Air Pollution Control Association, Denver, Colorado.  June 9-13,
     1974).

193.  Young, R. A., Editor.  Heat  Recovery:  Pays for Air Incineration  and
     Process Drying.  Pollution Engineering.  7 (9): 60-61.   September 1975.

194.  Beltram, M. R.   Heat Recovery and Smoke Abatement Can Be Profitable.
     American Dyestuff  Reporter.  August 1975.  p. 22-23.

195.  Thermal Versus Catalytic  Incineration.  Products  Finishing.
     38: 83-85.   November 1975.

196.  Kon-den-Solver, a  subsidiary of Allied Air Products Co.  Technical
     Bulletin KDS-100-179.

197.  Berry, J. C.  Chemical Application Section, EPA,  Research Triangle
     Park, North Carolina.  Memo  to Robert Walsh,  Chemical Petroleum
     Branch, EPA, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina.  January 15, 1979.
                                 3-100

-------
198.  Hurst, T.  and R.  F.  Jongleux.   Stack Emission Sampling at Ford Motor
     Co., Pico Riveria, California.   TRW (Rough Draft), Durham, North
     Carolina.   EPA Research Triangle Park, North Carolina.
     February 13, 1979.
                                 3-101

-------
                  4.   MODIFICATION AND RECONSTRUCTION

     After the new source performance standards have been promulgated in
accordance with Section 111  of the Clean Air Act,  as amended,  all  "affected
facilities" will include those constructed,  modified, or reconstructed
after the date of proposal.   These new source performance standards are
also to apply to an "existing facility" as defined in 40 CFR 60.2.   An
existing facility would become an affected facility if determined to be
modified or reconstructed.  This chapter provides  potential  examples of
modified and reconstructed affected facilities and details the required
conditions under which an existing facility becomes subject to the stan-
dards of performance.   However, the enforcement division of the appropriate
EPA regional office will make the final determination as to whether a
source is modified or reconstructed and, as a result, becomes an affected
facility.  The remainder of the sections in this chapter defines and
provides potential examples of modification and reconstruction.
4.1  40 CFR 60 PROVISIONS FOR MODIFICATION AND RECONSTRUCTION
4.1.1  Definition of Modification
     It is important that these provisions be understood before considering
potential examples of modifications.
     Section 60.14 defines modification as follows:
          except as provided under paragraphs (e)  and (f) of this
     section, any physical or operational changes  to an existing
     facility which result in an increase in emission rate to the
     atmosphere of any pollutant or precursor to pollutant to which a
     standard applies shall  be a modification.  Upon modification, an
     existing facility shall become an affected facility for each
     pollutant to which a standard applies and for which there is an
     increase in the emission rate.
     Paragraph (e) lists certain physical or operational changes which are
not considered as modifications, regardless of any changes in the emission
rate.  These changes are shown below:
                                  4-1

-------
     (1)  Routine maintenance,  repair,  and replacement.
     (2)  An increase in the production rate not requiring a capital
expenditure as defined in Section 60.2.
     (3)  An increase in the hours of operation.
     (4)  Use of an alternative fuel  or raw material  if, prior to the
standard, the existing facility was designed to accommodate that
alternate fuel or raw material.
     (5)  The addition or use of any system or device whose primary
function is the reduction of air pollutants, except when an emission
control system is removed or replaced by a system considered to be less
efficient.
     (6)  The relocation or change in ownership of an existing facility.
     Paragraph (b) specifies that an increase in emissions is defined in
kilograms per hour and delineates the methods for determining the increase,
including the use of emission factors, material balances, continuous
monitoring  systems, and manual emission tests.  Paragraph (c) affirms
that the addition of an affected facility to a  stationary source does
not make any  other facility within that source  subject  to standards  of
performance.  Paragraph  (f) simply provides for superseding any conflicting
provisions.
4.1.2   Definition of Reconstruction
     Section  60.15 regarding reconstruction states:
           If  an  owner  or  operator  of an existing facility proposes
     to replace  components, and  the  fixed capital  cost  of the  new
     components  exceeds  50  percent of  the fixed capital  cost which
     would  be required to construct  a  comparable,  entirely  new
     facility,  he shall  notify the Administrator of  the proposed
     replacements.   The notice must  be postmarked  60 days (or  as
     soon  as  practicable) before construction  of the replacements
      is commenced.
     The purpose of  the reconstruction portion of  the regulation  is  to
 prevent an  owner or  operator  from continuously replacing an operating
 process except  for support  structures, frames, housing, etc.,  in  an
 attempt to avoid falling under new source performance standards.
 4.2 APPLICABILITY TO SURFACE COATING  OF  METAL FURNITURE
     The purpose of this section is  to outline some  of the  most probable
 types  of "modifications" to existing plants and to describe the applica-
 bility of "reconstruction"  to this industry.   The  modification and

                                  4-2

-------
reconstruction samples provided in this section are only to be examples
of changes that would require an existing facility to comply with the
standard.  The final determination will be made by the appropriate EPA
regional office on a case-by-case basis.
     The examples apply to process areas  of a metal furniture coating
line that emit volatile organic compounds (VOCs) which are precursors to
air pollution.  This would include the coating application, flash-off
and bake oven areas, and exempts metal part precleaning and preheating
areas.  The amount of VOCs emitted from the application, flash-off, and
bake oven areas varies depending on the method of coating application.
Paint can be applied by spray, dip, flow, and roller coating methods.
The following two sections define modification and reconstruction
examples for the metal furniture coating lines.
4.2.1  Modification Examples
     Examples of increasing VOC emissions as a result of raw material,
coating application, and process changes are provided.  Each change is
discussed and the ones that are considered to be potential modifications
are identified.  The examples  to be evaluated are  shown in Table 4-1
along with a determination as  to whether or not the example is a
modification.  Each is discussed in the following  paragraphs.
     The modification examples  1 through 3, as shown  in Table 4-1, would
cause an  increase in VOC emissions.   Despite the fact that VOC emissions
would increase, examples 1 and  2 are  not considered to be a modification
because of 40 CFR Part 60.14(e)(4).   This  is because  a change in raw
materials, regardless of emission  rate, does not constitute a process
modification  if the existing  process  was designed  to  handle the  new raw
materials.  The only exception  to  this might be operators or owners of
coating  lines who switch from  applying powder  to organic  solvent-based
coatings.  Such a switch might result in a redesign of the application,
flash-off and bake  oven areas  for  some affected facilities.  Even  though
this  type of  switch  is highly  unlikely,  it could occur as a result of
changing  the  color  of the  coating  applied  to a  particular part at  the
request of the  customer.   This would  happen  if  the required color  was
not commercially available in  the  powder coating.  However, because of
                                     4-3

-------
             Table  4-1.   POTENTIAL  MODIFICATION  EXAMPLES
      Potential  modification
              example
          Determination of
            modification
(1)   Switching from a higher to  a
     lower solids  coating.
(2)  Adding solvent thinners  to
     coatings.
Is not a modification based on the
above definition in accordance with
40 CFR Part 60.14(e)(4).

Same as (1) above.
(3)  Increasing coating thickness.     A potential  modification.
(4)  Changing part size or
     complexity.
(5)  Addition of extra applica-
     tion equipment.

(6)  Temporary substitution of
     process equipment.
(7)  Relocation of a coating line
     from another plant site.
Is not a modification based on the
above definition in accordance with
40 CFR Part 60.14(e)(l) and 40 CFR
Part 60.14(e)(4).

A potential modification.
Is not a modification based on the
above definition in accordance with
40 CFR Part 60.14(e)(l).

Is not a modification based on the
above definition in accordance with
40 CFR Part 60.14 (e)(6).
                                      4-4

-------
 the cost of such a switch, the change might be termed a reconstruction
 instead of a modification.
      Increased coating thicknesses, other factors being constant, would
 result in increased VOC emissions.   Such a change could occur from a
 desire to increase durability and resistance for outdoor exposure.  This
 is a potential modification if the  spray booth is enlarged or extra
 spray guns are added or both on the coating line.  However,  operating
 changes such as higher air flow rate to a spray gun,  decreased conveyor
 speed,  etc., are not modifications  because the existing coating line
 would be designed to handle these operational  changes.
      Changing  part size or complexity could feasibly  increase VOC
 emissions from the existing facility.   An increase  in  part size,
 maintaining  a  constant conveyor speed,  would be a source  of  increased
 solvent emissions.  Changing the design  of a metal  part  on  a  production
 line is common engineering  practice.   If  the design change resulted  in  a
 more difficult metal  part  to  coat,  VOC  emissions  would  increase.   The
 increased emission  rate of  VOCs  would  be  due to higher  paint  consumption,
 poorer  paint transfer  efficiency or both.   Each of the  above  part  changes
 would not, however,  be  considered a modification  because of 40  CFR Part
 60.14(e)(l)  and  40  CFR  60  (e)(4).
     The  addition of extra  application  equipment  (increased VOC emissions)
 to an existing  coating  line in  order to increase  production and the
 improvement  of  product  quality  by the application of coating  for touch-
 up purposes, are examples of  process modifications, provided  the same
 coating is employed.  This could also involve reconstruction which is
 discussed in the next sections.
     Substitution of application equipment on a temporary basis at
 existing sources for specific coating jobs might increase VOC emissions.
 For example,  existing line components such as spray booths and flow
 chambers may be interchanged to handle certain customer demands.  These
 changes would not be considered a modification if such changes are made
 routinely with existing equipment prior to the development of a new
source performance standard.  This complies with 40 CFR Part 60.14(e)(l).
     The last potential modification example to be discussed is the
relocation of any VOC-emitting part  of a coating line  from one state  to
                                   4-5

-------
another state.  Emissions of VOC would increase at the new location but
in accordance with 40 CFR Part 60.14(e)(6), this would not be a modification,
4.2.2  Examples of Reconstruction
     This provision of the regulation is relatively straightforward in
that, regardless or the VOC emission rate, an existing facility may become
an affected facility because of the "50 percent of the fixed capital
cost" in the above definition.  Potential examples on a coating line
that would be affected are shown below:
     (1)  Replacing or enlarging of the coating application area.  This
would include the part touch-up area.
     (2)  Replacing or enlarging of the bake oven.
     (3)  Replacing or enlarging of the area (flash-off) between the
application and bake oven where the coated parts travel on a conveyor
line.
     The examples shown above are not restricted by any type of time
schedule under present regulations.  'In other words, once an existing
facility starts to replace or enlarge an existing line and exceeds 50
percent fixed capital costs requirement of a new comparable line, the
existing line may become an affected facility depending upon the
Administrator's decision.
                                      4-6

-------
               5.    MODEL PLANTS AND CONTROL OPTIONS

     This chapter defines model plants which represent the metal  furniture
surface coating industry and the alternative means by which volatile organic
compound (VOC) emissions can be regulated.
5.1  MODEL PLANTS
     Model surface coating plants were developed which represent the various
processes used in the industry and the various sizes of plants found in
existence.  The models were developed ^ +he basis of plant operation and
economic data collected from a variety of sources including trip reports,
                                                              1~15
industry surveys, computer listings, and published literature.
     Based on the industry size fragmentation described in Chapter 2, it
was tentatively decided that three model plants would be needed for each of
the three coating techniques.   Annual paint consumption was selected as the
basis for determining the size categories,  due to the fact that this type
of data was much more readily available than was information pertaining to
the total surface area coated per year.  The three size categories which
were selected are as follows:
                                       Annual Paint Consumption
Size Category                          liters	(gallons)
   Large                               400,000         (106,000)
   Medium                               75,000         ( 20,000)
   Small                                 4,000         (  1,050)
The medium size plant is approximately equal to the average plant size
found in the industry.
5.1.1  Spray Coating
     Spray coating is the most common application technique used in the
metal furniture industry.  Transfer efficiency for electrostatic spraying

-------
ranges from 50 to 95 percent depending upon the type of application equip-
                                                     1 c_] q
ment and the configuration of the item being painted.        Transfer effi-
ciency for flat surfaces is generally 85 percent and for complex shaped
objects, it is 65 percent.  This difference in efficiency has a substantial
affect on emission rates; therefore, two model plants were developed for
each size category.  Emission estimates were calculated by material balance
based upon a dry coating thickness of 2.54 x 103 cm (1  mil), a solvent
based alkyd paint with 35 percent by volume solids, and the indicated
application efficiency.  The amount of organic solvent emitted in the
application, flash-off, and curing areas was estimated at 40 percent
                                                                20
(including overspray), 30 percent, and 30 percent, respectively.    The
operating schedule for all plants is assumed to be 8 hours per day, 5 days
per week, 50 weeks per year.  Other operating data such as conveyor speed,
number of daily color changes, and energy consumption were estimated on the
basis of survey data.  Application exhaust flow rates were calculated on the
assumption that a  100 ppm organic solvent concentration would be maintained
in the spray booths.  Oven exhaust flow rates were calculated on the basis of
maintaining an organic solvent concentration of 15 percent of the  lower
explosive limit (LEL) in the curing ovens.  In addition a flow rate of approxi-
mately 15 meters per minute (50 ft/min) was assumed across all oven openings.
     Figures 5-1,  5-2, and 5-3 depict the model spray coating lines. Tables
5-1 through 5-6 show material and energy balances and operational  descrip-
tions of the spray coating model plants.
5.1.2  Dip Coating
     Dip coating is the  second most commonly  used method of paint  applica-
tion in the metal  furniture industry.  Transfer efficiency for this method
is approximately 90 percent and there is no appreciable difference resulting
from differing object  configurations.  Diagrams of the dip coating models
are shown in Figures 5-4 and 5-5.
     Emissions for the model plants were calculated by material balance
assuming a dry coating thickness of 2.54 x  103 cm  (1 mil), a  90 percent
transfer efficiency,   '    and the use of an alkyd  paint containing 35
volume  percent solids.   Energy  consumption  and other operating  data were
                                   5-2

-------
                       Load
en
GO
                        1.  Conveyor
                        2.  Three-stage washer
                        3.  Dry off oven
                        4.  Electrostatic disc spray booth
                        5.  Manual touch-up spray booth
                        6.  Flash-off
                        7.  Bake oven
                             Figure 5-1.   Example automated spray coating  lines with manual touch-up
                                            for  flat metal  furniture  surfaces  (Models  A and C).

-------
                   Load
01
                       1.
                       2.
                       3.
                       4.
                       5.
                       6.
                       7.
Conveyor
Three-stage washer
Dry off oven
Electrostatic bell spray booth
Manual touch-up spray booth
Flash-off
Bake oven
                       Figure 5-2.    Example  automated  spray  coating lines with manual  touch-up
                                       for complex metal  furniture  surfaces (Models  B and D).

-------
                          Load
cn
i
on
                            1.  Conveyor
                            2.  Three-stage washer
                            3.  Dry off oven
                            4.  Manual spray booth
                            5.  Flash-off
                            6.  Bake oven
Unload
                   Figure  5-3.   Example small metal  furniture  manual  spray coating line (Models  E and F)

-------
                                  Table 5-1.   MODEL  PLANT A
Application method/efficiency:  Electrostatic spray/85 percent
Surface type:  Flat
                                       2
Approximate surface area per  Item:  1.0 m
Total area coated per year:   4,000,000 m
Operating schedule:  8 hours/day S days/Meek 50 weeks/year
Conveyor speed:  4.2 Meters/win.
Number of lines:  6 (3 spray booths per line)
Number of color changes per day:  5
Number of plant employees:  620
Number of coating line employees:  45
MATERIAL BALANCE:
Items coated:
Coating used (liters):8
Material loss during application and
flash off
Solids (liters):
Solvents (Hters):b
Total coating applied to Items (liters):
Net dry solids on Items (liters):
Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):
Total emissions (kilograms):
Application exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
Application exhaust concentration (ppm) :
Oven exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION:
Application - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Cure - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
*35 percent solids
bOverspray Is also Included In this estimate.
Per Line
666,667
56,924

2,989
25.900
48.386
16.934
9.768
32.560
19
100
0.95
1,500
150 X 1010
0
3 X 1010
590 X 1010


Total
4,000.000
341.543

17.931
155.402
290.312
101.600
58.608
195.362
114
100
5.7
1.500
900 X 1010
0
18 X 1010
3538 X 1010


                                                      5-6

-------
                                  Table 5-2.   MODEL  PLANT  B
Application Method/efficiency:   Electrostatic spray/65 percent
Surface type:  Coaplex
Approximate surface area per Item:  0.33 m
Total area coated per year:   4,000,000 m
Operating schedule:  8 hours/day 5 days/week 50 weeks/year
Conveyor speed:  4.6 meters/mln
Number of lines:  10 (3 spray booths per line)
Number of color changes per day:   12
Number of plant employees:  620
Number of coating line employees:   75
MATERIAL BALANCE:
Items coated:
Coating used (liters):8
Material loss during application and
flash off
Solids (liters):
Solvents (liters): b
Total coating applied to Items (liters):
Net dry solids on Items (liters):
Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):
Total emissions (kilograms):
Application exhaust flow rate (meters /sec) :
Application exhaust concentration (ppm):
Oven exhaust flow rate (meters /sec) :
Ov*n exhaust concentration (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION:
Application - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Cure - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Per Line
1.200,000
44,660

5,471
20,320
29,029
10,160
7,664
25,545
19
100
0.95
1.500

150 X 1010
0
3 X 1010
590 X 1010
Total
12,000,000
446,593

54 ,708
203,200
290,285
101,600
76,636
255 ,452
190
100
9.5
1,500

1500 X 1010
0
30 X 1010
5896 X 1010
*35 percent solids

 bOverspray 1s also Included 1n this estimate.
                                                     5-7

-------
                               Table  5-3.    MODEL  PLANT  C
Application method/efficiency:  Electrostatic spray  85 percent
Surface type:  Flat
Approximate surface area per Item:  1.0 m
Total area coated per year:   780,000 meters2
Operating schedule:  8 hours/day  5 days/week 50 weeks/year
Conveyor speed:  2.5 meters/mln.
Number of lines:  2 (3 spray booths per line)
Number of color changes per day:   5
Number of plant employees:  140
Number of coating  line employees:  11
MATERIAL BALANCE:
I tens coated:
Coating used (liters)1
Material loss during application and
flash off
Solids (liters):
Solvents (liters):
Total coating applied to Items (liters):
Net dry solids on Items (liters):0
Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):
Total emissions (kilograms):
Application exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
Application exhaust concentration (ppm):
Oven exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION:
Application - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Cure - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Per Line
390,000
33,298

1.748
15,150
28,303
9,906
5,714
19.046
19
100
0.95
1,500
55 X 1010
0
3 X 1010
435 X 1010
Total
780,000
66.596

3,496
30,300
56,606
19,812
11.428
38,092
38
100
1.9
1,500
110 X 1010
0
6 X 1010
870 X 1010
 *35  percent solids

  bOverspray Is  also Included 1n this  estimate
                                                      5-8

-------
                                  Table  5-4.   MODEL  PLANT  D
Application «ethod/eff1dency:  Electrostatic spray/65 percent
Surface type:   Conplex
ApproxlMBte surface  area per Item:  0.33 meters
Total area coated per year: 780,000 meters
Operating schedule:  8  hours/day 5 days/week 50 weeks/year
  Conveyor speed:  2.4 meters/m1n.
  Number of lines:  2 (3 spray booths per Hne)
  Number of color changes per day:  5
  Number of plant employees:  140
  Number of coating line employees:  11
MATERIAL BALANCE:
Items coated
Coating used (liters):8
Material loss during  application and
flash off
     Solids (liters):
     Solvents (liters):b
Total coating applied to  Items  (liters):
Net dry solids on  Items  (liters):
Solvent emissions  during  curing (kilograms):
Total emissions (kilograms):
Application exhaust flow  rate  (meters /sec):
Application exhaust concentration  (ppm):
Oven exhaust flow  rate  (meters  /sec):
Oven exhaust concentration  (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION:
Application - Electric  (joules):
            - Gas  (joules):
Cure - Electric (joules):
     - Gas (joules):
  Per Line
1,181,800
   43,543


    5,334
   19,812
   28,303
    9,906
    7,472
   24,907
       19
      100
        0.95
    1,500
    55 X 10
          0
     3 X 10
   435 X 10
           10
  Total
2,363,636
   87,086
   10,668
   39,624
   56,606
   19,812
   14,944
   49,814
       38
      100
        1.9
    1,500
  110 X 10
         0
    6 X 10
  870 X 10
                                   10
*35 percent solids

 bOverspray 1s also  Included  1n this estimate.
                                                     5-9

-------
                            Table  5-5.    MODEL  PLANT  E
                   an,, per Item:   1..
           coated per year:  45.000 meters2                        Nurt>er of plant e*>loyees:   U
          sc^Je   slurs/day 5  days/*** SO weeks/year         Nu*er of coating line employees:

MATERIAL BALANCE:                                                          ~—
       ~   '                                                              <9,QUU
Items coated:   .                                                           3 M2
Coating used  (liters):
Material loss  during application and
flash off                                                                    202
     Solids (liters):                                                         ;48
     Solvents (liters)-.                                                     '
Total coating applied to 1tew  (liters):                                     •
                                                                           1.143

 Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):
Net dry solids on Items (liters):                                            g5g

                                                                          2.197
 Total  emissions (kilograms):
 Application exhaust flow rate (meters  /sec):                                  ^
 Application exhaust concentration (ppm):
 Oven exhaust  flow rate (meters /sec):                                         ^
 Oven exhaust  concentration  (ppm):
 ENERGY CONSUMPTION:                                                       
-------
                               Table  5-6.   MODEL  PLANT  F
Application »ethod/eff1c1ency:   Electrostatic spray/65 percent     Conveyor speed:   2.5  meters/m1n.
Surface type:  Complex                                            Number of lines:   1  (1  spray booth)
Approximate surface area per Item:   0.33 meters       '             Number of color  changes per day:  5
Total area coated per year:   45.000  meters                         Number of plant  employees:  18
Operating schedule:  8 hours/day 5 days/week 50 weeks/year         Number of coating line  employees:  3
MATERIAL BALANCE:                                                           Total
Items coated:                                                             136,360
Coating used (liters):'                                                     5,024
Material loss during application and
flash off
     Solids (liters):                                                          615
     Solvents (Hters):b                                                    2,286
Total coating applied  to Items  (liters):                                     3,266
Net dry solids on Hems (liters):                                            1,143
Solvent emissions during curing  (kilograms):                                   862
Total emissions (kilograms):                                                 2,874
Application exhaust flow rate (meters3/sec):                                    19
Application exhaust concentration (ppm):                                       100
Oven exhaust flow rate  (meters /sec):                                           0.95
Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):                                            1,500
ENERGY CONSUMPTION:
Application - Electric  (joules):                                           45 x  1010
            - Gas (joules):                                                     0
Cure - Electric (joules):                                                   2 X  1010
     - Gas  (joules):                                                      366 x  1010
*35 percent solids

 bOverspray 1s also Included  1n  this estimate.
                                                  5-11

-------
en
i
                  Load
                   1.  Conveyor
                   2.  Three stage washer
                   3.  Dry off oven
                   4.  53 m3 Dip tank
                   5.  Flash-off
                   6.  Bake oven
             ©
Unload
                      Figure 5-4.   Example metal  furniture  dip coating  lines  for medium and large
                                     plants (Models G  and H).

-------
                  Load
en

CO
                                                                                   Conveyor
                                                                                   Three stage washer
                                                                                   Dry off oven
                                                                                   19 m3 dip tank
                                                                                   Flash-off
                                                                                   Bake oven
                        Figure 5-5.   Example  small  metal  furniture  dip  coating  line  (Model I)

-------
estimated from the survey data.   Application area and oven exhaust flow
rates were calculated in the same manner described in the previous section.
     Material and energy balances and operational data are listed in Tables
5-7, 5-8, and 5-9 for the three dip coating model plants.
5.1.3  Flow Coating
     Flow coating is the least used application method in the metal furniture
industry.  This method is used primarily by small plants; therefore, only
one model plant was developed.
     Transfer efficiency for flow coating is estimated at 90 percent with
no difference for varying part complexity.16'17  Emissions for the model
plant were calculated by material balance using the  same assumption dis-
cussed for dip coating.  Energy  consumption and other operating data were
estimated from the  survey information.  Application  area and exhaust flow
rates were calculated by the methods previously  delineated.
     Figure  5-6 depicts the model flow  coating plant.  Material and energy
balances and operational data are listed  in Table  5-10 for this model.
5.2  REGULATORY ALTERNATIVES
     The purpose  of this section is  to  define different  regulatory alterna-
tives  based  upon  their  effectiveness for  reducing  VOC  emissions.   The
regulatory alternatives are established from the control  technologies
described in Chapter 3.   Four regulatory  alternatives  are considered  in
developing the  control  options:
       I.  No additional emission reduction above the baseline  case.
      II.  30 percent VOC emission reduction above the baseline case.
     III.  50 percent VOC emission reduction above the baseline case.
      IV.  85 percent VOC emission reduction above the baseline case.
      The baseline case is the emission limitation required by existing
 regulations in the absence of an NSPS.   This emission limitation is recom-
 mended  in the Control Techniques Guideline (CTG) document for this industry.
 Many states have already adopted or are in the process of adopting this
 emission limitation into their  State Implementation Plans (SIPs).  For the
 purpose of  this study  it is assumed that the SIPs are based on the emission
 limitation  of 0.36  kg of VOC per liter of coating (minus water).
                                    5-14

-------
                                 Table  5-7.    MODEL  PLANT  G
Application Method/efficiency:   Dip coating/90 percent
Surface type:  Complex
Approximate surface area per Item:  0.33 meters2
Total area coated per year:   4,000,000 meters
Operating schedule: 8 hours/day 5  days/week  50 weeks/year

MATERIAL BALANCE
   Items coated:
   Coating used (liters)b:
   Material loss during application and
   flash off
      Solids (liters):
      Solvents (liters):
   Total coating applied to  items  (liters):
   Net dry solids on Items  (liters):
   Solvent emissions during  curing  (kilograms):
   Total emissions (kilograms):
   Application exhaust flow  rate (meters3/sec):
   Application exhaust concentration (ppm):
   Oven exhaust flow rate (meters3/sec):
   Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION
   Application - Electric (joules):
               - Gas (joules):
   Cure - Electric (joules):
        - Gas (joules):
Conveyor speed:  4.6 meters/min.
Number of lines:  10 (1-53  m3  tank per  line)
Number of color  changes  per day: Oa
Number of plant  employees:  620
Number of coating line employees:  60
   Per line
1,200,000
   32,254


    1,129
    8,386
   29,029
   10,160
   11,070
   18,449
        2.5
      100
        0.95
    1,500
    7 x 10
        0
    3 x 10
  590 x 10
          10
   Total
12,000.000
   322,540
    11,289
    83,860
   290,^90
   101,600
   110,700
   184,490
        25
       100
         9.5
     1,500
   70 x 10
         0
   30 x 10
5.900 x 10
                                10
'Different color paints  1n  the different tanks.
 35 percent solids.
                                                   5-15

-------
                                  Table  5-8.    MODEL  PLANT  H
Application Kthod/efflclency: Dip coating/90  percent
Surface type:  Conplex
                                        eters
                                        .2
Approximate surface area per Item:  0.33
Total area coated per year:   780.000 meters'
Oiwntlng schedule: 8 hours/day 5 days/week 50 weeks/year
Conveyor speed: 2.5 «eters/m1n.
Number of lines: 2 (1-53 m3 tank per line)
Number of color changes per day: Oa
Number of plant employees:  140
Number of coating line employees:   11
MATERIAL BALANCE
Items coated:
Coated used (11ters)b:
Material loss during application and
flash off
Solids (liters):
Solvents (liters):
Total coating applied to Items (liters):
Net dry solids on Items (liters):
Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):
Total emissions (kilograms):
Application exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
Application exhaust concentration (ppm):
Oven exhaust flow rate (meters 3/sec):
Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION
Application - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Cure - Electric (joules):
- Gas (joules):
Per line
1,181,818
31.448


1.100
8.177
28.303
9.906
10.793
17.988
2.5
100
0.95
1.500
1 A
7 x 1010
0
in
3 x 1010
1 A
435 x 1010
Total
2.363.636
62.896


2.200
16.354
56.606
19.812
21.586
35.976
5
100
1.
1.500

14 x
0
3 x
870 x













,9

in
1010
10
101U
in
iolu
 'Different color In each tank.
 b35 percent solIds.
                                                         5-16

-------
                                 Table  5-9.   MODEL PLANT  I
Application «ethod/eff1ciency:  Dip coating/90 percent          Conveyor speed: 2.5 meters/min.
Surface type:   C«*>lex                                          Number of lines: 1 (1-19 m  tank)
Approximate surface  area per Item:  0.33 meters2                Number of color changes per day:   0
Total area coated per year: 45,000 meters2                      Number of plant employees: 18
Operating schedule:  8  hours/day 5 days/week 50 weeks/year      Number of coating line employees:   3
MATERIAL BALANCE
   Items coated:                                                         136,360
   Coating used (liters):3                                                 3'629
   Material loss during  application and
   flash off
      Solids (liters):                                                        127
      Solvents (liters):                                                      944
   Total coating applied to items  intersj:                                3,266
   Net dry solids on Items  (liters):                                       L143
   Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):                            1.245
   Total emissions (kilograms):                                            2-076
   Application exhaust flow rate (meters  /sec):                                 0-3
   Application exhaust concentration  (ppm):                                   100
   Oven exhaust flow rate (meters 3/sec):                                        °-95
   Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):                                        1>500
 ENERGY CONSUMPTION
   Application - Electric (joules):                                           2 x  10
               - Gas (joules):                                                °
   Cure -  Electric (joules):                                                 2 *  1°
        -  Gas  (joules):                                                     366 x  10

 a35  percent solids.
                                                   5-17

-------
                  Load v
tn
oo
                                                                                    Unload
1.  Conveyor
2.  Three stage washer
3.  Dry off oven
4.  Flow coat chamber
5.  Flash-off
6.  Dake oven
                             Figure 5-6.  Example  metal  furniture  flow  coating  line  (Model  J).

-------
                                    Table  5-10.    MODEL  PLANT J
Application Mthod/efflclency:   Flow coating/90 percent
Surface type:   Complex
Approximate surface area  per  Item: 0.33 meters
                                         o
Total area coated per year:   45,000 meters
Operating schedule:   8 hours/day 5 days/week 50 weeks/year

MATERIAL BALANCE
   Items coated:
   Coating used (liters)9:
   Material loss during application and
   flash off
      Solids (liters):
      Solvents (liters):
   Total coating applied  to Items (liters):
   Net dry solids on items (liters);
   Solvent emissions during curing (kilograms):
   Total emissions (kilograms):
   Application exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
   Application exhaust concentration (ppm):
   Oven exhaust flow rate (meters /sec):
   Oven exhaust concentration (ppm):
ENERGY CONSUMPTION
   Application - Electric (joules):
               - Gas (joules):
   Cure - Electric (joules):
        - Gas  (joules):
Conveyor speed:  2.5 Meters/min.
Number of lines:   1 (1  flow-coat booth)
Number of color  changes  per day:  0
Number of plant  employees:  18
Number of coating line  employees:  3

             Total
             136,360
               3,629


                 127
               1,877
               3,266
               1,413
                 415
               2,076
                   0.4
                 100
                   0.95
               1,500
                 3 x 10
                   0
                 2 x 10
               366 x 10
                       10
*35 percent solids.
                                                        5-19

-------
     Listed below are the selected control  options  (from control  techniques
in Chapter 3) for each emission reduction level:
     a    No NSPS above recommended baseline case.
     •    30 percent VOC emission reduction
          1.   Electrostatic spraying of powder coatings.
          2.   Applying powder coatings by a fluidized bed.
          3.   Electrostatic spraying of high solids coatings (60-80 percent).
          4.   Electrostatic spraying of waterborne coatings (82/18 and
               67/33).
          5.   Thermal incinerator on bake oven plus electrostatic spraying
               of high solids coatings (60-80 percent).
          6.   Dip coating with waterborne coatings (82/18 and 67/33).
          7.   Flow  coating with a waterborne coating  (82/18).
          8.   Thermal incinerator on bake oven plus dip coating with
               waterborne coating  (82/18 and 67/33).
          9.   Electrodeposition with a 82/18 waterborne coating.
      •    50 percent VOC emission  reduction.
          1.   Electrostatic  spraying of powder coatings.
           2.   Applying  powder coatings  by a fluidized bed.
           3.   Electrostatic  spraying with a waterborne coating  (82/18).
           4.   Dip  coating  with a waterborne coating  (82/18).
           5.   Thermal  incinerator on  bake oven plus  dip coating with a
               waterborne  coating (82/18).
           6.   Electrodeposition with  a 82/18  waterborne coating.
           7.   Flow coating with a 82/18 waterborne coating.
      •    85 percent VOC emission reduction.
           1.   Electrostatic spray of powder coatings.
           2.   Applying powder coatings by a fluidized bed.
           3.   Electrodeposition with a 82/18 waterborne coating.
 Some possible control techniques are not presented (e.g.,  carbon adsorption)
 and the reasons for this are discussed later in Section 5.2.1.  The above
 list of control  options is large and was reduced to a more manageable  size
 through consideration of a cost effectiveness screening study.  The analyses
 indicated  the number of control options required for  spray, dip, and flow
 coating lines varies as follows:
                                   5-20

-------
                                                  Use frequency of control
                                                     techniques to meet
Coating line            Control  alternative           control options
Spray                         30 percent                      4
Spray                         50 percent                      2
Spray                         85 percent                      1
Dip                           30 percent                      4
Dip                           50 percent                      4
Dip                           85 percent                      2
Flow                          30-85 percent                   1
The main parameter was cost changes to comply with any proposed NSPS above
the baseline case associated with the control options.  As a result, the
above number of required control techniques are representative of all of
the possible control options from a cost change standpoint.   This is also
true regardless of the three regulatory alternatives selected at VOC emis-
sion reduction levels.
     The selected control options are shown in Table 5-11.  Two general
types of control options are presented in Table 5-11:  (a) add-on control
equipment, and (b) coating formulation changes.  Emission reductions of VOC
are shown in Tables 5-12 through 5-21 for each model plant.   Each control
option is discussed in Sections  5.2.1 and 5.2.2.   For reasons which will be
discussed later, not all control techniques evaluated in Chapter 3 can be
applied to each model  plant.
5.2.1  Add-on Control  Equipment
     Add-on control equipment which can be used for metal furniture coating
operations are thermal and catalytic incinerators, carbon adsorbers, and
condensers.  A combination of the above can also be used, but this was not
considered in developing control options.  The reason for not considering
combinations is presented in the following sections.
     5.2.1.1  Incineration.   Incineration can be used to control emissions
for curing only and has been used to a limited extent in the metal
furniture industry.  Based on information provided in Chapter 3, incinera-
tion of emissions from the application area is not considered technologi-
cally feasible due to the high flow rate and low solvent concentration of
the exhaust gas.
                                  5-21

-------
    Table 5-11.   CONTROL OPTION SUMMARY FOR EACH MODEL PLANT
  Control option
                                           Model plants
D
               I
Powder coating             X    X    X    X
Electrodeposition
Waterborne                 X    X    X    X
70 percent high solids     X    X    X    X
Incineration               X    X    X    X
65 percent high solids     X    X    X    X
     X
     X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X   X
                                  5-22

-------
                            Table  5-12.   EMISSION  REDUCTION  FOR  MODEL  PLANT  A -  LARGE  SPRAY  COATING  FACILITY
                                                            FOR  FLAT  METAL  FURNITURE SURFACES
in
 i
ro




Plant
A
A


A

A
A

A



Regulatory
alternative
IV
III


II

II
I

I



Control
technique
Powder
Waterborne (35i
by volume solids
82/18 H20 to
solvent'
70% by volume
high solids
Thermal incinerator
65% by volume
high solids
Base case

Emission
reduction
by
weight (X)
98
80


75

96
69

61


Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire line6
Entire line


Entire line

Bake oven
Entire line

Entire line

Em1ss1onb
estimate
for coating
line (kg/yr)
3,680
38,000


48,300

52 ,600
60,700

75,100
Emission
reduction
by weight0
over the
base case (%)
95
50


35

30
19

--

Emission
reduction by .
weight over the
uncontrolled plant (X)
98
80


75

72
69

61
                   'Emission  reduction for the individual control technique,  but not the entire coating line.


                    Overall emission estimate for the entire coating line.


                   °Base case  = 0.35 kg VOC/liter of coating applied.


                   Uncontrolled • 35 percent solids paint.


                   e"Entire line" only refers to the processes on the coating  line that might emit VOCs.  Therefore, this includes application,
                   flash-off  and curing oven areas.

-------
Table  5'13-EMISSION

Regulatory
Plant alternative
B iv
B III

B II
B II
01
8 B '
B I

Control
technique
Powder
Materbome (35X
volume sol Ids,
82/18 H,0 to
solvent)
70X by volume
high solids
Thermal Incinerator
65X by volume
high solids
Base case

Emission
reduction
by
weight (X)
99
80

75
96
68
61

Process being
controlled
on coating Hne
Entire line6
Entire Hne

Entire line
Bake oven
Entire Hne
Entire Hne
	
Emission..
estimate"
for coating
line (kg/yr)
3,680
51,000

64,200
69,800
80,600
99,700
Emission
reduction
by weight
over the
base case (X)
96
50

36
50
19
~

Emission
reduction by rf
weight over the
uncontrolled plant (X)
99
80

75
72
68
61
"Emission  reduction for the Individual  control technique, but not the entire coating line



 Overall emission estimate for the entire coating Hne.



cB«se case » 0.36 kg VOC/Hter of coating applied.



 Uncontrolled • 35 percent solids paint.





"fla'sh-off'a'n'd
                                                                                        th1s 1nclude$ «PP"«t1on.

-------
                        Table 5-14.  EMISSION REDUCTION FOR MODEL PLANT C  -  MEDIUM SIZE SPRAY COATING

                                         FACILITY FOR FLAT METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
Ol
I
ro
en
Plant
C
C
C
C
C
C
Regulatory
alternative
IV
III
II
II
I
I
'Emission reduction
bOverall
Control
technique
Powder
Waterborne (35*
by volume solids,
82/18 H20 to
solvent)
70% by volume
high solids
Thermal Incinerator
65% by volume
high solids
Base case
Emission
reduction
by
weight (%)
98
80
75
96
69
62
for the Individual control technique,
emission estimate for the entire
C8ase case « 0.35 kg
VOC/Hter of coating
coating Hne.
applied.
Process being
controlled
on coating Hne
Entire line6
Entire line
Entire line
Bake oven
Entire Hne
Entire line
Emission.
estimate
for coating
line (kg/yr)
715
7,300
9,350
10,200
11,800
14,500
Emission
reduction
by weight
over the
base case (X)
95
50
36
30
19
--
Emission
reduction by
weight over thed
'uncontrolled plant (?)
98
80
75
72
69
62
but not the entire coating line.








Uncontrolled - 35 percent solids paint.
"Entire line" only refers to the processe
flash-off and curing oven areas.
s on the coating
line that might
emit VOCs. Therel
Fore, thl, includ
es application,

-------
ro
01
                             Table 5-15.   EMISSION  REDUCTION  FOR MODEL  PLANT  D -  MEDIUM SIZE  SPRAY  COATING

                                                   FACILITY  FOR COMPLEX  METAL  FURNITURE SURFACES
Plant
0
D

D

D
0

D
Regulatory
alternative
IV
III

II

II
I

I
Control
technique
Powder
Waterborne (35%
by volume solids,
82/18 H20 to
solvent}
70% by volume
high sol Ids
Thermal Incinerator
65% by volume
high solids
Base case
Emission
reduction
by
weight (%)
99
80

75

96
69

61
Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire I1nee
Entire line

Entire line

Bake oven
Entire Hne

Entire line
Em1ss1onb
estimate
for coating
Hne (kg/yr)
715
9,700

12 400

13,600
15 600

19/00
Emission
reduction
by weight
over the c
base case (%)
96
50

36

30
20
»
—
Emission
reduction by
weight over thed
uncontrolled plant (%)
99
80

75

72
69

61
                     Emission reduction for the Individual control  technique, but not the entire coating Hne.



                     Overall  emission estimate for the entire coating Hne.



                    °Base case =• 0.36 kg VOC/Hter of coating applied.



                     Uncontrolled = 35 percent solids paint.
**e!! on1? refers to the
flash-off and curing oven areas.
                                                        «• the coating  Hne that might emit VOCs.  Therefore, this Includes application,

-------
                                  Table  5-16.   EMISSION  REDUCTION FOR  MODEL  PLANT  E -  SMALL  SPRAY COATING
                                                     FACILITY FOR  FLAT METAL FURNITURE  SURFACES
ro
-vl


Plant
E
E
E

E

E


Regulatory
alternative
IV
III
II

I

I


Control
technique
Powder
Waterborne
70% by volume
high solids
65% by volume
high solids
Base case

Emission
reduction
by
weight (%)
98
80
76

69

62


Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire I1nee
Entire line
Entire line

Entire line

Entire line

Em1ss1onh
estimate"
for coating
line (kg/yr)
41
420
539

678

838
Emission
reduction Emission
by weight reduction by .
over the weight over the
base case (X) uncontrolled plant (%)
95 98
50 80
36 76

19 69


                   "Emission reduction for the Individual  control technique, but not the entire coating line.


                    Overall emission estimate for the entire coating Hne.


                   cBase case = 0.36 kg VOC/llter of coating applied.


                    Uncontrolled = 35 percent solids paint.


                   e"Ent1re line" only refers to the processes on the coating line that might emit VOCs.  Therefore, this  Includes application,
                    flash-off and curing oven areas.

-------
                                  Table  5-17.   EMISSION  REDUCTION  FOR MODEL  PLANT F  - SMALL SPRAY COATING

                                                    FACILITY  FOR COMPLEX  METAL  FURNITURE  SURFACES
en
 i
ro
00

Plant
F
F
F

F

F


Regulatory
alternative
IV
III
II

I

I


Control
technique
Powder
Waterborne
70% by volume
high solids
65% by volume
high solids
Base case


Emission
reduction
by
weight (*)
99
80
75

69

61


Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire line*
Entire Hne
Entire line

Entire Hne

Entire line


Em1ss1onh
estimate
for coating
Hne (kg/yr)
39
560
780

905

1 ,120

Emission
reduction
by weight
over the
base case (%)
97
50
36

19

--


Emission
reduction by .
weight over thi
uncontrolled plant (%)
99
80
75

69

61
V
                         Emission reduction for the Individual  control technique,  but not the entire coating Hne.


                         Overall emission estimate for the entire coating line.


                        C8ase case • 0.36 kg VOC/llter of coating applied.


                         Uncontrolled * 35 percent solids paint.



                        e"Entire Hne" only refers to the processes on the coating Hne that might emit VOCs.  Therefore, this Includes application,
                         flash-off and curing oven areas.

-------
cn
i
no
                                  Table  5-18.   EMISSION REDUCTION  FOR  MODEL PLANT  G -  LARGE DIP COATING

                                                           FACILITY  FOR METAL  FURNITURE
Emission Emission,
. . , 4 , reduction' Process being estimate"
Regulatory Control by controlled for coating
Plant alternative technique weight (X) on coating line line (kg/yr)
G IV
G IV
G III
G III
G II9
Powder-fluldlzed 96 Entire line6'*1 8 370
DGQ
Electrodeposition 95 Entire line 9 300
of waterborne •
Thermal Incinerator 96 Bake oven 31 700
Haterborne 82 Entire line 34.100
Base case 60 Entire line 74.800
Emission
reduction Emission
by weight reduction by
over the6 weight over the"
base case (X) uncontrolled plant (X)
89 96
88 95
58 83
54 82
60
"Emission reduction for the Individual control technique, but not the entire coating line.
Overall emission
^ase case - 0.36
dUncontrolled « 35
"m.bSff'E cur
estimate for the entire coating line.
kg VOC/Hter of coating applied.
percent solids paint.
ers to the processes on the coating line that might emit VOCs Therefor*
Ing oven areas. ' =•»•=.



this Includes application.
                   Assuming a thermosettlng powder or thermoplastic powder that does not require a primer.




                  stasc case - regulatory alternative II i*ciu$o of Increased transfer efficiency.

-------
en
 i
CO
o
                                 Table  5-19.   EMISSION  REDUCTION  FOR MODEL  PLANT  H  - MEDIUM SIZE DIP  COATING
                                                                 FACILITY  FOR METAL  FURNITURE

Plant
H

H

H
H
H

Regulatory
alternative
IV

IV

III
III
II

Control
technique
Powder-fluidized
bed
Electrodeposltion
waterborne
Thermal Incinerator
Waterborne
Base case

Emission
reduction
by
weight (%)
96

95

96
82
60

Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire linee>f

Entire line

Bake oven
Entire line
Entire line

Em1ss1onb
estimate
for coating
line (kg/yr)
1.550

1 ,800

6,120
6,640
14.500
Emission
reduction
by weight
over the
base case (%)
89

87

58
54


Emission
reduction by j
weight over thr
uncontrolled plant (%)
96

95

83
82
60
                   aEmission reduction for the individual  control  technique,  but not the entire coating line.


                   bOverall emission estimate for the entire coating line.


                   cBase case - 0.36 kg VOC/liter of coating applied.


                   Uncontrolled - 35 percent solids paint.


                   e"Ent1re line" only refers to the processes on  the coating line  that might emit VOCs.- Therefore, this Includes application,

                    flash-off and curing oven areas.


                   fAssuming a thermosetting or a thermoplastic powder that does not require a primer.



                   9Base case - regulatory alternative II  because  of Increased  transfer efficiency.

-------
                                                                                                                                 DIP COATING
cn
CO

Plant
I
I
I
I
Regulatory Control
alternative technique
IV Powder-fluldlzed
bed
IV Electrodeposltlon
waterborne
I" Haterborne
II Base case
Emission ,
reduction"
by
weight (X)
96
95
82
60
Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire I1nee'f
Entire line
Entire line
Entire line
Em1ss1onK
estimate0
for coating
line (kg/yr)
89
104
383
838
Emission
reduction
by weight
over thec
base case (X)
89
88
54
Emission
reduction by .
weight over the"
uncontrolled plant (X)
96
95
82
60

                         Overall  emission estimate for the entire coating line.
                        cBase case - 0.36 kg VOC/llter of coating applied.

                         Uncontrolled »  35 percent solids paint.
                        "'
                                                         '"""" " ""
        ff
Assuming a thermosettlng powder or a  thermoplastic powder that does  not require a primer.

9Base case -  regulatory alternative II because of Increased transfer  efficiency.
                                                                                                            Therefore'  th1s
                                                                                                                                    Plication.

-------
                              Table  5-21.   EMISSION REDUCTION  FOR  MODEL  PLANT J  -  SMALL  FLOW  COATING
                                                              FACILITY  FOR  METAL  FURNITURE


Regulatory
Plant alternative
J III
J IIf

Control
technique
Water-borne
Base case

Emission
reduction
by
weight (*)
82
60

Process being
controlled
on coating line
Entire line6
Entire line

Emission^
estimate
for coating
line (kg/yr)
383
838
Emission
reduction
by weight
over the
base case (%)
54
—

Emission
reduction by ,j
weight over the
uncontrolled plant
82
60

(*)


en
 i
CO
ro
                 'Emission reduction for the  individual control technique, but not the  entire coating line.



                 bOverall emission estimate for the entire coating line.


                 cBase  case « 0.36 kg VOC/liter of coating applied.


                 dUncontrolled = 35 percent solids paint.


                 -Entire line" only refers to the processes on the coating line that might emit VOCs.  Therefore,  this Includes application,

                   flash-off and curing oven areas.


                 fBase case - regulatory alternative II because of increased transfer efficiency.

-------
     Thermal incineration is applied only to model plants A, B, C, D, G,
and H.   The emission estimates are based on the addition of the incinerator
to the curing oven of a coating line using a CTG level coating material
(60 percent by volume solids or waterborne).  Catalytic incineration was
not considered for two reasons; (a) it has lower control efficiencies than
thermal incineration, and (b) precleaning equipment might be necessary to
protect the catalyst.  The smaller plants (models E, F, I, and J) are not
considered due to their low emission rates and the high cost of this control
technique.  Incineration is most effective for dip coating lines due to the fact
that more solvent (50 to 70 percent) is evaporated in the baking oven with this
process.   Spray and flow coating operations emit less during curing.  Figure 5-7
shows a block diagram of a process controlled by incineration.
     5.2.1.2  Carbon Adsorption.   Carbon adsorption can be applied only to
the application and flash-off areas of a coating line.  Carbon adsorption
is not presently ustu in the metal furniture industry; however, it is
conceivable that some companies may choose to use it.  The emission reduc-
tion achievable is similar to that of incineration; however, the costs are
extremely high.  Because of the expense and the technological problems
discussed in Chapter 3, this control technique was not employed as a control
option .
     5.2.1.3  Condenser.   Condensers can possibly be applied to control
VOC's from the flash-off and bake oven gaseous exhausts.  However, this
control technique was not employed as a control option since it is not a
proven technology.
5.2.2  Coating Formulation Change
     Coating formulation changes evaluated for control options are powder,
high solids, and waterborne coatings.
     5.2.2.1  Powder Coating.  Control of VOC emissions by coating with
powder is evaluated for two application techniques: (a) electrostatic spray
and (b) fluidized bed.   Electrostatic spray application of thermoset powders
is evaluated for all spray coating model plants.   This option offers the
greatest emission reduction potential  when compared with other control
techniques.   Changes that would occur in model plants A through F as a
                                  5-33

-------
                         voc
Parts
                                                          Incinerator
/ \





Spray Booth
VOC
1
1
i
Flash-off
Area
1 VOC
1
1
Curing
Oven

	 y

                                                                              Coated Parts
                   Figure 5-7.   VOC  control  by incineration.
                                        5-34

-------
result of switching from conventional  organic solvent to powder coatings
are shown in Table 5-22.
     Also, application of thermoplastic or thermoset powder with a fluidized
bed is evaluated for all dip coating model plants.   It is assumed that no
primer is added to the parts before they are coated with a thermoplastic
powder.   Changes that would occur on the dip coating lines are also shown
in Table 5-22.
     Powder coating is not considered as a control  alternative for flow
coating because no appropriate application method is known to be available.
     5.2.2.2  High Solids Coatings.  Control of VOC emissions by the use of
high solids coatings is considered for electrostatic spray model plants
only.   Problems with dip and flow coating are encountered due to the visco-
sity of high solids paints.
     Two different levels of high solids coatings are considered (65 and 70
percent).  Coating formulations in this range are used to a limited extent
in the metal furniture industry, however, it is a proven technology.
     Transfer efficiencies for high solids paints were assumed to be
slightly less than those for conventional solvent-borne paints.  The
transfer efficiencies used in calculating emission reduction potential
are 80 percent for flat surfaces and 60 percent for complex surfaces.
Table 5-23 shows coating line changes that result in switching from
organic solvent-borne coatings to high solids coatings.
     5.2.2.3  Waterborne Coatings.  Waterborne coatings can be used as
control  options for all types of application techniques.  A volatile formu-
lation of 82 percent water and 18 percent solvent is used to calculate
emissions from this alternative.  For electrostatic spray operations,
application efficiencies of 80 percent for flat surfaces and 60 percent for
complex surfaces are used.
     Two control options are developed for waterborne dip coating.   Standard
dip coating of waterborne paint involves an application efficiency of 90
percent and an emission reduction of 82 percent.   Electrodeposition of
waterbornes, however, yields a much higher application efficiency and an
overall  emission reduction of 95 percent.
                                  5-35

-------
OJ
en
                                                Table 5-22.   PROCESS  PARAMETERS  FOR  MODEL  PLANTS
                                                                  APPLYING  POWDER  COATINGS
Model
plant
Spraying
A
B
C
0
E
F
Dipping
G
H
I
Coating* used,
103 liters (103 gallons)

283
283
55
55
3.2
3.2

644
119
6.9

(75)
(75)
(15)
(15)
(0.85)
(0.85)

(170)
(31)
(1.8)
Application
exhaust flow rate
m3/sec (ft3/m1n)

1.7
2.3
0.3
0.45
0.02
0.03

	
	
	

(3600)
(4900)
(640)
(950)
(42)
(59)

--
—
--
Ovenc
exhaust flow rate
m3/sec (ft3/m1n)

2.85
4.75
0.95
0.60
0.48
0.48

	
	
	

(6 000)
(10 000)
(2 000)
(1 260)
(1 000}
(1 000)

• -
.-
..
Operating energy consumption"
total electric
1010 Joules OO'MI)

672
1 450
110
110
4
4

130
22
5

(2.42)
(4.03)
(0.31)
(0.31)
(0.09)
(0.09)

(0.36)
(0.06)
(0.01)
total gas,
1010 Joules (10* BTU/hr)

1 770
2 950
435
435
183
183

2 950
435
183

(16
(28
( 4
( 4
( 1
( 1

(28
( 4
( 1

800)
000)
120)
120)
730)
730)

000)
120)
730)
                          a-ssurning coating thicknesses for spraying and dipping to be 6.35 and 15.24 (10  ) cm, respectively.
                          bAir flow rates  (entire line) based upon a LEL of 30 g/m3 (0.03 OZ/ft ).
                                                                                            22
                          cAssumed about half the flow rate  (entire  line) required for model plants.
                           Energy consumption data based on  Table 7-20.
                          eFor model plants A through D the  assumed  powder utilization was 90 percent due to the required color change.  For model plants E and f
                           powder utilization was 95 percent.
                          f?o«'der utilizations for model  plants G, H, and I  are 95 percent and 97.5 percent, respectively.

-------
                   Table  5-23.    PROCESS PARAMETERS FOR  MODEL  PLANTS APPLYING  HIGH  SOLIDS COATINGS
cn
i
co
Model
plant
A
A
B
B
C
C
0
0
E
E
F
F
1 bv volume
solid'.
65
70
65
70
65
70
65
70
65
70
65
70
Coating8
103 liters (10
197
183
262
243
38.2
35.4
50.8
47.1
2.2
2.0
2.9
2.7
used,
gallons)
(52)
(4fl)
(69)
(64)
(10.1)
( 9.35)
(13.4)
(12.4)
( 0.58)
( 0.53)
( 0.77)
( 0.71)
Application
exhaust flow rate
m3/sec (ft3/m1n)
35
23.5
59
47.5
12
9.5
12
9.5
5.9
4.75
5.9
4.75
(74,200)
(60,400)
(125,000)
(100,700)
(25,440)
(20,140)
(25,440)
(20,140)
(12,500)
(10,230)
(12,500)
(10,070)
Ovenb
exhaust flow rate
m3/sec (ft3/nin)
1.9
1.3
3.2
2.1
0.6
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.3
0.2
(4,020)
(2,750)
(6,780)
(4,450)
(1,270)
(850)
. (850)
(640)
(640)
(420)
(640)
(420)
Operating energy consumption0
total electric
1010 Joules (106kwh)
872
>I72
!,•' 50
1/50
10
;io
no
no
34
34
34
34
(2.42)
(2.42)
(4.03)
(4 03)
(0.31)
(0.31)
(0.31)
(0.31)
(0.09)
(0.09)
(0.09)
(0.09)
total
1010 Joules
?, 370 '
2,370
3,950
3,950
583
583
583
583
245'
245
245
245
gas.
(106 BTU/hr)
(22,500)
(22,500)
(37,400)
(37.400)
(5,530)
(5,530)
(5,530)
(5,530)
(2,320)
(2,320)
(2,320)
(2,320)
              a A coating thickness of 2.54 (10  ) cm was employed.


                Flow rates through spray booths and ovens were reduced based on percent solvent savings from the model plant parameters.

                Some regulations, however, may require ninimum flow rates  for all spray booths.



              ""Energy consumption data based upon Table  7-20.

-------
     Waterborne paint can be applied by flow coaters with an application
efficiency of 90 percent.  This yields an emission reduction of 82 percent.
Table 5-24 shows coating line changes that result in switching from organic
solvent-borne coatings to waterborne coatings.
                                   5-38

-------
                      Table 5-24.    PROCESS  PARAMETERS  FOR MODEL  PLANTS APPLYING  WATERBORNE COATINGS
tn
oo
'•lodel
plant
Spraying
A
8
C
D
E
F
Oippinq
ay require mninium flow rates for all spray booths.
               cClectrodeposition-type processes.

-------
                           REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER 5


  1.    Oge,  M.  T.  Trip Report.   Bunting  Company.   Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.
       Spn'ngborn  Laboratories,  Enfield  Connecticut.   Trip Report 86
       March 8,  1976.

  2.    Oge,  M.  T.   Trip Report.   Goodman Brothers Manufacturing Company'.
       Philadelphia,   Pennsylvania.   Springborn Laboratories, Enfield
       Connecticut.   Trip  Report 85.   March  8,  1976.

  3.    Oge,  M.  T.   Trip Report.   Steelcase Company.   Grand Rapids, Michigan.
       Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield, Connecticut.   Trip Report 72
       February 24, 1976.

  4.    Fisher,  J.  R.   Trip  Report.  Virco Manufacturing Corporation.   Gardena,
       California.  Springborn Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.  Trip
       Report 57.   February 11,  1976.

  5.    Oge,  M.  T.   Trip Report.   Herman  Miller  Incorporated.   Zeeland, Michigan.
       Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.  . Trip Report 100
       April  2,  1976.

  6.    Thompson, M. S.   Trip Report.   U.S. Furniture  Industries.   Blacksmith
       Shop  Division.   Highpoint, North  Carolina.  Springborn Laboratories,
       Enfield,  Connecticut.  Trip Report 108.  April  6,  1976.

  7.    Oge,  M. T.  Trip  Report.  Angel Steel  Company.   Plainwell,  Michigan.
       Springborn  Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.   Trip Report 103
       April  5,  1976.

 8.    Industrial  Surface Coating Questionnaire.  OMB  No.  158-S75014.   Simmons
       Company.   Atlanta, Georgia.  December  4, 1975.

 9.    Industrial  Surface Coating Questionnaire.  OMB  No.  158-S75014.   Lyon
      Metal  Products,  Inc.  Aurora, Illinois.  February  12,  1976.

 10.    Industrial  Surface Coating Questionnaire.  OMB  No.  158-S75014.   Shelby
      Williams Industrial, Inc.   Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.   February 26,
      1976.

 11.   Telecon Survey.  TRW Inc., Environmental Engineering Division.   Telecon
      survey of metal furniture coating plants regarding  annual paint consump-
      tion.   January-February 1979.

 12.   California Air Resources Board Survey  of Metal  Furniture Coatina
      Plants.  1978.

 13.   Economic Information Systems.   Listing of metal furniture coating
      establishments.
                                  5-41
\

-------
14.   Nunn, A.  B.  and D.  L.  Anderson.  Trip Report.  Steelcase, Inc.  Grand
     Rapids, Michigan.   TRW, Inc., Durham, North Carolina.  March 27-28,
     1979.

15.   Nunn, A.  B.  and D.  L.  Anderson.  Trip Report.  Delwood Furniture Co.
     Irondale, Alabama.   TRW, Inc., Durham, North Carolina.  April 18, 1979.

16.   Brewer, George E.  F.   Painting Waste Loads Associated with Metal
     Finishing.  Journal of Coatings Technology.  49 (625).  February 1977.

17.   Danielson, J. A., Editor.  Air Pollution Engineering Manual.  AP-40,
     Second Edition, Air Pollution Control District of  Los Angeles,  EPA,
     Office of Air and Water Programs.  Office  of Air Quality  Planning and
     Standards.  Research Triangle  Park, North  Carolina.  May  1973.

18.   Bernard, D. A.  Will High Solids Work?  High Solids  Coatings.   3 (4):
     12-15.  December 1978.

19.   Walberg, A. C.  Electrostatic  Painting Efficiency.   A. C. Walberg  and
     Company.  Downers Grove, Illinois.

20.  Suther, B. J., (Foster  D. Snell) and U. Potasku  (JACA Corporation).
     Controlling Pollution  from the Manufacturing and Coating  of  Metal
     Products.  Metal Coating Air Pollution Control.  Volume  1.
     EPA-625/3-77-009.  May  1977.

21.  Cole,  G. W.  (GCA Corporation), and  D. Scarborough  (Nordson  Corporation).
     Volatile  Organic Emissions and Safety Considerations for  Automotive
     Powder Finishes.   SAE.   Dearborn, Michigan.

22.  Goodell,  P. H.  Economic Justification of  Powder Coating.   The  Associa-
     tion for  Finishing Process of SME.   Dearborn, Michigan.   FC  76-459.

23.  Lunde, D.  I.  Aqueous  and High Solids  Acrylic Industrial  Coatings.
     High Solids  Coatings.   1(2):13-15.   April  1976.
                                  5-42

-------
                          6.   ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT

      This  chapter discusses  the environmental  impacts  associated with each
 control  option  developed in  Chapter 5.   The environmental  analyses  include
 impacts  from  air and water pollution,  solid waste,  and energy consumption.
 Each  is  addressed in separate  sections  of  this  chapter.
      For each specific  analysis,  both primary and secondary  impacts  are
 identified and  discussed.  Primary  impacts  are  those directly associated
 with  the application of a  control option.   Examples of primary impacts
 caused by  employing  one of the  control  options  (such as a  thermal incinera-
 tor)  are decreased air  emissions  and increased  energy  utilization.   An
 example  of a  secondary  impact  is  the carbon  dioxide generated  while  burning
 the volatile  organic  compounds  (VOC) emitted from a bake oven.
 6.1   AIR POLLUTION IMPACT
      The air  pollution  impact  is  evaluated for  coating  lines applying
 paints by  spray,  dip, and  flow  coating methods.    Emission  reduction  of VOC
 industry-wide for each  application technique were determined and are shown
 in Tables 6-1, 6-2, and 6-3.   The methodology for developing the emission
 estimates shown in the tables is presented in the following paragraphs.
     Uncontrolled emission estimates are based on paint consumption of
about 113.6 x 106 liters (30.0 x 106 gallons) in 1975.   Of this consump-
tion,  65 percent by volume is solvent.   This represents about 68 percent  of
the total solvent used in this industry during 1975.   Therefore, the total
uncontrolled emission estimate for the  metal furniture  industry is calcu-
lated  in the following manner.1'2
    Amount of solvent in paint = 113.6  x 106 (.65)  =  73.8  (106) liters
        using  a  solvent density of 0.88  kg/1  (Reference 3)

-------

               Table 6-1.   EMISSION  ESTIMATES FOR SPRAY  COATING  EMPLOYING  CONTROL OPTIONS
                                   VOC  Emissions, Metric  Tons  per Yeara
Year
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980°
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
Uncontrolled
emissions
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
96,700
100,000
104,000
108,000
112,000
116,000
120,000
SIP
regulations
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
90,900
88,300
86,100
83,800
81,600
79,300
77,000
High
solids
(65%)
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
90,100
86,800
83,700
80,600
77,600
74,500
71,400
Thermal b
incinerator
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
89,800
86,200
82,800
79,500
76,100
72,700
69, 300
High
solids
(70%)
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
89,500
85,700
82,000
78,300
74,600
70,900
67, 200
Waterborne
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
89,100
84,700
80,500
76,300
72,100
67,900
63,700
Powder
81,300
84,200
87,100
90,200
93,400
87,300
81,300
75,200
69,200
63,100
57,000
51, 000
      a
 'Columns 3 through 9 are emission estimates for the control options presented in Chapter 5.
 On curing oven only.
cEmission controls begin in 1980.

-------
Ol
 I
GO
                  Table 6-2.  EMISSION ESTIMATES FOR DIP COATING EMPLOYING CONTROL OPTIONS

                                    VOC Emissions, Metric Tons per Year3
Year
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980d
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
Uncontrolled
emissions
8,600
8,900
9,220
9,540
9,880
10,200
10,600
11,000
11,400
11,900
12,300
12,700
SIP .
regulations
8,600
8,900
9,220
9,540
9,880
9,600
9,350
9,110
8,860
8,650
8,400
8,160
Waterborne
8,600
8,900
9,220
9,540
9,880
9,400
8,920
8,450
7,980
7,530
7,060
6,590
Thermal
incinerator
8,600
8,900
9,220
9,540
9,880
9,390
8,900
8,420
7,940
7,480
7,000
6,520
El ectrodeposi ti on
8,600
8,900
9,220
9,540
9,880
9,270
8,660
8,050
7,440
6,840
6,230
5,620
Powder
8 600
8,900
9,220
9,540
9 880
9,260
8,620
7,990
7,360
6,730
6,100
5,470
       Columns 3 through 8 are emission estimates  for the control  options presented in Chapter 5.

       Must be a waterborne coating that would at  least provide a  61 percent by weight emission
       reduction.

       On curing oven only.

       Emission controls begin in 1980.

-------
                    Table 6-3.   EMISSION ESTIMATES  FOR FLOW COATING EMPLOYING CONTROL OPTIONS
                                      VOC Emissions,  Metric Tons per Year3
01
Year
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
Uncontrolled emissions
5,640
5,840
6,050
6,260
6,480
6,710
6,970
7,230
7,500
7,780
8,080
8,390
SIP regulations
5,640
5,840
6,050
6,260
6,480
6,310
6,160
6,000
5,850
5,700
5, 560
5,420
Waterborne
5,640
5,840
6,050
6,260
6,480
6,170
5,860
5,550
5,240
4,930
4,630
4,330
       ^Columns 3 and 4  are  emission estimates for the control options  presented  in  Chapter 5.
       ""Emission controls  begin  in  1980.

-------
     Amount of solvent consumed in kg = 73-8 (1Q6) (0-88)
                                              0.68
     Amount of solvent consumed in metric tons (MT) = 95,500 (for 1975)
     The uncontrolled emission estimates developed in 1975 are proportioned
 into the three different application techniques (spray, dip, and flow)
 based on survey data.   The
 projected from Equation 6-1.
based on survey data.    The uncontrolled emissions shown in the tables are
                       UE = Eig?5 (1 + G)Yr F                    (6-1)
where, UE = uncontrolled emissions, MT.
     E19?5= 95 500, MT.
        G = New coating line growth rate, per year 0.0353 (1975-1980)
            and 0.0379 (1981-1985).
        F = Fraction of industry employing a certain application
            technique.
       Yr = Years since 1975.
     The growth rate in Equation 6-1 is based on economic data presented in
Chapter 7 and is weighted based on emission estimates per Standard Industrial
Classification (SIC) code obtained from emission inventory data.
     The controlled emission estimates are based on three separate pro-
jections that considered State Implementation Plans (SIP) and New Source
Performance Standards (NSPS) based on the control options.  The first
projection, (AE)new, represents emission estimates after air pollution
controls are required on new coating lines because of SIP or NSPS regula-
tions.   The next projection, (AE)m&r, is for affected,  modified, and recon-
structed coating lines  which have been assumed to have  a 15-year life.   The
last projections,  (AE)     is for facilities remaining uncontrolled after
SIP and NSPS regulations.   These terms are combined into Equation 6-2.
                    E = (AE)    + (AE)m&r + (AE)yr               (6-2)
where, E = controlled emissions, MT.
 (AE)new = 
   E1979 = emissions for which the SIP and NSPS regulations go into effect,
           MT.
      CE = control  efficiency of selected control  techniques from Chapter 5,
           or SIP requirement.
                                  6-5

-------
 (AE)m&r = (n) MR E1979 (
       n = 1+ years after  1979.
      MR = rate per year of modified and reconstructed coating lines,  0.067
           (see Chapter 7)
  (AE)yr = UE - (AE)m&r
     For the above calculations  it was assumed that emission controls  would
take effect in 1980.
     The primary impacts of the  control  options from Chapter 5 are summarized
below.
     •    All of the control options will reduce VOC emissions below 1975
levels before the last projected year of 1986 (see Tables 6-1 to 6-3).
This assumes that NSPS regulations will  be required by 1980.
     Secondary impacts associated with each control option is discussed
below.
     •    Carbon dioxide is produced as a combustion product from coating
lines employing thermal incineration as a control technique.  Even though
carbon dioxide is not considered a pollutant, it is being studied to deter-
mine  if increased emissions of carbon dioxide from combusting fossil fuels,
forest fires, etc., could cause a "green house" effect.  Thermal incineration
is a  source of increased emissions of carbon dioxide because of the organic
solvents and fossil fuels  burned by the incinerators.  No emission estimate
is presented for carbon dioxide because chemical composition of the solvent
used  in the metal furniture industry varies from plant to plant.
      •    The utilization of waterborne coatings has been identified as a
potential source of N-nitrosamines.   N-nitrosamines are considered to be
among the most potent and versatile of all chemical carcinogenic agents.
The amines released from waterborne coatings may contribute to the formation
of N-nitrosamines in the atmosphere.  No data are available on emission
rates of these compounds,  however, based on ambient data reported in
Reference 7, the health hazard associated with the amine emissions is
minimal.  Therefore, until  other data can be obtained  it is assumed in this
report that emission of amines from waterborne coatings does  not appear to
be a  significant health hazard.
                                  6-6

-------
 6.2  WATER  POLLUTION  IMPACT
     This section  addresses water  quantities  and  qualities  impacted  by  the
 control  option  for a  coating  line.
     Processes  on  the coating  line that  use water are  listed below:
          Process                                 Coating  type
     Pretreatment                             All  coating  types
     Spray  booth                              Conventional organic
                                              solvent-borne, some
                                              high solids, some
                                              waterborne.
     Dip tank                                 Waterborne,  conventional
                                              solvent-borne.
     Electrodeposition tank                   Waterborne
     Only water pollution associated with the above processes is considered
 in this  section.
     Table  6-4 shows  "typical" waste effluents from coating lines (not
 necessarily the metal  furniture) in metal finishing facilities that  have
             o
 been studied.   It  is  assumed  for  this evaluation that the metal furniture
 facilities  using conventional  organic solvent-borne coatings fall within
 the effluent ranges shown in the table.   The  effluent concentration  and
 chemical composition  is due to process water  from the metal pretreatment
 and application areas. In this industry process water reuse seems to be the
 general rule of operation. Water usage from the pretreatment area increases
 or remains the same for all of the control options.   For high solids and
waterborne coatings, water usage associated with pretreatment may actually
 increase due to the need for more pretreatment.
     Spray booths are usually equipped with water curtains which aid in
particulate capture and removal of overspray.   The utilization of water
curtains for existing lines that are modified or reconstructed will  pro-
bably continue unless the metal parts are coated with powder.   This  is a
problem for waterborne spray coatings containing water-miscible solvents
which require removal  by ultrafiltration.  For new coating lines employing
coating formulation changes such as high solids,  waterborne or powder,
spray booths will  be designed without water curtains.   Some high solids and
waterborne spray booths are equipped with filter pads while all  powder
                                  6-7

-------
                   Table  6-4.   QUALITY OF  WATER DISCHARGE
         Subcategory 7  -  Material  Coating  (variations  among plants)
Parameter3'
PH
Turbidity (JTU)C
Temperature
Dissolved oxygen
Sulfide
Cyanide
Total solids
Total suspended solids
Settleable solids
Cadmi urn
Chromium, total
Chromium, hexavalent
Copper
Fluoride
Iron, total
Iron, dissolved
Lead
Oil, grease
COD
Total phosphates
Zinc
Boron
Mercury
Nickel
Silver
Flow (for a production
Minimum
1.5
0.300
282K
1.0
0.010
0.010
35
0.200
0.200
0.002
0.005
0.005
0.011
0.130
0.130
0.003
0.006
0.500
3.7
0.200
0.020
0.050
0.002
0.007
0.002
floor area
Maximum
11.3
3800
336K
12.0
24
1.6
63,090
28,390
40
60.9.
400
36.4
1060
110
422.2
367.7
102.8
13,510
40,000
62.4
86.5
21.3
0.055
0.950
0.100
of 107,000 ft2) - 108,000
Mean
	
395.6
296. 3K
7.0
1.3
1.03
2917.9
917.8
10.5
2.1
20.1
1.5
21.1
6.8
21.6
17.9
1.7
545.2
1837
9.5
4.6
2.5
0.012
0.207
0.007
GPD
aAll  parameters measured in mg/liter except pH, turbidity,  and temperature.
bMany of these pollutants are under consideration.
cJackson Turbidity Units.

                                     6-8

-------
spray booths utilize an exhaust gas filtration system.  This reduction in
water usage should benefit facilities having to comply with water pollution
control regulations.
     Coating lines employing dip or electrodeposition tanks have a water
pollution problem because of dragout.  Dragout is defined as the volume of
solution carried over the edge of a process tank by an emerging piece of
work.  The solution usually ends up in water used to clean the application
area, or in process drains.  Switching to a control option such as powder
(fluidized-bed) will reduce or eliminate this problem.
     The use of electrodeposition, however, presents a somewhat different
problem due to the difference in paint formulation.  Because of this,
ultrafiltration is usually an integral part of an electrodeposition process.
This is quite effective in removing paint solids from the waste streams.
     Table 6-5 qualitatively summarizes water usage for Model Plant A
concerning each control option.   Projections are not presented for water
usage for this industry because it is difficult to differentiate water flow
data into recycled or fresh water.   Also, Table 6-6 provides a qualitative
evaluation of some of the pollutant flows from Table 6-4 versus control
options.
     Water pollution regulations for this and other industries are governed
by the Federal  Water Pollution Control Act.   This Act specifies several
levels of control  that are applicable to industries including the metal
furniture coating industry.   These levels of control are:
     1.    For existing plants,  best practicable control  technology currently
available (BPCTCA/BPT) by 1977.
     2.    For existing plants,  best available technology economically
achievable (BATEA/BAT) by 1983.
     3.    For new sources, New Source Performance Standards considering
costs and any non-water quality  environmental  impact and energy requirements.
     4.    The Act allows States  to establish more stringent than Federal
standards if desired.
     Methods that facilities  can employ  to reduce or eliminate  water pollution
include  in-plant controls and wastewater treatment.   In-plant controls
reduce water pollution treatment costs by minimizing pollutants to be
                                  6-9

-------
    Table 6-5.   QUALITATIVE  ANALYSIS  FOR  WATER  USAGE  AT  MODEL  PLANT  A

Control
option
Powder
Waterborne
High solids
Thermal incinerator
Pretreatment
area
Unchanged
Increased or
unchanged
Increased or
unchanged
Increased or
Application
area
Reduced or
eliminated
Unchanged
or reduced
Unchanged
or reduced
Unchanged or
Overall
water usage
Reduced
Unknown
Unknown
Unknown
plus high solids     unchanged
reduced
                                  6-10

-------
                 Table 6-6.  QUALITATIVE ANALYSIS FOR POLLUTANT DISCHARGE RATES IN WATER
                             EFFLUENTS VERSUS COATING FORMULATION CHANGES
Pollutant
Sulfide
Cyanide
Total solids
Total suspended
solids
Cadmi urn
Chromium,
total
Iron, total
Lead
COD
Powder3
spray
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Unchanged
Reduced
Reduced
Powder3
fluidized bed
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Reduced
Unchanged
Reduced
Reduced
Waterborne3 to
spray
Unknown
Unknown
b
b
Unknown
Increased
or unchanged
Increased
or unchanged
Unknown
Increased
/aterborne h
dip
Unknown
Unknown
b
b
Unknown
Increased
or unchanged
Increased
or unchanged
Unknown
Increased
ligh solids3
spray
Unknown
Unknown
b
b
Unknown
Increased
or unchanged
Increased
or unchanged
Unknown
Increased
3Control options presented in Chapter 5.
 May depend on whether the coating line is new or existing.

-------
 treated.   In-plant controls  include  reducing process  flow,  improving  house-
 keeping,  separating nonprocess  and process  water,  employing counter current
 concept,  equalizing water  flow,  and  reusing and  recycling water.   After
 in-plant  controls  have  been  applied  to  the  practical  limit,  wastewater
 treatment may  be necessary to satisfy permits  or municipal  requirements.
 These  treatment technologies have been  divided into categories  of  primary
 treatment,  physical/chemical treatment,  biological treatment, membrane
 technologies,  and  sludge treatment.   Primary treatment  is the method  chosen
 by  those  plants that merely  separate solids from wastewater without chemical
 conditioning,  and  it is often a  first treatment  step  for those  that treat
 the wastes  further.  Physical/chemical  treatment involving  chemical addition
 to  enhance  precipitation,  separation, etc.,  is the most widely  practiced of
 the treatment  options.  Biological treatment in  aerated lagoons  is applicable
 to  waterborne  wastes and has been practiced.   It is particular  relevance
 for direct  dischargers when  BOD  and  COD  would  not otherwise  be  sufficiently
 reduced.  Membrane  treatment technologies of ultrafiltration and reverse
 osmosis are described as potentially effective methods for  the  treatment of
 painting  wastewater.  Sludge treatment  describes the methods used to  thicken,
 dewater,  and chemically treat the sludge solids  generated by the solids
 separation  treatment technology  used.10
 6.3  SOLID WASTE IMPACT
     Table  6-7 shows quantities  of soViu «aste that are produced from the
 model plants for each control option.  These data are based on a material
 balance performed on each model   plant.  The  following assumptions were
 employed  during development of the solid waste estimates.
     1.   Transfer efficiencies and paint consumption data reported in
 Chapter 5 were utilized in the calculations.
     2.   Solid waste estimates are limited to  those for the application
 area of the coating  line.
     3.   Solid waste generated from pretreatment areas on a coating line is
 considered to be negligible.
     Other solid waste produced  in the application area but not estimated
 include filter pads and dry filter media.  Filter pads are used instead of
water curtains on spray booths for coating formulations such as high solids
                                  6-12

-------
I
CO
                                 Table 6-7.   SOLIDS WASTE ESTIMATES FOR MODEL PLANTS
                                                      Kg per Year

Model
Plant





p
r

T
1
i
J

Solvent-3 High solids
borne 60% 65% 70%

ninn QQ onn oocnn oocnn
, 1UU oo , oUU oo , bill) oo , bUU

10 , yuu i/ , ^uu i/ , ^uu -L' j j-UU
O£O 0~M O"7O O~M

-------
and waterborne.   Dry filter media are installed on spray booths and fluidized
beds applying powder coatings to metal  parts.   This waste is removed to a
landfill.   The amount of waste from these sources cannot be quantified since
these data have not been reported in the literature.
     The chemical composition of the solid waste presented in Table 6-7
depends upon tne type of film formers,  pigments, and additives contained in
the applied paint.   The film formers contain the synthetic organic resins
(e.g., alkyd, vinyl, acrylic, etc.) that produce the protective covering of
the metal  part.   The pigments are inorganic or organic compounds which give
the formed film color.   Inorganic pigments are sources of elements such as
zinc, lead, arsenic, bismuth, tin, and cadmium.   Additives contain organic
and inorganic compounds which provide surface agents, driers, thickeners,
flame retardants, etc., and are very important for coatings such as water-
borne and high solids.   Solid wastes produced from coating lines are dis-
posed of in three ways:  (1) incineration, (2) landfill, and (3) stockpiling.
While combustible waste recovered from a coating line can be incinerated,
trace elements may be emitted as air pollutants. Also, incineration of some
                                   q
powder coatings may be impractical.   Most industries use the second method
of disposal, landfill.   However, many landfill operators are beginning to
reject solid waste from industry because of some of the elements present in
the waste.  The last method of solid waste disposal is stockpiling or
dumping of material on property owned by the facility which produced the
solid wastes.  Solid waste stored in this manner could be concentrated in
rain water runoff,  however, and therefore presents an adverse impact.
     Projections of solid waste over a five year period were not done since
the estimates would show the same impacts as displayed in Table 6-7.  Those
primary impacts are summarized as:
     1.  Sprayed high solids and waterborne coatings produce more solid
waste because of lower transfer efficiencies.
     2.  Solid waste generated from powder coatings sprayed on parts is a
function of the number of color changes and total amount of powder utilized.
     3.  For dip coating operations powder applied by the fluidized bed
technique is the biggest producer of solid waste.  The lowest amount of
solid waste produced for this coating technique is from electrodeposition
applying waterborne paints.
                                  6-14

-------
     4.   Solid wastes generated from 60, 65, and 70 percent-by-volume high
solids coatings are comparable.
6.4  ENERGY IMPACT
     Table 6-8 shows energy consumption estimates for the model plants by
control  options.   These data are based on References 1-15 of Chapter 5.
For each control  option total energy consumption is less than for the
uncontrolled case (solvent-borne).   The only exception consists of water-
borne coatings applied by the electrodeposition process.  Though it might
not be expected that thermal incineration would consume less energy than
the uncontrolled case, it does because the incinerator is utilized on a
coating line applying high solids (60 percent by volume) rather than a
conventional solvent-borne coating.
     Explanations for the lower energy consumption for powder, high solids,
and waterborne coatings when compared with organic solvent-borne coatings
are shown quantitatively in Table 6-9.
     Energy consumption projections for 1979 and 1983 are shown in Table 6-10.
The projections are for a five year period covering SIP and NSPS regulations.
Equation 6-3 is employed for projecting energy consumption for spray coating
lines.
             (EE)RA              (EE)SIPs
(Energy)yr = — ff- (energy)RA + — -f— (energy)sips
             UE R(energy),,r                                      (6-3)
            (UE)B
  Where, (Energy)   = energy consumed in any one year (1979-1983), joules.
(EE)RA and (EE)5jps = emission estimates from equation 6-1 for each control
                      option and SIP regulation, respectively.
    B          B
(EE)RA and (EE)Sjps = emission estimates from Table 5-2 (Model  Plant B) for
                      each control  option and SIP regulation, respectively.
(energy)RA, (energy)sips and (energy)^ = energy consumption estimates from
                      Table 6-8 for each control option, SIP regulation,
                      and solvent-borne, respectively.
                  P
       UE and (LIE)  = uncontrolled emission estimates from Table 6-1 and
                      Table 5-2, respectively.
                                  6-15

-------
en
 i
                             Table 6-8.   ENERGY CONSUMPTION ESTIMATES FOR MODEL PLANTS


                                                1010 Joules per year3
Model
plants
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
Solvent-
borne
918
1,530
116
116
47
47
100
17
4
5
(3,540)
(5,896)
( 870)
( 870)
( 366)
( 366)
(5,900)
( 870)
( 366)
( 366)
High sol
(60, 65,
872 (2
1,450 (3
110 (
110 (
34 (
34 (




ids0
70%)
,370)
,950)
583)
583)
245)
245)

	 c
O

Water-0
borne
1,060
1,760
133
54
54
54
& 500
& 85
& 20
6
(2,
(3,
(
(
(
(
(3,
(
370)
950)
583)
245)
245)
254)
950)e
583 )e
245 )e
245)
Powder0 Thermal0'01
incinerator
872
1,450
110
34
34
34
130
22
5

(1,770) 872
(2,950) 1,450
( 435) 110
( 1 QO"\ 	
V. looj 	
/ IQ-^ 	
V J.OO )
( TQ^\ 	
^ J.OJJ —--
(2,950) 100
( 435) 17
183) 	

(2,590)
(4,130)
( 635)


(4,020)
( 688)


    a
     First set of numbers are  for total electric usage and numbers inside parentheses  are  total additional

     natural  gas usage.


     Estimates for uncontrolled plant.


     Estimates for control options presented in Chapter 5.


     For thermal incinerators  utilizing 50 percent energy recovery.
    p

     The range of electric usage rates for dip and electrodeposition, respectively.

-------
                       Table 6-9.   QUALITATIVE  ANALYSIS OF  ENERGY CONSUMPTION ON A COATING LINE
      Coating type3   Pretreatment area    Dry-off oven     Application area    Flash-off area     Bake oven
        Powder
Same as organic
solvent-borne.
Same as organic  Energy reduction
solvent-borne.    because of less
                 make-up air.
                    Energy reduction
                    because there is
                    no flash-off area.
                   Energy reduc-
                   tion because
                   of elimination
                   of heat-up
                   zone.
        High solids
en
A possible
increase in
energy con-
sumption, or
remain the
same.
Same as
organic
solvent-borne.
Energy reduction
because of less
make-up air.
Energy reduction
because of less
solvent applied.
Energy reduc-
tion because
of possible
lower curing
temperature.
Waterborne





A possible
increase in
energy con-
sumption, or
remain the
same.
Energy reduc-
tion because
this step is
not always
necessary.

Energy reduction
because of less
make-up air.



Same as organic Increase of
solvent-borne. energy con-
sumption
because of
water.

      Boating formulation changes that are some of the control options presented in Chapter 5.

-------
                  Table 6-10.   PROJECTIONS OF ENERGY CONSUMPTION FOR EACH CONTROL OPTION
                                          Joules (1014) per Year

Year
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
Conventional
solvent-borne
272
281
291
302
314
High solids
(60, 65, and 70%)
251
240
229
219
225
Waterborne
251
241
232
223
227
Powder
251
232
212
193
171
Thermal ,
incinerator '
251
241
232
223
229
Estimates industrywide for uncontrolled plants.
Estimates obtained after each control option  (see Chapter 5) has been applied industrywide.
cThis control  option should vary more  than any control option when considering energy
 consumption.

-------
     The primary impact of the control options according to Equation 6-3
seems to occur after year 1982.  For all regulatory alternatives except
powder, energy consumption will begin to increase during 1983.  However,
the amount of energy consumed is still less in each case than for conven-
tional solvent-borne coatings.
     Although discussion in this section has been limited to energy consump-
tion associated with the coating line, energy consumption related to producing
and shipping each control option must also be addressed. Energy consumption
associated with producing different coating formulations has not been
compiled.   However, it is known that powder and high solids coatings require
less energy to ship than any other alternative since fewer drums have to be
shipped to perform a coating job.   In addition, waterborne coatings require
less shipment energy due to the reduced need for additional solvent.
6.5  OTHER ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS
     Some electrodeposition coatings that contain amines may cause visible
emissions from a bake oven.   Some automobile coating plants have, as a
result, utilized incinerators on bake exhaust streams to eliminate visible
emissions and odors associated with these amines.    Such a problem has not
been witnessed at a metal furniture coating facility.
     The only other possible environmental impact is associated with visible
emissions resulting from powder coatings.   During one plant trip, visible
emissions were observed from a fluidized bed process in which metal parts
were coated with powder.   This particular case occurred because the baghouse
                                                Q
attached to the fluidized bed was not operating.
6.6  OTHER ENVIRONMENTAL CONCERNS
6.6.1  Irreversible and Irretrievable Commitment of Resources
     Regardless of which alternative emission control system is selected,
additional equipment will be required.  Thus, additional steel and other
raw materials will be consumed.  This commitment of resources is small
compared to the national  usage of each resource.   However, a good quantity
of these resources will ultimately be salvaged and recycled.  Also, the
commitment of land on which to locate additional  control devices or applica-
tion equipment or both is expected to be minor.
                                  6-19

-------
     Without heat recovery, significant energy would be lost.   Thus,  the
use of primary and secondary heat recovery would enhance the value of
incineration.
6.6.2  Environmental Impact of Delayed Standards
     Increased emissions of VOC based on growth projections for the metal
furniture industry are discussed in Section 6.1 of this chapter.   If a new
source performance standard is delayed, VOC emissions would continue to
increase even though SIP regulations now exist.  Also, the amount of energy
consumed on a coating line will continue to increase after 1982.
     The only possible negative environmental impacts associated with the
control options are for water and solid waste.  The use of some waterborne
coatings may require ultrafiltration to remove dissolved solids.   All of
the coating formulation changes, except powder, could cause an increase  in
the amount of solid waste generated by the industry. However, both impacts
are considered to be minor compared to the environmental gains achievable
by reduction of VOC emissions into the air.
                                   6-20

-------
                          REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER 6
1.   Sources and Consumption of Chemical Raw Materials  in  Paints  and
     Coatings - Type and End-Use.  Stanford Research  Institute.
     November 1974.

2.   Ocko, B.  Modern Paint and Coating Magazine.  March 1977.  p. 61.

3.   Gallagher, V.  N. and J. Pratapas.  Control of Volatile Organic Emissions
     from Existing Stationary Sources.  Volume III:   Surface Coating of
     Metal Furniture.  EPA-450/2-77-032.  U. S. Environmental Protection
     Agency, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina.  December  1977.

4.   California Air Resources Board Survey of Metal Furniture Coating
     Plants.  1978.

5.   NEDS Emission Inventory Data.  NADB, Research Triangle Park, North
     Carolina.

6.   Fugita, E.  M.  and L. G. Shepard.  Consideration  of Model Rule for the
     Control of Volatile Organic Compound Emissions from Metal  Furniture
     and Fixture Coating Operations.   State of California Air Resources
     Board.   June 29, 1978.

7.   Bachmann,  J.  D.  and J.  B.  Cohen.  In situ Investigation of Atmospheric
     Nitrosamine Formation.   American Chemical Society Meeting, Division of
     Environmental  Chemistry.   Anaheim, California.   March 1978.

8.   Suther, B.  J.  (Foster D.  Snell) and Uday Potasku (JACA Corp.) Controlling
     Pollution from the Manufacturing and Coating of  Metal Products—Metal
     Coating Air Pollution Control, Volume 1.  EPA-624/3-77-009.  May 1977.

9.   Nunn, A. B.  and D.  L.  Anderson.   Trip Report - Steelcase,  Inc., Grand
     Rapids, Michigan.   TRW, Inc., Durham,  North Carolina.   March 27-28, 1979.

10.   Contractor Report for Development of Effluent Limitations Guidelines
     for Paint Application Processes Used in the Mechanical and Electrical
     Products Industries.   U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,
     Washington,  D.C.,  July 1979.

11.   Gabris, T.   Trip Report -  Ford Motor Co., Milpitas, California.  Spring-
     born Laboratories,  Inc.,  Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report No  112
     April 7, 1976.
                                  6-21

-------
                           7.   ECONOMIC IMPACT
7.1  INDUSTRY PROFILE
     This section profiles the metal furniture manufacturing industry.  The
information contained herein is intended as an input to the analysis of
economic impact that results from the control of volatile organic compound
(VOC) emissions from metal furniture coating operations.  The manufacturing
industry is of concern because the amount of metal furniture coating and
painting performed is highly correlated with industry output.  Because
manufacturers perform most of the coating themselves, the main burden of
control costs falls on them.   A small percentage of furniture is sent to
independent jobbers who coat items that they do not manufacture.  This type
of operation is largely undocumented; for instance, although jobbers are
covered by Standard Industrial Classification (SIC) 3479 (metal coating,
engraving,  and allied services), published data do not separate them speci-
fically from sandblasters, galvanizers, and other operations.  It is
believed that the volume of metal  furniture painted by jobbers is small and
that these  operations are relatively few in number.
     The metal  furniture industry is covered by four SIC codes:
     1.    Metal  household furniture (SIC 2514);
     2.    Metal  office furniture (SIC 2522);
     3.    Public building and related furniture (SIC 2531);
     4.    Metal  partitions and fixtures (SIC 2542).
     A finer breakdown of the four categories can be found in section 2.1.
7.1.1  Industry Structure
     In 1976,  the metal  furniture industry included approximately 1400
establishments,  employed about 100,000 people and made shipments valued at
$3,657 million  (see Table 7-1).   Figures on the four segments of the industry
show that three  of them have  a similar small business orientation.

-------
ro
                            Table 7-1.  METAt FURNITURE WKJFACTURIN6  INDUSTRY, 1976-1977
                           Number of
                         establishments
                       1976*
1977
       Value  of
  frodti&tpy  stotpmerts
 (nrmtorre  of doTTars)1

T976C    %
                                      T§76
 Number of        Average shipments
 employees        per establishment
(thousands)      (millions of dollars)

 d   %   1977b
                                                      1976
                                                                                                     1977
        Metal household
        furniture
        (SIC 2514)       391
        Metal office
        furniture
        (SIC 2522)       177
        Public  building
        and related
28    441      991.6   27   1256.7



13    185     1073.1   29   1375.5
                         30.5   31   32.2
                          25.7   36   28.4
rurniture
(SIC 2531) 377
Metal partitions
and fixtures
(SIC 2542) 449
Total 1394
27

32

415

NA

716.2

875.8
3656.7
20

24

764.8

NA

20.6

21.9
98.7
21

22

19. .6

NA

                                                        2.5
                                                        6.1
                                                                                            1.9
                                                                                            2.0
                              2.8
                              7.4
                                                          1.8
                                                          NA
        Bounty Business  Patterns, 1976.  U.S.  Sumnttry  Statistics, Department of Commerce.   Washington,  D.  C.
        bMptal Household  Furniture    T977 QHTSUS of Manufactures  Preliminary Report.  Department of Commerce.

         ™f^W^U52tt S3TS* ,T
         1977 Census of Manufactures Preliminary Report,  Department of Commerce, Washington, D.C. May 19/y.   P.  t.
        cAnnual Survey of Manufactures. General Statistics for Industry Groups awd Industries.  Department of
         Commerce. Washington,  D. C. December 1977.
        dAnnual Survey of Manufactures.  TS76 Value of  Product Shipments.   Department of Commerce, Washington,  D.C.
         December 1977.
        NOTE:  Because 1976 figures for establishments  and shipments  are  from separate sources, they may not be
               entirely compatible.

-------
The fourth segment - the metal office furniture category - is smaller in
terms of number of establishments but operates on a somewhat larger
scale than do the other segments.
     In 1976, for instance, metal household furniture, public building
and related furniture, and metal partitions each had around 400 establish-
ments and between $700 million and one billion dollars in shipments.
Metal office furniture had only 177 establishments and over one billion
dollars in shipments, putting its average shipments per establishment at
over six million dollars, versus approximately two million dollars for
the other sectors (Table 7-1).  Preliminary figures for 1977 show this
trend continuing.
     Historical data confirm the disparity between metal office furni-
ture and the other three sectors.  In terms of concentration, the
industry's shipments are dispersed among a number of companies, with
less than 20 percent of shipments made by the top four firms in 1972
(see Table 7-2) except in the case of metal office furniture.  Here,
concentration is much greater, with 37 percent of shipments made by four
firms and 88 percent made by the 50 largest companies.
     Metal office furniture is much more heavily weighted towards multi-
unit companies than are the other three segments (Table 7-3).  Metal
office furniture has only 17 percent of its shipments made by single-
unit firms versus 40 percent for the other three segments.
     Similarly, metal office furniture has fewer firms with a low number
of employees.   As shown in Table 7-4, the other segments have over 50
percent of their establishments falling into the category of less than
20 employees, while office furniture has only 39.1 percent of its
establishments in that category.
     Even though office furniture companies tend to operate on a larger
scale,  private ownership is prevalent in this sector, as it is in the
remaining three.    In terms of legal organization, approximately 80
percent or more of the firms in all  sectors were incorporated in 1972
(see Table 7-5).
     7.1.1.1   Geographic Distribution of Industry.   Metal  furniture
manufacturing establishments are spread throughout the United States,
                                  7-3

-------
     Table 7-2.  CONCENTRATION RATIOS IN METAL FURNITURE MANUFACTURING

Percent of value of shipments
accounted for by:

Metal household furniture
(SIC 2514)
1972
1967
1963
1958
Metal office furniture
(SIC 2522)
1972
1967
1963
1958
Public building and
related furniture
(SIC 2531)
1972
1967
1963
19B8
Metal partitions and
fixtures
(SIC 2542)
1972
1967
1963
1958
4 largest
companies


14
12
12
12


37
32
39
33



18
18
21
24



13
19
19
(NA)
8 largest
companies


23
21
18
19


49
45
45
49



26
30
32
34



22
27
26
(NA)
20 largest
companies


41
35
31
33


70
69
69
73



40
46
45
47



39
43
31
(NA)
50 largest
companies


65
56
53
52


88
88
88
89
-


59
64
62
65



59
64
61
(NA)
Source:  U. S. Department of Commerce.  Census of Manufactures.  1972.
NA - Not available.
                                     7-4

-------
     Table 7-3.  PERCENT OF VALUE OF INDUSTRY SHIPMENT IN METAL FURNITURE
       MANUFACTURING MADE BY MULTI-UNIT AND SINGLE-UNIT COMPANIES, 1972
                                   Multi-unit          Single-unit
                                   companies           companies
                                   (percent)           (percent)

Metal household furniture
(SIC 2514)                             62                  38

Metal office furniture
(SIC 2522)                             83                  17

Public building and
related furniture
(SIC 2531)                             56                  43

Metal partitions and
fixtures
(SIC 2542)                             58                  42


Source:  U.S.  Department of Commerce.   Census of Manufactures.   1972.
                                    7-5

-------
CTl
                        Table 7-4.  DISTRIBUTION OF ESTABLISHMENTS IN THE METAL FURNITURE
                                       MANUFACTURING INDUSTRY BY FIRM SIZE, 1972

Firm size,
number of
employees per
establishment
1 to 19
20 to 49
50 to 99
100 to 249
250 to 499
500 to 999
1000 to 2499
2500 or more
Metal household
furniture
(SIC 2514)

50.7
18.0
10.3
13.1
6.2
1.3
0.4
—
Metal office
furniture
(SIC 2522)

39.1
14.1
15.6
18.2
6.3
4.2
2.1
0.5
Public building and
furniture
(SIC 2531

53.8
20.9
11.4
10.2
2.8
0.7
0.2

Metal partitions and
fixtures
(SIC 2542)

52.3
22.5
12.0
8.9
2.4
1.4
—
	 . 	 — — — 	
         Source:   U.  S.  Department  of  Commerce.  Census of Manufactures.   1972.

-------
           Table 7-5.  LEGAL FORM OF ORGANIZATION FOR METAL FURNITURE MANUFACTURERS, 1972
Metal household
furniture


Corporate
Noncorporate total
Individual
Partnership
Other and unknown
Number of
estabs.
401
66
29
13
24

%
86
14
6
3
5
Metal
furni
Number
estabs
167
26
18
3
5
office
ture
of
%
87
13
9
2
2
Public
related
Number
estabs.
331
91
52
15
24
building and
furniture
of
%
78
22
12
4
6
Metal partitions
fixtures
Number of
estabs.
425
82
46
14
22
and

%
84
16
9
3
4
1972 Census of Manufactures.   Department of Commerce.   Washington,  D.C.   January 1975.
p. SR3-33 to SR3-34.

-------
although there is light representation in Pacific Division states other
than California (see Table 7-6).   About 70 percent of establishments in
1976 were located in nine states:
     New York        16 percent         New Jersey          5 percent
     California      16 percent         Texas               4 percent
     Illinois         8 percent         Michigan            4 percent
     Pennsylvania     7 percent         Florida             4 percent
     Ohio             6 percent
     7.1.1.2  Product Mix.  Table 7-7 shows the product mix for all
sectors from 1963 through 1976.  This mix has remained quite stable over
time.  Tables 7-8, 7-9, and 7-10 give a more detailed product breakdown
for each sector in 1977 except metal partitions.  The tables help to
identify the various surface types that are coated by the industry.
     7.1.1.3  Capacity Utilization Rate.  Table 7-11 summarizes the
capacity utilization situation in the metal furniture industry as of the
fourth quarters of 1976 and 1977.  This table shows the practical rate
of utilization, which is the highest possible percentage utilization,
given cost and other constraints.  The preferred rate, shown as a
percent of the practical rate, is a point between the actual and
practical rates which could be defined as optimal.
     Because of the standard error of the 1977 practical rate estimates,
it is difficult to cite a trend with much confidence.  The numbers do
indicate that the actual rate  of utilization in 1977 is likely to be
less than 70 percent for each  sector.  (This is based on the assumption
that the actual rate is lower  than the preferred rate, which can be
expressed in terms of total available capacity by multiplying the
preferred rate in the table by the practical rate).
7.1.2  Trends in the Industry
     7.1.2.1  Establishments and Employees.  Changes in the number of
establishments and employees are depicted  in Figure 7-1 through 7-4,
plotted  from numbers in Table  7-12.  These graphs show a downward  trend
in the number of establishments between  1972 and 1976.  Preliminary  1977
figures  for the household, office, and public building sectors show  an
upturn in number of establishments.  Although the curves for each  sector
                                   7-8

-------
Table 7-6.  GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION OF METAL
      FURNITURE ESTABLISHMENTS, 1976





Region and State
New England
Maine
Massachusetts
Connecticut
New Hampshire
Rhode Island
Middle Atlantic
New York
New Jersey
Pennsylvania
East North Central
Ohio
Indiana
Illinois
Michigan
Wisconsin
West North Central
Minnesota
Iowa
Missouri
Kansas
Nebraska
South Atlantic
Maryland
Delaware
Virginia
North Carolina
South Carolina
Georgia
Florida
West Virginia
East South Central
Kentucky
Tennessee
Alabama
Mississippi



Metal
household
furniture
(SIC 2514)

	
13
5
1
—

66
14
24

12
4
31
8
6

3
—
6
—
—

6
—
8
13
3
5
30
—

5
9
9
4



Metal
office
furniture
(SIC 2522)

—
4
—
0
—

27
9
17

9
6
11
8
4

3
1
6
3
—

—
1
3
5
—
7
3
—

2
3
4
—
(continued)
7-9
Public
building
and related
furniture
(SIC 2531 )a

1
8
4
1
—

20
7
24

27
11
23
17
17

6
8
—
4
—

—
—
7
16
2
—
12
—

5
18
6
3



Metal
partitions
and fixtures
(SIC 2543)

—
9
—
0
4

93
29
26

32
7
41
23
6

9
1
11
5.
2

—
—
—
4
4
7
8
3

3
6
6
3






Total

1
34
9
2
4

206
59
91

80
28
105
56
33

21
10
23
12
2

6
1
19
38
9
19
53
3

15
36
25
10



-------
                            Table 7-6.   Concluded



Region and State
West South Central
Arkansas
Texas
Oklahoma
Mountain Division
Utah
Colorado
Pacific Division
Oregon
Washington
California
United States Total

Metal
household
furniture
(SIC 2514)

2
16
4

_ __
—

—
69
391

Metal
office
furniture
(SIC 2522)

0
6
—

—
—

—
30
188
Public
building
and related
furniture
(SIC 2531 )a

19
22
—

2
3

5
50
377

Metal
partitions
and fixtures
(SIC 2543)

3
15
2

—
3

3
67
449



Total

24
c r\
59


2


8
7
216
1394
Source:  U.  S.  Department of Commerce.   County  Business  Patterns  (by State).



Includes wood, metal, and plastic furniture.
                                     7-10

-------
            Table 7-7.  METAL FURNITURE PRODUCT MIX, 1963-1976
                (as a percent of total industry shipments)


Metal household
furniture
(SIC 2514)
Dining, breakfast
Kitchen
Porch, lawn, outdoor
Other
N.s.k.
Metal office
furniture
(SIC 2522)
Office seating
Desks
Cabinets, cases
Other
N.s.k.
Public building
related furniture
(SIC 2531)
School furniture
Non-school furniture
Other
Metal partitions
and fixtures
(SIC 2542)
Partitions
Shelving and lockers
Storage racks
Fixtures
Other
1976a


27.1
7.4
2.0
7.3
9.7
0.6


29.3
7.3
4.6
10.6
6.0
0.8


19.6
6.6
12.5
0.3


24.0
2.0
8.2
5.2
6.8
1.6
1975a


28.1
9.2
1.7
6.8
10.5
—


27.8
7.0
4.5
10.9
5.4
—


19.5
7.2
11.8
0.5


24.7
3.4
8.0
4.7
6.6
1.9
1974a


28.1
8.9
1.7
6.8
10.7
—


29.5
7.7
5.5
11.2
5.1
—


17.4
6.7
10.1
0.6


25-.0
3.1
7.8
5.5
6.6
2.1
1973a


29.9
8.5
2.7
6.1
12.5
—


28.9
7.5
5.5
11.4
4.5
—


17.3
6.3
9.7
1.3


24.0
2.5
8.2
3.4
8.3
1.5
1972b


30.1
8.6
2.5
6.2
12.8
—


27.4
6.8
5.4
10.5
4.8
—


17.4
6.4
9.8
1.2


25.0
2.8
8.3
3.3
7.6
3.0
1967b


28.3
7.9
2.7
5.3
12.4
—


28.2
6.4
7.3
9.6
4.9
—


18.8
7.6
10.1
1.0


24.7
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
1963b


22.9
9.4
4.2
6.8
13.5
—


23.9
4.9
5.9
9.6
3.6
—


17.6
7.9
9.0
0.7


24.6
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
N.s.k.  = Not specified by kind.
    NA = Not available.
a
 Annual survey of Manufactures.   1976 Value of Product Shipments.   Department
 of Commerce, Washington, D.C.  December 1977.
 Census of Manufactures.   1972 and 1967 (separate volumes).  Department of
 Commerce.  Washington, D.  C.
                                   7-11

-------
Table 7-8.   1977 PRODUCT BREAKDOWN FOR METAL HOUSEHOLD FURNITURE (SIC 2514)


                                                 Shipments         Percent
                                            (millions of dollars)  (of total)

Total	H47.7             100.0

Metal household dining, dinette, and
breakfast furniture 	    309.1              26.9
   Tubular metal, including chairs whether
   padded or plain:
   • Sets (tables and chairs)	    236.1              20.6
   0 Tables (not sold with a set)	 .     16.9               1.5
   § Chairs (not sold with a set)	     13.4               1.2
   Other metal dining, dinette, and
   breakfast furniture	     35.7               3.1
   Metal household dining, dinette, and
   breakfast furniture, n.s.k	      7.0               0.6

Metal kitchen furniture .  .  .'	     73.3               6.4
   Kitchen furniture,  excluding breakfast
   furniture reported  as "dining, dinette,
   and  breakfast furniture":
   0 Cabinets  such as  base,  top,  and  base
   -   wall, utility, etc	    49.5               4.3
   0 Stools,  padded and plain	    17.2               1.5
   0 Tables,  including hostess  carts	      5.5               0.5
   Metal  kitchen furniture,  n.s.k	      1.1               0.1

 Metal porch,  lawn, outdoor,  and casual
 furniture 	    262.9              22.9
   Tubular  aluminum:
   0 Chairs,  rockers,  benches,  chaise lounges,
      and settes	    122.5              10.7
    0 Other tubular aluminum porch,  lawn,  and
      outdoor furniture, including gliders,
      swings,  and hammocks	     20.0               1-7
    Cast and wrought iron:
    0 Chairs,  rockers,  benches,  chaise lounges,
      and settes	     44.3               3.9
    0 Other cast and wrought iron porch, lawn,
      and outdoor furniture, including
      gliders, swings,  and hammocks	     12.6               1.1
    Other metal porch,  lawn, outdoor, and
    casual furniture,  including picnic
    tables	     37.4               3.3
    Metal porch, lawn, outdoor, and casual
    furniture, n.s.k	     26.1               2.3

                          "        (continued)      ~        ~~~
                                     7-12

-------
                           Table 7-8.  Concluded
                                               Shipments          Percent)
                                          (millions of dollars)   (of total)
Other metal household furniture 	   391.2                34.1
   Folding cots, reliable cots, army cots,
   and other metal beds	    10.5                 0.9
   Metal bed frames (complete metal bed frames
   sold separately, with or without a
   headboard	    57.0                 5.0
   Upholstered metal household furniture. .  .    12.4                 1.1
   Card tables and chairs	    (a)
   Medicine cabinets, including "wall type"
   and "insert type"	    60.2                 5.2
   Metal radio, phonograph, TV, and hi-fi
   cabinets	     5.0                 0.4
   Infants' high chairs	    12.1                 1.1
   Infants' car seats	    13.6                 1.2
   Other infants' and children's metal
   furniture, including chairs, tables,
   playpens, play yards, and portable
   cribs	    46.2                 4.0
   Metal folding tray tables	    (a)
   Other metal household furniture	   110.1                 9.6
   Other metal household furniture, n.s.k.  .    22.5                 2.0
Metal household furniture, n.s.k., typically
for companies with 5 employees or more. ...    81.4                 7.1
Metal household furniture, n.s.k., typically
for companies with less than 5 employees. .  .    29.8                 2.6

(a) Withheld to avoid disclosing operations of individual companies.
n.s.k. = Not specified by kind.

Metal Household Furniture.  1977 Census of Manufactures.  Preliminary
Report.   U. S. Department of Commerce, Washington, D.C.  April 1976.
p. 3.
                                  7-13

-------
 Table 7-9.   1977 PRODUCT BREAKDOWN FOR METAL OFFICE FURNITURE  (SIC 2522)


                                                Shipments           Percent
                                           (millions of dollars)   (of total)

Total	    1334.6             100.0

Metal office seating, including upholsteres:
   As reported in census of manufactures.  .  .     386.2              28.9
   As reported in Current Industrial Report
   MA-25H:
   • Office furniture 	     377.7              28.3
   • Stacking chairs	      74.6               5.6
   t Secretarial posture chairs 	      59.6               4.5
   • Executive chairs 	     123.4               9.2
   • Chairs, side and arm	     138.4              10.4
   • Sofas, couches, settees, stools, etc.
     including:
     Upholstered	      11.7               0.9
   • Tandem seating	       7.8               0.6
   • Metal office seating, including
     upholstered, n.s.k	       (a)  .

 Desks, including modular unit desks:
   As reported  in census of manufactures. .  .     226.1              16.9
   As reported  in Current Industrial Report
   MA-25H:
   • Office furniture 	     227.3              17.0
   t Executive-type  desks  	       61.8               4.6
   • Clerical and secretarial desks, with
     or without  typewriter mechanism	     148.7              11.1
   • Desks, n.s.k	       16.8               1.3

 Filing cabinets  and  cases:
   As reported  in census of manufactures.  .  .     477.9              35.8
   As reported  in Current  Industrial Report
   MA-25H:
   • Office furniture 	     479.0              35.9
   • Vertical filing cabinets,  noninsulated,
      nonmechanical,  nonvisible,  including
      security files:
       Letter 	     133.9               10.0
       Legal	       69.1               5.2
       Other, except letter  and legal  ....       29.1               2.2
   • Horizontal  filing  cabinets,  noninsulated,
     mechanical, nonvisible,  including
      security files	       99.4               7.4
   • Mechanical  nonvisible  files, all  sizes,
      manual  and electrical	       24.3               1.8
   • Insulated  filing,  film,  and tape  cabinets,
      and  security files, excluding stores .  .       26.4               2.0

                                  (continued)
                                    7-14

-------
                        Table 7-9.    Concluded
                                             Shipments            Percent
                                        (millions  of dollars)    (of total)
   • Visible equipment (other than
     insulated),  including vertical
     and rotary units:
       Nonmechanical,  including
       cabinets,  reference panel
       type chart boards,  book
       type, etc	    31.9                2.4
   • Mechanical,  including card size
     and reference type, manually or
     electrically operated	     4.5                0.3
   • Filing cabinets  and cases, n.s.k.   .  .  .    60.4                4.5

Other metal office furniture, including
tables, stands, etc.:
   As reported in census of manufactures.  ..   218.0               16.3
   As reported in Current  Industrial
   Report MA-25H:
   • Office furniture 	   211.1               15.8
   • Metal tables and stands	    51.6                3.9
   Modular service units,  except desks. .  .  .    30.6                2.3
   t Metal furniture  panel systems:
     Panels or screens as  space dividers
     only	
     Panels with capability of accepting
     hangers	
     Panel-supported  work surfaces	
     Panel-supported  files	
     Panel-supported  storage and
     accessories	    54.4                4.1
   0 Metal systems office furniture:
     Systems desk/work surface	
     Systems storage	
     Systems panels 	
   • Other metal office furniture, including
     bookcases, storage cabinets, costumers,
     etc	        91.1                7.2
   • Other metal office furniture, including
     tables, stands,  etc., n.s.k	    (a)
Metal office furniture, n.s.k., typically for
establishments with 5 employees or more ...    12.5                0.9
Metal office furniture, n.s.k., typically for
establishments with less than  5 employees .  .    13.9                1.0


aTo be revised.
n.s.k. =  Not specified by kind.
                                  7-15

-------
        Table 7-10.   1977 PRODUCT BREAKDOWN FOR PUBLIC BUILDING
                   AND RELATED FURNITURE (SIC 2531)


                                              Shipments          Percent
                                         (millions of dollars)   (of total)

Total	712.3              100.0

School furniture, except stone, concrete,
and library furniture	193.7               27.2
   • Single pupil units 	 34.9                4.9
   • Chairs, all purpose (nonfolding) 	 22.3                3.1
   • Storage cabinets 	 45.3                6.4
   • Other school furniture designed
     specifically for use in schools, including
     two or more pupil desks and tables,
     combination folding tables and benches,
     tables, teacher desks, study carrels,
     chalk boards, etc	83.2               11.7
   t School furniture, n.s.k	8.0                1.1

Public building and related furniture,
except for school and restaurant	457.2               64.2
   • Seats for public conveyances,
     automobile, trucks, aircraft,
     and buses	166.2               23.3
   • Church pews	32.9                4.6
   • Other church furniture (pulpits,
     altars, lecterns, etc.)	10.9                1.5
   • Folding tables,  including folding
     banquet tables	33.0                4.6
   t Chairs and  seats, including theater
     and auditorium:
     Fixed	26.8                3.8
     Portable  folding chairs,  single or
     ganged	21.3                3.0
   • Stadium bleacher seating, including
     grandstands	43.8                6.1
   • Library furniture,  all types,  including
     chairs, charging desks, study  carrels,
     reading tables,  etc	24.3                3.4
   • Other public building furniture	56.6                7.9
   • Public  building  and related furniture,
     except  school,  n.s.k	14.0                2.0

Public building  furniture, n.s.k.,  typically
for  establishments with  5 employees  or more  .  . 33.4                4.7
Public building  furniture, n.s.k.,  typically
for  establishments with  less than 5  employees   28.0                3.9

n.s.k. = Not specified by kind.
Public Building  and  Related Furniture.   1977  Census  of Manufactures.
Preliminary  Report.   U.S. Department of  Commerce.   Washington,  D.C. May  1979.
P. 3.

                                  7-16

-------
Table 7-11.  CAPACITY UTILIZATION RATES:  FOURTH QUARTERS, 1977 and 1976
                               1977               1976
                                                            Standard error
                      Preferred    Practical    Practical   of 1977 practical
                        rate3        rate         rate           rate

Metal household
furniture
(SIC 2514)               91           77           70              19

Metal office
furniture
(SIC 2522)               88           73           76              15

Public building and
related furniture
(SIC 2531)               92           70           69              21

Metal partitions
and fixtures
(SIC 2542)               90           68           69              19


aShown as a percent of  the practical rate.

Survey of Plant Capacity.  1977  Current  Industrial Report.
U. S. Department of Commerce.  Washington,  B.C.   August 1978.
p. 4.
                                   7-17

-------
   1000
    900
    800
    700
M   600

5   500
I
42   400

5   300
fc   200
100
                                                                100
                                                                 90
                                                                 80
                                                                 70
                                                                 60

                                                                 50

                                                                 40


                                                                 30



                                                                 20
   1956  60    62
                         64
                                66    68    70    72    74    76
                                                                      10
                                                                   1978
Figure 7-1.  Trends in numbers of establishments and employees  in
        the Metal Household Furniture Industry  (SIC 2514).
                                                                          3
                                                                          T3
                                                                          (D
                                                                          in
                                                                          3-
                                                                          O
                                                                          c.
                                                                          in
                                                                          EU
                                                                          3
                                                                          O.
                                                                          in
 Figure 7-2.  Trends in numbers of establishments and employees  in
            the Metal Office Furniture  Industry  (SIC 2522).
                                                                       -a
                                                                       o
                                                                       n>
                                                                       re
                                                                       o
                                                                       c
                                                                       (SI
                                                                       3
                                                                       O-
                                  7-18

-------
c
(U
I/)

1000
900
300
700
cnn
ODD
Rnn

A nn
4UU
onn
oUU
?nn
cUU
100
1(







• i"





358 6(











• 	

3 62






m




__,

> 6'






Ej- -t-Tih '
stao



•" i

I 6t
- i
i
1
j
i
i
!
. i
. ! 4^ "
1

i
1
1 X ^
1 i /
inployees
i
> 68 7C






1



•v —


) 72


-



***-^
^


^ — "* •


! 11-







	 >-





\ K
~"





^
^





j 1?
100
on
yu
on
oU
70
60
sn

40

30



in
)78
      Figure 7-3.   Trends in numbers of establishments and  employees  ii
        the Public Building and Related Furniture  Industry  (SIC  2531).
    1000
     900
     300
     700
     600

     500
to
;z    400
     300
     200
     100
                                    -Employees
                                                   100
                                                    90
                                                    80
                                                    70
                                                    60

                                                    50

                                                    40
                                                    30
                                                    20
                                                    10
        1958  60
62
64
66
63
70
72
74
76
1978
      Figure 7-4.   Trends in numbers of establishments and  employees  in
            the Metal  Partitions and Fixtures Industry (SIC 2542).
                                                                            rtl
                                                                            CD
                                                                            O
                                                         Z3
                                                         CL
                                                  o

                                                  I/)

                                                  3
                                                  Q.
                                                  (/l
                                     7-19

-------
      Table  7-12.  NUMBER OF  ESTABLISHMENTS AND EMPLOYEES IN METAL FURNITURE MANUFACTURING INDUSTRY, 1958-1977
ro
o

(SIC 2514)
Metal household
furniture
Year
1977
1976C
1975
1974
1973
1972
1971
1970
1969
1968
1967
1963
1958
Estab.a
441
391
NA
NA
NA
467
NA
NA
NA
NA
486
517
626
Emp.
32.2
30.5
28.1
35.4
36.9
34.4
31.5
32.4
32.8
32.1
31.0
29.3
30.3
(SIC 2522)
Metal office
furniture
Estab.a
185
177
NA
NA
NA
192
NA
NA
NA
NA
187
170
151
Emp.b
28.4
25.7
25.2
31.1
30.1
27.6
25.0
27.6
30.5
27.1
27.0
19.9
17.5
(SIC 2531)
Public building
related furniture
Estab.a
415
377
NA
NA
NA
422
NA
NA
NA
NA
438
429
390
Emp.
19.6
20.6
20.0
21.6
22.2
21.4
21.0
23.1
23.4
21.0
22.6
16.9
16.0
(SIC 2542)
Metal partitions
and fixtures
Estab.a
NA
449
NA
NA
NA
507
NA
NA
NA
NA
500
513
NA
Emp.
NA
21.9
21.0
25.6
26.3
26.2
22.2
22.7
25.2
23.4
22.7
20.3
NA
       Establishments
       Employees (thousands)
      C1976 data for establishments:
      NA = Not available.
U.  S.  Department of Commerce.   County Business Patterns,  1976.
      Source for remaining data:   U.  S.  Department of Commerce.  Census of Manufactures,  1972.
      Report.   Annual  Survey of Manufactures,  1973, 1974,  1975, 1976.
                                                          1977 Preliminary

-------
 over the past 18 years differ from each other in shape, they are similar
 in the sense that the percent changes between the points are small.
 These small differences indicate that the industry is relatively stable
 with moderate rates of exit and new entry.
      Numbers of employees have varied quite a bit over recent years for
 all sectors.  Each sector shows an increase in employees in 1976,
 signaling an upturn that is mirrowed in large part by industry shipments.
 For the household and office furniture sectors,  this trend continued
 through 1977.
      7-1-2.2  Value of Industry Shipments.   Figures 7-5 through 7-8,
 derived from Table 7-13,  show trends in the value of shipments for  the
 four sectors in  current dollars and in constant  1967 dollars scaled by the
 wholesale price  indices for household and commercial  furniture.  The current
 dollar trend lines show steady growth interrupted in 1970  and 1975  by
 slowing or a downturn in  shipment  growth.   The public building and  related
 furniture sector shows the  effect  of slowing the  least of  any sector,
 possibly because of its dependence  on government  spending.
      By plotting shipments  in  constant dollars, the effect of inflation
 is  suppressed  and the figures  better reflect unit shipments.   The trend
 lines  for these  values show that there has  been little real  growth  in  the
 industry  as  a  whole  over  the past ten years.   Instead,  the  value of
 industry  shipments  have moved  cyclically, with peaks  occurring  in 1969
 and  1972-1973.   The  average  industry  growth  between those  peaks is
 approximately  three  percent per year.
      In order  to  evaluate the  four  sectors'   relation  to gross national
 product,  the trends  in percent changes  in real GNP  and  in constant dollar
 shipments shown  in Table 7-14 are plotted in Figures  7-9 through 7-12.  In
 general,  the industry mirrors GNP,  but  its changes are more volatile, i.e.,
 industry  shipments expand more rapidly  during a period of growth and
contract more quickly during a decline.  The metal office furniture sector
 is the most volatile and the public building sector the least.
     7.1.2.3  Factors Affecting Future Growth of the Industry.  The factors
that affect growth in the future differ for  the four sectors.  Purchases
of metal household furniture are connected to the number of new households
and to consumer discretionary income.  Patio and  recreational furniture,  as
                                  7-21

-------
  1200
  1100
  1000
c
o
00
600

500
    400
     1967   68    69   70    71    72    73   74    75   76  77  1978

        Figure 7-5.   Trends  in the  value of  shipments  for the
        Metal  Household  Furniture  Industry  (SIC  2514)  in current
                         and constant  dollars.
   1400
     1967  68  69  70   71    72   73   74   75   76   77  1978
         Figure 7-6.   Trends  in  value  of  shipments  for the
        Metal  Office  Furniture  Industry  (SIC  2522)  in current
                        and constant dollars.

                                 7-22

-------
 to
 c
 o
1/5
to
E
O
    800
    750
    700
650
.7  600
    550
500

450


400
                             t
                                 Curjrerit
                                     x	
                                     >s
                                      5Z
                                                 z
                                          -t-
       1967  68    69    70  71   72   73   74  75   76   77  1978

    Figure 7-7.   Trends in the value of shipments for the Public
    Building  and  Related  Furniture  Industry  (SIC 2531) in current
                       and  constant dollars.
    900
    800
700
c
OJ
   450
                                                      77  1978
  Figure 7-8.  Trends in the value of shipments for the Metal
     Partitions and Fixtures Industry (SIC 2542) in current
                     and constant dollars.
                              7-23

-------
                Table 7-13.  INDUSTRY SHIPMENTS FOR METAL FURNITURE MANUFACTURING IN
                               CURRENT AND CONSTANT DOLLARS, 1967-1977
                                        (millions of dollars)
^-J

IN3
                             1967   1968   1969   1970   1971    1972   1973   1974   1975   1976   1977

Wholesale price index for
commercial furniture
100.0  103.8  108.1   114.5  118.1   120.2  129.4  152.4  166.7  173.3  185.9


100.0  103.9  108.4   111.7  114.9   117.3  123.0  136.6  146.3  153.6  162.2


537.4  604.3  657.0   650.7  693.1   859.3  970.7  934.0  895.3  991.6 1147.7
Industry price index for
household furniture

Metal household furniture
current dollars^5

Constant dollars
(using household furniture
index)0

Metal office furniture
current dollarsb

Metal office furniture
constant dollars0

Public building and    .
related current dollars

Public building and
related constant dollars

Metal partitions and    b
fixtures current dollars

Metal partitions and
fixtures constant dollars0   512.0  504.9  540.1  505.7  491.2  611.1  596.4  557.7  487.5  505.4  NA
537.4  581.6  606.1   582.5  603.2  732.6  789.2  683.8  612.0  645.6  707.6


622.9  654.2  764.5   682.1  682.5  850.7  927.1 1001.8  948.3 1073.1 1375.5


622.9  630.3  707.2   595.7  577.0  707.7  716.5  657.3  568.9  619.2  739.9


421.2  432.5  468.5   462.6  471.8  535.3  555.0  592.1  639.2  716.2  764.8


421.2  416.5  433.4   404.0  399.5  445.3  428.9  388.5  383.4  413.3  411.4


512.0  524.1  583.8   579.0  580.1  734.5  771.8  850.0  812.6  875.8  NA
NA = Not available
a
 Statistical abstract of the U.S. Department of Commerce. Washington, D.C.

 )1967-1972: Census of Manufactures, 1972.
 1973-1976: Annual Survey of Manufactures, (respective years).
 1977-     : Census of Manufactures, Preliminary Report.
                                                    "Constant dollars =
                                                     (current dollars * price
                                                     index) X 100.

-------
                     Table 7-14.   PERCENT CHANGES FROM PREVIOUS YEAR IN REAL GROSS NATIONAL PRODUCT
                              AND CONSTANT METAL FURNITURE MANUFACTURING INDUSTRY SHIPMENTS


                                    1968   1969   1970   1971    1972   1973   1974   1975   1976   1977

         Percent change in
         real GNPa                  4.38   2.57  .0.32   2.99    5.74   5.32 -1.84 -1.57   6.15   4.90

         $ Change in metal
         household, furniture
         shipments0                 8.2    4.2  - 3.9    3.6   21.5    7.7  -13.4  -10.5    5.5    9.6

         Percent change in
         metal office       ,
         furniture shipments0       1.1   12.3  -15.8  -3.0   22.5    1.2    8.2  -13.5    8.8   19.5

         Percent change in
--j        public building and
r\3        related furniture
         shipments5               -1.2    4.2  -6.9  -1.1   11.5  -3.7  -9.4  -1.3    7.8  -0.5

         Percent change in
         metal partitions
         shipments0               - 1.4    7.1  - 6.4  - 2.9   24.5  - 2.4  - 6.5  -12.6    3.7    NA


         NA = Not available.

         aSource:  Statistical Abstract of the United States,  1977.

          Source:  Table 7-13.

-------
c
OJ
o
!~
01
CD
O

QJ
Q.
    25
    20
    15
    10
   - 5
   -10
   -15
         1968  69
71
72   73   74   75   76  77  1978
     Figure 7-9.  Percent changes from previous year in real
       gross national product and constant Metal Household
             Furniture Industry shipments (SIC 2514).
       ' 1968  69   70   71   72   73  74   75  76   77  1978

     Figure 7-10.  Percent changes from previous year  in real
         gross national product and constant Metal Office
             Furniture Industry shipments  (SIC 2522).
                               7-26

-------
1 J
10
5
+•>
§ 0
OJ
Q_
- 5
-10
-15








Pub
Reli
-



r

*»s
_J


fc ^
?**•

	 7-
*(? B
ited


1968








^X

s:
-1--
atV
11 1d3
Fufni
-
- , —
;-



.
- --
**





k

-— + ---

a?
ture
•'

69 70
/






••?
/
^
/

~'-
cf


—

Ship

- :
.'


v

:..-

I
r~i

• - \-.\
---[-^
.- 1
nents


1
— i —

r
rojss
HH&R
rsL
-::P4|
"





\
%

i
1

Nalti
"*• i
i
M-^
. i f
: ~jr
/ I


j



snai t

/
,J/
Y \
i

i

;


- -_:
A
^



N
s
"-







-- -: ;









72 73 74 75 76 77 19
                                                           73
O)
D.
    Figure 7-11.  Percent changes from previous year  in  real
       gross national product and constant Public Building
       and Related Furniture Industry shipments (SIC  2531).
1968
                                        74  75   76   77  1978
    Figure 7-12.  Percent changes from previous year  in real
     gross national product and constant Metal Partitions and
             Fixtures Industry shipments (SIC 2542).
                               7-27

-------
 luxury  items, may be more susceptible to general economic conditions
 than  kitchen furniture, the other major type of metal household furni-
 ture.
      Metal office furniture shipments are tied to new office building
 construction and the financial prospects for businesses considering
 replacement of ^ld furniture.  If necessary, new purchases can be
 delayed, or old furniture renovated.
      As mentioned above, public building and related furniture purchases
 are related to government spending.  For this reason, steady sales seem
 assured.  The only factor that might change this situation is a move
 toward austerity in government budgets.
      Purchases of metal partitions and fixtures may depend on conflicting
 factors.  Partitions may be used to facilitate locating a greater number
 of workers in a small space as an economy measure.   On the other hand,
 workers can be crowded together without the use of partitions if a
 business is not concerned with the quality of the work environment.
      7.1.2.4  Recent Developments in the Industry.   The graphs of
 industry shipments show a substantial upturn for all four sectors in
 1976, even in constant dollars.  Preliminary figures for three sectors
 show  that the upturn continued for household and office furniture in
 1977.  These increases were 9.6 percent and 19.5 percent, respectively,
 in real terms.   Shipments in constant dollars for the public building
 sector decreased slightly.   Figures for 1977 and 1978 are available from
 the Business and Institutional Furniture Manufacturers Association
 (BIFMA), whose membership includes firms from each of the sectors except
 household furniture.   These data show a 26.4 percent increase in constant
 dollar shipments for wood and metal furniture combined during 1977.2
During the first 11  months  of 1978 constant dollar shipments of products
other than wood (presumably metal, primarily) were up 10 percent over
the first 11  months  of 1977.3
7.1.3  Industry Operating Statistics
     Table 7-15 shows that  labor and fuel  costs represented roughly a
constant percentage  of the  value of shipments from 1958 to 1975.   As
shown in Table 7-16,  coating material costs decreased between 1967 and
1972 as a percent of cost of materials in  all segments except public
                                  7-28

-------
      Table 7-15.  LABOR AND MATERIALS COSTS IN METAL FURNITURE
          MANUFACTURING RELATIVE TO VALUE OF INDUSTRY SHIPMENTS
Year
1975
1974
1973
1972
1971
1970
1969
1968
1967
1963
1958
Production workers'
wages3
17.0
18.2
18.6
19.0
18.6
19.4
19.8
19.1
19.4
19.9
20.2
Cost of materials
fuel9
46.6
46.7
45.2
45.6
44.8
44.4
44.6
44.3
44.4
47.1
48.7
Percentage of value of shipments.
Source:  U. S. Department of Commerce.   Census  of  Manufactures,  1972.
                                  7-29

-------
Table 7-16   METAL FURNITURE COATING MATERIALS COSTS VERSUS TOTAL MATERIALS
                 COSTS AND VALUE OF SHIPMENTS, 1972 AND 1967
r.nating Materials Costs

Percent of
cost of
materials
1972
Percent of
value of
industry
shipments
1967
Percent of
Percent of value of
cost of industry
materials shipments
Metal  household
furniture
 (SIC  2514)           1.7

Metal  office
furniture
 (SIC  2522)           3.2

 Public building
 and related
 furniture
 (SIC 2531)           1.9

 Metal partitions
 and fixtures
 (SIC 2542)           3.6
0.8
1.0
0.8
 1.4
2.1
4.2
1.9
4.7
1.0
                               1.3
                               0.8
                               1.8
 Source:  U. S. Department of Commerce.  Census of Manufactures, 1972.
                                    7-30

-------
buildings and fixtures, in which they remained constant.  The identical
phenomenon occurred with respect to coating materials as a percent of
value of industry shipments.
     The industry as a whole includes many sizes and types of firms so
that the financial performance varies widely.   Tables 7-17 and 7-18
summarize the historical profitability of the business and institutional/
office furniture and metal household furniture sectors, respectively.
In general, it can be noted from these figures that for the metal house-
hold furniture sector, profitability suffered in 1970 and again in 1974,
and recovered in 1976 and 1977.   The same phenomenon occurred for the
metal office furniture sector in 1974 and 1976/1977.  Members of BIFMA,
which include wood furniture manufacturers, seem to enjoy consistently
higher profitability than the office furniture sector.  No real relation-
ship can be assumed, however, because the samples used to derive the
figures may not be representative, and may not be comparable to each
other.  The figures do seem to indicate that when shipments drop,
profitability also dips, as would be expected.
7.1.4  Imports and Exports
     Exports of metal furniture are in the range of one to two percent
                                         4
of the total value of industry shipments.   Imports of metal furniture
per s£ are not recorded, but indications are that they have minimal
impact on the industry as a whole.
7.1.5  Projections of Affected Facilities
     The New Source Performance Standards (NSPS) apply to facilities
(defined in this study as individual paint lines) that are constructed
in a new plant, as part of an expansion of an existing plant, or as a
replacement for retired equipment.  In order to assess the impact of the
standard on the industry, it is necessary to project how many facilities
would be constructed in the absence of a regulation.  This section
develops a methodology and makes those projections for the four metal
furniture SIC categories.
     To some extent, new facilities are related to growth in demand for
metal furniture.  Manufacturers' expectations about future demand are an
important factor too, because investment decisions must be made in
                                  7-31

-------
        Table  7-17.   PROFIT BEFORE TAXES OVER TOTAL ASSETS  FOR  HOUSEHOLD  FURNITURE  MANUFACTURES

High quartile
Median
Low quartile
No. of firms
surveyed
1967
NA
8.5
NA
41
1968
NA
13.9
NA
30
1969
NA
11.3
NA
29
1970
NA
7.8
NA
20
1971
NA
8.7
NA
25
1972
NA
14.1
NA
25
1973
15.6
11.9
5.8
28
1974
15.5
5.8
2.1
34
1975
16.3
5.5
0.9
30
1976
19.5
iO.5
3.4
35
1977
17.8
13.0
4.6
35
RMA Annual Statement Studies (respective years).   Robert Morris Associates.  Philadelphia, Pennsylvania,



NA = Not available.

-------
      Table 7-18.   PROFIT BEFORE TAXES  OVER TOTAL ASSETS  FOR METAL  OFFICE
                    FURNITURE MANUFACTURERS AND BUSINESS  AND
                      INSTITUTIONAL  FURNITURE MANUFACTURERS
                                    (percent)
                         1972      1973      1974      1975      1976      1977


  Percent profit before
  taxes/total  assets

     BIFMA members3      13.04    19.38    18.64    11.33    11.66    17.51

  Metal  office
  furniture'3
Upper quartile
Median
Lower quartile
Number of firms
surveyed
NA
NA
NA
NA
12.2
7.0
2.7
30
15.5
6.7
2.1
31
11.1
4.8
0.3
38
9.4
5.7
1.0
31
11.7
6.6
0.5
27
 BIFMA Annual  Statistics.   Industry Performance - 1976 and 1977.   Business
 and Institutional  Furniture Manufacturers Association.   Grand Rapids,
 Michigan.   May 1977 and May 1978.

 RMA Annual  Statement Studies,  1974-1978.   Robert Morris Associates.
 Philadelphia, Pennsylvania.

NA = Not available.

NOTE:  The sample sizes for both sources of data are small and may not be
       representative of the industry as a whole.  BIFMA includes companies
       that  manufacture wood as well  as metal  furniture.
                                     7-33

-------
advance of actual  orders.   Capacity utilization in the industry also plays
a big role in the  number of new facilities that could be built.   If the
industry has been  depressed for some time, or if the new facilities were
constructed to fill orders that never materialized, the resultant excess
capacity can absorb some growth in demand before additional  facilities are
required.
     7.1.5.1  Growth Rates.  Most growth projections for the metal
furniture industry sectors are made in terms of percent growth in
constant dollar shipments.  In order to make these projections more
reflective of unit shipments, an inflation factor must be subtracted
out.  Seven percent is generally used to approximate future inflation.
     An  industry study5 has projected a six to eight percent per year
growth rate for metal office furniture through 1990.  The same study
estimated growth for the metal household  furniture  sector at three  to
four percent per year over the same period.  A third designation,  "panel
systems," was projected at 16.4 percent annual growth.  This growth
probably will be felt to  some degree  in the office  and public building
sectors  as well as the partition segment.  Several  growth estimates for
the household sector available from other  sources  suggest that shipments
are likely  to increase  in  the range of six to  eight percent per year.
      For the purpose of estimating new affected  facilities, these
estimates  have  been manipulated somewhat  to reflect qualitative concerns.
According to an industry  spokesman, household  furniture  growth will
probably be lower  than  that  for both  office and  public  sector  furni-
ture.7  In  addition  to  this  consideration, some  of the  growth  attributed
to the partition  sector was  shifted to  the office and public  sector
 furniture categories.   Finally, price increases  of approximately  seven
 percent were subtracted out  of  the growth estimates.   The  resulting
 projections are:   zero  growth  through 1980 for the metal  household
 furniture sector  followed by one  percent growth  through 1985;  four
 percent growth  through  1985  for the metal office furniture  sector; two
 percent growth  through  1985  for the public building furniture sector;
 seven percent growth through 1985 for the metal  partition  sector.
      7.1.5.2  Projection Methodology.  The methodology used to determine
 the number of affected  facilities through 1985 is based in  the paint use
                                   7-34

-------
of a medium size plant in each of the sectors in 1976, which was discussed
in Chapter 6.   The growth rates developed above were applied to the
number of facilities in 1976 to escalate them to 1980 levels.  Growth
rates were then applied to the 1980 figures to determine an estimate of
affected facilities for 1985.  The difference between the 1980 and 1985
estimates represent the new affected facilities.  To account for replacement
of retired lines, one-third of the 1980 number was added to the total
new facilities (the one-third arises from the assumption that equipment
life is fifteen years; if one-fifteenth of the equipment is retired each
year, then between 1980 and 1985, five-fifteenths or one-third will be
retired or replaced).
     7.1.5.3  Results.  The calculation of affected facilities in each
sector is shown in Table 7-19.   The results show 338 new lines in the
household sector, 254 lines in the office sector, 400 lines in the
public building sector, and 971 lines in the metal parition sector for a
total of 1 963 total new lines between 1980 and 1985.  An industry
spokesman for business and institutional furniture manufacturers indicates
that in general, small firms tend to increase capacity by means of on-
                                                                         o
site expansions whereas larger firms are more likely to build new plants.
7.2  METAL FURNITURE COST ANALYSIS
     This section develops cost estimates for emission control techniques
that can be applied to the model  plants described in Chapter 5.  These
costs are based on engineering estimates that were made using vendor
quotes, figures from actual installations and previous studies, and
adjusting formulas for plant capacity.   For the model plant assumptions
made, the estimates are considered accurate to within ± 30 percent.
     This section also estimates  the cost effectiveness of each alterna-
tive.  Cost effectiveness is estimated by dividing the total annualized
control cost by the annual reduction of emissions achieved.   In this
way, the various control  alternatives may be ranked on a relative basis.
7.2.1  New Facilities
     7.2.1.1   Model Plants/Control Options Description.   As is explained
in Chapter 5,  the ten  model plants were developed to be representative
of metal furniture coating facilities that will  be built in the future.
The models cover three capacity sizes,  three coating application methods,

                                  7-35

-------
                          Table  7-19.   CALCULATION  OF TOTAL AFFECTED FACILITIES, 1980-1985
OJ
CT>
© ~"
Total
paint
used
per yr
mil. liters
(mil. gal)
Household
SIC 2514
34.24
(10.12)
Office
SIC 2522
20.82
( 6.15)
Public
SIC 2531
29.14
( 8.61)
Partitions
SIC 2541
45.99
(13.59)
® ®
Paint used
per yr in No. of
medium lines in
size plant medium
liters size
(gallons) plant
87,055 2
(23,000)

117,335 2
(31,000)

77,290 2
(20,420)

102,195 2
(27,000)
® © © © ® ® ® ©
Lines in Total
Lines in Growth Lines in Growth Lines in 1980 x affected
1976 rate 1980 rate 1985 New lines 5/15 facilities
(t) * (2) thru (3)x /, thru © x ,- 1980-1985 replace- 1980-1985
x© 1980 (1 + (§)) 1985 (1 +(28 © - © ment (9) + ©
880 0 880 1% 925 45 293 338

396 4% 463 4% 563 100 154 254

844 2% 914 2% 1,009 95 305 400

1 006 7% 1,319 7% 1,850 531 440 971
1,963

-------
 and two types of furniture - flat and complex.   All  uncontrolled plants
 are assumed to use 35 percent solids (as applied)  organic solvent-based
 paint.
      The purpose of the three size categories  is to  cover the size
 diversity of the industry.   The  reason for estimating the costs  of  the
 three application techniques is  to show the difference in annualized
 capital  and operating costs  among the various  techniques.   In addition,
 there are some control  alternatives  which  are  applicable  to only  one
 application technique.   It is necessary,  therefore,  to estimate  the
 costs for spray,  dip,  and  flow coating separately.
      The effect of metal furniture part complexity on the annualized
 capital  and operating  costs  of spray coating lines is substantial and  is
 therefore presented in  the cost  analysis.   Complex parts  generally
 require  more space on  a coating  line and as a  result,  fewer items can  be
 coated per day for each line.  More  capital equipment is  needed,
 therefore,  to  paint complex  items  than  is  needed to  paint  flat items.
 In  addition,  spray coating transfer  efficiency is lower for complex
 items than  for flat items.    Paint  consumption  is, therefore,  higher
 resulting in  higher operating  costs.
      7.2.1.2   Base  Case Model  Plants.   The Clean Air  Act Amendments  of
 1977  require the  states to develop revisions to  their  State  Implementation
 Plans (SIPs).  Many  of  the SIP revisions (including those  for states
 having the majority  of  the metal  furniture manufacturing facilities)
 submitted for  Federal approval include  standards of metal  furniture
 coating emissions.   Therefore, this  analysis estimates the  incremental
 costs incurred above the SIP for several control options.  To measure
 that incremental cost, a "base case" that meets SIP levels was developed
 and costed for each model plant.
     An SIP level of 0.36 kg of organic solvent per liter of coating
 (3.0 pounds per gallon) at  application was assumed because that level
 has been proposed by several  heavily industrialized states (see section
7.3).   To meet that level,  the base cases are assumed to use 60 percent
 solids paint (as applied) for spraying and 63/37 waterborne paint for
dip and flow coating, rather than the 35 percent solids paint associated
                                  7-37

-------
with the uncontrolled model plants.   The paint substitution necessitates
equipment changes that are reflected in the costs developed for each base
case.
     7.2.1.3  Control Cost Bases.   This section summarizes the assumptions
used in developing the control costs for the model plants and control
options.  The technical operating parameters which serve as the basis for
the cost estimates (i.e., coating thickness, exhaust flow rates, line
configuration, etc.) are presented in Chapter 5 and are not repeated here.
     Several types of costs are included in the total cost for a control
option.  The first is the initial investment required for equipment and
installation.  From this investment one can estimate such capital related
charges as depreciation, interest, property taxes, insurance and general
administration.  Expressed on an annual basis, these charges are called
annualized capital costs.  To them are added recurring costs such as
utilities, materials, and  labor for operation and maintenance of the
equipment during its  life.  The sum of these capital related costs  and
operating costs  is the total  annualized cost of the control alternative.
Coating line and control equipment costs are estimated on the basis  of
vendor estimates on  the  basis of trade association and industry survey
data.   The remaining  assumptions used  in calculating control costs  are
shown  in Table 7-20.9~17
     The annual  cost  factors  used for  the  model plant cost analysis  are
presented in Table 7-21.
     7.2.1.4   Control  Costs and Cost Effectiveness.  Tables 7-22 through
7-31 display the control  cost estimates for each  plant.   The  use of high
solids content paint appears  to result in  a lower total  annualized  cost
than the  uncontrolled model plants,  even though  the  coating material  is
                                                        18—23
more expensive on  a  volume basis than  low  solids  paint.        This  savings
 results mainly because high solids  paint covers  a greater area per  unit of
 volume applied.
      Cost effectiveness  plots for  controls applied to  the base case model
 plants are  presented in  Figures  8-13 and 8-14.   As can  be seen,  the cost
 effectiveness  ratios for the  waterborne option is much  higher for  the spray
 coating lines  than are the other  control options.   The  powder option is
                                   7-38

-------
                Table 7-20.   BASES FOR CONTROL COST ESTIMATES

Control
technique
Powder
Capital
Equipment
Vendor
estimates
costs
Building
Equal to
uncontrolled
Operating
Electricity
Uncontrolled
- 5 percent
costs
Fuel
Uncontrolled
- 50 percent
Waterborne
60% and 70%
High solids

Thermal
incinerator

Fluidized
bed

Electrodeposition
Base case
(SIP level)

Uncontrolled
Uncontrolled
+ 30 percent

Equal to
uncontrolled

Vendor
estimates

Vendor
estimates

Vendor
estimates

Vendor
estimates

Vendor
estimates
Uncontrolled
+ 10 percent

Equal to
uncontrolled

Equal to
uncontrolled

Equal to
base case

Base case
+ 10 percent

Equal to
Uncontrolled

Survey
information
Uncontrolled
+ 15 percent

Uncontrolled
- 5 percent

Base case
+ 5 percent

Uncontrolled
+ 30 percent

5 X
Uncontrolled

Uncontrolled
- 5 percent

Survey
information
Uncontrolled
- 33 percent

Uncontrolled
- 33 percent

Vendor
estimates

Uncontrolled
- 50 percent

Equal to
base case

Uncontrolled
- 33 percent

Survey
information
                                     7-39

-------
          Table 7-21.  MODEL  PLANT ANNUAL  CONTROL  COST  FACTORS9
Operating schedule                         2 000 hours/year
Electricity                                $0.08/107  joule ($0.03/KWH)
Natural Gas                                $1.89/109  joule ($2.00/106 Btu)
Paint:
  Conventional solvent-borne (35% solids)  $1.85/liter ($7.00/gallon)
  High solids (60 to 70% solids)           $2.80/liter ($10.75/gallon)
  63/37 Waterborne                         $1.98/liter ($7.50/gallon)
  80/20 Waterborne                         $2.10/liter ($8.00/gallon)
  Powder5                                  $3.53/kg ($1,60/pound)
Labor                                      $6.70/manhour
Capital recovery factor assumptions
(Equipment life and interest rate):
  Coating  line equipment                   15 years at 10% interest
  Building                                 25 years at 10% interest
  Add-on control  equipment                  10 years at 10% interest
Taxes, insurance  and G&A                   4% of  total installed cost
Maintenance  labor                          10%  of direct  labor
Maintenance  material                        1.5% of equipment  cost

 Overhead            "                      80%  of direct  labor  cost

 aSee Appendix E to this BID for additional cost and economic analyses.
bPowder costs presented in  Tables  7-22  through  7-50 are based on a film
  thickness of 6.35  x 10  cm (2.5 mil).   However,  based on the data
  presented in Appendix E powder costs are  reduced  significantly at a
  film thickness of  3.81 x 10    cm  (1.5  mil).
                                   7-40

-------
   Table 7-Z2.   CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL  PLANT  A -  LARGE  SPRAY  COATING
                FACILITY FOR FLAT METAL  FURNITURE  SURFACES
                                    A-l    A-2
                                                Control options'
                                                A-3   A-4   A-5
                  A-6   A-U
 INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($  1000)

 Line(s)
 Add-on control  equipment
 Building
 Total  capital  costs

 Annualized capital  costs
 Insurance, taxes  and  G & A
 Total  annualized  capital  costs

 OPERATING COSTS ($  1000/yr)

 Direct labor
 Maintenance labor
 Overhead
 Maintenance Materials
 Paint
 Electricity
 Natural gas
 Total  operating costs
                                   1810  2041  1570  1570  1570  1570  1570
                                   	  	  	   130  	  	  	
                                   2063  2270  2063  2063  2063  2063  2063
                                   3873  4311  3633  3763  3633  3633  3633
                                    444   495
                                    155   172
                                    599   667
413
145
558
433   413
151   145
584   558
413
145
558
 Cost  (credit)  per  kg  of emission
   reduction  versus uncontrolled
   plant  ($/kg)
 Cost  (credit)  per  kg  of emission
   reduction  versus base case
   ($/kg)
 Cost  per  area  covered
   ($/1000 i/)
413
145
558
                                    600   600   600   600   600   600   600
                                                 60
                                                480
                                                 24
                                                507
                                                 69
                                         	    45
                                   2565  2060  1785  I88T  T824"  1871  1936
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yr) 3164  2727  2343  2465  2382  2429  2494



                                    3.4   1.5  (1.0)  (0.2)  (0.8)  (0.5)   N/A
                                   10.3   8.0  (3.2)   1.6  (3.3)   N/A   N/A


                                    791   682   586   616   596    607   624
^\-l  Powder
 A-2  Waterborne
 A-3  70 percent  high  solids
 A-4  Incinerator on base case line(s)
 A-5  65 percent  high  solids
 A-6  Base  case—typical SIP
 A-U  Uncontrolled plant
 N/A  Not applicable
                                                                  cm
 This cost for powder is based on a film thickness  of 6,35 x 10"
 (2.5 mil).   However, at a film thickness of 3.81  x 10   cm (1.5  mil)
 the cost changes significantly (see Appendix E).
                                    7-41

-------
    Table 7-23.  CONTROL COSTS  FOR MODEL PLANT B - LARGE SPRAY COATING
               FACILITY FOR COMPLEX METAL  FURNITURE SURFACES
                                     B-l    B-2
             Control  options
             B-3   B-4   B-5
                        B-6   B-U
 INSTALLED  CAPITAL  COSTS  ($  1000)

 Lines(s)
 Add-on  control  equipment
 Building
 Total capital  costs

 Annualized capital costs
 Insurance, taxes and  G&A
 Total annualized captial  costs

 OPERATING  COSTS ($ 1000/yr)

 Direct  labor
 Maintenance labor
 Overhead
 Maintenance materials
 Paint
 Electricity
 Natural gas
 Total operating costs
3197  3614  2780  2780  2780  2780  2780
	   130  	  	  	
2096  2306  2096  2096  2096  2096  2096
5293  5920  4876  5006  4876  4876  4876
 630
 212
706
237
575
195
595
200
575
195
575
195
 100   100
 800   800
  48L   54
      100
      800
       42
1295U 1014   675
 116   140   116
  56    74    74
      100   100
      800   800
       44
      790
      116
             78
       42
      725
      116
       74
      100
      800
       42
      790
      116
       74
 Cost (credit)  per kg of emission
   reduction versus uncontrolled
   plant ($/kg)

 Cost (credit)  per kg of emission
   reduction versus base case
   ($/kg)

 Cost per area  covered
   ($/1000 mz)
575
195
 842   943   770   795   770   770   770
1000  1000  1000  1000  1000  1000  1000
      100
      800
       42
      826
      122
      116
3415  3182  2807  2928  2857  2922  3001
 TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($1000/yr)    4257   4125  3577   3723   3627   3692  3771
 1.9   1.7  (1.0) (0.3) (0.8) (0.5)  N/A
 5.9   8.9   (3.2) 1.1   (3.4) N/A   N/A
1064  1031   894   931   907   923   943
as-1  Powder
 B-2  Waterborne
 B-3  70 percent high solids
 B-4  Incinerator on base case line(s)
 B-5  65 percent high solids
 B-6  Base case—typical  SIP
 B-U  Uncontrolled plant
 N/A  Not applicable
  This cost for powder is based on a film thickness  of 6.35 x 10~°cm (2.5 mil)
  However, at a film thickness  of 3.81 x 10" cm (1.5 mil)  the cost changes
  significantly (see Appendix E). .
                                      7-42

-------
     Table 7-24.  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT C - MEDIUM SIZE SPRAY
                  COATING FACILITY FOR FLAT METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
C-l    C-2
                                               Control  options

                                               C-3   C-4   C-5
                                                                C-6    C-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs

626

402
1028
127
41
164

706

442
1148
137
46
183

543

402
945
112
38
150

543
no

402
1055
129
42
171

543

402
945
112
38
150

543

402
945
112
38
150

543

402
945
112
38
150
OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)

Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs

TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yr)  728   638   562   603   569   579   591

Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus uncontrolled
  plant ($/kg)                      3.7
150
15
120
9b
253
9
8
T64
150
15
120
10
139
10
11
455
150
15
120
8
99
9
11
412
150
15
120
10
116
9
12
432
150
15
120
8
106
9
11
419
150
15
120
8
116
9
11
429
150
15
120
8
123
9
16
441
                                          1.5  (1.0)   0.4  (0.9)  (0.6)   N/A
Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus base case
  ($/kg)

Cost per area covered
  ($/1000 m2)
10.8

 933
       8.4

       818
                                               (3.3)  5.9

                                                721   779
                                                           (3.7)  N/A   N/A

                                                            729   742   758
 -1   Powder
C-2   Waterborne
C-3   70 percent high solids
C-4   Incinerator on base case line(s)
C-5   65 percent high solids
C-6   Base case—typical  SIP
C-U   Uncontrolled plant
N/A   Not applicable
h                                                              -?
 This cost for powder is based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10"  cm (2.5 mil)
 However, at a film thickness of 3.81 x 10~ cm (1.5 mil)  the cost changes
 significantly (see Appendix E).

                                     7-43

-------
      Table 7-25.  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT D - MEDIUM SIZE SPRAY
                   COATING FACILITY FOR COMPLEX METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
                                   D-l   D-2
          Control options9
          D-3    D-4    D-5
D-6   D-U
OSTS ($ 1000)

,
pment

costs
id G&A
pita! costs

644

402
1046
125
42
167

728

442
1170
140
47
187

560

402
962
114
38
T52

560
i in
1 1 U
402
1072
131
43
174

560

402
962
114
38
152

560

402
962
114
38
152

560

402
962
114
38
152
 Line(s)
 Add-on control  equipment
 Building
 Total capital  costs
 Annualized capital costs
 Insurance, taxes  and G&A
 OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)

 Direct labor
 Maintenance labor
 Overhead
 Maintenance materials
 Paint
 Electricity
 Natural gas
 Total operating costs

 TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yr)  732   702   597   644   607   619   631
150
15
120
10
253f>
9
8
565
150
15
120
11
198
10
11
515
150
15
120
8
132
9
11
445
150
15
120
10
154
9
12
470
150
15
120
8
142
9
11
455
150
15
120
8
154
9
11
467
150
15
120
8
161
9
16
479
 Cost (credit) per kg of emission
   reduction versus uncontrolled
   plant ($/kg)

 Cost (credit) per kg of emission
   reduction versus base case
   ($/kg)
 Cost per area covered
   ($71000 m2)
2.1   1.8  (0.9)  0.4  (0.7) (0.4)  N/A



6.0   9.0  (3.1)  4.6  (3.2)  N/A   N/A


938   900   765   832   778   794   809
aD-l  Powder
 D-2  Waterborne
 D-3  70 percent high solids
 D-4  Incinerator on base case  line(s)
 D-5  65 percent high solids
 D-6  Base  case—typical SIP
 D-U  Uncontrolled  plant
 N/A  Not applicable                                           _3
 This cost  for powder is based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10  cm (2.5 mil)
 However, at. a film thickness of 3.81 x 10  cm (1.5 mil) the cost changes
 significantly  (see Appendix  E).
                                      7-44

-------
      Table 7-26.   CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT E - SMALL SPRAY COATING
                   FACILITY  FOR FLAT METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
                                   E-l
    Control  options3
 E-2   E-3   E-4   E-5
                                E-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
fill _ i.»j»y>vT A J-l 1 1 -4 (-V*V>*-\ Y\ 4-
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yi

225


23
248
32
10
42

40
4
32
3
14b
4
4
101
r) 143

225


25
250
32
11
43

40
4
32
4
7
5
5
97
140

196


23
219
28
9
37

40
4
32
3
6
4
5
94
131

196


23
219
28
9
37

40
4
32
3
6
4
5
94
131

196


23
219
28
9
37

40
4
32
3
6
4
5
94
131

196


23
219
28
9
37

40
4
32
3
7
4
7
97
134
Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus uncontrolled
  plant ($/kg)                     4.2

Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus base case
  ($/kg)                          15.1
Cost per area covered
  ($/1000 n»2)
3178
 3.4  (1.8) (2.0) (2.2)  N/A
22.2   0.0   0.0   N/A   N/A
3111  2911  2911  2911  2977
E-l  Powder
E-2  Waterborne
E-3  70 percent high solids
E-4  65 percent high solids
E-5  Base case—typical SIP
E-U  Uncontrolled plant
N/A  Not applicable
This cost for  powder is based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10~3cm (2.5 mil)
However, at a  film thickness of 3.81 x 10  cm  (1.5 mil) the cost changes
significantly  (see Appendix E).

                                     7-45

-------
     Table 7-27.
CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT F - SMALL SPRAY COATING
FACILITY FOR COMPLEX METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
                                   F-l
                         Control  options

                      F-2   F-3   F-4   F-5
                                                                 F-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
RUT 1 fHnn
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs

248
23
271
35
11
46

40
4
32
4b
14b
4
4
102

281
25
306
39
12
51

40
4
32
4
13
5
T03

216
23
239
31
10
41

40
4
32
3
9
4
	

216
23
239
31
10
41

40
32


4
97

216
23
239
31
10
4T

40
32



97

216
23
239
31
10
41

40
32


7
"99
 TOTAL  ANNUALIZED  COSTS  ($  1000/yr) 148    154    138   138   138   140
 Cost (credit)  per kg  of emission
   reduction  versus uncontrolled
   plant ($/kg)

 Cost (credit)  per kg  of emission
   reduction  versus base case
   ($/kg)

 Cost per area covered
   ($/1000 m2)
                 2.9   6.3  (1.0) (1.1) (1.2)  N/A



                 9.3  22.1   0.0   0.0   N/A   N/A


                3289  3422  3067  3067  3067   3111
aF-l  Powder
 F-2  Waterborne
 F-3  70 percent high solids
 F-4  65 percent high solids
 F-5  Base case—typical SIP
 F-U  Uncontrolled plant
.N/A  Not applicable                                           _3
bThis cost for powder is based on a film thickness  of 6.35  x  10 cm  (2.5 mil)
 However, at a film thickness of 3.81 x 10~Jcm (1.5 mil)  the  cost  changes
 significantly  (see Appendix E).
                                      7-46

-------
      Table 7-28.   CONTROL COSTS  FOR MODEL PLANT  6  -  LARGE  DIP  COATING
                   FACILITY FOR METAL FURNITURE
                                      G-l
            Control  options
        G-2    6-3    6-4    6-5
                            G-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
• i i . 
-------
     Table 7-29.
CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT H -  MEDIUM SIZE DIP
COATING FACILITY FOR METAL FURNITURE
                                              Control options

                                      H-l   H-2   H-3   H-4   H-5   H-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
L1ne(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance* taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs

520

240
760
92
30
122

1100

-264
1364
171
55
226

540
nn
1 1 U
240
890
112
35
147

540

240
780
95
31
126

540

240
780
95
31
126

415

218
633
79
25
104
OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)

Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs

TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yr)     582    641   579   563   555   528
150
15
120
17
97
5
11
4T5
150
15
120
9
124
1
13
432
150
15
120
8
132
1
11
437
150
15
120
8
124
1
11
429
150
15
120
6
116
1
16
424
Cost  (credit) per kg of emission
   reduction versus uncontrolled
   plant  ($/kg)

Cost  (credit) per kg of emission
                     1.6
3.3   1.7   1.2   1.3   N/A
ICUUl»blV»l »CI JUWJ L/UJ>- %»u.*«-
($/kg)
Cost per area covered
($/1000 m2)
2.1
746
6.8
822
2.9
742
1.0
722
N/A
712
N/A
677
 H-l   Fluidized bed
 H-2   Electrodeposition
 H-3   Incinerator on base case  line(s)
 H-4   Haterborne
 H-5   Base case—typical  SIP
 H-U   Uncontrolled plant
 N/A   Not applicable
                                     7-48

-------
     Table 7-30.
                  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT I - SMALL DIP COATING
                  FACILITY FOR METAL FURNITURE
                                      1-1
                                                Control options

                                              1-2     1-3     1-4
Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus uncontrolled
  plant ($/kg)

Cost (credit) per kg of emission
                                      14.1
21.8    5.9
                                                               8.1
L-l   Fluidized bed
1-2   Electrodeposition
1-3   Waterborne
1-4   Base case—typical SIP
I-U   Uncontrolled plant
N/A  Not applicable
                                                                      I-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
/ Maintenance materials
Paint
/Electricity
/ Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yr)

225
14
239
31
10
41

40
4
32
3
32
0
4
115
156

420
15
435
57
17
74

40
4
32
6
6
4
5
97
171

250
14
264
34
11
45

40
4
32
4
8
0
5
93
138

250
14
264
34
11
45

40
32


0
93
138

192
13
205
27
8
35

40
32



93
128
N/A
($/kg)
Cost per area covered
($71000 m2)
24.0
?467
45.0
3800
0.0
3067
N/A
3067
N/A
2844
                                     7-49

-------
      Table 7-31.   CONTROL  COSTS  FOR  MODEL  PLANT  J  - SMALL  FLOW  COATING
                   FACILITY FOR METAL FURNITURE
                                                 Control options
                                             J-l        J-2        J-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs

250
- —
14
264
34
11
45

250
— — —
14
264
34
11
45

192
_* —
13
205
27
8
35
OPERATING COSTS ($ 1000/yr)

Direct labor                                  40        40        40
Maintenance labor                              444
Overhead                                      32        32        32
Maintenance materials                          443
Paint                                          887
Electricity                          '          000
Natural gas                                   _5        _5_        _7
Total operating costs                         93        93        93

TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($ 1000/yr)           138       138       128

Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus uncontrolled
  plant ($/kg)                               5.9       8.1       N/A

Cost (credit) per kg of emission
  reduction versus base case
  ($/kg)                                     0.0       N/A       N/A

Cost per area covered
  ($/1000 m2)                                3067      3067      2844


J-l  Waterborne
J-2  Base case—typical SIP
J-U  Uncontrolled plant
N/A  Not applicable
                                     7-50

-------
       30
        25
tn
      o
                                           Waterborne - Complex surfaces
                                              Powder  - Complex  surfaces
                                              Thermal  incinerator  -  Complex  surfaces
                                  65 and 70 percent high solids - Complex surfaces
                      500
                                                                                       -O
         -G
                                                                                      -O
                                                                                       -O
3500     4000
 2
1000     1500       2000      2500       3000
               Total  area coated  per year -  1000m£
  Figure 7-13.   Spray coating cost effectiveness vs.  base case.

-------
I
01
ro
       u

       T3
       c
       o
        in
       •r—

        OJ

        C7I
        (U
        Q.
        \s>
        I/)
        (U
        c
        (U
        U
        (U
        O)
        o
        o
                                                           Thermal  incinerator
                       500       1000      1500     2000      2500      3000     3500       4000
                                                                                    2
                                               Total area covered  per year - 1000 m

                              Figure  7-14.   Dip and flow coating  cost effectiveness  vs.  base case.

-------
the second highest for spray coating lines but costs for the control  option
can change significantly depending upon coating thickness and complexity of
the part coated.   The material  costs for powder are based upon 6.35 x 10 3 cm
(2.5 mil) film thickness.   As a result of this film thickness, the powder
costs are high.   However,  based on a film thickness of 3.81 x 10 3 cm
(1.5 mil) powder can produce a savings for the metal furniture manufacturer.
This information is presented in Appendix E.   For dip coating lines the
control options of electrodeposition and powder produce the highest cost
effectiveness ratios.
     In almost all cases,  the curves slope downward with increasing plant
size.  This is particularly true for electrodeposition and incineration.
The reason for this phenomenon is that these options are rather capital
intensive.  As plant size increases, the impact of the capital costs
decreases thereby decreasing the cost effectiveness ratio.
7.2.2  Modified or Reconstruction Facilities
     As defined in Chapter 4 of this report, metal furniture coating
facilities may undergo "modification" or "reconstruction" thereby bringing
the facility under the purview of the NSPS.  As a result of such actions,
the facility would incur certain costs or savings from the conversion to
the mode of operation necessary to achieve the standard.  Presented in
Tables 7-32 through 7-41 are the costs for each model plant associated with
a switch from the base (CTG) level to each of the control options presented
in Chapter 5.  The costs involved in a switch from the uncontrolled state
to each of the control options are presented in Tables 7-42 through 7-51.
     All control cost factors presented in Table 7-21 are valid for the
conversion costs presented in this section.  Capital costs are estimated on
the basis of the amount of coating line equipment that would  have to be
replaced to comply with each control option.  For spray coating lines there
are three options which would required a capital investment to switch from
the base case.  Powder coating would require a complete change of the spray
coating equipment and spray booths.  Waterborne coatings would require
modifications of the spray equipment (including insulation and isolation),
extension of the flash-off area, and an increase in the amount of climate
control equipment in the plant.  The incineration option would require  the
                                  7-53

-------
  Table 7-32.  PLANT A  -  CONTROL COSTS FOR .MODIFICATION OR
                         RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL  FACILITIES
                                          A-l
Control options
 A-2   A-3   A-4
                                                                  A-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual! zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual i zed capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 nf)
aA-l Powder
A-2 Waterborne
A-3 70 percent high solids
A-4 Incinerator on base line(s)
A-5 65 percent high solids

750
0
0
750
99
30
129

0

n
702 b

691
1000) 820
205





500
0
207
707
87
28
115

0
n
u
8
167
15
1 
-------
 Table  7-33. PLANT B -
                      CONTROL  COSTS  FOR  MODIFICATION  OR
                      RECONSTRUCTION OF  SIP  LEVEL  FACILITIES
                                          B-l
                                              Control  options
                                              B-2   B-3   B-4
                                                                  B-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual i zed capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials"
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 m2)
aB-l Powder
B-2 Waterborne
B-3 70 percent high solids
B-4 Incinerator on base case line(s)
LB-5 65 percent high solids
h — . .1 i f • ~t ... j_ L

1325 900
0 0
0 210
1325 1110
174 139
53 44
227 183

0 0
0 0
0 0
20. 14
505T 224
0 26
(37) 0
488 264
715 447
179 H2






0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0

0
(115)
0
rn5)
(115)
(29)




: oc « 1

0
130
0
130
20
5
25

0


0
0
6
8
33
8




1 l~\~^r-m

0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0

ri
(65)
I65T
(65)
(16)




lO C mi
is cost for powder is based on  a  film thickness  of  6.35
   S            w    i                      -           .w    .        _.
However, at a film thickness of 3.81  x  10~3cm (1.5  mil)  the  cost  changes
significantly (see Appendix E).
                                 7-55

-------
  TahlP 7-34   PLANT  C - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
  Table 7 34.  PLAN!     ^CONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL  FACILITIES
                                             Control options


                                        C-l   C-2   C-3   C-4   C-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s) 2
Add-on control equipment
Building -;
Total capital costs '
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual i zed capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operatinq costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 m2)
^C-l Powder
C-2 Waterborne
C-3 70 percent high solids
C-4 Incinerator on base case nne(s)
C-5 65 percent high solids
b-rh-ic- /-net fnr> nnurlpr 15 based On 3 film 1
!50
0
0
>50
39
in
49

0
0
0
137b
J51
136
135
237



thickn
175
0
40
215
27
36

0
0
0
23
0
28
64
82



ess of
0
0
0
TJ
0
0

0


07)
0
Tiry
07)
(22)



6.35
0
110
0
no
17
21

0


0
n
u
1
3
24
31



x 10"3
0
0
0
0
0
0

0

Q
(10)
o
0
TToT
00)
03)



cm (2.5 mi
•This cost for powder is  based on a mm  imuiim*:. ui «.—    *«  «,.  x^.- -
 However,  at a film thickness of 3.81  x 10-3cm  (1.5 mil) the  cost  changes

 significantly (see Appendix E).
                                   7-56

-------
    Table 7-35. PLANT D - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                          RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP 1EVEL FACILITIES
                                                Control options3

                                            D-l    D-2    D-l   D-4
D-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 nf)
^-l Powder
D-2 Waterborne
D-3 70 percent high solids
D-4 Incinerator on base case line(s)
,D-5 65 percent high solids

260
0
0
76T5
34
10
44

0
0
0
4
99 b
0
-15)
98
144

185






182
0
40
"222
28
9
37

0
0
0
3
44
2
0
86

no






0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
(22)
0
0
722]
(22)

(28)






0
no
0
770
17
4
21

0
0
0
2
0
0
1.
3
24

31




..-3

0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
(12)
0
0
TTT)
(12)

(15)





JThis  cost  for  powder  is  based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10  cm  (2.5 mil),
 However, at  a  film  thickness of 3.81 x 10'^cm  (1.5 mil) the cost changes
 significantly  (see  Appendix E).
                                   7-57

-------
                                              Control options3

                                          E-l    E-2    E-3    E-4


INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS <$ 1000)


Line(s)           .                          9n      0       0       0
Add-on control equipment                     n      2       0       0
Building                                    on"     57      0       0
Total capital costs                         3U

Annualized capital costs                    11      7       0       0
Insurance, taxes and G&A                     4      t       jj.      -
Total annualized capital  costs              15      y       u

OPERATING COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($  1000)

Direct  labor                                 n      0      0      0
Maintenance  labor                             n      0      0      0
Overhead             -                         i      1      0      0
Maintenance  materials                         'b     i      o      0
Paint                                        n      1      0      0
Electricity                                  (2)     0      P_     P_
Natural  gas                                  *-J-    T     o      0
Total operating  costs                         '

TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)   22     12      0      0

 Cost (savings) per area covered
   ($/1000nf)                              489    267      °      U
 ^-l  Powder
  E-2  Waterborne
  E-3  70  percent high solids
 .E-4  65  percent high solids                                   _3
 bThis cost for powder is  based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10  cm (2.5 mil;
  However, at a film  thickness of 3.81 x lQ-3cm (1.5 mil) the cost changes
  significantly (see  Appendix  E).
                                    7-58

-------
    Table 7-37.  PLANT F - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                          RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL FACILITIES
 OPERATING COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($  1000)

 Direct labor
 Maintenance labor
 Overhead
 Maintenance materials
 Paint
 Electricity
 Natural gas
 Total operating  costs
                                             F-l
     Control  options3
       F-2     F-3     F-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs

100
0
0
100
13
4
17

70
0
2
72
9
3
12

0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
0
0
0
 0
 0
 0

 I"
 0
(21
 5
                                                     0
                                                     0
                                                     0
                                                     1
                                                     4
                                                     1
                                                     0
                                                     6
Cost (savings) per area covered
  ($/1000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
p_
0
 TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($  1000)   22      18      0      0
                                            489
       400
aF-l   Powder
 F-2   Waterborne
 F-3   70 percent high solids
 F-4   65 percent high solids                                   3
 This cost for powder is based  on  a  film  thickness of 6.35 x  10" cm  (2.5 mil),
 However, at a film thickness of 3.81  x  10~3cm  (1.5 mil)  the  cost changes
 significantly (see Appendix  E).
                                   7-59

-------
  Table 7-38  PLANT G - CONTROL  COSTS  FOR MODIFICATION OR
                        RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL  FACILITIES
                                               Control  options

                                            G-l    G-2   G-3  6-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
RIII 1 rH nn
ui4 i i u 1 1 iy
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Tncnvanrp 1"AVP^ anH GXA
X I IO Ul I Gl 1 v»C J l»Q/\C J UIIU \dWn
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($71000 nf)

1040
0
Q
1040
137
42
179

0
0
0
16
696
1
(39)
674
853

213

2500
0
126
2626
342
105
447

0
0
0
38
(141)
32
0
(71)
376

94

0
130
0
130
20
5
25

0
0
0
2
0
0
5
7
32

8

0


0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
37
0
0
37
37


G-l  Fluidized bed
G-2  Electrodeposition
G-3  Incinerator on base case line(s)
G-4  Waterborne
                                  7-60

-------
   Table 7-39. PLANT H - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                         RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL FACILITIES
                                                 Control options

                                            H-l    H-2    H-3    H-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs

210
0
0
210
28
8
36

550
0
354
904
107
36
143

0
110
0
no
17
4
21

0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OPERATING COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)

Direct labor                                  0000
Maintenance labor                             0000
Overhead                                      0000
Maintenance materials                         3820
Paint                                        34    (27)    (8)     8
Electricity                                   1800
Natural gas                                  (6)     0      2      0
Total operating  costs                        32    (11)    T4J     8

TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)    63    132     17      8

Cost (savings) per area covered
  ($/1000 m2)                                87    169     22     10


H-l  Fluidized bed
H-2  Electrodeposition
H-3  Incinerator on base case line(s)
H-4  Waterborne
                                  7-61

-------
   Table 7-40  PLANT I  -  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION  OR
   Table   4U.  PLANl      RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL  FACILITIES
                                                 Control  options

                                             1-1       1-2       1-3
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)

Line(s)                                       90       210         0
Add-on control equipment                       0         0         u
Building                                      _JL      —i         £
Total capital costs                           90       211         0

Annual!zed capital costs                      12        28         0
Insurance, taxes and G&A                      JL        -|         %
Total annual i zed capital costs                16        Jo         u

OPERATING COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)

Direct labor                                    n          0         0
Maintenance labor                               n          o         0
Overhead                                        i          3         0
Maintenance materials                           '         m       n
Paint                                          2£        U>       o
Electricity                                    ,^        0         Q
Natural gas                                    •£-*•        -5          Q
Total  operating  costs                          "

TOTAL  ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)     39        40          °

Cost (savings)  per area covered
   ($/1000m2)                                867
 1-1  Fluidized bed
 1-2  Electrodeposition
 1-3  Waterborne
                                   7-62

-------
   Table 7-41.  PLANT J  -  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                         RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL FACILITIES
                                                 Control  options

                                 	      J-1

INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)

Line(s)                                                  0
Add-on control equipment                                 0
Building                                                 0.
Total capital costs                                      0

Annualized capital costs                                 0
Insurance, taxes and 6&A                                 0.
Total annualized capital costs   ,                        0

OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)

Direct labor                                             0
Maintenance labor                                        0
Overhead                                                 0
Maintenance materials                                    0
Paint                                                    0
Electricity                                              °
Natural gas                                              P_
Total operating costs                                    0

TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS  (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)                0

Cost (savings) per area covered
  ($/1000 m2)                                            0
J-1  Waterborne
                                  7-63

-------
Table 7-42.
              PLANT A r CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                        RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
                                         A-l
                                               Control options3

                                                A-2   A-3   A-4
A-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Addron control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual i zed capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
I U 1 1 1 IF
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 m2)
aA-l Powder
A- 2 Haterborne
A-3 70 percent high solids
A-4 Incinerator on base case line(s)
A-5 65 percent high solids

750
0
0
750
99
30
129

0
0
0
663b
(4)
(42)
628
757

189






500
0
207
707
87
28
Tf5

0
0
0
8
128
11
(20)
242

61




f f

180
0
0
180
24
7
31

0
0
0
(125)
(4)
(20)
0461
(115)

(29)




*ir

180
1f\f\
30
0
310
44
12
56

0
0
0
(39)
(4)
(15)
T531
(3)

1




1 f\ ™*^ nw*

180


180
24
7
31

0
0
0
(86)
(4)
(20)
0071
(76)

(19)




/o c m-;
     cost for powder is based  on  a film thickness of 6.35 x
However, at a film thickness of 3.81  x Krjcm  (1.5 mil) the
significantly (see Appendix E).
                                                          cost changes
                                7-64

-------
     Table  7-43.
PLANT B - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
          RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
                                             B-l
                                 Control  options3
                                 B-2   B-3   B-4
B-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annuali zed capital costs

1325
0
0

1325
174
53
227

900
0
210
1110
139
44
183

300
0
0

300
39
12
51

300
130
0

430
59
17
76

300
0
0

300
39
12
51
  OPERATING COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($  1000)

  Direct labor
  Maintenance labor
  Overhead
  Maintenance materials
  Paint
  Electricity
  Natural gas
  Total operating  costs

  TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)  639   371  (135)   12   (85)
0
0
0
20
,469 b
(7)
(70)
"412
0
0
0
14
188
19
(33
188
   Cost  (savings)  per  area  covered
     ($/1000 nf)
                            150     93    (34)     3    (21)
 B-l   Powder
 B-2   Waterborne
 B-3   70  percent  high solids
 B-4   Incinerator on base case line(s)
,B-5   65  percent  high solids
                                             -3.
bThis cost for powder is  based  on  a  film thickness of 6.35 x 10" cm (2.5 mil)
 However,  at a film thickness  of  3.81  x
 significantly (see Appendix E).
                      10"3cm (1.5 mil) the cost changes
                                     7-65

-------
     Table 7-44.  PLANT C - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                            RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
                                             C-l
Control optionsa

 C-2   C-3   C-4
C-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line (s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and 6&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 m2)
aC-l Powder
C-2 Waterborne
C-3 70 percent high solids
C-4 Incinerator on base case line(s)
C-5 65 percent high solids

250
0
0
250
39
10
49

0
0
0
4.
130b
(1)
Up)
123~
172

221






175
0
40
215
27
9
36

0
0
0
3
16
1
151
15
51

65




f ^ *^ r*

60
0
0
60
8
2
10

0
0
0
1
(24)
(1)
Jk
TvT)
(7)

(9)




<* r\ ~:

60
110
0
170
25
7
32

0
0
0
3
(7)
(1)
{4)
(9)
23

29




3.... /„

60
0
0
60
8
2
10

0
0
0
1
(17)
(1)
J51
(22)
(12)
(_ ._ V
15)





This cost for powder is based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10
However, at a film thickness of 3.81 x 10~3cm (1.5 mil)  the cost changes
significantly (see Appendix E).
                                    7-66

-------
    Table 7-45.   PLANT D -CONTROL  COSTS -FOR MODIFICATION  DR
                           RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED  FACILITIES
                                             D-'l
           Control options3
            D-2   D-3   D-4
D-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Bui 1 ding
Total capital costs
Annuali zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($71000 nf)
aD-l Powder
D-2 Waterborne
D-3 70 percent high solids
D-4 Incinerator on base case line(s)
D-5 65 percent high solids

260
0
0
260
34
10
44

0
0
0
4,
92 b
(D
HPJ
85
129

165






182
0
40
222
28
9
37

0
0
0
3
37
1
15}
36
73

94






60
0
0
60
8
2
10

0
0
0
1
(29)
(D
15J
(34)
(24)

(31)






60
no
0
170
25
7
32

0
0
0
3
(7)
(D
ID
(9)
23

29




3

60
0
0
60
8
2
10

0
0
0
1
(19)
(D
_L5J
(24)
(14)

(18)





                                                            10
However, at a film thickness of 3.81 x
significantly (see Appendix E),
10~3cm (1.5 mil)  the cost changes
                                    7-67

-------
     Table 7-46.   PLANT  E  - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                           RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
                                                   Control  options

                                                E-l    E-2    E-3   E-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
($/1000 nf)

90
0
0
90
11
4
15

0
0
0
7b
0
.(.41

19
422

55
0
2
57
7
2
9

0
0
0
1
0

0
9
200

5
0
0
5
1
0
1

0
0
0
(1)
If}
(3)
(2)
(44)

5

_
5
1
_
1

0


(1)

*• '
(2)
(44)
aE-l    Powder
 E-2    Waterborne
 E-3    70 percent high solids
.E-4    65 percent high solids                                   3
bThis cost for powder is based on a film thickness  of  6.35  x  10  cm  (2.5  mi I)
 However, at a film thickness of 3.81 x lO^cm (1.5 mil)  the  cost  changes
 significantly (see Appendix E).
                                     7-68

-------
      Table 7-47   PLANT F - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                             RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES

                                                   Control options3

                                                F-l   F-2   F-3   F-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered
(S/1000 mz)

100
0
0
100
13
4
17

0
0
0
2
5b
0
~r
20

444

70
0
2
72
9
3
12

0
0
0
1
4
1
(2)
4"
16

356

5
0
0
5
1
0
1

0
0
0
0
0
0
(2)
(2)
(1)

(22)

5
0
0
5
1
0
1

0
0
0
0
0
0
- (2)
/ — M. \
TZT
(i)

(22)
aF-l   Powder
 F-2   Waterborne
 F-3   70 percent high solids
 F-4  65 percent high solids                                    „
 This cost for powder is based on a film thickness of 6.35 x 10  cm (2.5 mil),
 However, at a film thickness of 3.81 x 10"3cm (1.5 mil) the cost changes
 significantly  (see Appendix E).
                                     7-69

-------
   Table  7-48.  PLANT G -  CONTROL  COSTS  FOR  MODIFICATION OR
                           RECONSTRUCTION OF  UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
Control
G-l G-2
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Bui Iding
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operatinq costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)
Cost (savings) per area covered

1040
0
1040
137
42
179

0
n

"
16
720
i
i

664
843
2,1

2500
126
2626
342
105
447

0
n
n
u
\
(117)
"V?

"ToTT

366
92
options
G-3 G-4

625
118
873
114
35
149

0
o
n

1 '
n
/ pQ ^
-^~cL

155
39

625
n
118
743
94
124

0
0
n

' '
0

:?8

162
41
G-l  Fluidized bed
G-2  Electrodeposition
G-3  Incinerator  on base case line(s)
G-4  Waterborne
                                    7-70

-------
    Table 7-49.   PLANT H - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                           RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
                                                  Control options

                                               H-l   H-2   H-3   H-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annualized capital costs
Insurance, taxes and G&A
Total annualized capital costs

210
0
0
210
28
8
36

550
0
354
904
107
36
143

125
no
22
257
35
10
45

125
0
22
147
18
6
24
  OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)

  Direct labor                                   0000
  Maintenance labor                              0000
  Overhead                                       0000
  Maintenance materials                          3822
  Paint                                         42    (19)    8     8
  Electricity                                    1800
  Natural gas                                   (11)    (5)    (3)    (5)
  Total operating costs                         35     (8)    7     5

  TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)     71    135     52     29

  Cost (savings) per area covered
     ($71000 nf)                                 91    173     67     37
H-l   Fluidized bed
H-2   Electrodeposition
H-3   Incinerator on base case line(s)
H-4   Waterborne
                                    7-71

-------
  Table 7-50   PLANT I  -  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                         RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES
                                                  Control options

                                   	1-1     1-2     1-3

  INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($ 1000)

  Line(s)                                         90     210      58
  Add-on control equipment                         000
  Building                                        _0     	1      _L
  Total capital  costs                             90     211      59

  Annual!zed capital costs                        12      28       8
  Insurance, taxes and G&A                        _4      _8      _2
  Total annualized capital costs   ,               16      36      10

  OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($ 1000)

  Direct labor                                     000
  Maintenance labor                                000
  Overhead                                         °      2       ?
  Maintenance materials                            1       3       ]
  Paint                                           25     0)     1
  Electricity                                      «      J       u
  Natural gas                                     \7/
  Total operating costs                           22

  TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS  (SAVINGS) ($1000)       38     39     10

  Cost (savings) per area covered
    ($/1000 nf)                                   844    867    222
1-1    Fluidized  bed
1-2    Electrodeposition
1-3    Waterborne
                                    7-72

-------
   Table  7-51.  PLANT J - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                          RECONSTRUCTION OF UNCONTROLLED FACILITIES


                                                   Control  options

 	J-l

  INSTALLED CAPITAL  COSTS  ($  1000)

  Line(s)                                                 58
  Add-on control equipment                                0
  Building                                                 ]
  Total capital  costs                                    "59
  Annualized capital costs                                8
  Insurance, taxes and  G&A                              _2
  Total annualized capital costs                          10

  OPERATING COSTS  (SAVINGS)  ($  1000)

  Direct labor                                          •   0
  Maintenance  labor                                        0
  Overhead                                                 0
  Maintenance materials.                                   1
  Paint                                                    1
  Electricity                                              0
  Natural gas                                             (2)
  Total operating costs                                    0

  TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS)  ($ 1000)               10

  Cost (savings) per area  covered
   ($/1000  nf)                                          222
0-1  Waterborne
                                   7-73

-------
addition of a thermal  incinerator to the curing oven exhaust.   All  other
costs associated with the change would be related to operating costs.
     There are also three options for dip coating lines which  would require
capital expenditures.   For the fluidized bed powder coating option  most of
the line would have to be replaced with the exception of the pretreatment
area.  Electrodeposition (EDP) requires a large capital investment  due to
the need for more pretreatment and the great expense of an EDP tank and
filtration system.  As with spray lines, the only capital expense associated
with the incineration option is the incinerator itself.
     The flow coating model plant has only one option which would require
no investment when switching from the base case.
7.3  OTHER COST CONSIDERATIONS
     This section deals with two subjects:  the costs borne by metal
furniture coating facilities in complying with current regulatory require-
ments and the impact of a New Source Performance Standard on state and
local regulatory enforcement agencies.
7.3.1  Water Treatment
     As explained in Chapter 6, metal furniture coating facilities  have a
limited potential to pollute water.  For economic reasons, water which is
used in the pretreatment section of the coating line and in the water wash
spray booths is recirculated with only make-up water being added, as needed,
due to evaporation.  One source of water pollution is clean-up water which
falls through process area drains.
     The overall cost of water treatment to the metal furniture coater is
minimal.  There is a possibility of a slight increase due to the use of
waterborne paint, however, this has no appreciable impact on the overall
cost of operation of a coating line.
7.3.2  Solid Waste Disposal
     Solid waste disposal which results from overspray in the application
area of a coating line must be collected and disposed of periodically.  As
with water treatment, these disposal costs are minimal.  The use of high
solids paint results in a more difficult clean-up, however, there is no
significant increase in the actual amount of solid waste which must be
disposed of.  Waterborne paints may create somewhat more solid waste however
the  increase is not significant.
                                  7-74

-------
7.3.3  OSHA Requirements
     Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) regulations for
metal furniture coating facilities specify air flow requirements through
spray booths in order to keep the VOC concentration below the threshold
limit value (TLV).  In addition, oven exhaust flow rates are regulated in
order to keep VOC concentrations below the lower explosive limit (LEL).
     Waterborne paints present a problem for spray coating facilities due
to the electrical shock potential.   Certain costs would be incurred in
providing proper insulation from such hazards.   These costs are also
included in the overall costs presented in Section 7.2.
7.3.4  Regulatory Agency Manpower Requirements
     The burden of enforcement of NSPS falls on state and local agencies.
In accordance with the Clean Air Act amendments of 1977, states are already
under obligation to propose, adopt, and enforce State Implementation Plans
for the reduction of VOC emissions.  Most of these SIPs include regulations
on emissions from metal furniture painting operations.   At least six states
have proposed a level  of permissible emissions of 0.36 kilograms of organic
solvent per liter of coating (3.0 pounds per gallon) at application.  These
states are highly industrialized, as are the states in which most metal
furniture manufacturers are located (see Section 2.1 and 7.1).   It is
expected that such states will  already have a regulatory framework for the
enforcement of state environmental  laws either previous to or as a result
of the Clean Air Act amendments.   In the event that the NSPS is less strict
than an existing state regulation,  the regulatory agency manpower impact
will be negligible.   In states where NSPS is stricter than the state
regulation the incremental  manpower requirements should be minimal.
7.4  ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT
7.4.1  Introduction and Summary
     7.4.1.1  Introduction.  This section analyzes the potential inhibiting
effects of NSPS controls on investment in new,  modified, and reconstructed
surface coating facilities  in the metal furniture industry.   Two measures
of potential impacts used in the analysis are changes to profit and capital
availability.
                                  7-75

-------
     As part of the  analysis,  several  basic  questions  are  addressed:
     •    Which of the control  options have  the  greatest impacts  upon  the
          i ndustry?
     •    How do impacts vary  from one type  of plant to another?
     •    How do impacts vary  by size  of plant?
     •    How might  the structure of the industry be affected by  the control
          options?
     •    What magnitude of industry-wide compliance costs might  be antici-
          pated?
     The analysis is divided into four major sections.  Section 7.4.2
establishes the general context for the analysis by covering the  subject of
industry expansion.   Section 7.4.3 summarizes the methodology used in the
analysis.  Section 7.4.4 discusses the results of the  analysis.  Finally,
Section 7.4.5 summarizes industry-wide compliance costs.  Aggregate effects
on industry structure, employment, inflation, and energy are analyzed in
Section 7.5.
     7.4.1.2  Summary.  The impact assessment was performed using a model
plant approach.  Ten model plants were employed.  Of this total,  three were
shelving plants, and seven were chair plants.  Shelves and chairs were
chosen to represent the flat and complex surfaces that would be coated.
The characteristics of the plants in terms of size and coating method used
are given in Tables 7-52 and 7-53.
     All of the shelving plants are spray-coating operations, while the
chair plants are divided between spray coating, dip coating, and flow
coating operations.   Only one model plant (Plant J) is  used for flow
coating.
     The  impact analysis was performed for both new and modified/reconstructed
facilities, and compared estimated profit and capital  availability  after
NSPS controls  to both  SIP and uncontrolled baseline.
     The potential of  the control options for reducing  plant profits was
examined  using a  form  of "worst  case" analysis which  assumed that  incremental
annualized  control costs would be fully  absorbed by the model  plants.  The
analysis  indicated major profit  reduction for all  shelving plants  (Plants
A, C,  and E)  for  the  powder options.  (A "major" impact is defined  as  an
                                   7-76

-------
                       Table 7-52.  MODEL SHELVING PLANTS
Plant
 Size
Area coated per year
Coating method
  A
  C
  E
Large
Medium
Small
  4,000,000 m2
    780,000 m2
     45,000 m2
   Spray
   Spray
   Spray
                       Table 7-53.   MODEL CHAIR PLANTS
Plant
B
D
F
G
H
I
J
Size
Large
Medium
Small
Large
Medium
Small
Small
Area coated per year
4,000,000 m2
780,000 m2
45,000 m2
4,000,000 m2
780,000 m2
45,000 m2
45,000 m2
Coating method
Spray
Spray
Spray
Dip
Dip
Dip
Flow
                                   7-77

-------
impact which can result in a decision not to invest in a new source.)
However, based upon data presented in Appendix E, this is not true if
powder is applied at film thickness of 3.81 x 10"3cm (1.5 mil) or less.   In
the case of Plant A, major profit reductions were exhibited for modified/
reconstructed facilities relative to both the SIP and uncontrolled baselines.
For Plants C and E, major impacts were indicated for both new and modified/
reconstructed facilities, relative to both baselines.   (A profit reduction
of 15 percent or more was determined as constituting a "major" impact.  The
rationale for this criterion is developed in Section 7.4.3.3.)  Plant E,
the smallest shelving plant, was also found to be subject to major impact
by the waterborne options for new facilities relative to the SIP baseline,
and for modified/reconstructed facilities relative to both baselines.  In
the case of the 70 percent high solids options, none of the shelving plants
were subject to major impacts - in fact, profits in all situations were
either favorably affected or not affected at all.  The results were similar
for the 65 percent  high solids option.  For incineration with RACT coating,
profit reductions were relatively small (largest reduction was 2.79 percent).
A summary of the major impacts is given in Table 7-54.
     Of the seven chair plants, Plant I (small dip-coating plant) was the
only one found to be subject to major profit impacts.   These impacts were
associated with the powder and electrodeposition control options.  In the
case of powder, the major impacts were exhibited for modified/ reconstructed
facilities relative to both the SIP and uncontrolled baselines.   For electro-
deposition, major profit reductions were indicated for both new and modified/
reconstructed facilities relative to both baselines.   Among all  of the
chair plants, no profit reduction was associated with the 70 percent and
65 percent high solids options.  For incineration with RACT coating, the
largest impact was relatively minor (only 2.56 percent).  With respect to
waterborne, the greatest profit reduction was 8.60 percent.   A summary of
the major impacts is given in Table 7-55.
     In general, for both shelves and chairs, it was found that the severity
of profit reduction associated with a given control  option tends to vary
inversely with the size of the plant.   Thus, in a situation where two
plants of unequal size employ the same control option, the smaller is
likely to be at a competitive disadvantage relative  to the larger.
                                  7-78

-------
                     Table 7-54  SUMMARY OF MAJOR IMPACTSa

                                SHELVING PLANTS
Plant
A
Large
Spray
o
Control
Option
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Profit impact
Modified/
New Reconstruc.
SIP Uncon SIP Uncon.
X X
Capital availability impact
Modified/
New Reconstruc.
SIP Uncon. SIP Uncon.

       Waterborne
Medium 70% High solids
Spray  Incinerator &
         RACT coating
       65% High solids

  E    Powder (spray)
       Waterborne
Small  70% High solids
Spray  65% High solids
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
a"X" indicates major impact.

NOTE:  Under each of the impact headings in the table, a distinction is made between
       new facilities and modified/reconstructed facilities.  In turn, within each
       of these categories of facilities, a further distinction is made between
       impacts relative to the SIP baseline, and those relative to the uncontrolled
       baseline.
 This is not the case for powder applied at a
 (1.5 mil) or less (see Appendix E).
                film thickness of 3.81 x
                             10"3cm
                                         7-79

-------
              Table 7-55.   SUMMARY OF MAJOR IMPACTS9 CHAIR PLANTS
Plant
B
Large
Spray
Control
Option
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Profit impact
Modified/
New Reconstruc.
SIP Uncon SIP Uncon.

Capital avai
New
SIP Uncon.

lability impact
Modified/
Reconstruc.
SIP Uncon

  D    Powder (spray)
       Waterborne
Medium 70% High solids
Spray  Incinerator &
         RACT coating
       65% High solids

  F    Powder (spray)
       Waterborne
Small  70% High solids
Spray  65% High solids
Large
Dip
  H
       Powder (fid.bed)
       Electrodepositi on
       Incinerator &
         RACT coating
       Waterborne(conv.)
       Powder(fid.bed)
       Electrodeposition
Medium Incinerator &
Dip      RACT coating
       Waterborne(conv.)
  I
Small
Dip

  J
Small
Flow
       Powder(fid.bed)
       Electrodeposition
       Waterborne(conv.)

       Waterborne
x
x
x
x
a"X" indicates major impact.

NOTE:  Under each of the impact headings  in the table, a distinction  is made  between
       new facilities and modified/reconstructed facilities.   In turn, within each
       of these categories of facilities, a further distinction is made between
       impacts relative to the SIP baseline, and those relative to the uncontrolled
       baseline.
                                     7-80

-------
     In analyzing the effects of the control options on capital availability,
associated increases in capital requirements of 10 percent or more were
considered to be major.  (The rationale for this criterion is developed in
Section 7.4.4.4.)  For shelving, the smallest plant (Plant E) was subject
to major impact by the waterborne options and by powder (spray) if applied
            -3
at 6.35 x 10  cm (2.5 mil).   In both situations, this was for modified/
reconstructed facilities relative to both baselines.  For chairs, the small
dip-coating plant (Plant I) was subject to major impact by electrodeposition
for new facilities relative to the uncontrolled baseline, and for modified/
reconstructed facilities relative to both baselines.  Again for any given
control option, the magnitude of impacts tended to vary inversely with
plant size.  The phenomenon is especially pronounced with Plants E and I.
     Based on the results obtained in the analyses of profit reduction and
capital availability, another analysis was performed to assess differentials
in impacts between the smallest and largest plants producing the same
product for each of the control options.  In virtually all cases, for both
profit reduction and capital availability, the impact for the smallest
plant was found to be greater than the impact for the largest plant.   In
several cases, the differences in impacts were large.  For example, in
comparing Plant I (small dip-coating plant) with Plant G (large dip-coating
plant) with regard to the electrodeposition option, the following types of
differences were found for the modified/reconstructed facilities - SIP
baseline combination:

     Profit reduction:

       Plant I:          17.29 percent
       Plant G:           1.88 percent
       Difference:       15.41 percent

     Capital availability:

       Plant I:           7.98 percent
       Plant G:           1.13 percent
       Difference:        6.85 percent
                                  7-81

-------
These differences underscore the fact that Plant I is clearly disadvantaged
relative to its larger dip-coating competitors.  As Table 7-55 shows,
Plant I is already subject to major profit impacts for powder and electro-
deposition, and major capital availability impacts for electrodeposition.
Waterborne is the only control option available to Plant I which is not
connected with some form of major impact.
     With regard to the case of shelving plants, one effect of the major
impacts (either profit or capital availability) is that either small shelving
plants would be built or reconstructed having fewer control options available,
or that the tendency would be to build or modify/reconstruct larger shelving
plants.   Similarly, new small dip-coating plants (like Plant I) would have
only one control option available, or the tendency would be to build or
reconstruct larger dip-coating plants.
     It should be noted that even in situations where major impacts are not
involved, the existence of large differentials are likely to lead to shifts
within the size distribution of plants towards greater proportional
representation by larger plants.
     In summary, as Tables 7-54 and 7-55 show, the powder options (spray
and fluidized bed) cause major impacts for four of the model plants (A, C,
E, and I).   However, this is only true if powder is applied at a film
thickness of 6.35 x 10"3 cm (2.5 mil) or greater (see Appendix E).   In only
one case (Plant I) does electrodeposition cause major impacts.   Likewise,
waterborne cause major impacts only in the case of Plant E.  No major
impacts are associated with the other control options.
     In order to provide an estimate of the range over which industrywide
compliance costs might vary, cost calculations were carried out for four of
the various combinations of control options that might be employed.  The
combinations are as follows:
     t  Combination #1
        Spray-coating plants:  all six types of plants (A-F) use 70 percent
                               high solids.
        Dip-coating plants:     all three types of plants (G, H, I) use
                               conventional waterborne.
        Flow-coating plants:   the one type of plant (J) uses waterborne.
                                  7-82

-------
     •  Combination #2
        Spray-coating plants:
        Dip-coating plants:

        Flow-coating plants:
     •  Combination #3
        Spray-coating plants:
        Dip-coating plants:
        Flow-coating plants:
        Combination #4
                               all six types of plants (A-F) use powder.
                               all three types of plants (G, H, I) use
                               electrodepos i ti on.
                               the one type of plant (J) uses waterborne.

                               four types of plants (A-D) use incinerator
                               with RACT coating,  the other two types of
                               plants (E & F) use waterborne.
                               all three types of plants (G, H, I) use
                               conventional waterborne.

                               the one type of plant (J) uses waterborne.
        Dip-coating plants:

        Flow-coating plants:
        Spray-coating plants:   all six types of plants (A-F) use 70 percent
                               high solids, powder, and waterborne
                               (options equally represented).
                               all three types of plants (G, H, I) use
                               conventional waterborne.
                               the one type of plant (J) uses waterborne.
Through the use of a methodology described in Section 7.4.5, industrywide
incremental annualized control costs (relative to the SIP baseline) were
estimated for each of the above combinations of control options, with the
estimations being based upon the number of new and replacement coating
lines projected for 1985 (as presented in Section 7.1.5.3).   The costs are
as follows:
Combination #1:
Combination #2:
Combination #3:
Combination #4:
                         From Tables 7-78,
                          7-79. and 7-80
                          ($14.7 million)
                          $126 million
                          $17.6 million
                                  i
                          $54.8 million
From Tables 7-78, E-8,
and E-9 of Appendix E
    ($18 million)
    ($1.7 million)
    $17 million
    $11 million
                                  7-83

-------
At $126 million, Combination #2 is by far the most costly of the four,  and
exceeds by $26 million the threshold for a Significant Action Analysis  (as
articulated in Executive Order 12044).   However,  costs associated with
Combination #2 change significantly if powder is  applied at film thicknesses
of 3.81 x 10"3cm (1.5 mil) or less (see Appendix  E).
7.4.2  Industry Expansion
     A detailed profile of the metal furniture industry has been presented
in Section 7.1 of this document.   This section builds upon that material
and presents an examination of factors which will have an important bearing
upon the future expansion of the industry.   The purpose of the discussion
is to provide baseline context for the impact analysis which follows in
Section 7.4.4.
     This section is divided into two parts, one  dealing with the household
furniture component of the industry (SIC 2514), and the other with the
business and institutional furniture component (comprised of SIC groups
2522, 2531, and 2542).
     7.4.2.1  Metal Household Furniture.  The metal household furniture
industry (SIC 2514) is comprised of nearly 400 establishments.24  Major
products of the industry include:  indoor dining, dinette, and breakfast
furniture; porch, lawn, outdoor,  and casual seating and tables; kitchen
cabinets and stools; bed frames;  medicine cabinets; and infants' furniture.
     Demand.  As discussed in Section 7.1.5.1, it is anticipated that
between now and 1985, shipments of metal household furniture will exhibit a
pattern of no growth through 1980, followed by growth on the order of one
percent per year through 1985.
     Looking at the growth potential of particular product areas, it appears
likely that the fastest growth will occur in the  area of summer and casual
furniture.   Two basic reasons for this expectation are the trend towards
increasingly casual lifestyles, and the relatively low prices charged for
this type of furniture.
     There are several critical factors underlying the overall demand for
metal househould furniture.  These include:  demographic trends influencing
the rate of new household formation; disposable personal income and consumer
spending on durable goods; housing starts and sales; interest rates; consumer
confidence; and, outstanding consumer installment debt.
                                  7-84

-------
     Due to a lack of quantitative studies on the subject, nothing definite
can be said about the price elasticity of demand for metal household furni-
ture.   On the basis of economic principles, however, one might expect that
the elasticity could vary somewhat from one type of metal household furniture
to another.   Generally speaking, the more substitutes a particular type of
furniture has, and the higher its price, the greater will tend to be the
price elasticity of demand.  Variation is also possible within a given type
of furniture -- i.e., the price elasticity of demand for the product of one
manufacturer may differ from the elasticity for the product of another
manufacturer.
     From the standpoint of the impact analysis which follows, price
elasticity of demand is an important factor in two respects.   First, the
extent to which a firm can pass through incremental control costs to the
consumer is reflective of the price elasticity of demand for the particular
product which the firm manufactures.  If the demand for the firm's product
is inelastic, the firm may be able to pass through much or all of the
incremental  costs to the consumer.  The extent to which this is possible
would depend upon intra-industry competitive factors.  Locational considera-
tions would be most important in this regard.   If the demand for the firm's
product tends to be elastic, the potential for cost pass-through is reduced.
     The second reason why price elasticity of demand is important to the
impact analysis is that it has a major bearing on the inflationary effects
of NSPS regulations.   If the demand for metal  household furniture tended to
be inelastic with respect to price increases,  the inflationary impact upon
the economy would be greater than if the demand were elastic (since price
increases would be resisted in the latter situation).
     According to a U.S.  Department of Commerce representative, price has
not been a critical factor in demand for metal furniture versus furniture
of other materials.  One reason given is that in the past, metal household
furniture price increases have been consistent with price increases for
household furniture made from other materials.  Another is that the general
state of the economy is typically a more important factor in demand shifts
..                    25
than price increases.
     Supply.  The metal household furniture industry is characterized by
diversification and a small business orientation.  In 1976, the industry
                                  7-85

-------
had 391 establishments and employed approximately 31,000 workers, with
                                 26
shipments valued at $992 million.    Vertical integration is not common
within the industry.  The majority of firms purchase raw materials and
other inputs from external sources, and are not forwardly integrated into
marketing.
     According to a trade association representative, the future size
distribution of firms within the industry will consist predominately of
large and small firms, with the number of medium-sized companies substan-
tially reduced.   Small firms will continue to exist because of the ease of
entry characteristic of certain types of metal household furniture manufac-
ture (for example, the capital requirements of the manufacture of tubular
aluminum  lawn  furniture are relatively modest) and transportation cost
advantages stemming from plant location near  retail markets.
     As discussed in Section 7.1.1.3, the actual rate of capacity utilization
in the metal household furniture industry was perhaps less than 70 percent
in 1977.  Given this level of utilization and the anticipated demand trends
discussed above, it would appear that no additional capacity will be needed
until after 1980.
     7.4.2.2   Business and Institutional Furniture.  The business and
institutional  component of the metal furniture industry is comprised of
three SIC groups:   SIC 2522 (metal office furniture); SIC 2531 (public
building  and related furniture); and SIC 2542 (metal partitions and fix-
tures).   Major products of the office furniture component include chairs,
desks, filing  and storage cabinets, and panel systems.  The public building
and  related component produces items such as  benches, bleacher seating,
folding chairs, and seating for  automobiles  and public conveyances.  The
metal partitions and fixtures component produces items including  room
dividers, shelves,  lockers, and  storage bins.
     Demand.   In recent years, the business  and  institutional furniture
industry  (including both  wood and  metal furniture)  has enjoyed a  steady
growth  in demand.   As mentioned  in Section 7.1.2.4,  following a  substantial
upturn  in 1976, shipments of  business and  institutional  furniture in constant
dollars continued to  increase through 1977 and 1978.  The trend  is expected
to continue at least through  the near future.  According to the  Business
                                   7-86

-------
and Institutional  Furniture Manufacturers'  Association (BIFMA), the market
is likely to remain strong, given the general trend towards increasing
construction of commercial office buildings in many cities across the
        2
country.    Superimposed upon this general trend, however, are the high
interest rates which have resulted from the federal government's efforts to
strengthen the dollar.   These rates will probably have a dampening effect
upon the rate of new office building construction.   In the opinion of
BIFMA, however, this impact may be partially offset by increased demands
for remodeled facilities since there still  appears to be a shortage of
office space.  As discussed earlier in Section 7.1.5.1, the anticipated
annual growth rates for demand through 1985 are four percent for metal
office furniture,  two percent for the public building component, and seven
percent for the metal partition component.
     By all indications, the industry's growth potential is greatest in the
area of panel systems.   A recent development, such systems are modular
units containing panels, desks or work surfaces, files, and storage
accessories.  One study projects growth in value of shipments through 1990
at 16.4 percent on a current dollar basis.
     The factors underlying the demand for business and institutional
furniture are varied.  In the case of office furniture for example, some of
the more important factors include:  construction of new office buildings
and renovation of existing facilities; growth of the white collar work
force; prospects for replacement of old furniture; and concern over the
quality of the white collar working environment.
     As was the case with metal household furniture, there are no quantita-
tive studies available on the price elasticity of demand for business and
institutional furniture.  No definite statement can therefore be made as to
whether demand tends to be elastic or inelastic.  It would seem, however,
that purchases of business and institutional furniture tend to be influenced
more by factors relating to operational necessity and general business and
economic conditions rather than changes in price.  The implications of
price elasticity with respect to cost pass through and inflation are the
same as those discussed above in connection with metal household furniture.
     The price cross-elasticity of demand for metal office furniture is
relatively low with respect to office furniture made from other materials
                                  7-87

-------
(mainly wood).   According to a BIFMA representative, consumers do not
choose between metal and wood business and institutional  furniture on the
basis of price alone.   Design and material itself are critical relative
demand factors.  Wood is a prestige item, valued for its  rich appearance,
and tends to be purchased for upper level management only.   Although
substitution may take place if there are supply shortages,  the markets for
wood and metal business and institutional furniture are essentially segmented.
     Supply.  In 1976, there were 1,003 manufacturing establishments in the
business and institutional component of the metal furniture industry.  The
breakdown was as follows:  metal office furniture (SIC 2522), 177; public
building and related furniture (SIC 2531), 377; and metal partitions and
fixtures (SIC 2542), 449.  Together, the three SIC groups employed
                                                                              24
approximately 68,000 workers and had shipments valued at nearly $2.7 billion.
     Of the three industry groups, metal office furniture (SIC 2522) is by
far the most concentrated.  In 1972, 37 percent of the value  of shipments
for the metal office furniture component was accounted for by the four
largest companies.   The comparable figures for the public building and
related component and the metal partitions and fixtures component were  18
percent and 13 percent, respectively.  The metal  office furniture component
is also much more heavily weighted towards multi-plant firms  than are the
other  two  components.   Census data show  that in 1972, 83 percent  of  the
value  of shipments  for  the metal office  furniture component was accounted
for by multi-plant  companies.  The comparable  figures for the public building
                                                                              27
and metal  partitions components were  56  percent and 58 percent,  respectively.
     Vertical  integration  is  not widespread  in any  of the three  industry
groups.  Raw materials  and  other  inputs  tend to be  obtained  largely  from
external sources, and only  the  largest companies  are forwardly integrated
into marketing.   Distribution to  end  users is  generally  accomplished through
local  dealers  who handle  the  products of a number of different manufacturers.
     The business and  institutional  furniture  industry is currently  stable.
There  have been  few entries  or  exits  of  firms.
     According to BIFMA,  manufacturers of business  and institutional furniture
                                             29
have  been  operating at  near capacity  levels.     Additional  capacity  is  now
required  not  only to meet anticipated growth  in  demand,  but  to also  create
                                   7-88

-------
a sufficient buffer.  No serious production bottlenecks  are anticipated,
however, supply is expected to keep up with demand.   It is likely that much
of the new capacity in the industry will be devoted to the manufacture of
panel systems.
7.4.3  Methodology
     This section presents a summary of the steps and procedures used in
assessing the potential impacts of the control options at the level of the
individual plant.
     The assessment was performed using a model plant approach, in which
ten different model plants were subjected to analysis.   Details of these
plants are given in Table 7-56.  Three of the model  plants are shelving
plants, while the other seven are chair plants.  Shelves and chairs were
chosen to represent the flat and complex surfaces that would be coated.
Plant size is expressed in terms of surface area coated per year and the
                                                                      2
equivalent number of shelves or chairs (assuming coated areas of 1.0 m  for
                   2
shelves, and 0.33 m  for chairs).   The shelving plants are of three different
sizes.  All, however,  are spray-coating operations.   The chair plants are
differentiated in terms of both size and coating method.  Three types of
coating methods are represented:   spray, dip, and flow.   The spray and dip
categories are each represented by three different sizes of plants.  There
is only one plant for  the flow category.
     The analysis examines impacts on both new facilities and modified/
reconstructed facilities.   Within each of these categories of facilities,
the impacts are measured relative to both an SIP baseline and an "uncon-
trolled" baseline.   As discussed in Chapter 5, a total  of six different
control options are considered.
     Two types of impacts are examined in the analysis:
     •  Profit impairment
     •  Adverse effects upon capital availability.
The methodologies used in examining these impacts are described fully in
Sections 7.4.4.3 and 7.4.4.4, and need not be detailed at this point.   A
few words are in order, however.   In the analysis of profit impairment,  the
objective is to determine the extent to which the profits of the model
plants would be reduced under the various NSPS control  options.  To simplify
                                  7-89

-------
Table 7-56.  MODEL SHELVING AND CHAIR PLANTS
Plant
A
C
E
Plant
B
D
F
G
H
I
J
Coating
method
Spray
Spray
Spray
Coating
method
Spray
Spray
Spray
Dip
Dip
Dip
Flow
Shelving
Area coated
per year
(sq. meters)
4,000,000
780,000
45,000
Chair
Area coated
per year
(sq. meters)
4,000,000
780,000
45,000
4,000,000
780,000
45,000
45,000
Plants:
No. of shelves
coated per year
4,000,000
780,000
45,000
Plants:
No. of chairs
coated per year
12,000,000
1,181,800
136,360
12,000,000
1,181,800
136,360
136,360
Correspondi ng
SIC group
2522
2514,2522,2531,
2514,2522,2531,
Corresponding
SIC group
2522
2514,2522,2531
2514,2522,2531
2522
2514,2522,2531
2514,2522,2531
2514,2522,2531


2542
2542


,2542
,2542

,2542
,2542
,2542
                   7-90

-------
the analysis, the impacts are examined using a "worst case" approach which
assumes that incremental annualized control costs are fully absorbed by the
plants.  In evaluating the impacts, a profit reduction of 15 percent or
more is judged to be a major impact.  (The derivation of this criterion is
discussed in Section 7.4.4.3.)  A "major" impact is here defined as an
impact which could result in a decision not to invest in a new source.
     In the analysis of capital availability, effort focuses on determining
the extent to which the capital requirements of the model plants would be
increased under the various control options.  For purposes of evaluation,
increases in capital requirements of 10 percent or more are considered to
be major.  (The derivation of this criterion is discussed in Section 7.4.4.4.)
     Based on results obtained from the analyses of profit reduction and
capital availability, another analysis is performed to assess differentials
in impacts between the smallest and largest plants producing the same
product for each of the control options.   The discussion is presented in
Section 7.4.4.5.
7.4.4  Plant-Level Impact Analysis
     7.4.4.1  Product Price Determination.  One of the basic preliminary
steps in the model plant analysis was that of determining prices for the
shelves and chairs manufactured by the model plants.
     Two types of prices were determined - F.O.B.  (i.e.  producer price at
the plant) and retail list.   In the sections which follow, the F.O.B.
prices are used in estimating model plant revenues, and determining the
extent of profit impairment associated with the various control  options.
The retail  list prices are used in measuring the inflationary impacts of
the control  options.
     Shelves.   The shelf size assumed for the model plant is 1.2 m x 0.5 m,
or approximately 4'  x 20".   The surface coating area is approximately one
square meter.
     The F.O.B.  and retail  list prices for shelving of this size were
                                                                        OQ
developed from information contained in the GSA Federal  Supply Schedule.
On the basis of an examination of three different sets of prices contained
in the Schedule,  a representative F.O.B.  price of $25.55 was developed.
Given this F.O.B.  price, a retail list price of $38.33 was derived by
                                  7-91

-------
assuming a markup of 50 percent.   This markup was determined as being
representative on the basis of industry information.
     Chairs.   The type of chair assumed for the model  plants is a stackable
stationary (i.e., not a swivel or rolling model) office chair with arms.
Only the frame, and not the seat or back, is assumed to be painted.   The
surface coating area is 0.33 square meters.
     Prices were determined from a survey of retail prices as presented in
office furniture catalogues.  Only chairs having roughly the same surface
coating requirements as those specified in the model plant parameters were
considered.  In all, 21 different prices were obtained.  The price of
$52.50 was the representative mean.  An F.O.B. price of $35.00 was obtained
by assuming that the retail list price represented a 50 percent markup.
     7.4.4.2  Comparison of Per-Unit-Of-Product Costs for Control Options.
As pointed out in Section 7.4.3, six types of control options are considered
in the analysis.  In this section, the costs of these options are compared
on a per-unit-of-product basis (i.e., per  shelf or chair).  The comparisons
are intended to provide a frame of reference for the impact analyses which
follow.  The cost data are  presented  in Tables 7-57 to 7-64.  The data are
in  incremental form, and express additional  costs  or savings per  shelf or
chair  relative to the  baseline (SIP or uncontrolled).  The  data were derived
from the  control costs presented  in Section  7.2, by dividing the  total
incremental annualized costs  for each model  plant  by the  number of  items
coated per year  (as obtained  from  Chapter  5).   The shelves  and chairs  are
the same  as those  defined  in  Section  7.4.4.1.
     Cost for shelving plants.   Powder  (spray)  applied at a film  thickness
of  6.35 x I0"3cm (2.5  mil)  is the  most  expensive of the control  options,
with incremental  costs per shelf ranging from $.17 to  $.49.   However,  at a
 film thickness of  3.81 x 10"3cm (1.5  mil)  the incremental costs change
 significantly (see Appendix E).   This is followed by waterborne,  for which
 figures vary  from $.06 to $.27.   In the case of the 70 percent high solids
 control option,  cost savings  are experienced in all of the situations
 except one,  in which there is no change in cost from the baseline case.
 The costs for incineration plus RACT coating are relatively low,  and in two
 situations (involving Plants A and E) cost savings are experienced.  With
                                   7-92

-------
                           Table  7-57.   PROFIT IMPACT

                        SHELVING  PLANTS -  NEW FACILITIES

                                  SIP BASELINE
Plant
A





C





E



Incremental
annualized
Control control cost9
Option ($000)
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder ( spray ).
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
735
298
(86)

36
(47)
149
59
(17)

24
(10)
12
9
0
0
# Shelves
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000

4000
4000
780
780
780

780
780
45
45
45
45
Incremental
annualized
control cost
per shelf
coated3 ($)
.18
.07
(.02)

.01
(-01)
.19
.08
(.02)

.03
(.01)
.27
.20
c
c
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per shelf ($) $
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
.70
.27
d

.04
d
.74
.31
d

.12
d
1.06
.78
d
d
^Parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
 The profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on
 data presented in Appendix E.
jNo change in cost from baseline case.
 No negative impact on profit margin.
                                         7-93

-------
                          Table 7-58.  PROFIT IMPACT

                       SHELVING PLANTS - NEW FACILITIES

                             UNCONTROLLED BASELINE
Plant
A





C




E



Incremental
annuali zed
Control control costa
Option ($000)
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
670
233
(151)

(29)
(112)
137
47
(29)

12
(22)
9
6
(3)
(3)
# Shelves
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000

4000
4000
780
780
780

780
780
45
45
45
45
Incremental
annual i zed
control cost
per shelf
coateda ($)
.17
.06
(.04)

(.01)
(.03)
.18
.06
(.04)

.02
(.03)
.20
.13
(.07)
(.07)
Profit margin
F.O.B. price
per shelf ($)
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
impact
%
.67
.23
c

c
c
.70
.23
c

.08
c
.78
.51
c
c
^Parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
DThe profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on
 data presented in Appendix E.
SNO change in cost from baseline case.
 No negative impact on profit margin.
                                          7-94

-------
                           Table 7-59.  PROFIT IMPACT

               SHELVING PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES

                                   SIP BASELINE
Plant
A





C





E



Incremental
annual ized
Control control cost9
Option ($000)
Powder (spray) ^
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator 8
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray) °
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
820
305
(86)

30
(47)
185
64
(17)

24
(10)
22
12
0
0
# Shelves
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000

4000
4000
780
780
780

780
780
45
45
45
45
Incremental
annual ized
control cost
per shelf
coated9 ($)
.21
.08
(.02)

.01
(.01)
.24
.08
(.02)

.03
(.01)
.49
.27
c
c
Profit margi
n impact
F.O.B. price
per shelf ($) %
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
.82
.31
d

.04
d
.94
.31
d

.12
d
1.92
1.06
d
d
aParentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
bThe profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on data
 presented in Appendix E.
GNo change in cost from baseline case.
    negative impact on profit margin.
                                         7-95

-------
                          Table 7-60.  PROFIT IMPACT

              SHELVING PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES

                            UNCONTROLLED BASELINE
Plant
A



C



E

Incremental
annual ized
Control control cost8
Option ($000)
Powder (spray) b
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray) b
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray) b
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
757
242
(115)

(3)
(76)
172
51
(7)

23
(12)
19
9
(2)
(2)
# Shelves.
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000

4000
4000
780
780
780

780
780
45
45
45
45
Incremental
annual ized
control cost
per shelf
coated9 ($)
.19
.06
(.03)

d
(.02)
.22
.07
(.01)

.03
(.02)
.42
.20
(.04)
(.04)
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per shelf ($) %
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
.74
.23
c

c
c
.86
.27
c

.12
c
1.64
.78
c
c
^Parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
 The profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on data
 presented in Appendix E.
SNO change in cost from baseline case.
 No negative impact on profit margin.
                                         7-96

-------
 Table 7-61.  PROFIT IMPACT



CHAIR PLANTS - NEW FACILITIES



         SIP BASELINE
Incremental
Incremental annual ized
annuali zed # Chairs control cost
Control control cost9 coated per chair
Plant Option ($000) (000) coated^ ($)
B





D





F



G




H




Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Elect rodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
565
433
(115)

31
(65)
113
85
(22)

25
(12)
10
16
0
0
667
335

30
38
27
86

24
8
12,000
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
136
136
136
136
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
.05
.04
(.01)


(.01)
.10
.07
(.02)

.02
(.01)
.07
.12
c
c
.06
.03

e
e
.02
.07

.02
.01
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per chair ($)
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
%
.14
.11
d

.01
d
.29
.20
d

.06
d
.20
.34
d
d
.17
.09

.01
.01
.06
.20

.06
.03
            7-97

-------
                           Table  7-61.   PROFIT IMPACT

                          CHAIR PLANTS  - NEW  FACILITIES

                                   SIP  BASELINE

                                    (Continued)
Plant
Control
Option
 Incremental
 annualized
control cost3
   ($000)
           Incremental
           annual ized
# Chairs  control  cost  Profit margin impact
coated      per chair   F.O.B. price
 (OOP)     coated3 ($)   per chair ($)    %
  I  Powder (Fid. Bd.)        18
     Electrodeposition        33
     Waterborne (Convent.)     0

  J  Waterborne                0
                                  136
                                  136
                                  136

                                  136
                               .13
                               .24
                                b
                            35.00
                            35.00
                            35.00

                            35.00
.37
.69
 c
   .Parentheses  indicate decrease from baseline case.
   The profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on data
   presented in Appendix E.
   SNO change in cost from  baseline case.
   No negative  impact on profit margin.
   eLess  than $.01.
                                          7-98

-------
 Table 7-62.   PROFIT IMPACT



CHAIR PLANTS  - NEW FACILITIES



    UNCONTROLLED BASELINE
Incremental
annual ized # Chairs
Control control costa coated
Plant Option ($000) (000)
B





D





F


G



H



Powder (spray) ^
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray) b
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
486
354
(194)

(48)
(144)
101
73
(34)

13
(24)
8
14
(2)
(2)
790
458

153
161
54
113

51
35
12,000
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
136
136
136
136
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
incremental
annual ized
control cost
per chair
coateda ($)
.04
.03
(-02)

c
(.01)
.09
.06
(.03)

.01
(.02)
.06
.10
(.01)
(.01)
.07
.04

.01
.01
.05
.10

.04
.03
Profit margi
F.O.B. price
per chair ($
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35 00
\S\s • \J \J
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
n impact
) %
1 1
• J. J.
no
• \J 3
d

d
U
d
?fi
. L.U
.17
• i /
d

.03
» V w>
d
1 7
• -L /
.29
• (_ — '
d
d
?n
• cu
.11

.03
.03
.14
• A r
.29

.11
.09
           7-99

-------
                           Table  7-62.   PROFIT IMPACT

                          CHAIR PLANTS  - NEW  FACILITIES

                              UNCONTROLLED  BASELINE

                                    (Continued)
Plant
Control
Option
 Incremental
 annualized
control costs
   ($000)
# Chairs
coated
 (OOP)
 Incremental
 annualized
control  cost
  per chair
 coated9 ($)
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per chair ($)    %
  I  Powder (Fid.  Bd.)        28
     Electrodeposition        43
     Waterborne (Convent.)     10

  J  Waterborne               10
                                  136
                                  136
                                  136

                                  136
                               .21
                               .32
                               .07

                               .07
                            35.00
                            35.00
                            35.00

                            35.00
                              .60
                              .91
                              .20

                              .20
  parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
   The profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on data
   presented in Appendix E.
   .Decrease less than $.01.
   No negative impact on profit margin.
                                         7-100

-------
           Table 7-63.  PROFIT IMPACT



CHAIR PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES



                   SIP BASELINE
Incremental
Incremental annual ized
annual ized # Chairs control cost
Control control cost9 coated per chair
Plant Option ($000) (000) coateda ($)
B





D





F



G




H




Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder ( spray )b
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)'3
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
El ect rodepos i t i on
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
715
447
(115)

33
(65)
144
86
(22)

24
(12)
22
18
0
0
853
376

32
37
68
132

.17
8
12,000
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
136
136
136
136
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
.06
.04
(.01)

e
(.01)
.12
.07
(.02)

.02
(.01)
.16
.13
c
c
.07
.03

e
e
.06
.11

.01
.01
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per chair ($)
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
%
.17
.11
d

.01
d
.34
.20
d

.06
d
.46
.37
d
d
.20
.09

.01
.01
.17
.31

.03
.03
                      7-101

-------
                           Table 7-63.   PROFIT IMPACT

               CHAIR PLANTS -  MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED  FACILITIES

                                   SIP  BASELINE

                                    (Continued)
Plant
Control
Option
 Incremental
 annualized
control  cost3
   ($000)
# Chairs
coated
 (OOP)
 Incremental
 annualized
control  cost
  per chair
 coateda  ($)
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per chair ($)    %
  I  Powder (Fid. Bo1.)        39
     Electrodeposition        40
     Waterborne (Convent.)     0

  J  Waterborne                0
                                  136
                                  136
                                  136

                                  136
                               .29
                               .29
                                c
                            35.00
                            35.00
                            35.00

                            35.00
                              .83
                              .83
                               d
   ^Parentheses  indicate decrease from baseline case.
   b
   The  profit  impact changes  significantly from the powder option based on data
   presented in Appendix E.
   No negative impact on profit margin.
   Less than $.01.
                                          7-102

-------
           Table 7-64.  PROFIT IMPACT



CHAIR PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES



             UNCONTROLLED BASELINE
Incremental
annual ized # Chairs
Control control costa coated
Plant Option ($000) (000)
B





D





F



G




H




Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray) b
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Elect rodeposition
Incinerator 8
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
Powder (Fid. Bd.)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
639
371
(135)

12
(85)
129
73
(24)

23
(14)
20
16
(1)
(D
843
366

155
162
71
135

52
29
12,000
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
136
136
136
136
12,000
12,000

12,000
12,000
1,182
1,182

1,182
1,182
Incremental
annual ized
control cost
per chair
coateda ($)
.05
.03
(.01)

c
(.01)
.11
.06
(.02)

.02
(-01)
.15
.12
(.01)
(.01)
.07
.03

.01
.01
.06
.11

.04
.02
Profit margin impact
F.O.B. price
per chair ($) %
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
.14
.09
d

e
d
.31
.17
d

.06
d
.43
.34
d
d
.20
.09

.03
.03
.17
.31

.11
.06
                      7-103

-------
                           Table  7-64.   PROFIT  IMPACT

                CHAIR  PLANTS  -  MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED  FACILITIES

                             UNCONTROLLED  BASELINE

                                   (Continued)
Plant
Control
Option
 Incremental
 annualized
control  cost9
   ($000)
                                                   Incremental
                                                   annualized
                                        # Chairs  control  cost   Profit margin impact
                                                    per chair   F.O.B. price
                                                   rnatPda ($)   per chair ($)    %
coated
 (OOP)
  I  Powder (Fid.  Bd.)        38
     Electrodeposition        39
     Waterborne (Convent.)    10

  J  Waterborne               10
                                  136
                                  136
                                  136

                                  136
                               .28
                               .29
                               .07

                               .07
                            35.00
                            35.00
                            35.00

                            35.00
.80
.83
.20

.20
  ^Parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
   The profit impact changes significantly from the powder option based on data
   presented in Appendix E.
  Uess than $.01.
   No negative impact on profit margin.
   'Negative impact on profit margins less than .01 percent.
                                          7-104

-------
the 65 percent high solids option, savings are experienced in all but two
situations, in which there is no change in cost from the baseline case.
For any given control option, costs tend to vary inversely with the size of
the plant.
     Cost for chair plants.  As pointed out earlier, in the case of the
chair plants, separate models have been developed for spray, dip-coating,
and flow-coating operations.
     Plants B, D, and F employ the spray-coating method.  For Plants B and
D, the most expensive control option is powder, (applied at a film thickness
of 2.5 mil) for which the incremental costs per chair range from $.04 to
$.12.   However, based on data presented in Appendix E, the powder option
may produce a savings for Plant D.  This is followed by waterborne whose
costs vary from $.03 to $.07 per chair coated.  In the case of Plant F,  the
most expensive option for new facilities is waterborne ($.12 per chair for
SIP baseline and $.10 per chair for uncontrolled baseline).  Among the
three plants, savings are experienced with the 70 percent high solids
option in all but two situations, where there is no change in cost from the
baseline case.  For incineration plus RACT coating (does not apply to Plant
F), costs range from a saving in one situation to a maximum of $.02 per
chair.   The 65 percent high solids option results in savings in all but two
situations where there is no change in cost from the baseline situation.
     Plants G, H, and I employ the dip-coating method.   The control options
are conventional waterborne,  incinerator plus RACT coating, powder (fluidized
bed),  and waterborne with electrodeposition.   For  Plant G, the most expensive
option is powder (fluidized bed), for which the incremental cost per chair
coated is $.06 for new facilities relative to the SIP baseline, and $.07
for the other three facility/baseline combinations.   This is followed by
electrodeposition, the costs  of which $.04 per chair in one case, and $.03
in the other three cases.   With respect to Plants H and I, the most expensive
control option is electrodeposition.   Among these two plants, the cost of
this option ranges from $.07 to $.32 per chair coated.   Powder is next,
with costs ranging from $.02 to $.29 per chair.   For all three of the
plants, the costs of the conventional waterborne option are relatively low,
ranging from a situation of no change in cost from the baseline to $.07 per
                                  7-105

-------
chair coated.   The option involving incineration plus RACT coating has
costs varying from less than $.01 to $.04 (this option does not apply to
Plant I).
     In the case of Plant J, which employs dip-coating, the only control
option considered is conventional waterborne.   The incremental  costs for
this option range from zero to $.07 per chair.
     7.4.4.3  Profit Impact.  The impact of the control options on model
plant profits was examined using a form of "worst case" analysis which
assumed that the incremental annualized control costs would be fully
absorbed by the plants.  Measurement of impact was carried out in two
steps.  The first step involved calculating the extent to which the profit
margin on sales for each shelf or chair would be affected by the incremental
control costs.  This was done as follows:
Incremental Annualized Control
     Cost Per Shelf or Chair
                                   x 100 = Profit Margin Impact Per
F.O.B. Price Per Shelf or Chair              She]f Qr Chai>

The data used for this calculation are presented in the third through sixth
columns in Tables 7-57 to 7-64.  The F.O.B. price used for shelves is
$25.55; for chairs; $35.00.  The impacts, expressed as percentages, are
given  in the seventh column in each of the tables.  These percentages are
the amounts by which the profit margins for the shelves or chairs would be
reduced if the incremental control costs were fully absorbed, rather than
being  passed on to the consumer in the form of a price increases.  (Note
that when interpreted differently, this type of calculation can  be used to
determine maximum price increase.)  It will be noted that in the seventh
column, impact figures are not given for some of the control options.  In
these  cases, the impact of the option on the profit margin is either posi-
tive because of attendant cost savings or neutral because of there being no
change in cost from the baseline case.
      In the  second step, the  impact on total model plant profits was
determined as  follows:

  Profit Margin Impact  Per  Shelf or Chair     10Q = j    t Qn Model R1ant
Average Profit Rate on Sales  for  Industry            r  Profits

                                  7-106

-------
This calculation was performed for every plant control option combination
exhibiting impairment of profit in the first step above.   The profit
rate (on sales) used in the divisor were determined by the industry
group affiliation of the model plant in question.  The profit rates were
obtained from the 1978 edition of Annual Statement Studies, published by
Robert Morris Associates.   The rates used were as follows:  SIC 2514,
5.6 percent; SIC 2522, 4.8 percent; and SIC 2542, 4.3 percent.   No rate
for SIC 2531 was available.  With the exception of cases involving
Plants A, B, and G, the figures on profit margin impact per shelf or
chair were divided by all  three of the profit rates.   This is due to the
fact that with the exception of A, B, and G, all of the model plants are
associated with all four of the SIC groups comprising the metal furniture
industry.  Plants A, B, and G are associated only with SIC 2522.   The
percentage figures resulting from the calculations are indicative of the
extent to which plant profits would be reduced as a result of having to
fully absorb the incremental control costs involved.
     The results of the analysis are presented in Tables 7-65 to 7-68.
An impact on a plant was said to be "major" if the impairment to profits
amounted to 15 percent or more.  The rationale for determining that a 15
percent reduction in profits constitutes a major impact was established
as follows:  A general criterion applicable to the four SIC groups and
the control options involved was established on the basis of the degree
of impact that would lead to a decision not to invest in a new source in
the most marginal of the four SIC groups.  After selecting the least
profitable SIC group (as based on the published data), a discounted cash
flow (DCF) analysis was performed to determine what percent increase in
operating costs would cause the investment to be rejected on economic
grounds, when it would otherwise be justified before controls.
     The DCF technique estimates and compares cash inflows and outflows
over the life of the project (i.e., new, modified, or reconstructed
metal furniture coating lines).  The changing value of money over time
is considered in the comparisons by discounting those cash flows to the
present time.  The discount rate used is the firm's cost of capital.  If
the present value of the discounted cash outflows, the project is
economically justified.
                                  7-107

-------
                        Table 7-65.   PROFIT IMPAIRMENT

                       SHELVING PLANTS - NEW FACILITIES

                        SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES
% Impairment at
Control
Plant 	 Option
A Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
C Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
SIP baseline
4.3%
b
b
b

b
b
17.20
7.21
c
2.79
c
24.65
18.14
d,
d
4.8%
14.58
5.63
c

0.83
c
15.41
6.46
c
2.50
c
22.08
16.25
d
d
5.6%
b
b
b

b
b
13.21
5.54
c
2.14
c
18.93
13.73
d
d
profit rates below

Uncontrolled baseline
4.3%
b
b
b

b
b
16.28
5.35
c
1.86
c
18.13
11.86
c
c
4.8%
13.95
4.79
c

c
c
14.58
4.79
c
1.67
c
16.25
10.63
c
c
5.6%
b
b
b

b

12.50
4.11
c
1.43
c
13.93
9.11
c
c
3The profit impairment changes significantly for the powder option based on data
.presented in Appendix E.
HProfit rate does not apply to this plant.                          .
% profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this control
 •option is negative - i.e., there is a decrease in cost from the baseline case.
'llo profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this control
 option is zero - i.e., there is no change in cost from the baseline case.
                                      7-108

-------
                         Table 7-66.  PROFIT IMPAIRMENT

               SHELVING PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES

                         SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES
Control
Plant Option
A Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
C Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)9
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids

SIP
4.3%
b
b
b

b
b
21.86
7.21
c

2.79
c
44.65
24.65
d
d
% Impairment at
baseline
4.8% 5.6%
17.08 b
6.46 b
c b

0.83 b
c b
19.58 16.79
6.46 5.54
c c

2.50 2.14
c c
40.00 34.29
22.08 18.93
d d
d d
profit rates below
Uncontrolled
4.3% 4.8%
b 15.42
b 4.79
b c

b c
b c
20.00 17.92
6.28 5.63
c c

2.79 2.50
c c
38.14 34.17
18.14 16.25
c c
c c

baseline
5.6%
b
b
b

b
b
15.36
4.82
c

2.14
c
29.29
13.93
c
c
 The profit impairment changes significantly for the powder option based on data
.presented in Appendix E.
profit  rate does  not  apply to this  plant.
 No profit impairment  involved.   Incremental  annualized cost for this control
^option  is negative -  i.e., there is a decrease in cost from the baseline case.
 rJo profit impairment  involved.   Incremental  annualized cost for this control
 option  is zero -  i.e.,  there is  no  change  in cost from the baseline case.
                                      7-109

-------
Table 7-67.  PROFIT IMPAIRMENT



 CHAIR PLANTS - NEW FACILITIES



SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES
— % Impairment at profit rates below
Control
Plant Option
B Powder (spray) a
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
D Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
F Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
G Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator & RACT
coati ng
Waterborne (Convent.)
H Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator & RACT
coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
SIP
4.3%
b
b
b

b
b
6.74
4.65
c

1.40
c
4.65
7.91
d
d
b
b

b
b
1.40
4.65

1.40
0.70
baseline
4.8%
2.92
2.29
c

0.21
c
6.04
4.17
c

1.25
c
4.17
7.08
d
d
3.54
1.88

0.23
0.23
1.25
4.17

1.25
0.63
5.6%
b
b
b

b
b
5.18
3.57
c

1.07
c
3.57
6.07
d
d
b
b

b
b
1..07
3.57

1.07
0.54
Uncontrolled baseline
4.3%
b
b
>b

b
b
6.05
3.95
c

0.70
c
3.95
6.74
c
c
b
b

b
b
3.26
6.74

2.56
2.09
4.8%
2.29
1.88
c

c
c
5.42
3.54
c

0.63
c
3.54
6.04
c
c
4.17
2.29

0.63
0.63
2.92
6.04

2.29
1.88
5.6%
b
b
b

b
b
4.64
3.04
c

0.54
c
3.04
5.18
c
c
b
b

b
b
2.50
5.18

1.96
1.61
              7-110

-------
                         Table 7-67.  PROFIT IMPAIRMENT

                          CHAIR PLANTS - NEW FACILITIES

                         SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES

                                   (Continued)
Plant
Control
Option
                                        % Impairment at profit rates below
                                  SIP baseline
4.3%    4.8%
5.6%
                              Uncontrolled baseline
4.3%
4.1
5.6%
       Powder (fluidized bed)  8.60    7.71    6.61
       Electrodeposition      16.05   14.38   12.32
       Waterborne (Convent.)    d       d       d

       Waterborne               d       d       d
                                                 13.95
                                                 21.16
                                                  4.65

                                                  4.65
                                      12.50
                                      18.96
                                       4.17

                                       4.17
                              10.71
                              16.25
                               3.57
                               3.57
 The profit impairment changes significantly for the powder option based on data
.presented in Appendix E.
 Profit rate does not apply to this plant.
cNo profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this control
 option is negative - i.e., there is a decrease in cost from the baseline case.
dNo profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this control
 option is zero - i.e.,  there is no change in cost from the baseline case.
                                      7-111

-------
         Table 7-68.  PROFIT IMPAIRMENT



CHAIR PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES



         SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES
% Impairment at
Plant
B





D





F



G




H




Control
Option
Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)9
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)3
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator & RACT
coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator & RACT
coating
Waterborne (Convent.)
SIP
4.3%
b
b
b

b
b
7.91
4.65
c

1.40
c
10.70
8.60
d
d
b
b

b
b
3.95
7.21

0.70
0.70
baseline
4.8%
3.54
2.29
c

0.21
c
7.08
4.17
c

1.25
c
9.58
7.71
d
d
4.17
1.88

0.21
0.21
3.54
6.46

0.63
0.63
5.6%
b
b
b

b
b
6.07
3.57
c

1.07
c
8.21
6.61
d
d
b
b

b
b
3.04
5.54

0.54
0.54
profit rates below
Uncontrolled baseline
4.3%
b
b
b

b
b
7.21
3.95
c

1.40
c
10.00
7.91
c
c
b
b

b
b
3.95
7 21

2.56
0.70
4.8%
2.92
1.88
c

0.06
c
6.46
3.54
c

1.25
c
8.96
7.08
c
c
4.17
1.88

0.63
0.63
3.54
6.46

2.29
0.63
5.6%
b
b
b

b
b
5.54
3.04
c

1.07
c
7.68
6.07
c
c
b


b

3.04
5.54

1.96
0.54
                       7-112

-------
                         Table 7-68.   PROFIT IMPAIRMENT

                 CHAIR PLANTS - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES

                         SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES

                                   (Continued)
Plant
Control
Option
                                        % Impairment at profit rates below"
                                  SIP baseline
4.3%    4.8%
 5.6%
                              Uncontrolled baseline
 4.3%
 4.8%    5.6%
       Powder (fluidized bed) 19.30
       Electrodeposition
       Waterborne (Convent.)
                   19.30
                     d
       17.29
       17.29
         d
14.82
14.82
  d
       Waterborne
18.60
19.30
 4.65

 4.65
16.67
17.29
 4.17

 4.17
14.29
14.82
 3.57

 3.57
aThe profit impairment changes significantly for the powder option based on data
.presented in Appendix E.
 Profit rate does not apply to this plant.
 No profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this control
 •option is negative - i.e., there is a decrease in cost from the baseline case.
 No profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this control
 option is zero - i.e., there is no change in cost from the baseline case.
                                      7-113

-------
     The DCF technique is considered appropriate for decision-making on
a profit maximizing basis, and has the capacity to address all  of the
important economic variables involved in such a decision context.   It is
recognized that factors other than profit maximization may exert considerable
influence in individual plant investment decision (maintenance or enhancement
of market share is one example); however, such factors are generally not
amenable to objective analysis.
     According to Robert Morris Associates (RMA) data, SIC 2522 (metal
office  furniture) has the lowest pre-tax profit rate on sales — 5.7 per-
cent — as  averaged over  the past four years.  Based on this profit
rate and other RMA financial ratios  for the  same  SIC group, a DCF analysis
was performed to  compare  the investment decision  before and after the
 imposition  of pollution  control.  The analysis  indicated  that before
 controls the  investment  in  a metal  furniture coating  line would be
 justified.   However,  if  a 15 percent profit  reduction  were to  occur
 after  controls  the project would only return the  minimum  acceptable rate
 of return  on the  investment and therefore be considered in the  realm of
 indifference.   The calculations are shown in Table 7-69.
      The table shows  the derivation of cash  flow estimates before and
 after pollution control.  The "after" column differences  from the "before"
 column occur in annualized costs, depreciation, interest, working capital,
 and capital (investment) costs, and are all  attributable to  the control
 costs.  All the costs are expressed on a per unit chair basis.
      The first cash inflow to derive is profit after taxes before and
 after  control.   In the table, revenue remains constant before and after
 since  it is assumed that control costs will be absorbed.   Production
 costs  and  depreciation are subtracted from  revenue to obtain profits
 before taxes.  The higher  production cost figure  "after"  control is
 attributable to  control  costs.  The specific  figure was  derived on  a
 trial  and  error  basis.   The higher  "after"  depreciation  figure was  based
 on  an average  (for the  control  options)  of  15  percent of annualized
 control costs  being  comprised of depreciation.   The  increase  in  annual
 control costs  (shown on the  table  as an  increase in  production costs) is
 $.19.   Depreciation  is  therefore  15 percent of $.19,  or  $.03.
                                    7-114

-------
        Table  7-69.   DCF ANALYSIS FOR DETERMINING GENERAL CRITERIA

                       FOR MAJOR PROFIT  IMPAIRMENT
                                         Before
                                         pollution control
After
pollution control
Revenue Per Chair
- Prod, costs
- Depr. (2% of revenue; before control
= Profits before taxes
(5.7% of sales, before control)
- Taxes (46%)
= Profit after taxes
+ Depr.
+ Interest x (1 - tax rate)
= Net cash inflow/year
x Discount factor for 15 years at
10% discount rate
+ Working capital recovery
+ Pollution control investment tax
credit
Net present value of cash inflows
Investment (cash outflow) at 2:1
sales to assets ratio (before
control )
Decision:
$ 25.55
23.58
.51
1.46
.67
.79
.51
.37
1.67
7.7688
12.97
.73

$ 13.70
$ 12.78
Invest
$ 25.55
23.77a'b
.54a'c
1.24
.57
.67
.54a
.39a
1.60
7.7688
12.43
.75a
.05a'e
$ 13.23
$ 13.23a'd
Indifferent
 Including pollution control

 Increase derived on iterative basis,  i.e.,  trial  and error.

 Based on control depreciation being an average of 15% of annualized control
 costs.

 Incremental  investment (i.e.  difference between $13.23 and $12.78)  equals
 yearly increase in depreciation at $.03 times 15 years = $.45.

 10% times incremental  investment cost of $.45.

fTax rate =  46%

 Source of Data:  Annual  Statement Sudies,  Robert Morris Associates,
                  Philadelphia,  PA.
                                      7-115

-------
     Since the DCF analysis  is  based on  cash flows,  the  tax savings  from
depreciation and the interest on borrowed money must be  added to  profits
after taxes.  The higher "after" control figures for depreciation and
interest are attributable to pollution control.
     The next cash inflow figure is on a yearly basis and must be multiplied
by the discount factor for 15 years.  The figure is multiplied by 7.7688
years versus 15 years to take into account the reduced value of money over
time represented by the discount factor of 10 percent, which was not derived
but adopted as a reasonable cost of capital.  Added to this running cash
flow figure is the present value of the working capital  which is initially
invested  and then recovered at  the  end  of fifteen years.  The $.73  is
derived as  25 percent of the initial  investment times the 15-year discount
rate.  The  higher "after" figure for  working capital  recovery is that which
is  added  for control.   The  last cash  inflow is  the  investment tax credit
attributable  to  the  control  capital  (investment) cost of 10  percent times
$.45.  The  $.45  represents  the  average  yearly  depreciation of $.03  times 15
years.
      The  cash outflow line  is  represented by the  initial  investment which
 on a per  unit chair basis  is one-half of the revenue.   To  that  must be
 added the $.45 investment  derived above to reflect the  incremental  control
 capital  costs.
      The last line of the table indicates a decision to invest before
 control  since the 13.70 cash inflow exceeds the 12.78 cash outflow.  However,
 the after control line shows indifference since cash outflows after control
 equal the cash inflow.   A 15 percent reduction in profits is what provided
 the indifference level and is  thus adopted as the criterion for major
 profitability impact.
      As  can be  seen in Tables  7-65 and 7-66,  all shelving plants are subject
 to a major profit impairment when  powder is applied  at a  film thickness of
 6.35 x I0"3cm  (2.5  mil).   However, the profit  impairment  is not significant
 (see Appendix  E) if powder (spray)  is  applied at a  film thickness  of 3.81 x
 I0"3cm (1.5 mil).   For the waterborne  option,  Plant  E  (the  smallest) is the
 only one subject to major  impacts.   In the case of  the 70  percent  high
 solids option,  none of the plants  are  subject to major  impacts  —  in fact,
                                    7-116

-------
all of the plants are either favorably impacted or not impacted at all.
The situation is similar for the 65 percent high solids option.  For
incineration plus RACT coating (which does not apply to Plant E), the
profit reductions are relatively small.   In general, for any given control
option, the magnitude of the impact tends to vary inversely with the size
of the plant.  For example, in the case of new facilities relative to the
SIP baseline, the impact of the waterborne option varies (assuming a 4.8 per-
                                                         2
cent profit rate) from 16.25 percent for Plant E (45,000m /year coated), to
6.46 percent for Plant C (780,000m2/year coated), to 5.63 percent for Plant
             2
A (4,000,000m /year coated).  Thus, assuming that two plants of unequal
size employ the same control option, the smaller plant will usually be at a
disadvantage relative to the larger.
     Profit impacts for the chair plants are presented in Tables 7-67 and
7-68.  Of the seven chair plants, Plant I (small dip-coating plant) is the
only one subject to major impacts.  These impacts are associated with the
powder and electrodeposition control options.   In the case of powder, the
major impacts are exhibited for modified/reconstructed facilities relative
to both the SIP and uncontrolled baselines, and range in magnitude from
16.67 percent to 19.30 percent.  In the case of electrodeposition, major
profit reductions are indicated for both new and modified/reconstructed
facilities, relative to both baselines.   The reductions range in value from
16.05 percent to 21.16 percent.  Among all of the chair plants, no profit
reduction is associated with the 70 percent and 65 percent high solids
options.   For incineration with RACT coating,  the largest impact is relatively
minor (only 2.56 percent).  In the case of waterborne, the greatest profit
reduction is 8.60 percent.  As with the shelving plants, for any given
control option, the severity of profit impairment exhibited among the chair
plants tends to vary inversely with plant size.  For instance, in the case
of new facilities relative to the SIP baseline, the impact of the electro-
deposition control option ranges (assuming a 4.8 percent profit rate) from
14.38 percent for Plant I (780,000 m /year coated), to 1.88 percent for
Plant G (4,000 m /year coated).
     7.4.4.4  Impact on Capital Availability.   The impact of the control
options on the availability of capital was determined in the following way.
                                  7-117

-------
First, annual sales were calculated for each of the ten model plants.   This
was done by multiplying the number of shelves or chairs produced per year
by the F.O.B. price - $25.55 for shelves and $35.00 for chairs.
     Next, the assets for each of the model plants were derived by utilizing
sales/total assets ratios obtained from the 1978 edition of Annual Statement
Studies, published by Robert Morris Associates.  In situations where a
given model plant was said to correspond to more than one SIC group, different
ratios were applied to account for this factor.  The ratios used were as
follows:  SIC 2514, 2.2; SIC 2522, 1.8; and SIC 2542, 2.5.  No ratio was
available for SIC 2531.  The asset bases computed by this method are shown
in Table 7-70.
      For each model plant, the impact of a given regulatory  alternative on
capital availability was determined as  follows:

Incremental  Capital Cost
of Regulatory Alternative    IQQ =  j    t  on  Cap1tal Availability
      Total Assets

The  incremental  capital cost for a  regulatory alternative  is  obtained  by
subtracting  the  capital cost for the baseline case  from the  capital  cost
for  the alternative.   The  incremental  costs  are presented  in Tables  7-71
and  7-72.
      Results of  the analysis are presented in Tables 7-73  and 7-74.
 Increases in capital  requirements  of 10 percent or more were considered to
 be major.   The  rationale  for  this  criterion was established  in the following
way.   A general  criterion applicable to the four SIC groups  and the regula-
 tory alternatives involved was established on the basis of the increase in
 capital requirements that would cause the ratio of cash flow to current
 maturities of long-term debt to fall below 2:1.  This  ratio is viewed by
 the banking community as an indicator of the ability of cash flow to cover
 debts.  As a general rule of thumb, a ratio of 2:1 is  considered marginal.
 The circumstances of individual cases sometimes warrant that loans be made
 when the ratio  is less than 2:1; nonetheless, the ratio of 2:1 is an
 indication of potential problems.
                                   7-118

-------
             Table  7-70.   ESTIMATED ASSETS  FOR MODEL PLANTS'
Plant
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
Sales
($000)
102,200
420,000
19,929
41,370
1,150
4,760
420,000
41,370
4,760
4,760

SIC 2514
b
b
9,059
18,805
523
2,164
b
18,805
2,164
2,164
Assets ($000)
SIC 2522
56,778
233,333
11,072
22,983
639
2,644
233,333
22,983
2,644
2,644

SIC 2542
b
b
7,972
16,548
460
1,904
b
16,548
1,904
1.904
aSales/total  assets ratios used:
       SIC 2514:   2.2
       SIC 2522:   1.8
       SIC 2542   2.5
bPlant is not associated with this SIC group.
                                  7-119

-------
Table 7-71. INCREMENTAL CAPITAL COSTS FOR NEW FACILITIES
                         ($000)
Control
Plant Option 	
A Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT coating
65% High solids
B Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT coating
65% High solids
C Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT coating
65% High solids
D Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator & RACT coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
F Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
G Powder (fid. bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator & RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
Increments
SIPa
240
678
0
130
0
417
1,044
0
130
0
83
203
0
110
0
84
208
0
no
0
29
31
0
0
32
67
0
0
(110)
2,416
110
0
relative to:
Uncontrolled
240
678
0
130
0
417
1,044

130
0
83
203
110
0
84
208
0
IT f\
10
0
29
*31
ol


32
en
D/
0

633
3,159
853
743
                            7-120

-------
             Table  7-71.  INCREMENTAL  CAPITAL COSTS FOR NEW FACILITIES
                                     ($000)
                                  (continued)

Control
Plant Option
H Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator & RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
I Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Waterborne (convent.)
J Waterborne
Increments

SIP
(20)
914
110
0
(25)
171
0
0
relative to:

Uncontrolled
127
1,061
257
147
34
230
59
59
aParentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
                                     7-121

-------
     Table  7-72.  INCREMENTAL  CAPITAL  COSTS  FOR  MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES
                                    ($000)
                                                  Increments relative to:
Plant
Control
Option
                                               SIP
Uncontrolled
       Powder (spray)
       Waterborne
       70% High solids
       Incinerator & RACT coating
       65% High solids

       Powder (spray)
       Waterborne
       70% High solids
       Incinerator & RACT coating
       65% High solids

       Powder  (spray)
       Waterborne
       70% High  solids
       Incinerator & RACT coating
       65% High  solids

       Powder  (spray)
       Waterborne
       70%  High  solids
        Incinerator  & RACT coating
       65%  High  solids

        Powder(spray)
        Waterborne
        70% High solids
        65% High solids

        Powder(spray)
        Waterborne
        70% High solids
        65% High solids

        Powder (fid.bed)
        Electrodeposition
        Incinerator  & RACT coating
        Waterborne  (convent.)
750
707
0
130
0
1,325
1,110
0
130
0
250
215
0
110
0
260
222
0
110
0
90
57
0
0
100
72
0
0
1,040
2,626
130
0
750
707
180
310
180
1,325
1,110
300
430
300
250
215
60
170
60
260
222
60
170
60
90
57
5
5
100
72
5
5
1,040
2,626
873
743
                                       7-122

-------
     Table 7-72. INCREMENTAL CAPITAL COSTS FOR MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES
                                    ($000)
                                 (continued)
Plant
Control
Option
   Increments relative to:

SIP                Uncontrolled
       Powder (fluidized bed)
       E1ect rodepos i t i on
       Incinerator & RACT coating
       Waterborne (convent.)

       Powder (fluidized bed)
       Electrodeposition
       Waterborne (convent.)

       Waterborne
                                    210
                                    904
                                    110
                                      0

                                     90
                                    211
                                      0

                                      0
                       210
                       904
                       257
                       147

                        90
                       211
                        59

                        59
                                     7-123

-------
Table 7-73. CAPITAL AVAILABILITY IMPACT FOR NEW FACILITIES

Control
Plant Option 	
A Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
B Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
C Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
D Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
F Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
G Powder (fid. bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
% Impact
SIP
SIC
2514
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
.92
2.24
b

1.21
b
.45
1.11
b
.58
b
5.54
5.93
b
b ,
1.48
3.10
b
b
a
a

a
a
relative to
baseline
SIC
2522
.42
1.19
b

.23
b
.18
.45
b

.06
b
.75
1.83
b

.99
b
.37
.91
b
.48
b
4.54
4.85
b
b
1.21
2.53
b
b
c
1.04

.05
b
SIC
2542
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
1.04
2.55
b

1.38
b
.51
1.26
b
.66
b
6.30
6.74
b
b
1.68
3.52
b

a
a

a
a
% Impact relative to
uncontrolled baseline
SIC
2514
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
.92
2.24
b

1.21
b
.45
1.11
b
.58
b
5.54
5.93
b
b
1.48
3.10
b

a
a

a
a
SIC
2522
.42
11 n
.1 9
b

.23
b
.18
A C
.45
b

.06
b
.75
1.83
b

.99
b
.37
.91

.48
b
4.54
4.85
b
b
1.21
2.53
k
D
.27
1.35
f\ —j
.37
*"> O
.32
ML
2542
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
1.04
2.55

10 r\
.38

.51
1.26

.66
b
6.30
6.74


1.68
3.52
K
U
a
a

a
a
                          (continued)
                           7-124

-------
           Table 7-73.  CAPITAL AVAILABILITY IMPACT FOR NEW FACILITIES
                                   (continued)
  H    Powder (fid. bed)
       Electrodeposition
       Incinerator &
         RACT coating
       Waterborne (convent.)

  I    Powder (fid. bed)
       Electrodeposition
       Waterborne (convent.)

  J    Waterborne
                                 % Impact relative to
                                      SIP baseline
4.86

 .58
3.98

 .48
7.90    6.47
5.52

 .66



8.98
                          % Impact relative to
                          uncontrolled baseline
Plant
Control
Option
SIC
2514
SIC
2522
SIC
2542
SIC
2514
SIC
2522
SIC
2542
  .68
 5.64

 1.37
  .78

 1.57
10.63
 2.73
 .55
4.62

1.12
 .64

1.29
8.70
2.23
                           2.73   2.23
  .77
 6.41

 1.55
  .89

 1.79
12.08
 3.10

 3.10
^Plant is not associated with this SIC group.
 No impact involved - capital cost unchanged from baseline case.
 No impact involved - decrease in capital  cost from baseline case.
                                    7-125

-------
Table 7-74. CAPITAL AVAILABILITY IMPACT FOR MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES
Plant
A





B





C




D





E


F


G




Control
Option
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Powder (fid. bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
% Impact
SIP
SIC
2514
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
2.76
2.37


1.21
b
1.38
1.18
b

.58
b
17.21
10.90
b
b
4.62
3.33
b
b
a
a

a
a
relative to
baseline
SIC
2522
1.32
1.25
b

.23
b
.57
.48
b

.06
b
2.26
1.94
b

.99
b
1.13
.97
b

.48
b
14.08
8.92
b
b
3.78
2.72
b
b
.45
1.13

.06
b
SIC
2542
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
3.14
2.70
b.

1.38
b
1.57
1.34
b

.66
b
19.56
12.39
b
b
5.25
3.78
b
b
a
a

a
a
% Impact relative to
uncontrolled baseline
SIC
2514
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
2.76
2.37
.66

1.88
.66
1.38
1.18
.32

.90
.32
17.21
10.90
.96
.96
4.62
3.33
.23
.23
a
a

a
a
SIC
2522
1.32
1.25
.32

.55
.32
.57
.48
.13

.18
.13
2.26
1.94
.54

1.54
.54
1.13
.97
.26

.74
.26
14.08
8.92
.78
.78
3.78
2.72
.19
.19
.45
1.13

.37
.32
ML
2542
a
a
a

a
a
a
a
a

a
a
3.14
2.70
.76

2.13
.76
1.57
1.34
.36

1.03
.36
19.56
12.39
1.09
1.09
5.25
3.78
.26
.26
a
a

a
a
                                   (continued)
                                     7-126

-------
Table 7-74.  CAPITAL AVAILABILITY IMPACT FOR MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES
                                   (continued)

% Impact relative to
SIP baseline

Plant
H




I


J
Control
Option
Powder (fid. bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
Powder (fid. bed)
Electrodeposition
Waterborne (convent.)
Waterborne
SIC
2514
1.12
4.81

.58
b
4.16
9.75
b
b
SIC
2522
.91
3.93

.48
b
3.40
7.98
b
b
SIC
2542
1.27
5.46

.66
b
4.73
11.08
b
b
% Impact relative to
uncontrolled baseline
SIC
2514
1.12
4.81

1.37
.78
4.16
9.75
2.73
2.73
SIC
2522
.91
3.43

1.12
.64
3.40
7.98
2.23
2.23
SIC
2542
1.27
5.46

1.55
.89
4.73
11.08
3.10
3.10
^Plant is not associated with this SIC group.
 No impact involved - capital cost unchanged from baseline  case.
                                    7-127

-------
Table 7-75.  CASH FLOW TO CURRENT MATURITIES
          OF LONG-TERM DEBT ANALYSIS
    Cash  Flow  From Model Plant of Table  7-69:

          Net  profits                .79

          +  Depreciation             .51

          =  Net  cash  flow           1.30

          *  2.2  (pre-control  ratio
            of cash flow to  current
            maturities  of  long-term
            debt3                    .59
            2.0 (ratio
            considered as
            marginal)                .65
               .65 - .59
               	  =10% increase
                  .59
aSource:  Annual Statement Studies. Robert
          Morris Associates, Phi la., PA.
                    7-128

-------
     For the metal office furniture component (SIC 2522) chosen earlier in
the profit  impact assessment as the least profitable of the four SIC groups
involved in this analysis, the Robert Morris Associates data  shows the
ratio of cash flow to current maturities of long-term debt as 2.2:1.  Table
7-75, which builds upon the discounted cash flow analysis presented in
Table 7-69, shows that a 10 percent increase in the current maturities of
long-term debt would reduce the ratio to 2:1.   This percentage change in
capital requirements was chosen as a level of potentially major impact.
     A review of the data in Table 7-73 and 7-74 reveals that, in the case
of shelving plants, Plant E is the only one subject to major impact.  The
impacts are associated with the waterborne options and if powder is applied
at a film thickness of 6.35 x I0"3cm (2.5 mil).   For chairs, Plant I (small
dip-coating plant) is subject to major impact under the electrodeposition
option.  Again, the presence of differential impact is apparent.   For
example, if Plant I is compared with its larger counterparts, Plant G and
H, it can be seen that the magnitudes of the impacts drop off considerably
with increasing plant size.   For the new facility/uncontrolled baseline
combination, the impact of the electrodeposition option on Plant I (under
SIC 2542) is 12.08 percent.   The corresponding impact for Plant H (medium)
is 6.41 percent.   (The largest dip-coating plant,  Plant G, is only associated
with SIC 2522).   Thus, as far as the use of electrodeposition is concerned,
Plant I would suffer a disadvantage relative to  its larger competitor,
Plant H.
     7.4.4.5  Differential  Impact Analysis.   Based on the results obtained
in the analyses of profit reduction and capital  availability, another
analysis was performed to assess differentials in  impacts between the
smallest and largest plants  producing the same product for each of the
control options.   In virtually all  cases, for  both profit reduction and
capital availability,  the impact for the smallest  plant is greater than the
impact for the largest plant.   In several cases,  the differences in impacts
are large.   For example,  in  comparing Plant I  (small  dip-coating plant)
with Plant G (large dip-coating plant)  for the electrodeposition option,
the following types of differences  are  found for the modified/reconstructed
facilities - SIP baseline combination:
                                  7-129

-------
     Profit reduction:

       Plant I:      17.29 percent
       Plant G:       1.88 percent
       Difference   15.41 percent

     Capital availability:

       Plant I:       7.98 percent
       Plant G:       1.13 percent
       Difference    6.85 percent

These differences underscore the fact that Plant I is clearly disadvantaged
relative to its larger dip-coating competitors.   As pointed out earlier,
Plant I is subject to major profit impacts for powder and electrodeposition,
and major capital availability impacts for electrodeposition.  Waterborne
is the only control option available to Plant I which is not connected with
some form of major impact.
7.4.5  Industry Compliance Costs
     The preceding discussion has focused upon the impact of the NSPS
regulations at the level of the individual plant.  In this section, results
from the plant-level analysis are utilized as a basis for assessing the
potential incremental annualized cost which the metal furniture industry as
a whole may have to bear.
     In order to provide an estimate of the range over which industrywide
compliance costs might vary, cost calculations were carried out for four of
the various combinations of control options that might be employed.  The
combinations are shown in Table 7-76.  For example, under Combination #1,
70 percent  high  solids would be used for all spray-coating operations
(plant types A-F), waterborne for all dip-coating operations (plant types
G, H, and  I), and waterborne, again, for flow-coating operations (plant
type J).
     The estimates of the industrywide compliance costs associated with the
four combinations of control options were based  upon the projected numbers
of new and  replacement coating  lines, as presented in Section 7.1.5.3.  The
                                  7-130

-------
 projections  in Section 7.1.5.3  call  for the  total  number  of  new  and
 replacement  lines  to  reach 1,963 by  the end  of the 1980-85 period.   This
 total  is  divided between 771  new facilities  and  1,192  replacements of
 existing  facilities.
     Based on the  discussion  in Chapter 6, it was  assumed that both  the new
 and the replacement lines would be distributed on  the  basis  of 85 percent
 being  spray-coating lines, 10 percent being  dip-coating lines, and 5 percent
 being  flow-coating lines.  The  estimated numbers of lines in each
 coating-method category are as  follows:

                         New  Lines      Replacement Lines
     Spray                  655                1,013
     Dip                     77                  119
     Flow                    39         	60
                            771                1,192

     For the numbers of new and replacement  lines in the spray-and dip-coating
 categories,  it was assumed that 25 percent of the lines would be accounted
 for by large plants, 50 percent by medium-sized plants, and the remaining
 25 percent by small plants.   For the flow-coating category, all of the
 lines are accounted for by one type of plant of small  size (Plant J).  This
 distribution is given in Table 7-77.
     In order to facilitate calculations of cost for coating lines in the
 spray-coating category, it was necessary to select three plant types from
 among the six spray plants (Plants A-F), as being representative of large,
 medium, and small  spray-coating operations.  It will  be recalled that
within the spray-coating category,  there are two model  plants for each size
classification (A & B, large;  C & D,  medium;  and E & F, small).   Cost data
 for the pairs of plant types were compared, and the differences were found
to be small enough to permit the use of three plant types as the bases for
the calculating compliance costs for the spray-coating  category.   The three
plant types chosen were A,  D,  and E.   For the dip-coating category,  plant
types G,  H, and I  were used as the bases for calculating compliance  costs
for large, medium,  and small  operations, respectively.   For the flow-coating
category,  plant type J was used as  the basis  for cost  calculations.
                                  7-131

-------
OJ
ro
                                  Table 7-76.  REPRESENTATIVE  COMBINATIONS  OF  CONTROL OPTIONS


                                             COVERING THE TEN  TYPES  OF  MODEL  PLANTS
Plant
type
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
Application
method Size
Spray
Spray
Spray
Spray
Spray
Spray
Dip
Dip
Dip
Flow
Large
Large
Medium
Medium
Small
Small
Large
Medium
Small
Small
rnntml options employed in combinations below
Combination #1
70% High solids
70% High solids
70% High solids
70% High solids
70% High solids
70% High solids
Conventional
waterborne
Conventional
waterborne
Conventional
waterborne
Waterborne
Combination #2
Powder
Powder
Powder
Powder
Powder
Powder
Electrodeposition
Electrodeposition
Electrodeposition
Waterborne
Combination #3
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne
Waterborne
Conventional
waterborne
Conventional
waterborne
Conventional
waterborne
Waterborne
Combination #4
70% High solids,
powder, & wHerbornea
70% High solids,
powder, & waterbornea
70% High solids,
powder, & waterbornea
70% High solids,
powder, & waterbornea
70% High solids,
powder, & waterborne3
70% High solids,
powder, & waterbornea
Conventional waterborne
Conventional waterborne
Conventional waterborne
Waterborne
          aThe three control options are assumed to be equally represented.

-------
                      Table 7-77.  DISTRIBUTION

                OF LINES IN COATING-METHOD CATEGORIES

                      BY SIZE OF PLANT INVOLVED
Coating method
Spray


Dip


Flow
Plant size
Large
Medium
Small
Large
Medium
Smal 1
Small
Number of
New3
164
328
164
19
39
19
39
lines in 1985
Replacement3
253
507
253
30
60
30
60
Due to rounding error, numbers for new spray lines and replacement dip
lines do not add up exactly to 655 and 119,  respectively.
                                 7-133

-------
     For each of the above plant types (i.e.,  A,  D,  E,  G,  H,  I,  and J),  the
amount of surface area coated annually per line was  determined (based on
data obtained from Chapter 5).   These figures  were then multiplied by the
numbers of lines corresponding to the different coating method/plant  size
combinations (as shown in Table 7-77).  The results  of the calculations  are
given in Table 7-78.
     The cost data used for extrapolation of the  industrywide compliance
costs are given in Tables 7-79 and 7-80, or Tables E-9 and E-10 (see
Appendix E).  The incremental costs presented in  the tables are per thousand
square meters coated.  The data were obtained from Section 7.2.   Only
incremental costs relative to the SIP baseline are considered.
     To obtain the  total compliance costs for the four combinations of
control options, the above costs were multiplied by the corresponding
figures on  surface  area coated  (as given  in Table 7-78).  The results are
as  follows:

                          From Tables  7-78,        From Tables 7-78, E-9,
                           7-79 and 7-80          and  E-10 of Appendix  E
Combination #1:            ($14.7 million)             ($18 million)
Combination #2:            $126 million                ($1.7 million)
Combination #3:            $17.6 million               $17 million
Combination #4:            $54.8 million               $11 million

At $126 million,  Combination #2 is  by far the most  costly of  the  four,  and
exceeds by $26 million the threshold for  a Significant Action Analysis  (as
articulated in Executive Order 12044).   However,  this  value  ($126 million)
 is based on powder being applied at 6.35  x 10~3cm (2.5 mil).  This value
 changes to a savings of nearly $2 million (see Appendix E)  if powder is
 applied at 3.81 x I0"3cm (1.5 mil).   Combination #1 would involve a savings
 of nearly $15 million.
      The four combinations of control options were compared in  terms of
 their cost effectiveness, using the emission estimates for the model plants
 presented  in Chapter 5.  For each of the coating method/plant size combina-
 tions examined, emissions at the SIP level were  calculated and summed to
                                   7-134

-------
 Table 7-78.   SURFACE AREA
COATED PER YEAR BY PROJECTED
 NEW AND REPLACEMENT LINES

Coating method Plant size
Spray Large
Medium
Small
Dip Large
Medium
Small
Flow Small
? i
Surface area coated per year (m x 10 )
New lines
109,333
127,920
7,380
7,600
15,210
855
1,755
270,053
Replacement lines
168,667
197,730
11,385
12,000
23,400
1,350
2,700
417,232
       Industrywide  total:   687,285,000 m2
            7-135

-------
           Table 7-79.   INCREMENTAL ANNUALIZED CONTROL COST

                   PER THOUSAND SQUARE METERS COATED

                     NEW FACILITIES - SIP BASELINE

                             (in dollars)
Plant
A
D
E
G
H
I
J
70% High
solidsc
(21)
(29)
0
b
b
b
b
Conventional
waterborne
75
106
200
9
10
0
0
n j d
Powder
184
144
267
a
a
a
b
EDP
b
b
b
84
110
733
b
Incinerator &
RACT coating
9
32
b
a
a
b
b
aNot considered for this plant under the four combinations of
.control options being examined.
 Control option does not apply to this plant.
^Parentheses indicate savings from baseline.
dThese incremental annualized control costs are based on a film
 thickness of 6.35 x lQ-3cm (2.5 mil).  However, the incremental
 annualized control costs are reduced significantly if powder is
 applied at a film thickness of 3.81 x 10-3cm (1.5 mil).  This
 data is presented in Appendix E.
                                     7-136

-------
             Table 7-80.   INCREMENTAL  ANNUALIZED  CONTROL  COST

                     PER  THOUSAND SQUARE METERS COATED

             MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES  -  SIP  BASELINE

                               (in dollars)
         70% High     Conventional                      Incinerator &
Plant     solidsc       waterborne     Powder"   EDP    RACT coating
A
D
E
G
H
I
J
(22)
(28)
0
b
b
b
b
76
110
267
9
10
0
0
205
185
489
a
a
a
b
b
b
b
94
169
889
b
8
31
b
a
a
b
b
  aNot considered for this plant under the four combinations of
  •control options being examined.
   Control option does not apply to this plant.
  ^Parentheses indicate savings from baseline.
   These  incremental annual!zed control costs are based on a film
   thickness of 6.35 x lQ-3cm (2.5 mil).  However, the incremental
   annualized control costs are reduced significantly if powder is
   applied at a film thickness of 3.81 x 10-3cm (1.5 mil).  This
   data is presented in Appendix E.
                                      7-137

-------
yield a total for the projected 1,963 new and replacement lines.   Similarlyv
total emissions associated with each of the four combinations of control
options were also calculated.    The results are as follows:

Data                             Chapter 7                  Appendix E Data
Combination              Total Emissions (kg/year)             (kg/year)
 SIP level                      53,089,870                     58,603,389
   #1                           33,104,807                     36,647,286
   #2                            2,825,595                      1,806,853
   #3                           36,647,988                     39,648,887
   #4                           21,531,082                     20,693,304

The  reductions  in emissions from the SIP level  are:  19,985,063 kg/year for
Combination  #1;  50,264,275 kg/year  for  Combination #2; 16,441,882  kg/year
for  Combination  #3;  and 31,558,788  kg/year  for  Combination #4.  When these
figures  are  divided  into  the  corresponding  industrywide  incremental annualized
costs, the  following incremental costs  per  kilogram  of emission reduction
are  obtained:

                            Chapter 7              Appendix E Data
 Combination #1:               ($  .74)                    ($-82)
 Combination #2:                $2.52                    ($.03)
 Combination #3:                $1.07                     $.90
 Combination #4:                $1.74                     $.29

 7.5  AGGREGATE ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT
      The purpose of this  section is to analyze the macroeconomic  and
 socio-economic effects of the proposed NSPS, and to determine whether they
 trigger the criteria for a Regulatory (Significant Action)  Analysis.   These
 criteria, as established by Executive Order 12044, are as follows:
      •    Additional annualized costs of compliance that, including capital
           charge (interest and depreciation), will total $100 million (i)
           within any one of the first five years of implementation (normally
           in the fifth year for NSPS), or  (ii) if applicable, within any
                                   7-138

-------
          calendar year up to the date by which the law requires attainment
          of the relevant pollution standard.
     •    Total additional cost of production of any major industry product
          or service will exceed 5 percent of the selling price of the
          product.
     •    Net national energy consumption will increase by the equivalent
          of 25,000 barrels of oil per day.
     t    Additional annual demand will increase or annual supply will
          decrease by more than 3 percent for any of the following materials
          by the attainment date, if applicable, or within five years of
          implementation:  plate steel, tubular steel, stainless steel,
          scrap steel, aluminum, copper, manganese, magnesium, zinc, ethylene,
          ethylene glycol, liquified petroleum gasses, ammonia, urea,
          plastics, synthetic rubber, or pulp.
7.5.1  Industry Structure and Concentration Effects
     As shown in Section 7.4, for any given control option, the magnitude
of impacts tends to vary inversely with the size of the plant; i.e., differen-
tial impact is present.  Given a situation involving a full pass-through of
costs, the resulting price increases would be smaller for large plants than
for smaller plants.  As pointed out in Section 7.4.2, the extent to which a
firm can pass through incremental costs to the consumer is affected in part
by the price elasticity of demand for the firm's product.  If the demand
for the firms's product is inelastic, a firm may be able to pass through
incremental costs to the consumer.  The extent to which this is possible,
however, would depend upon intra-industry competitive factors.  Locational
considerations would be most important in this regard.  If the demand for
the firm's product tends to be elastic, the potential for cost pass-through
is reduced.  In this latter type of situation, the competitive disadvantage
of small plants relative to large plants would tend to be accentuated.
Over the long run,  this increased disadvantage could lead to greater concen-
trations within the industry.  Such a trend towards increased concentration
would be encouraged more by some of the control options than by others.
7.5.2  Employment Effects
     It is not anticipated that the proposed NSPS will have a major impact
upon employment within the metal furniture industry.   At most, the number
                                  7-139

-------
of plants which would be forced to close as  a result of the  NSPS  would be
very small.   Also, it is not expected that the standard would result in the
curtailment of new construction in many cases.
7.5.3  Balance of Trade Effects
     The proposed NPSP is not expected to have a measurable impact on the
balance of trade.  Exports account for only a very small share of the metal
furniture industry's total value of shipments.  Moreover, as pointed out in
Section 7.1.4,  imports are not an  important factor  in the metal furniture
market.
7.5.4   Inflationary  Impact
     The  potential inflationary  impacts  of  the control  options were  determined
as follows:

      Incremental  Annualized Control  Cost Per Shelf  or Chair x 1QO
     	Retail  List Price Per Shelf or Chair

 The calculation yields the percentage by which retail list price would
 increase if the incremental control cost per shelf or chair were wholly
 passed on to the consumer.  For shelves, a retail list price of $38.33 was
 used; for chairs, $52.50.  (The derivation of these prices is discussed in
 Section 7.4.4.1.)   Impacts for the shelving plants are presented in Table 7-81,
 and for the chair plants in Table 7-82.  The incremental annualized control
 costs  used in  calculating the impacts were obtained  from Tables 7-57 to
 7-64.
       In  no case  is  there  a potential  increase of more  than 5 percent  (one
  of the criteria  in  Executive  Order  12044 for determination of major economic
  impacts).
  7.5.5  Energy Impact
       Energy consumption estimates for each model plant control  option
  combination are presented in Chapters 5 and 6 of this document.   These
  estimates are given in terms of joules.  Energy savings resulting from the
  use of less solvent are factored in the data.
       For the purpose of this analysis, the estimates for each model plant
  were reduced to the amount of consumption per line per day.  The number of
                                    7-140

-------
 days  used  in the calculation was 365.  The  data were then converted  to
 incremental form relative to both SIP and uncontrolled baselines.  In turn,
 these data, expressed  in joules, were converted to equivalent barrels of
 crude oil  by multiplying each amount by a factor of 1.63 (derived by assuming
 1 BTU = 1055 joules, and 1 barrel = 5,800,000 BTU).
     The results of this procedure are presented in Tables 7-83 and  7-84.
 In the case of the data calculated from the uncontrolled baseline, there
 are no situations involving incremental energy consumption.  Energy  savings
 are evidenced in all situations.  With regard to the data calculated from
 the SIP baseline, the  results are mixed.   In the case of the high solids
 options (70 percent and 65 percent), there  is no change in energy consumption
 from the baseline.   For the conventional  waterborne option, however, there
 are increments ranging from 0.08 to 0.15 barrel per day.   For waterborne
 with electrodeposition, incremental consumption ranges from 0.10 to 0.21 barrel
 per day.   The powder option involves energy savings in all cases.  For
 thermal incineration with RACT coating, incremental consumption ranges from
 0.03 barrel per day to 0.23 barrel per day.
     With  respect to energy consumption,  Executive Order 12044 defines a
 major impact as one involving an increase in net energy consumption by the
 equivalent of 25,000 barrels of oil per day.  To determine whether the NSPS
 would result in such an impact,  a form of "worst case" analysis was performed.
 In the procedure described above, it was  determined that the largest incre-
 mental consumption  of energy would be equivalent to 0.23 barrel  of crude
 oil  per day.   In Section 7.1,  the total  number of affected facilities
 (coating lines) was projected to reach 1,963 by the end of the 1980-85
 period.   If this figure is multiplied by  0.23, the result is an incremental
 consumption figure  of 451 barrels per day.   This is far below the 25,000-barrel
 threshold level,  and,  in reality, the figure would more likely be somewhat
 lower, and perhaps  even negative.  The conclusion is therefore that the
 NSPS will  not have  a major energy impact.
7.5.6  Industrywide Compliance  Cost
     The subject of industrywide incremental annualized control  costs was
presented in Section 7.4.5.   Of the four  combinations  of control  options
discussed,  Combination #2 (involving powder, electrodepostion,  and waterborne)
                                  7-141

-------
Table 7-81.  INFLATION IMPACT



       SHELVING PLANTSa
                     Inflation Impact %
Modified/

Control
Plant Option
A Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
C Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
New

SIP
.47
.18
c

.03
c
.50
.21
c

.08
c
.70
.52
c
c
Facilities

Uncontrolled
.44
.16
c

c
c
.47
.16
c

.05
c
.52
.34
c
c
Reconstructed

facilities

SIP Uncontrolled
.55
.21
c

.03
c
.63
.21
c

.08
c
1.28
.70
c
c
^Impacts calculated on the basis of a retail list price of $38.33
The inflation impact changes significantly for the powder (spray)
based on data presented in
°No impact involved.
Appendix

E.



.50
If
6
c

c
C'
.57
T C\
.18
c

.08
c
1.10
.52
c
c
per shelf.
option


        7-142

-------
Table 7-82.  INFLATION IMPACT



       CHAIR PLANTSa
                     Inflation Impact %
Control
Plant Option
B Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
D Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
F Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
G Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
New
SIP
.10
.08
c

.01
c
.19
.13
c

.04
c
.13
.23
c
c
.11
.06

.01
.01
Facilities
Uncontrolled
.08
.06
c

c
c
.17
.11
c

.02
c
.11
.19
c
c
.13
.08

.02
.02
Modified/
Reconstructed facilities
SIP
.11
.08
c

.01
c
.23
.13
c

.04
c
.30
.25
c
c
.13
.06

.01
.01
Uncontrolled
.10
.06
c

d
c
.21
.11
c

.04
c
.29
.23
c
c
.13
.06

.03
.03
       7-143

-------
                          Table 7-82.   INFLATION IMPACT

                                 CHAIR PLANTS3

                                  (continued)
                                               Inflation Impact %
Modified/

Control
Plant Option
H Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Incinerator &
RACT coating
Waterborne (convent.)
I Powder (fluidized bed)
Electrodeposition
Waterborne (convent.)
J Waterborne 	 	
New

SIP
.04
.13

.04
.02
.25
.46
c
c
Facilities

Uncontrolled
.10
.19

.08
.06
.40
.61
.13
.13
Reconstructed

facilities

SIP Uncontrolled
.11
.21

.02
.02
.55
.55
c
c
.11
.21

.08
.04
.53
.55
1 O
. lo
.13
^Impacts calculated on the basis of a retail  list price  of $52.50 per chair.
bThe inflation impact changes significantly for the powder (spray) option
 based on data presented in Appendix E.
SNO impact involved.
QLess than .01%.
                                     7-144

-------
                             Table  7-83.   INCREMENTAL  ENERGY  USE PER LINE PER DAY SIP BASELINE
I
en
Plant
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
High
Joules'3
0
0
0
0
0
0
d
d
d
d
Solidsa
Barrels
0
0
0
0
0
0
d
d
d
d
Conventional
waterborne
Joules^
.09
.08
.09
.09
.05
.05
0
0
0
0
Barrels
.15
.13
.15
.15
.08
.08
0
0
0
0
Waterborne
with EDP
Joules^
d
d
d
d
d
d
.11
.06
.13
d
Barrels
d
d
d
d
d
d
.18
.10
.21
d
Thermal i
PowderC and RACT
Joulesb
(.27)
(.27)
(.20)
(.20)
(.17)
(.17)
(.27)
(.20)
(.17)
d
Barrels Joulesb
(.44) .10
(.44) .05
(.33) .07
(.33) .07
(.28) d
(.28) d
(.44) .02
(.33) .14
(.28) d
d d
ncinerator
coating
Barrels
16
08
11
11
d
d
.03
.23
d
d
        aRefers to both 65% and 70% high solids coatings.
        t>Units multiplied by TO™.
        cParentheses indicate savings from baseline case.
        ^Control option does not apply to this plant.

-------
              Table  7-84.   INCREMENTAL ENERGY USE PER LINE PER DAY UNCONTROLLED BASELINE
Hinh Snlidsa.C
Plant
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
Joulesb Barrels
(.56)
(.56)
(.40)
(.40)
(.37)
(.37)
d
d
d
d
(.91)
(.91)
(.65)
(.65)
(.60)
(.60)
d
d
d
d
Conventional
waterborne0
Joulesb
(.47)
(.47)
(.37)
(.37)
(.31)
(.31)
(.53)
(.39)
(.33)
(.33)
Barrels
(.77)
(.77)
(.60)
(.60)
(.51)
(.51)
(.86)
(.64)
(.54)
(.54)
Water borne
with EDPC
Joulesb
d
d
d
d
d
d
(.42)
(.33)
(.21)
d
Barrels
d
d
d
d
d
d
(.68)
(.54)
(.34)
d
I. i i
Thermal incinerator
Powder0 and RACT coating0
Joulesb
(.83)
(.83)
(.60)
(.60)
(.54)
(.54)
(.80)
(.59)
(.50)
d
Barrels Joulesb
(1.35)
(1.35)
(.98)
(.98)
(.88)
(.88)
(1.30)
(.96)
(.82)
d
(.45)
(.51)
(.33)
(.33)
d
d
(.52)
(.25)
d
d
Barrels
(.73)
(.83)
(.54)
(.54)
d
d
(.85)
(.41)
d
d
^Refers to both 65% and 70% high solids  coatings
bunits multiplied by 10™.
cparentheses indicate savings from baseline case.
dControl option does not apply to this plant.

-------
would have a cost exceeding the $100 million threshold  for a Significant
Action Analysis.   However, this is based on powder (spray) applied at a
film thickness of 6.35 x 10~ cm, (2.5 mil),   Combination #2 could result in
a savings of nearly $2 million if powder is applied at 3.81 x 10~3cm (1.5 mil).
Details of these costs are presented in Appendix E.
                                 7-147

-------
                        REFERENCES FOR CHAPTER 7
 1.  Steven D. Channer, Executive Director of the Business and
     Institutional Furniture Manufacturers Association (BIFMA), meet-
     ing with Lynn Fugii and Abigail Mumy, JACA Corp., June 27, 1979.

 2.  "BIFMA Statistics, year ended December, 1977."  Grand Rapids,
     Michigan, BIFMA, May 10, 1978.

 3.  "Market Statistics for November, 1978."  Grand Rapids, Michigan,
     BIFMA, January 18, 1979.

 4.  U.S. Exports of Domestic Merchandise, SIC Based, 1977.  Department
     of Commerce (Washington, D.C.).

 5.  Predicasts Report 143.  Cleveland, Ohio, Predicasts, Inc., September
     26, 1977.

 6.  Wall Street Transcript, P.  52898, December 25, 1979.  Household
     Furniture Industry:  An Economic, Marketing and Financial Study.
     Morton Research Corp., Merrick, New York, 1978.

 7.  Michael Sherman, Director of Economic and Market Research, National
     Association of Furniture Manufacturers, meeting with Abigail  Mumy,
     JACA Corp., July 12, 1979.

 8.  Oge, M. T.   Trip Report—Angel Steel  Company, Plainwell,  Michigan,
     Springborne Laboratories, Enfield, Connecticut.  Trip Report 103.
     April  5, 1976.

 9.  "Powder Coating a Good Investment," Proceedings of NPCA Chemical
     Coatings Conference, Cincinnati, Ohio.   April, 1976.

10.  Telecon.  Houser, J., TRW Environmental Engineering Division,
     Redondo Beach,  California,  with T. Elliot, Hirt Combustion Engin-
     eers.   April 10, 1979.  Cost and fuel requirements for thermal
     incinerators.

11.  Telecon.  Houser, J., TRW Environmental Engineering Division,
     Redondo Beach,  California,  with R. Gilbert, C-E Air Preheater.
     April  10, 1979.   Cost and fuel requirements for thermal incin-
     erators.

12.  Telecon.  Houser, J., TRW Environmental Engineering Division,
     Redondo Beach,  California,  with B. Ferraro, John Zink Company.
     April  10, 1979.   Cost and fuel requirements for thermal inciner-
     ators.
                                7-149

-------
13.   Letter from Wargel,  W.,  George Koch Sons,  Inc.,  Evansville,
     Indiana, to A.  Nunn, TRW Environmental  Engineering  Division,
     Durham, North Carolina.   May 17,  1979.   Coating  line cost esti-
     mate.

14.   Letter from Wargel,  W.,  George Koch Sons,  Inc.,  Evansville,
     Indiana, to A.  Nunn, TRW Environmental  Engineering  Division,
     Durham, North Carolina.   June 8,  1979.   Electrodeposition
     coating line cost estimates.

15.   Letter from Freimuth, B., Graco Inc., Franklin Park, Illinois,
     to D.  Anderson, TRW Environmental Engineering Division, Durham,
     North Carolina.  May 7, 1979.  Coating equipment costs.

16.  Letter from Masterson, D., Arvid C. Walberg and Co., Downers
     Grove, Illinois, to L. Lawrence, TRW Environmental  Engineering
     Division,  Durham, North Carolina.  March 9, 1979.  Coating
     equipment  costs.

17.  Nunn, A. B. and D.  L. Anderson.  Trip Report—Ransburg Electro-
     static Equipment, Indianapolis,  Indiana, TRW Environmental
     Engineering Division, Durham, North  Carolina.  April 24-25, 1979.

18.  Letter from Aronow, A.  Sinclair Paints, Los Angeles,  California,
     to L.  Carter,  TRW Environmental  Engineering Division,  Durham, North
     Carolina.  March 20, 1979.   Coating  material costs.

19.  Telecon.   Carter, L., TRW  Environmental Engineering  Division,
     Durham,  North  Carolina, with J.  Spaulding, Chemical  Coatings
     Corporation, Pico Rivera,  California.   March 8,  1979.  Coating
     material  costs.

20.  Telecon.   Carter, L., TRW  Environmental Engineering Division,
     Durham,  North  Carolina,  with L.  Nunamaker, E.  I. Dupont, Inc.,
     Wilmington,  Delaware.   March 9,  1979.   Coating  material  costs.

 21.  Gallagher, V.   Trip Report—Blacksmith Shop  (Selrite Corpora-
     tion), Division of  U.S.  Furniture  Industries,  High Point, North
      Carolina, U.S. EPA/ESED,  Durham, North Carolina.   March  8,  1976.

 22.   Letter from LeBras, L.  R. , PPG,  Inc.,  to  W.  H.  Halley, Springborne
      Laboratories,  Enfield,  Connecticut.  September 16, 1977.  High
      solids coatings.

 23.   Telecon.  Halley, W. H., Springborne Laboratories, Enfield,
      Connecticut, with B. Kirkpatrick, Lilly Industrial Coatings.
      August 26, 1977.   High solids coatings.

 24.  U.S.  Department of Commerce.  Bureau of the Census.   County Business
      Patterns, 1976.  Washington, D.C.   U.S. Government  Printing Office.
      1978.
                                 7-150

-------
25.  Telecon.  Harris, John, Industry and Trade Administration,
     U.S. Department of Commerce, with Abigail Mumy, JACA Corp.
     July 19, 1979.  Demand elasticities for metal furniture.

26.  Refer to Table 7-1.

27.  Refer to Table 7-3.

28.  General Services Administration.  Schedule 71, A & B,
     Library Furniture - Wood and Metal.

29.  "BIFMA Statistics, Third Quarter Ended September 30, 1978 "
     Grand Rapids, Michigan, BIFMA, December 8, 1978.
                               7-151

-------
                              APPENDIX A

A.I  LITERATURE REVIEW

     The literature reviewed for this standard includes previous EPA

in-house reports, EPA-funded contractor reports, published literature, and

reports from industry and other private sources.  Specifically, the review

included the following:
     Date

August 11-20, 1975
September 26, 1975




April 21-23, 1976


August 23, 1977




August 25, 1977
April 1978
Literature Reviewed

Springborn Laboratories (SL)
conducted an equipment survey
to review coating equipment
contacting manufacturers
by telephone.

Office of Management and Budget
approved the EPA questionnaire
for distribution in the industrial
finishing industry.

SL attended Chemical Coatings
Conference in Cincinnati, Ohio.

SL conducted a telephone survey
with resin suppliers discussing
the present status of high solids
coating for metal furniture.

SL conducted a telephone survey with
resin suppliers discussing present
status of powder coatinqs and
waterborne coatings for metal
furniture.

SL submitted a draft copy of a
Study to Support New Source
Performance Standard for Surface
Coating of Metal Furniture
(EPA-450/3-78-008) to EPA.
                                  A-l

-------
November 25, 1978



January 15, 1979



January-March 1979




February 1979



March 1979




March-May 1979



May 1979


May 1979


June 1979
January-June 1979

October 12, 1979
TRW starts work on converting
EPA-450/3-78-008 into a Background
Information Document (BID).

TRW takes a trip to SL to collect
data base used for writing the draft
of EPA-450/3-79-008.

TRW conducted a telephone survey of
state and local agencies to obtain
regulations and information covering
the surface coating of metal furniture.

TRW received an AEROS computer printout
from EPA covering SIC codes 2514,
2522, 2531, and 2542.

TRW received data contained in computer
printout for metal furniture industries
in Texas.  Data obtained from Texas
Air Control Board.

TRW conducted a telephone survey of
equipment vendors and paint suppliers
for cost data.

TRW received cost data for model plant
coating lines from George Koch Sons, Inc.

TRW received cost data for some of the
model plant coating lines from Graco, Inc.

TRW received data from Gordon E. Cole,
GCA, concerning cure volatiles from
powder coatings.  Data also contained
powder coating thicknesses that are
achievable on an auto coating line.

TRW reviewed and reduced collected data.

TRW received Sections 7.4 and 7.5 of
the economics chapter from JACA.
A.2  EMISSION SOURCE TESTING

     No performance testing was done during the project.   This issue was

decided early in the project.   It was assumed that all of the VOC's in

coatings are emitted, thereby allowing easy material balance calculations.

Example calculations for VOC emissions are presented in Section 3.3 of the

BID.
                                  A-2

-------
A.3  PLANT AND EQUIPMENT VENDOR VISITS

     Plant trips were taken to observe different coating formulations being
applied to metal furniture parts.   Trips were taken to observe new types of

equipment vendor application equipment being marketed that allow higher

transfer efficiencies.

                                        Plant, Equipment Vendor, or
                                        Other Related Trips	

                                        SL visited Electrostatic Equipment
                                        Corp., to discuss the status of
                                        powder coatings and the ionized
                                        air coating process.

                                        SL visited Nordson Corp. and
                                        Interrad Corp.  to discuss the
                                        status of powder coatings and
                                        powder coating equipment.

                                        SL visited Simmons Co., Munster,
                                        Indiana, to observe the electro-
                                        static coating of metal drawers
                                        with high solids coatings.

                                        SL visited Lyon Metal Products,
                                        Inc., Aurora, Illinois, to observe
                                        organic solvent base coating of
                                        metal furniture.

                                        SL visited Virco Manufacturing
                                        Corp., Gardena, California, to
                                        observe powder coating of tubular
                                        furniture.  Also, witnessed at
                                        this plant was the operation of a
                                        thermal incinerator on the bake
                                        oven.

                                        SL visited Steel case Company,
                                        Grand Rapids, Michigan, to observe
                                        powder coating of office metal
                                        furniture parts.

                                        SL visited Goodman Brothers Manu-
                                        facturing Company, Philadelphia,
                                        Pennsylvania, to observe powder
                                        coating of metal furniture hospital
                                        beds.
   Date
August 18, 1975
August 22, 1975
January 14, 1976
February 3, 1976
February 11, 1979
February 24, 1976
February 25, 1976
                                  A-3

-------
   Date

February 25,  1976




March 8, 1976




March 9, 1979



March 23, 1976



April 21-23,  1976


September 26, 1976
January 15, 1979



February 2, 1979



February 2, 1979
Plant, Equipment Vendor,  or
Other Related Trips	

SL visited Bunting Company,
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, to
observe powder coating of outdoor
metal furniture.

SL visited U.S.  Furniture Industries,
Highpoint, North Carolina, to
observe powder coating of metal
furniture.

SL visited Angel Steel Co., Plainwell,
Michigan, to observe electrodeposition
coating of metal furniture.

SL visited Herman Miller, Inc.,
Zeeland, Michigan, to observe powder
coating of office metal furniture.

SL attended a Chemical Coatings
Conference in Cincinnati, Ohio.

SL visited George Koch & Sons, Inc.,
Evansville, Indiana, to review
available finishing technology.

SL visited other facilities
involved  in surface coating.
However,  the above list were
the only  facilities that are
involved  in surface coating of
metal furniture.

TRW visited SL, Enfield, Connecticut,
to obtain the data base for
EPA-450/3-78-006, Draft.

TRW visited EPA, Ohio, to obtain
data  for  metal  furniture facilities
in Ohio.

TRW attended the South Coast Air
Quality Management District meeting
to obtain information covering
proposed  regulations  for surface
coating of metal furniture.
                                  A-4

-------
   Date
March 26-27, 1979
April 18, 1979
April 24-25, 1979
Plant, Equipment Vendor, or
Other Related Trips	

TRW visited Steel case, Inc.,
Grand Rapids, Michigan, to obtain
information concerning coating
lines, and various air pollution
control techniques employed at
the plant.

TRW visited Delwood Furniture Corp.,
Irondale, Alabama, to observe water-
borne coating of metal furniture tables.

TRW visited Ransburg Electrostatic
Equipment, Indianapolis, Indiana,
to obtain information for high
solids coatings and electrostatic
spraying equipment.
A.4  MEETINGS WITH INDUSTRY

   Date

February 15, 1979
March 1979
January 30, 1980
Meeting

TRW attended meeting with Mr. E. W.
Pete Drum of Ransburg Electrostatic
Equipment to discuss electrostatic
spraying equipment.

TRW attended meeting with Mr. Wayne
Travis of Graco, Inc. to discuss
the costs of electrostatic spraying
equipment.

Meeting with Ron Farrell, Dr. Alexander
Ramig, and K. J. Mclnerney of Glidden
Coatings and Resins to discuss powder
coating costs and technical developments
in the area of powder coatings.
A.5  REPORTS AND REVIEW PROCESS

   Date

July 15, 1976



August 23, 1976
Report or Review Process

SL submitted first interim report
on Air Pollution Control Engineering
and Cost Study to EPA.

SL submitted second interim
report on Air Pollution Control
Engineering and Cost Study to
EPA.
                                  A-5

-------
     Date
May 19, 1977
June 14, 1977
 December  1977
 April  1978




 April  5-6, 1978




 October 10, 1979

 March 9, 1979


 May 31, 1979



 June  18,  1979


 July  31,  1979


 October 10,  1979



 October 31,  1979
 Report or Review Process

SL attended a meeting with EPA,
Research Triangle Park, North
Carolina to discuss all surface
coating projects.

SL received authorization from EPA
to continue and complete the study
to support a New Source Performance
Standard (NSPS) for surface coating
of metal furniture.

EPA  issued EPA-450/2-77-032 (OAQPS
No.  1.2-086) Control of Volatile
Organic Emissions  from Existing
Stationary Sources, Volume III:
Surface Coating  of Metal  Furniture.

EPA  issued EPA-450/3-78-006,
Study to  Support New Source  Performance
Standards  for  Surface  Coating  of  Metal
 Furniture.

 SL and EPA attended  a National Air
 Pollution Control  Techniques Advisory
 Committee (NAPCTAC)  meeting  to
 support the  proposed standard.

 TRW began work on the project.

 TRW finalized model  plants and
 regulatory alternatives.

 TRW attended initial meeting with EPA
 to obtain concurrence for selected
 model plants and regulatory alternatives.

 TRW submitted to EPA  a complete cost
 analysis.

 TRW and EPA decide upon basis for
 a standard.

 TRW  received draft copies of
 Sections 7.4 and  7.5  from JACA
 Corporation.

 TRW submitted to  EPA  draft copies of
 the  Background  Information Document
  (BID), and  preamble  and  regulation
  for the  EPA Working Group mail out.
                                    A-6

-------
     Date

December 21, 1979




January 11, 1980


January 29, 1980



February 27, 1980
Report or Review Process

TRW submitted to EPA draft copies of
the Background Information Document (BID),
preamble and regulation for the EPA
Steering Committee mail out.

TRW briefed the EPA Steering Committee
on the proposed NSPS.

TRW submitted to EPA draft copies of
the BID, preamble and regulation for the
NAPCTAC mail out.

TRW gave a NAPCTAC presentation.
                                 A-7

-------
                              APPENDIX B

             INDEX TO ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT CONSIDERATIONS
     Agency Guidelines for
   Preparing Regulatory Action
     Environmental  Impact
    Statements 39 FR 37419
                                            Location Within the
                                          Background Information
                                              Document (BID)
1.   Statutory basis for proposed
    standards
                                  The statutory basis for the
                                  proposed standard is summarized
                                  in Chapter 1.

Relationship to other regulatory  The various relationships between
agency actions.                   the proposed standard and other
                                  regulatory agency actions are
                                  summarized in Chapter 1,  Section 1.2.
    Industry  affected  by  the
    proposed  standards.
   Specific processes affected
   by the standard.
   Availability of control
   technology
   Existing regulations
                                  A discussion of the industries
                                  affected by the standard is  pre-
                                  sented  in Chapter 2,  Section 2.1.
                                  Also, details covering  the
                                  "business/economic"  nature of the
                                  industry is presented in Chapter 7,
                                  Section  7.1  (and  subsections).

                                  The specific  processes  and facilities
                                  affected by the proposed standard are
                                  described in  Chapter  2,  Section  2.2.
                                  Model plants  for  these  processes
                                  appear in Chapter 5,  Section  5.1
                                  (and subsections).

                                  Information on  the availability of
                                  control   technology is given  in
                                  Chapter  3.  The regulatory alternatives
                                  selected  from the control  technologies
                                 are shown  in Chapter 5,   Section 5.2
                                  (and subsections).

                                 A discussion of existing regulations
                                 on the industry to be affected by the
                                 standard  is included in  Chapter 2
                                 Section  2.3.
                                 B-l

-------
     Agency Guidelines for
   Preparing Regulatory Action
     Environmental  Impact
    Statements 39 FR 37419
2.  Alternatives to the proposed
    action

    Environmental Impacts
     Costs
           Location Within the
         Background Information
             Document (BID)
3.  Environmental impact of
    proposed action

    Air Pollution
     Water Pollution
     Solid Waste Disposal
     Energy
4.  Economic impact of proposed
    action
Environmental  effects of not
implementing the standard are
discussed in Chapter 6.

The costs of alternative control
techniques are discussed in
Chapter 7, Sections 7.2, 7.3, and
7.4.
The air pollution impact of the
proposed standard is discussed in
Chapter 6, Section 6.1.

The water pollution impact of the
proposed standard is discussed in
Chapter 6, Section 6.2.

The solid waste disposal impact of
the proposed standard is discussed in
Chapter 6, Section 6.3.

The energy impact of the proposed
standard is discussed in Chapter 6,
Section 6.4.

The economic impact of the proposed
standard on costs is discussed
in Chapter 7.
                                    B-2

-------
                              APPENDIX C
                       EMISSION SOURCE TEST DATA
     No emission testing was done during this project,  It is well
documented in the technical literature that all of the organic volatile
portion of coatings is emitted to the atmosphere.   As a result, it is
assumed for emission estimates that material  balance calculations for
volatile organic compounds (VOC) are acceptable.
                                  C-l

-------
      APPENDIX D.   EMISSION MEASUREMENT  AND  CONTINUOUS  MONITORING

 D.I   EMISSION MEASUREMENT METHODS
      A.   Emission  Testing
      No  emission measurement  tests  were conducted  by the  Environmental
 Protection Agency  (EPA)  for this source category.  The volatile organic
 compound (VOC) emissions  from this  coating  industry are similar to  the
 emissions from automobile and light duty truck surface coating opera-
 tions as well as other surface coating  operations.  Several test methods
 can  be used for measuring VOC emissions  from surface coating operations.1
 These include:
      1.  Total Gaseous Non-Methane  Organic  (TGNMO) Analysis, i.e.,
 oxidation/reduction of organics with Flame  lonization  Detection.
     2.  Direct Flame lonization Analysis (DFIA).
     3.  Gas Chromatographic  Separation/Flame lonization Detection
 (GC/FID).
Table D-l lists advantages and disadvantages of these  procedures.
     For determination of VOC emissions, the need for  identification and
quantification of individual  species is not necessary.   Therefore,
although useful in some cases, the GC/FID procedure was not considered
as the best approach for measuring VOC emissions from surface coating
operations.   The other methods listed above yield a single result  with-
out identification of individual  species present.   The  first two methods
listed above were investigated during the study conducted for automobile
and light duty truck surface coating operations.   In  the TGNMO method,
the sample is  manually collected  in a sampling  train  consisting of a
condensate trap and evacuated  cylinder.   The sampling train is  returned
to the laboratory where  the entire  organic  contents of  the condensate
                                    D-l

-------
                   Table D-l.   ADVANTAGES AND DISADVANTAGES OF EACH EMISSION  MEASUREMENT METHOD
             Emission measurement
                    method
                                          Advantage
                                   Disadvantage
       1.
Total Gaseous Nonmethane Organic
(TGNMO)
a
ro
       2.
Direct Flame lonization Analysis
(DFIA)
       3.  Gas Chromatography/Flame
           lonization Detector  (GC/FID)
A.  Has been successfully
    employed in determining
    compliance by Los Angeles
    Air Pollution Control
    District.

B.  Is considered to be the
    most accurate of sampling
    methods for measuring
    total carbon from sources
    of unknown organics.

A.  Has also been employed
    to determine compliance
    with state and local
    regulations.

B.  Costs less than TGNMO.

A.  Identifies individual
    species.
                                                                                A.   Most costly.
Not as accurate as
TGNMO for measuring
unknown compounds.
                                                                     A.  Expensive and complex.

-------
trap are oxidized to carbon dioxide, reduced to methane and quantitatively
measured by a Flame lonization Detector (FID).  The non-methane organics
collected in the tank (after chromatographic separation from carbon
monoxide, carbon dioxide, and methane) are similarly oxidized to carbon
dioxide, reduced to methane and quantitatively measured by a FID.  The
results are reported as total gaseous non-methane organics as carbon
(ppm or mass basis).  The advantage of this procedure is that because of
the oxidation/reduction procedure, all organics in the sample are
measured by the FID as methane, consequently, any variation in response
to the FID to different organic species is eliminated.
     The DFIA procedure involves directly measuring the effluent stream
with a FID.  VOC emission results are yielded in terms of the FID cali-
bration gas (ppm or mass basis).  Because FIDs have different response
factors for various organic compounds, the accuracy of the results
depends on the calibration gas chosen and the species of compounds in
the effluent.
     During the automotive coating study, a test was conducted on a
gas-fired incinerator controlling the effluent from an automotive bake
     2
oven.   The results of this test indicated that the concentrations
obtained from the DFIA technique were lower than the concentrations
obtained by the TGNMO procedure; especially at the incinerator outlet.
     B.  Coatings Testing
     Although no metal furniture coatings were tested, the recommended
test procedure based on the results from automotive coatings would be
Method 24, Determination of Volatile Organic Matter, Water Content,
                                                              3
Density, Volume Solids, and Weight Solids of Surface Coatings.   This
procedure uses ASTM methods to measure the coating density, the mass of
volatile material per mass of coatings, the volume of solid material per
volume of coatings, and the mass of water per mass of coating.  The
results from the different methods can be obtained to calculate the mass
of volatile organic material per volume of coating solids as applied.
The cost of analyzing a coating sample in triplicate using this
procedure would be approximately $250.
                                    D-3

-------
     Alternatively, the VOC content can be  determined from the manufacturer's
formulation data by calculation.
D.2  PERFORMANCE TEST METHODS
     A.  Emission Testing
     Reference Method 25, Determination of Total Gaseous Nonmethane
Organic Emissions  as Carbon, is recommended as the performance test
method for concentration measurement.  This method is recommended as the
reference test method  because the  problem of variation in response of a
FID  to different organic species is eliminated.  This is  accomplished by
reducing all  organic compounds to  methane  prior  to measurement by the
FID.   Since  the  FID in the reference method measures all  the  non-methane
organics as  methane, all carbon  atoms  give an  equal  response.  There-
fore,  Reference  Method 25  is recommended as  the  performance test method
for industrial  surface coating  operations  since the  effluent stream
 usually contains a mixture of various  unknown  organic species.
      The recommended procedure for determining the mass of VOC (as
 carbon) in the incinerator system vents uses a combination of several
 standard methods.  EPA Reference Method 1 is used to select the sampling
 site; Reference Method 2 measures the volumetric flow rate in the vent;
 and Methods  3 and 4 measure the molecular weight and moisture content to
 adjust the  volumetric flow to dry standard conditions.  The VOC concen-
 tration in  the vent is measured by Reference  Method 25.  The  results
 from  these  methods are combined to give the mass of VOC  (as  carbon) in
 the vent.
       Three  one-hour runs  of Reference Method  25 are recommended for a
 complete  test,  with Reference  Methods 2,  3, and 4  being  performed  at
  least twice during that period.   Measurements at the inlet,  outlet, and
  fugitive  emission vents should be performed simultaneously.   Although
  the actual  testing time using Reference Method 25 is only 3 hours, the
  total time required for one complete  performance test is estimated at 8
  hours, with an estimated overall  cost of $4,000, plus $2,000 for each
  fugitive vent measured.  During  the performance test, the process should
  be operating normally.  Because  this is a short-term test, the enforce-
  ment agency should consider the  solvents and coatings being  used and the
  products being produced  to ensure representativeness.
                                     D-4

-------
     B.  Coating Analysis
     Reference Method 24 is recommended as the reference method for
measuring the volatile content of metal furniture coatings.
D.3  MONITORING SYSTEMS AND DEVICES
     The purpose of monitoring is to ensure that the emission control
system is being properly operated and maintained after the performance
test.  One can either directly monitor the regulated pollutant, or
instead, monitor an operational parameter of the emission control
system.  The aim is to select a relatively inexpensive and simple method
which will indicate that the facility is in continual compliance with
the standard.
     For solvent recovery systems, the recommended monitoring test is
identical to the performance test.  A solvent inventory record is main-
tained, and the control efficiency is calculated every month.  Excluding
reporting costs, this monitoring procedure should not incur any additional
costs  for the affected facility, because these process data are normally
recorded anyway, and the liquid meters were already  installed for  the
earlier performance test.
     For incinerators, two monitoring approaches were considered:
(1) directly monitoring  the VOC content of the inlet, outlet, and  fugitive
vents  so that the monitoring test would be similar  to the performance
test;  and (2) monitoring the operating temperature  of the incinerator  as
an  indicator of compliance.  The first alternative  would require at
least  two continuous hydrocarbon monitors with recorders, (about $4,000
each), and frequent  calibration and maintenance.   Instead,  it  is
recommended  that a record  be  kept  of  the  incinerator temperature.  The
temperature  level  for  indication of compliance  should be related to the
average  temperature  measured  during the performance test.   The  averaging
 time for the temperature for  monitoring purposes should be  related to
 the time period for  the  performance test,  in  this  case  3  hours.  Since a
 temperature  monitor  is usually included as  a  standard feature  for
 incinerators,  it is  expected  that  this monitoring  requirement  will not
 incur additional  costs for the plant. The cost of purchasing  and
 installing  an accurate temperature measurement device and recorder is
 estimated at $1,000.
                                    D-5

-------
                      REFERENCES FOR APPENDIX  D


1    Guideline Series - Measurement of Volatile  Organic Compounds.
     Emission Measurement Branch, Emission Standards and Engineering
     Division.  EPA-450/2-78-041, OAQPS No.  1.2-115.  EPA,  Research
     Triangle Park, North Carolina.  October 1978.

2.   Emission Test Report:  Ford Motor Company,  Pico Riveria,  California,
     ESED Report Number 78-ISC-l.

3.   Determination of Volatile Organic Matter, Water Content,  Density,
     Volume Solids, and Weight Solids of Surface Coatings.   Draft,
     Emission Measurement Branch, Emission Standards and Engineering
     Division, EPA, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina.
                                     D-7

-------
                APPENDIX E - REVISIONS TO ECONOMIC DATA

     This appendix addresses issues concerning the technical content of
tha background ii. formation document (BID) for the surface coating of
metal furniture.   The following issues have been raised by industry
representati ves:
     1.   For all  calculations the powder film thicknesses can range from
          81 >
          1-6
2.03 to 3.81 x 10"3 cm (0.8 to 1.5 mil) instead of 6.35 x 10"3 cm
(2.5 mil).
     2.  New cost data for powder coatings were submitted by industry.
     3.  Other cost data and film thicknesses were submitted by industry
                                                                          136
for other low organic solvent coatings (e.g., high solids and waterborne). ' '
     4.  The impact of solid waste generated from different low solvent
coatings was questioned by industry.
     5.  The industry expressed concern that spray booth ventilation
rates could decrease as solvent levels of RACT coatings are decreased.
These are the major issues concerning the quality of the BID.   Each
issue is addressed separately in the following sections.
E.I  ADDITIONAL COSTS AND ECONOMIC ANALYSIS
E.I.I  Cost Analysis
     This section covers Issues 1-3.   Although Table E-l is similar to
Table 7-21 in the BID, the cost data contained in Table E-l have been
changed based upon data received from an industry representative.   The
selected base year for cost calculations both in the BID and in this
appendix is 1978.  The film coating thicknesses have also been changed
as shown below:
                                 E-l

-------
          Table E-l.   MODEL  PLANT ANNUAL  CONTROL  COST  FACTORS
Operating
Electricity
Natural gas
Paint:
  Conventional solvent-borne (35% solids)
  High solids (60% to 70% solids)
  60/40 Waterborne
  80/20 Waterborne
  Powder
Labor
Capital recovery factor assumptions
(Equipment life and interest rate):
  Coating line equipment
  Building
  Add-on control equipment
Taxes, insurance, and G&A
Maintenance  labor
Maintenance  material
Overhead
2000 h/yr
$0.08/107 J ($0.03/KWh)
$1.89/109 J ($2.00/106 Btu)
$1.85/liter ($7.00/gallon)
$2.80/liter ($10.75/gallon)
$1.98/liter ($7.50/gallon)
$2.10/liter ($8.00/gallon)
$3.53/kg ($1.60/lb)
$6.70/manhour
15 years 10% interest
25 years at 10% interest
10 years at 10% interest
4% of total installed cost
10% of direct labor
1.5% of equipment cost
80% of direct labor cost
                                    E-2

-------
        Low organic                                Film thickness..
      solvent coatings                                cm (mil)
      Powder                                       3.81 x 10-3 ,, CA
                                                               (1.5)
      High solids  (60-70 percent solids)            3.05 x 10~3 (1.2)
      Waterborne                                    Unchanged
 In  addition,  high solids coatings  are applied at transfer efficiencies
 as  high  or higher than  are  solvent-borne  coatings.   These transfer
 efficiencies  are  based  en -'^forraatien obtained *rc^> ~.r. V :!•.•; A-y representative.1
      As  a result  of  tha changes in film thickness and transfer efficiencies,
 the emission  estimates  for  powder  and high  solids coatings are not the
 same for spray coating  lines  (Chapter 5).   However,  emission  estimates
 for only three of the Model Plants (A, D  and  E)  are shown in  this
 appendix.   This is because  only three spray coating lines were employed
 in  Chapter 7  to determine total  fifth-year  annualized costs.   The  emission
 estimates  are shown  in  Table  E-2.
      Tables E-3 through E-10  show  the results  of these calculations for
 Model  Plants  A, D, E, G,  H, and I.  The costs  only  changed for Model
 Plants A,  D and E.
 E.I.2  Economic Analysis
     The total fifth-year annualized  costs  for three  regulatory alternatives
 are  listed below:

                                                                 Total
                                                               annualized
      Regulatory                                            costs  (savings),
     alternatives                  Combination                  $ millions
          11                            1                        (18)
          IV                            2                        (1.7)
          II                            3                        17
          III                           4                        11
The regulatory alternatives and combinations are defined  in Chapters 5  and
7, respectively,  of the BID.
     Based upon the analysis of the cost data, all of the  low organic
solvent coatings  are competitive.  The maximum inflationary impact, as
discussed in Chapter 7,  would still occur if Plant E applied powder

                                 E-3

-------
Table E-2.   EMISSION ESTIMATES FOR MODEL PLANTS
                   A, D AND E


Model
plant

Control
option
Emission
estimate
(kilograms)
           Uncontrolled
           SIPs (60% solids)
           65% solids
           SIPs + incineration
           70% solids
           Waterborne
           Powder

           Uncontrolled
           SIPs (60% solids)
           65% solids
           SIPs + incineration
           70% solids
           Waterborne
           Powder

           Uncontrolled
           SIPs (60% solids)
           65% solids
           70% solids
           Waterborne
           Powder
195,362
 84,148
 67,966
 58,904
 54,095
 38,000
  1,981

 49,814
 21,458
 17,144
 15,001
 13,715
  9,700
    386

  2,197
    947
    767
    606
    420
     22
                       E-4

-------
             Table E-3.  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT A - LARGE SPRAY COATING
                              FACILITY FOR FLAT METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
                                       A-l   A-2
                Control options
              A-3   A-4   A-5   A-6
A-U
 INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($1000's)

 Line(s)
 Add-on control  equipment
 Building
 Total  capital costs


 Annualized capital costs
 Insurance, taxes,  and  G&A
 Total  annualized  capital costs

 OPERATING COSTS C$1000's/yr)

 Direct labor
 Maintenance labor
 Overhead
 Maintenance materials
 Paint
 Electricity
 Natural  gas
 Total operating costs
$1810 $2041 $1570 $1570 $1570 $1570 $1570
2063
J8/3
444
155
b99
600
60
480
'£1
775
69
34
2270
4311
495
172
667
600
60
480
31
760
84
45
2063
3633
413
145
558
600
60
480
24
610
69
45
1JU
2063
3763
433
151
584
600
60
480
26
711
69
49
2063
3633
413
145
558
600
60
480
24
656
69
45
2063
3633
413
145
558
600
60
480
24
711
69
45
2063
3633
413
145
558
600
60
480
24
671
73
67
2045  2060   1888  1995   193T  1989
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($1000's/yr)  2644  2727  2446  2579  2492  2547  2533

Cost (credit) per kilogram of emis-
  sion reduction versus uncontrolled
  Plant                               0.6   1.2  (0.6)  0.3  (0.3)  0.1   N/Ab

Cost (credit) per kilogram of emis-
  sion reduction versus base case     1.2   3.9  (3.4)  1.3  (3.4)  N/A   N/A
Cost per area covered
  ($/1000 m2)
 661   682   612   645   623   637   633
aA-l
A-2
A-3
A-4
A-5
A-6
A-U
bN/A

Powder
Waterborne
70 percent high solids
Incinerator on base case
65 percent high solids
Base case—typical SIP
Uncontrolled plant.
Not applicable




line(s)




E-5

-------
       Table E-4.   CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT D - MEDIUM-SIZED SPRAY
             COATING FACILITY FOR COMPLEX METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
                                      D-l   D-2
              Control  options

             D-3   D-4   D-5   D-6
D-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($1000's)

Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costjL

Annualized capital costs
Insurance, taxes, and G&A
Total annualized capital costs

OPERATING COSTS ($1000's/yr)

Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
$644  $728  $560  $560  $560  $560  $560
—	   110  	  	  	
 402   552   402   402   402   402   402
1046  1170  "962"  1072   962   962   962

 125   140   114   131   114   114   114
  42    47    38    43    38    38    38
 TB7   187   152"   T7T   TBT   152"   T5T
150
15
120
10
95
9
8
150
15
120
11
198
10
11
150
15
120
8
158
9
11
150
15
120
10
185
9
12
150
15
120
8
171
9
11
150
15
120
8
185
9
11
L _ "I '
150
15
120
8
175
9
16
•- ' _
 407   515   471   501   484   4"98   493
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS  ($1000/yr)     574   702   623   675   636   650   645
Cost  (credit) per kilogram of emis-
   sion reduction versus uncontrolled
   plant
 (1.4)   1.4   (0.6)  0.9   (0.3)   0.2    N/Ab
 Cost  (credit)  per  kilogram  of  emis-
   sion  reduction versus  base case     (3.6)   4.4   (3.5)   3.9   (3.3)   N/A   N/A
 Cost  per  area  covered
   ($/1000 m2)
  736    900    799    865    815    833    827
Vi
D-2
D-3
D-4
D-5
D-6
D-U
bN/A
Powder
Waterborne
70 percent high solids
Incinerator on base case
65 percent high solids
Base case— typical SIP
Uncontrolled plant
Not applicable
line(s)
                                    E-6

-------
      Table E-5.  CONTROL COSTS FOR MODEL PLANT E - SMALL SPRAY COATING
                 FACILITY FOR FLAT METAL FURNITURE SURFACES
                                      E-l
           Control options

       E-2   E-3   E-4   E-5
OPERATING COSTS ($1000's/yr)

Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
  92    97    93    93    96
Cost (credit) per kilogram of emis-
  sion reduction versus uncontrolled
  plant
E-U
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($1000' s)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annuali zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes, and G&A
Total annual i zed capital costs
$225
23
"248
32
10
42
$225
25
250
32
11
~43~
$196
23
219
28
9
37
$196
23
219
28
9
37
$196
23
219
28
9
37
$196
23
219
28
9
37
40
4
32
3
5
4
4
40
4
32
4
7
5
5
40
4
32
3
7
4
5
40
4
32
3
7
4
5
40
4
32
3
8
4
5
40
4
32
3
8
4
7
Cost per area covered
  ($/1000 m2)
 98
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS ($1000's/yr)   134   140   130   130   133   135
(0.5)  2.8  (3.1) (3.5) (1.6)  N/Afc
Cost (credit) per kilogram of emis-
  sion reduction versus base case     1.1  13.3  (8.8)(16.7)  N/A   N/A
2978  3111  2889  2889  2956  3000
 E-l  Powder
 E-2  Waterborne
 E-3  70 percent high solids
 E-4  65 percent high solids
 E-5  Base case—typical  SIP
 E-U  Uncontrolled plant

3N/A  Not applicable
                                    E-7

-------
Table E- 6.  PLANT A  - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
         RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL FACILITIES
                                 A-l
Control options
A-2   A-3    A-4
A-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($1000' s)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes, and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($1000' s)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($1000'
Cost (savings) per area covered
($71000 m2)
aA-l Powder
A-2 Waterborne
A-3 70 percent high solids
A-4 Incinerator on base line(s)
A- 5 65 percent high solids.

$750
0
0
75B
99
30
125

0
0
0
11
64
0
<§§*
s) 182
46






$500
0
207
707
87
28
ITS

0
0
0
8
167
15
0
T50
305
76






0
0
0
0
0
0
B

0
0
0
0
$(101)
0
0
Tiory
(101)
(25)






0
$130
0
13U
20
5
25

0
0
0
2
0
0
5
7
30
8






0
0
0
0
0
0
U

0
0
0
0
$(55)
0
0
TB3T
(55)
(14)





                           E-8

-------
           Table E-7.  PLANT D  - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
                   RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL FACILITIES
                                                   Control  options3

                                            D-l     D-2    D-3     D-4    D-5
INSTALLED CAPITAL COSTS ($1000' s)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual i zed capital costs
Insurance, taxes, and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($1000 's)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs

$260
0
0
260
34
10
44

0
0
0
4
(90)
0
(5)
T9TT

$182
0
40
222
28
9
37

0
0
0
3
44
2
0
49

0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0
o
0
o
$(27)
o
0
7277

0
$110
o
\J
no
±^\j
17
•L /
4
21

n
\j
n
\J
n
V
2
C.
0
o
V
1
3

0
0
n
\J
n
\j
n
\J
o
\J
n
w
n
\j
n
u
o
\j
o
$(14)
n
\j
o
7T4T
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($1000's) (47)    86   (27)    24   (14)

Cost (savings) per area covered
  ($71000 m5)                              (60)   HO   (35)    31   (18)
 D-l  Powder
 D-2  Waterborne
 D-3  70 percent high solids
 D-4  Incinerator on base case  line(s)
 D-5  65 percent high solids.
                                   E-9

-------
      Table E-8.  PLANT E - CONTROL COSTS FOR MODIFICATION OR
              RECONSTRUCTION OF SIP LEVEL FACILITIES
                                              Control options

                                         E-l    E-2     E-3    E-4
INSTALLED CAPITAL COST ($1000' s)
Line(s)
Add-on control equipment
Building
Total capital costs
Annual ized capital costs
Insurance, taxes, and G&A
Total annual ized capital costs
OPERATING COSTS (SAVINGS) ($1000' s)
Direct labor
Maintenance labor
Overhead
Maintenance materials
Paint
Electricity
Natural gas
Total operating costs
TOTAL ANNUALIZED COSTS (SAVINGS) ($1000'
Cost (savings) per area covered
($71000 m2)

$90
0
0
90
11
4
15

0
0
0
1
(3)
0
(2)
T4T
s) 11

244

$55
0
2
57
7
2
9

0
0
0
1
1
1
0
3
12

267

0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
$(1)
0
0
TIT
(i)

(22)

0
0
0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
$(1)
0
0
TIT
(1)

(22)
E-l  Powder
E-2  Waterborne
E-3  70 percent high solids
E-4  65 percent high solids.
                                   E-10

-------
m
               Table E-9.  INCREMENTAL ANNUALIZED CONTROL COST (SAVINGS) PER THOUSAND SQUARE METERS
                                      COATED AT NEW FACILITIES - SIP BASELINE
                                                     ($1000's)

Plant
A
D
E
G
H
I
J
70%
High solids
$(25)
(34)
(67)
b
b
b
b
Conventional
waterborne
$45
67
155
9
10
0
0
Powder
$24
(97)
22
a
a
a
b
EDP
b
b
b
$84
110
733
b
Incinerator & RACT coating
$8
32
b
a
a
b
b
       aNot considered for this plant under the three combinations of control options being examined.
        Regulatory alternative does not apply to this plant.
       cParentheses indicate savings from baseline.

-------
                     Table E-10. INCREMENTAL ANNUALIZED CONTROL COST PER THOUSAND SQUARE METERS
                             COATED AT MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES - SIP BASELINE
                                                      ($1000's)
ro
Plant
A
D
E
G
H
I
J
70%
High solids
$(25)
(35)
(22)
b
b
b
b
Conventional
waterborne
$76
110
267
9
10
0
0
Powder
46
(60)
244
a
a
a
b
EDP
b
b
b
$94
169
889
b
Incinerator & KACT coating
$8
31
b
a
a
b
b
       aNot considered for this plant under the three combinations of control options being examined.
       bRegulatory alternative does not apply to this plant.
       cParentheses indicate savings from baseline.

-------
                  Table E-ll.   PROFIT  IMPACT
          MODEL PLANTS A, D AND E - NEW FACILITIES
                          SIP BASELINE
Control
Plant option
A Powder (spray)
(shelves) Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
D Powder (spray)
(chairs) Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)
(shelves) Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
Incremental
annual i zed
control cost
($000)
97
180
(101)

32
(55)
(76)
52
(27)

25
(14)
1
7
(3)
(3)
# Shelves
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000

4000
4000
780
780
780

780
780
45
45
45
45
Incremental
annual i zed
control cost
per shelf
coated3 ($)
.024
.045
(.02)

.008
(.014)
(-097)
.067
(.035)

.032
(.018)
.022
.156
(.067)
(.067)
Profit margin impacts
F.O.B. price
per shelf ($)
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
$
.09
.18
b

.03
b
b
.19
b

.09
b
.09
.61
b
b
?Parentheses indicated decrease from baseline case.
^lo negative impact on profit margin.
                                    E-13

-------
                  Table E-12.  PROFIT IMPACT
          MODEL  PLANTS A,  D AND  E  - NEW FACILITIES
                     UNCONTROLLED BASELINE
Incremental
Plant
A
(shelves)

D
(chairs)

E
(shelves)
Incremental
annual i zed
Control control cost
option ($000)
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
111
194
(87)
46
(41)
(71)
57
(22)
30
( 9)
( D
5
ill
# Shelves
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000
4000
4000
780
780
780
780
780
45
45
45
45
annual i zed
control cost Profit margin impact
per shelf F.O.B. price
coated3 ($) per shelf ($) %
.028
.049
(.022)
.012
(.010)
(.091)
.073
(.028)
.038
(.012)
(.022)
.111
(.111)
(.111)
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
35.00
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
.11
.20
b
.05
b
b
.21
b
.11
b
b
.43
b
b
"Parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
bHo negative impact on profit margin.
                                      E-14

-------
                    Table E-13.   PROFIT  IMPACT
   MODEL PLANTS A, D  AND E - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES
                            SIP BASELINE
Incremental
annuali zed
Control control cost
Plant option ($000)
A Powder (spray)
(shelves) Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
D Powder (spray)
(chairs) Waterborne
70% High solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% High solids
E Powder (spray)
(shelves) Waterborne
70% High solids
65% High solids
182
305
(101)

30
(55)
(47)
86
(27)

24
(14)
11
12
( D
( 1)
1 Shelves
coated
(000)
4000
4000
4000

4000
4000
780
780
780

780
780
45
45
45
45
Incremental
annualized
control cost
per shelf
coated3 ($)
.046
.08
(.025)

.01
(.014)
(.060)
.110
(.02)

.031
(.018)
.24
.27
(.022)
(.022)
Profit marqin
F.O.B. price
per shelf ($)
25.55
25.55
25.55

25.55
25.55
35.00
35.00
35.00

35.00
35.00
25.55
25.55
25.55
25.55
impact
%
.18
31
• tJl
h
V

b
b
V)
• J£
K
\J
no
• \jy
b
.96
1 Ofi
A * W
K
u
b
^Parentheses indicate decrease from baseline case.
"Mo negative impact on profit margin.
                                     E-15

-------
                      Table E-14.  PROFIT IMPAIRMENT

                 MODEL PLANTS A, D AND E - NEW FACILITIES

                      SIP AND UNCONTROLLED BASELINES
Plant
A
(shelves)




D
(chairs)




E
(shelves)


Control
option
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% high solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% high solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
65% high solids

SIP
4.3%
a
a
a

a
a
b
4.42
b

2.09
b
2.09
14.19
b
b
% Imp
base!
4.8%
1.88
3./b
b

0.63
b
b
3.96
b

1.88
b
1.88
12.71
b
b
lairment at
me
5.6%
a
a
a

a
a
b
3.39
b

1.61
b
1.61
10.89
b
b
profit rates below
Uncontrol
4.3%
a
a
a

a
a
b
4.88
b

2.56
b
b
10.00

b
led base
4.8%
2.29
.17


1.04

b
4.38


2.29

b
8.96

b
line
5.6%
a
a
a

a
a
b
3.75


1.96

b
7.68


aProfit rate does not apply to this plant.
bNo profit impairment involved.  Incremental annualized cost for this
 control option is negative - i.e., there is a decrease in cost from
 the baseline case.
                                     E-16

-------
                      Table E-15.  PROFIT IMPAIRMENT

       MODEL PLANTS A, D AND E - MODIFIED/RECONSTRUCTED FACILITIES

                              SIP BASELINE

m -.«4-
r lant
A
(shelves)




D
(chairs)




E
(shelves)


a-K — ^T 	
-Profit rate
Mrt t-i»rt/^^^ -I- -J
•"
Control
option
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% high solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
Incinerator & RACT
coating
65% high solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
65% high solids

does not apply to
% Impairment at
Sli
4.3%
a
a
a

a
a
b
7.44
b

2.09
b
22.33
24.65
b
b

this plant.
profit
P base!
4.8%
3.75
6.46
b

0.83
b
b
6.67
b

1.88
b
20.00
22.08
b
b


rates below
me
5.6%
a
a
a

a
a
b
5.71
b

1.61
b
17.14
18.93
b
b


No profit impairment involved.  Incremental annual 1 zed cost for this control
option is negative - i.e., there is a decrease in cost from the baseline case,
                                  E-17

-------
                      Table E-16.   INFLATION IMPACT

                       FOR MODEL PLANTS A, D AND E
Inflation Impact %




Plant
A
(shelves)




D
(chairs)




E
(shelves)





Control
option
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% high solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
Incinerator &
RACT coating
65% high solids
Powder (spray)
Waterborne
70% high solids
65% high solids


New

SIP
.06
.12
b

.02
b
b
.13
b

.06
b
.06
.41
b
b


Facilities

Uncontrolled
.07
.13
b

.03
b
b
.14
b

.07
b
b
.29
b
b
Modified/
Reconstructed
facilities

SIP
.12
.21
b

.03
b
b
.21
b

.06
b
.63
.70
b
b
 Impacts calculated on the basis of retail  list price of $38.33 per
bshelf, and $52.50 per chair.
 No impacts involved.
                                    E-18

-------
 coatings  at a thickness  of 6.35 x 10"3 cm (2.5 mil).   The worst-case impact
 for Plant E is about 1.3 percent.   However,  if the coating thickness is
                     _2
 changed to 3.81 x  10  cm (1.5  mil),  the  worst-case impact for Plant E is
 the waterborne control option,   Unde^ this  control  option,  the wholesale
 pi-ice  increases by about 0.70 percent.  Tables E-ll through E-16  show
 additional  information for profit impact, profit  impairment,  and  inflation
 impact employing the Different  film thicknesses arid transfer  efficiency
 values.   The  only  control  option to change  significantly  is the powder
 option,   in  a!"!  cases  for  powder the  -impacts  indicated  significant
 improvement  over Chapter 7 information.
 E.2 SOLID WASTE DATA
     This  section  covers  Issue  4.   Data reported  in Table 6-7  of  the  BID
 have been  questioned by  an industry representative.  However,  the
 variability of  the  data  presented  in Table 6-7 is due to the assumed
 transfer efficiencies  for  solvent-borne, high  solids, and waterborne
 coatings and to  the  powder utilization efficiencies and film thickness.
 Regardless of how the transfer  efficiencies are changed, the conclusion
 of  the solid waste  impact  reported  in Chapter 6 remains unchanged.
 E.3  SPRAY BOOTH VENTILATION RATES
     Another industry representative has questioned calculated application
 exhaust flow rates in areas that apply high solids and waterborne coatings,
 stating that these flow rates are fixed by OSHA regulations.7  However,
 as  shown in the following excerpt, this OSHA regulation allows a range of
 flow rates, and the second part of the regulation allows reduction of
flow rates because of quantity of "solids  and nonflammables contained in
the finish":
          "(6) Velocity and air  flow requirements.
          (i)  Except where a spray booth  has an adequate air replacement
     system,  the velocity of air into  all  openings of a spray booth  shall
     be not less than that specified in Table G-10 for the operating
     conditions specified.   An adequate air  replacement system is  one
     which introduces replacement air  upstream or  above the object
     being sprayed and is so designed  that the velocity of air in
     the booth cross section is  not less than that specified in
     Table G-10 when measured upstream or  above the object being
     sprayed.
                                 E-19

-------
           Table G-10—Minimum Maintained Velocities Into Spray Booths
Operating conditions for
objects completely inside
          booth
Cross draft, f.p.m.
                    Air flow velocities, f.p.m.
                      Design
Range
Electrostatic and automatic   Negligible.
  airless operating con-
  tained in booth without
  operator.
Air-operated guns, manual or  Up to 50.
  automatic
                  ,  50 large booth...  50-250
                   100 small booth...  75-125
                   100 large booth...  75-125
                   150 small booth... 125-175
Air-operated guns, manual or  Up to 100	 150 large booth... 125-175
  automatic                                      200 small booth... 150-250
Notes:
  (1) Attention is invited to the fact that the effectiveness of the spray
booth is dependent upon the relationship of the depth of the booth to its
height and width.
  (2) Crossdrafts can be eliminated through proper design and such design
should be sought.  Crossdrafts in excess of 100 fpm (feet per minute) should
not be permitted.
  (3) Excessive air pressures result in loss of both efficiency and material
waste in addition to creating a backlash that may carry overspray and fumes
into adjacent work areas.
  (4) Booths should be designed with velocities shown in the column headed
"Design".  However, booths operating with velocities shown in the column
headed "Range" are in compliance with this standard.

          (ii) In addition to the requirements in subdivision (i) of
     this subparagraph the total air volume exhausted through a spray
     booth shall be such as to dilute solvent vapor to at least
     25 percent of the lower explosive limit of the solvent being
     sprayed.  An example of the method of calculating this volume is
     given below . . . ."Note that the quantity of  solvent will be
     diminished by the quantity of solids and nonflammables contained
      in the  finish.

          "To determine  the volume of air in cubic  feet necessary to
     dilute  the vapor from 1 gallon of solvent to 25 percent of the
      lower explosive limit, apply the following formula:
                                  E-20

-------
n.,  ..     ,                    4(100-LEL)(cubic feet of vapor per gallon)
Dilution volume required per =  -		
  gallon of solvent
Using toluene as the solvent.
  (1) LEL of toluene ... is 1.4 percent.
  (2) Cubic feet of vapor per gallon ... is 30.4 cubic feet per gallon
  (3) Dilution volume required =

      4 (100-1.4) 30.4   n „,   ..  .  ^ „
      	5-4	8,564 cubic feet."


The reduced exhaust flow rates from the coating application area are
also supported by coating line designers contacted during the development
of the BID.
                                E-21

-------
                      REFERENCES FOR APPENDIX E

1.    Ramig, Alexander.  Rebuttal presentation concerning industrial surface
     coating of metal furniture.  Glidden Coatings and Resins Division.
     Strongsville, Ohio.  NAPCTAC meeting.  Raleigh, North Carolina.
     February 27, 1980.

2.    Lissy, Gus.  Rebuttal presentation concerning industrial surface
     coating of metal furniture.  Nordson Company.  Amherst, Ohio.  NAPCTAC
     meeting.  Raleigh, North Carolina.   February 27, 1980.

3.    Letter from Cole, G. E. , Dr., GCA Associates, Greenwich, Connecticut,
     to D. R. Goodwin, U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency, Research
     Triangle Park,  North Carolina.  January 18, 1980.  Draft -  Surface
     Coating of Metal  Furniture - Background Information for Proposed
     Standards.

4.   Letter from Cole, G. E., Dr., GCA Associates, Greenwich, Connecticut,
     to J. R. Farmer,  U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,  Research Triangle
     Park, North Carolina.   February 23,  1980.   Concerning changes made  to
     the  BID.

5.   Letter  from  Rothschild, M. V.,  Reliance Powder Products,  Inc., Tinley
     Park, Illinois, to  D.  R. Goodwin, U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,
     Research Triangle Park, North  Carolina.   February  26, 1980.  Concerning
     the  draft  BID.

6.   Letter  from  Scattoloni, T. J.,  Armstrong Products  Company,  Warsaw,
     Indiana,  to  D.  R.  Goodwin, U.S. Environmental  Protection  Agency,
     Research  Triangle Park, North  Carolina.   March 4,  1980.   Concerning
     the  draft  BID.

7.   Speir,  C.   Rebuttal  presentation  concerning industrial surface coating
     of metal  furniture.   Lyon  Metal Products, Inc.   Aurora, Illinois.
      NAPCTAC meeting.  Raleigh, North  Carolina.   February 27,  1980.

8.   Occupational  Safety and Health Administration.   29 CFR 1910.94.
     Washington,  D.C.  U.S. Government Printing Office.  1979.
                                   E-22

-------
                                    TECHNICAL REPORT DATA
                             (Please read Instructions on the reverse before completing)
 1. REPORT NO.
  EPA-450/3-80-007a
 4. TITLE AND SUBTITLE
  Surface  Coating of Metal  Furniture - Background
    Information for Proposed  Standards
                                                             3. RECIPIENT'S ACCESSION NO.
                                                             5. REPORT DATE
                             1 QRf)
              6. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION CODE
 7. AUTHOR(S)
                                                             8. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION REPORT NO
 9. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION NAME AND ADDRESS

  Office of Air Quality Planning  and Standards
  U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency
  Research  Triangle Park, NC 27711
              10. PROGRAM ELEMENT NO.
              11. CONTRACT/GRANT NO.
 12. SPONSORING AGENCY NAME AND ADDRESS
  DAA for Air  Quality Planning and  Standards
  Office of Air,  Noise, and Radiation
  U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency
  Research Triangle Park, NC 27711	
              13. TYPE OF REPORT AND PERIOD COVERED

                  Final
              14. SPONSORING AGENCY CODE
                  EPA  200/04
 15. SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
       Standards  of performance to  control  emissions  of volatile organic  compounds
  (VOC) from new, modified, and reconstructed metal furniture surface  coating
  facilities are  being proposed under Section 111 of  the Clean Air Act.   This
  document contains information on  the background and  authority, regulatory
  alternatives considered, and environmental  and economic impacts of the  regulatory
  alternatives.
                                KEY WORDS AND DOCUMENT ANALYSIS
                  DESCRIPTORS
                                               b.lDENTIFIERS/OPEN ENDED TERMS
                                                                             COSATl Field/Group
 Air  Pollution
 Metal  Furniture
 Pollution Control
 Standards of Performance
 Surface Coating Operations
 Volatile Organic Compounds (VOC)
  Air Pollution Control
13B
                "EMEf
 Unlimited
                                               19. SECURITY CLASS (This Report)
                                                 Unclassified
                            21. NO. OF PAGES
20. SECURITY CLASS (This page)

  Unclassified
                                                                          22. PRICE
EPA Form 2220-1 (Rev. 4-77)   PREVIOUS EDITION is OBSOLETE

-------
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency

Regwn 5.Library JPH»       -_
77 West Jackson Boulevard, iztti rwar
Chicago, II  60604-3590

-------